Star wildcard ranges (e.g., "info thread 2.*")
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2662 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2663 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2664 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2665 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2666 information on convenience variables.
2667
2668 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2669 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2670 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2671 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2672 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2673 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2674
2675 @table @code
2676 @kindex add-inferior
2677 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2678 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2679 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2680 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2681 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2682 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2683
2684 @kindex clone-inferior
2685 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2686 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2687 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2688 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2689 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2690
2691 @smallexample
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2695 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2696 Added inferior 2.
2697 1 inferiors added.
2698 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2699 Num Description Executable
2700 2 <null> helloworld
2701 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2705
2706 @kindex remove-inferiors
2707 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2708 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2709 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2710 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2711
2712 @end table
2713
2714 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2715 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2716 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2717 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2721 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2723 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2724 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2725 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2726
2727 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2728 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2730 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2731 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2732 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2736 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2737 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2738 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2739
2740
2741 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2742 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex set print inferior-events
2746 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2747 @item set print inferior-events
2748 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2750 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2751 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2752 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2753 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2754
2755 @kindex show print inferior-events
2756 @item show print inferior-events
2757 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2758 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2759 @end table
2760
2761 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2762 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2763 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2764
2765
2766 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2767 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2768 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2769 info program-spaces}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2773 @item maint info program-spaces
2774 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2775 @value{GDBN}.
2776
2777 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2778
2779 @enumerate
2780 @item
2781 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2782
2783 @item
2784 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2785 the @code{file} command.
2786
2787 @end enumerate
2788
2789 @noindent
2790 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2791 indicates the current program space.
2792
2793 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2794 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2795 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2796
2797 @smallexample
2798 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2799 Id Executable
2800 * 1 hello
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 @end smallexample
2804
2805 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2806 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2807 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2808 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2809 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2810
2811 @smallexample
2812 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2813 Id Executable
2814 * 1 vfork-test
2815 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2819 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2820 @end table
2821
2822 @node Threads
2823 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2824
2825 @cindex threads of execution
2826 @cindex multiple threads
2827 @cindex switching threads
2828 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2829 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2830 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2831 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2832 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2833 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2834 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2835
2836 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2837 programs:
2838
2839 @itemize @bullet
2840 @item automatic notification of new threads
2841 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2842 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2843 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2844 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2845 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2846 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2847 messages on thread start and exit.
2848 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2849 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2850 isn't compatible with the program.
2851 @end itemize
2852
2853 @cindex focus of debugging
2854 @cindex current thread
2855 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2856 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2857 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2858 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2859 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2860
2861 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2862 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2863 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2864 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2865 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2866 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2867 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2868 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2869 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2870 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2871
2872 @smallexample
2873 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2874 @end smallexample
2875
2876 @noindent
2877 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2878 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2879 further qualifier.
2880
2881 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2882 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2883 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2884 @c program?
2885 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2886 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2887 @c threads ab initio?
2888
2889 @anchor{thread numbers}
2890 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2891 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2892 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2893 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2894 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2895 between threads of different inferiors.
2896
2897 @cindex qualified thread ID
2898 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2899 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2900 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2901 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2902 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2903 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2904 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2905 inferior.
2906
2907 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2908 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2909 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2910 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2911
2912 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2913 @cindex thread ID lists
2914 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2915 argument. A list element can be:
2916
2917 @enumerate
2918 @item
2919 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2920 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2921 @samp{1}.
2922
2923 @item
2924 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2925 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2926 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2927
2928 @item
2929 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2930 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2931 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2932 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2933 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2934
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2938 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2939 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2940 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2941 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2942 7.1}.
2943
2944
2945 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2946 @cindex global thread number
2947 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2948 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2949 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2950 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2951 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2952 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2953
2954 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2955 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2956 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2957
2958 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2959 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2960 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2961 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2962 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2963 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2964 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2965 general information on convenience variables.
2966
2967 @table @code
2968 @kindex info threads
2969 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2970
2971 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2972 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2973 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2974 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2975
2976 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2977
2978 @enumerate
2979 @item
2980 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2981
2982 @item
2983 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
2984 option was specified
2985
2986 @item
2987 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2988
2989 @item
2990 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2991 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2992 program itself.
2993
2994 @item
2995 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2996 @end enumerate
2997
2998 @noindent
2999 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3000 indicates the current thread.
3001
3002 For example,
3003 @end table
3004 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3005
3006 @smallexample
3007 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3008 Id Target Id Frame
3009 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3010 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3011 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3012 at threadtest.c:68
3013 @end smallexample
3014
3015 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3016 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3017 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3018
3019 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3020 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3021
3022 @smallexample
3023 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3024 Id GId Target Id Frame
3025 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3026 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3027 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3028 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3032 Solaris-specific command:
3033
3034 @table @code
3035 @item maint info sol-threads
3036 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3037 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3038 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3039 @end table
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3043 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3044 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3045 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3046 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3047 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3048
3049 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3050 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3051
3052 @smallexample
3053 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3054 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3055 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3056 8 printf ("hello\n");
3057 @end smallexample
3058
3059 @noindent
3060 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3061 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3062 threads.
3063
3064 @kindex thread apply
3065 @cindex apply command to several threads
3066 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3067 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3068 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3069 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3070 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3071 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3072 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3073 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3074
3075
3076 @kindex thread name
3077 @cindex name a thread
3078 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3079 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3080 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3081 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3082
3083 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3084 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3085 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3086 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3087 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3088
3089 @kindex thread find
3090 @cindex search for a thread
3091 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3092 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3093 matches the supplied regular expression.
3094
3095 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3096 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3097 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3098 is the LWP id.
3099
3100 @smallexample
3101 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3102 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3103 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3104 Id Target Id Frame
3105 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3106 @end smallexample
3107
3108 @kindex set print thread-events
3109 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3110 @item set print thread-events
3111 @itemx set print thread-events on
3112 @itemx set print thread-events off
3113 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3114 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3115 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3116 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3117 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3118
3119 @kindex show print thread-events
3120 @item show print thread-events
3121 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3122 have started and exited.
3123 @end table
3124
3125 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3126 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3127 programs with multiple threads.
3128
3129 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3130 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3131
3132 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3133 @table @code
3134 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3135 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3136 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3137 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3138 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3139 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3140 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3141 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3142 macro.
3143
3144 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3145 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3146 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3147 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3148 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3149 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3150
3151 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3152 refers to the default system directories that are
3153 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3154 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3155 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3156
3157 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3158 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3159 was loaded in the inferior process.
3160
3161 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3162 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3163 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3164 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3165 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3166 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3167 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3168
3169 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3170 only on some platforms.
3171
3172 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3173 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3174 Display current libthread_db search path.
3175
3176 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3177 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3178 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3179 @item set debug libthread-db
3180 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3181 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3182 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3183 @end table
3184
3185 @node Forks
3186 @section Debugging Forks
3187
3188 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3189 @cindex multiple processes
3190 @cindex processes, multiple
3191 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3192 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3193 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3194 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3195 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3196 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3197 will cause it to terminate.
3198
3199 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3200 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3201 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3202 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3203 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3204 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3205 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3206 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3207 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3208 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3209
3210 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3211 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3212 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3213 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3214
3215 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3216 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3217 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3218
3219 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3220 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3221
3222 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3223 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3224
3225 @table @code
3226 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3227 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3228 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3229 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3230 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3231
3232 @table @code
3233 @item parent
3234 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3235 unimpeded. This is the default.
3236
3237 @item child
3238 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3239 unimpeded.
3240
3241 @end table
3242
3243 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3244 @item show follow-fork-mode
3245 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3246 @end table
3247
3248 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3249 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3250 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3251
3252 @table @code
3253 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3254 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3255 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3256 retain debugger control over them both.
3257
3258 @table @code
3259 @item on
3260 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3261 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3262 independently. This is the default.
3263
3264 @item off
3265 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3266 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3267 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3268 is held suspended.
3269
3270 @end table
3271
3272 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3273 @item show detach-on-fork
3274 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3275 @end table
3276
3277 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3278 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3279 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3280 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3281 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3282 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3283
3284 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3285 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3286 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3287 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3288 and Programs}.
3289
3290 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3291 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3292 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3293 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3294 the child process's @code{main}.
3295
3296 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3297 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3298
3299 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3300 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3301 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3302 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3303 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3304 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3305 command.
3306
3307 @table @code
3308 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3309 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3310
3311 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3312 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3313
3314 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3315
3316 @table @code
3317 @item new
3318 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3319 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3320 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3321 original inferior.
3322
3323 For example:
3324
3325 @smallexample
3326 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3327 (gdb) info inferior
3328 Id Description Executable
3329 * 1 <null> prog1
3330 (@value{GDBP}) run
3331 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3332 Program exited normally.
3333 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3334 Id Description Executable
3335 1 <null> prog1
3336 * 2 <null> prog2
3337 @end smallexample
3338
3339 @item same
3340 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3341 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3342 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3343 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3344 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3345
3346 For example:
3347
3348 @smallexample
3349 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3350 Id Description Executable
3351 * 1 <null> prog1
3352 (@value{GDBP}) run
3353 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3354 Program exited normally.
3355 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3356 Id Description Executable
3357 * 1 <null> prog2
3358 @end smallexample
3359
3360 @end table
3361 @end table
3362
3363 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3364 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3365
3366 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3367 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3368 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3369
3370 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3371 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3372
3373 @cindex checkpoint
3374 @cindex restart
3375 @cindex bookmark
3376 @cindex snapshot of a process
3377 @cindex rewind program state
3378
3379 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3380 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3381 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3382 later.
3383
3384 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3385 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3386 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3387 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3388 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3389
3390 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3391 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3392 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3393 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3394 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3395 start again from there.
3396
3397 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3398 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3399
3400 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3401
3402 @table @code
3403 @kindex checkpoint
3404 @item checkpoint
3405 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3406 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3407 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3408
3409 @kindex info checkpoints
3410 @item info checkpoints
3411 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3412 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3413 listed:
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @item Checkpoint ID
3417 @item Process ID
3418 @item Code Address
3419 @item Source line, or label
3420 @end table
3421
3422 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3423 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3424 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3425 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3426 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3427 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3428 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3429
3430 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3431 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3432 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3433 the debugger.
3434
3435 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3436 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3437 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3442 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3443 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3444 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3445 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3446 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3447 previously read data can be read again.
3448
3449 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3450 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3451 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3452 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3453 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3454 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3455
3456 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3457 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3458 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3459 different execution path this time.
3460
3461 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3462 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3463 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3464 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3465 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3466 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3467 potentially pose a problem.
3468
3469 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3470
3471 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3472 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3473 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3474 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3475 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3476 next.
3477
3478 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3479 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3480 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3481 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3482 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3483
3484 @node Stopping
3485 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3486
3487 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3488 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3489 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3490
3491 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3492 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3493 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3494 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3495 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3496 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3497 explicitly request this information at any time.
3498
3499 @table @code
3500 @kindex info program
3501 @item info program
3502 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3503 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3504 @end table
3505
3506 @menu
3507 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3508 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3509 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3510 Skipping over functions and files
3511 * Signals:: Signals
3512 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3513 @end menu
3514
3515 @node Breakpoints
3516 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3517
3518 @cindex breakpoints
3519 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3520 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3521 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3522 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3523 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3524 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3525 program.
3526
3527 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3528 the executable is run.
3529
3530 @cindex watchpoints
3531 @cindex data breakpoints
3532 @cindex memory tracing
3533 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3534 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3535 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3536 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3537 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3538 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3539 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3540 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3541 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3542 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3543 same commands.
3544
3545 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3546 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3547 Automatic Display}.
3548
3549 @cindex catchpoints
3550 @cindex breakpoint on events
3551 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3552 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3553 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3554 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3555 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3556 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3557 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3558
3559 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3560 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3561 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3562 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3563 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3564 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3565 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3566 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3567 enable it again.
3568
3569 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3570 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3571 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3572 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3573 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3574 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3575 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3576
3577 @menu
3578 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3579 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3580 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3581 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3582 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3583 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3584 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3585 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3586 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3587 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3588 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3589 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3590 @end menu
3591
3592 @node Set Breaks
3593 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3594
3595 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3596 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3597 @c
3598 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3599
3600 @kindex break
3601 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3602 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3603 @cindex latest breakpoint
3604 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3605 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3606 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3607 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3608 convenience variables.
3609
3610 @table @code
3611 @item break @var{location}
3612 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3613 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3614 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3615 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3616 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3617
3618 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3619 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3620 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3621 that situation.
3622
3623 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3624 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3625 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3626
3627 @item break
3628 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3629 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3630 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3631 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3632 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3633 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3634 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3635 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3636 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3637 inside loops.
3638
3639 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3640 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3641 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3642 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3643 existed when your program stopped.
3644
3645 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3646 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3647 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3648 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3649 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3650 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3651 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3652
3653 @kindex tbreak
3654 @item tbreak @var{args}
3655 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3656 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3657 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3658 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3659
3660 @kindex hbreak
3661 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3662 @item hbreak @var{args}
3663 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3664 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3665 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3666 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3667 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3668 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3669 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3670 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3671 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3672 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3673 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3674 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3675 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3676 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3677 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3678 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3679 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3680 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3681
3682 @kindex thbreak
3683 @item thbreak @var{args}
3684 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3685 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3686 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3687 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3688 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3689 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3690 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3691 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3692
3693 @kindex rbreak
3694 @cindex regular expression
3695 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3696 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3697 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3698 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3699 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3700 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3701 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3702 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3703 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3704
3705 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3706 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3707 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3708 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3709 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3710 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3711
3712 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3713 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3714 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3715 classes.
3716
3717 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3718 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3719 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3720
3721 @smallexample
3722 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3723 @end smallexample
3724
3725 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3726 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3727 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3728 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3729 every function in a given file:
3730
3731 @smallexample
3732 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3736 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3737
3738 @kindex info breakpoints
3739 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3740 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3741 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3742 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3743 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3744 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3745 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3746
3747 @table @emph
3748 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3749 @item Type
3750 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3751 @item Disposition
3752 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3753 @item Enabled or Disabled
3754 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3755 that are not enabled.
3756 @item Address
3757 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3758 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3759 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3760 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3761 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3762 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3763 @item What
3764 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3765 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3766 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3767 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3768 @end table
3769
3770 @noindent
3771 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3772 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3773 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3774 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3775 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3776 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3777
3778 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3779 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3780 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3781 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3782
3783 @noindent
3784 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3785 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3786 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3787 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3788 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3789
3790 @noindent
3791 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3792 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3793 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3794 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3795 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3796 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @noindent
3799 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3800 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3801
3802 @end table
3803
3804 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3805 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3806 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3807 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3808
3809 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3810 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3811 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3812 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3813
3814 @itemize @bullet
3815 @item
3816 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3817
3818 @item
3819 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3820 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3821
3822 @item
3823 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3824 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3825
3826 @item
3827 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3828 several places where that function is inlined.
3829 @end itemize
3830
3831 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3832 the relevant locations.
3833
3834 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3835 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3836 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3837 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3838 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3839 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3840 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3841
3842 For example:
3843
3844 @smallexample
3845 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3846 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3847 stop only if i==1
3848 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3849 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3850 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3851 @end smallexample
3852
3853 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3854 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3855 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3856 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3857 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3858 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3859 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3860 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3861 that belong to that breakpoint.
3862
3863 @cindex pending breakpoints
3864 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3865 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3866 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3867 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3868 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3869 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3870 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3871 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3872 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3873 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3874 is not yet resolved.
3875
3876 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3877 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3878 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3879 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3880 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3881 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3882
3883 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3884 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3885 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3886 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3887
3888 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3889 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3890 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3891
3892 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3893 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3894 address specification to an address:
3895
3896 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3897 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3898 @table @code
3899 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3900 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3901 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3902
3903 @item set breakpoint pending on
3904 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3905 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3906
3907 @item set breakpoint pending off
3908 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3909 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3910 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3911
3912 @item show breakpoint pending
3913 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3914 @end table
3915
3916 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3917 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3918 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3919
3920 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3921 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3922 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3923 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3924 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3925 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3926 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3927 breakpoints.
3928
3929 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3930
3931 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3932 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3933 @table @code
3934 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3935 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3936 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3937 breakpoint must be used.
3938
3939 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3940 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3941 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3942 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3943 @end table
3944
3945 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3946 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3947 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3948 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3949 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3950 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3951 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3952 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3953 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3954
3955 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3956 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3957 @table @code
3958 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3959 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3960 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3961 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3962
3963 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3964 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3965 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3966 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3967 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3968 @end table
3969
3970 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3971 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3972 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3973
3974 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3975 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3976
3977 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3978
3979 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3980 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3981 @table @code
3982 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3983 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3984 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3985 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3986 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3987
3988 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3989 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3990 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3991 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3992 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3993 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3994 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3995 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3996 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3997 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3998 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3999 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4000 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4001
4002 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4003 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4004 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4005 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4006 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4007 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4008 @end table
4009
4010
4011 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4012 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4013 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4014 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4015 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4016 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4017 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4018 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4019
4020
4021 @node Set Watchpoints
4022 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4023
4024 @cindex setting watchpoints
4025 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4026 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4027 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4028 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4029 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4030
4031 @itemize @bullet
4032 @item
4033 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4034
4035 @item
4036 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4037 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4038 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4039
4040 @item
4041 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4042 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4043 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4044 @end itemize
4045
4046 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4047 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4048 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4049 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4050 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4051 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4052 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4053 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4054 the expression changes.
4055
4056 @cindex software watchpoints
4057 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4058 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4059 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4060 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4061 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4062 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4063 culprit.)
4064
4065 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4066 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4067 slow down the running of your program.
4068
4069 @table @code
4070 @kindex watch
4071 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4072 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4073 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4074 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4075 to watch the value of a single variable:
4076
4077 @smallexample
4078 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4079 @end smallexample
4080
4081 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4082 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4083 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4084 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4085 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4086 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4087
4088 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4089 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4090 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4091 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4092 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4093 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4094 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4095 error.
4096
4097 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4098 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4099 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4100 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4101 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4102 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4103 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4104 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4105 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4106 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4107 Examples:
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4111 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4112 @end smallexample
4113
4114 @kindex rwatch
4115 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4116 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4117 by the program.
4118
4119 @kindex awatch
4120 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4121 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4122 or written into by the program.
4123
4124 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4125 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4126 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4127 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4128 @end table
4129
4130 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4131 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4132 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4133 a never-changing value:
4134
4135 @smallexample
4136 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4137 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4138 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4139 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4140 @end smallexample
4141
4142 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4143 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4144 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4145 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4146 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4147 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4148
4149 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4150 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4151 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4152 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4153 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4154 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4155 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4156 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4157
4158 @table @code
4159 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4160 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4161 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4162
4163 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4164 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4165 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4166 @end table
4167
4168 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4169 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4170 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4171
4172 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4173
4174 @smallexample
4175 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4176 @end smallexample
4177
4178 @noindent
4179 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4180
4181 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4182 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4183 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4184 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4185 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4186 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4187 will print a message like this:
4188
4189 @smallexample
4190 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4191 @end smallexample
4192
4193 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4194 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4195 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4196 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4197 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4198 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4199 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4200 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4201
4202 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4203 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4204 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4205 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4206 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4207 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4208
4209 @smallexample
4210 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4211 @end smallexample
4212
4213 @noindent
4214 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4215
4216 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4217 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4218 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4219 expression with separately allocated resources.
4220
4221 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4222 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4223 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4224
4225 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4226 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4227 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4228 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4229 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4230 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4231 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4232 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4233 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4234
4235 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4236 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4237 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4238 watched expression from every thread.
4239
4240 @quotation
4241 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4242 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4243 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4244 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4245 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4246 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4247 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4248 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4249 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4250 @end quotation
4251
4252 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4253
4254 @node Set Catchpoints
4255 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4256 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4257 @cindex exception handlers
4258 @cindex event handling
4259
4260 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4261 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4262 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4263
4264 @table @code
4265 @kindex catch
4266 @item catch @var{event}
4267 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4268
4269 @table @code
4270 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4271 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4272 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4273 @kindex catch throw
4274 @kindex catch rethrow
4275 @kindex catch catch
4276 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4277 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4278
4279 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4280 regular expression will be caught.
4281
4282 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4283 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4284 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4285 exception being thrown.
4286
4287 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4288 @value{GDBN}:
4289
4290 @itemize @bullet
4291 @item
4292 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4293 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4294 supported.
4295
4296 @item
4297 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4298 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4299 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4300 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4301 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4302 built.
4303
4304 @item
4305 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4306 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4307
4308 @item
4309 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4310 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4311 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4312 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4313
4314 @item
4315 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4316 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4317 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4318 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4319 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4320 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4321 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4322 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4323 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4324
4325 @item
4326 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4327
4328 @item
4329 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4330 @end itemize
4331
4332 @item exception
4333 @kindex catch exception
4334 @cindex Ada exception catching
4335 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4336 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4337 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4338 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4339 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4340
4341 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4342 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4343 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4344 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4345 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4346 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4347 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4348 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4349
4350 @item exception unhandled
4351 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4352 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4353
4354 @item assert
4355 @kindex catch assert
4356 A failed Ada assertion.
4357
4358 @item exec
4359 @kindex catch exec
4360 @cindex break on fork/exec
4361 A call to @code{exec}.
4362
4363 @item syscall
4364 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4365 @kindex catch syscall
4366 @cindex break on a system call.
4367 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4368 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4369 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4370 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4371 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4372 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4373 will be caught.
4374
4375 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4376 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4377 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4378 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4379
4380 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4381 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4382 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4383 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4384
4385 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4386 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4387 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4388 available choices.
4389
4390 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4391 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4392 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4393 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4394 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4395 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4396 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4397 behind the OS upgrades).
4398
4399 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4400 arguments to it:
4401
4402 @smallexample
4403 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4404 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4405 (@value{GDBP}) r
4406 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4407
4408 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4409 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4410 (@value{GDBP}) c
4411 Continuing.
4412
4413 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4414 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4415 (@value{GDBP})
4416 @end smallexample
4417
4418 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4419
4420 @smallexample
4421 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4422 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4423 (@value{GDBP}) r
4424 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4425
4426 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4427 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4428 (@value{GDBP}) c
4429 Continuing.
4430
4431 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4432 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4433 (@value{GDBP})
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4437 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4438 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4439
4440 @smallexample
4441 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4442 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4443 (@value{GDBP}) r
4444 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4445
4446 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4447 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4448 (@value{GDBP}) c
4449 Continuing.
4450
4451 Program exited normally.
4452 (@value{GDBP})
4453 @end smallexample
4454
4455 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4456 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4457 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4458 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4459
4460 @smallexample
4461 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4462 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4463 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4464 (@value{GDBP})
4465 @end smallexample
4466
4467 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4468 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4469 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4470 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4471 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4472 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4473
4474 @smallexample
4475 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4476 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4477 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4478 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4479 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4480 (@value{GDBP})
4481 @end smallexample
4482
4483 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4484
4485 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4486 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4487
4488 @smallexample
4489 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4490 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4491 @end smallexample
4492
4493 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4494
4495 @item fork
4496 @kindex catch fork
4497 A call to @code{fork}.
4498
4499 @item vfork
4500 @kindex catch vfork
4501 A call to @code{vfork}.
4502
4503 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4504 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4505 @kindex catch load
4506 @kindex catch unload
4507 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4508 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4509 matches one of the affected libraries.
4510
4511 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4512 @kindex catch signal
4513 The delivery of a signal.
4514
4515 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4516 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4517 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4518
4519 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4520 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4521 signal names.
4522
4523 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4524 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4525 will be caught.
4526
4527 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4528 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4529 catchpoint.
4530
4531 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4532 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4533 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4534 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4535 commands.
4536
4537 @end table
4538
4539 @item tcatch @var{event}
4540 @kindex tcatch
4541 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4542 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4543
4544 @end table
4545
4546 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4547
4548
4549 @node Delete Breaks
4550 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4551
4552 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4553 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4554 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4555 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4556 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4557 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4558
4559 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4560 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4561 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4562 their breakpoint numbers.
4563
4564 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4565 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4566 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4567
4568 @table @code
4569 @kindex clear
4570 @item clear
4571 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4572 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4573 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4574 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4575
4576 @item clear @var{location}
4577 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4578 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4579 most useful ones are listed below:
4580
4581 @table @code
4582 @item clear @var{function}
4583 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4584 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4585
4586 @item clear @var{linenum}
4587 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4588 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4589 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4590 @end table
4591
4592 @cindex delete breakpoints
4593 @kindex delete
4594 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4595 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4596 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4597 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4598 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4599 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4600 @end table
4601
4602 @node Disabling
4603 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4604
4605 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4606 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4607 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4608 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4609 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4610
4611 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4612 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4613 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4614 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4615 do not know which numbers to use.
4616
4617 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4618 affects all of its locations.
4619
4620 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4621 different states of enablement:
4622
4623 @itemize @bullet
4624 @item
4625 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4626 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4627 @item
4628 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4629 @item
4630 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4631 disabled.
4632 @item
4633 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4634 N times, then becomes disabled.
4635 @item
4636 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4637 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4638 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4639 @end itemize
4640
4641 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4642 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4643
4644 @table @code
4645 @kindex disable
4646 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4647 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4648 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4649 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4650 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4651 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4652 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4653
4654 @kindex enable
4655 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4656 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4657 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4658
4659 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4660 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4661 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4662
4663 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4664 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4665 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4666 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4667 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4668 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4669 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4670
4671 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4672 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4673 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4674 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4675 @end table
4676
4677 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4678 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4679 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4680 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4681 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4682 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4683 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4684 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4685 Stepping}.)
4686
4687 @node Conditions
4688 @subsection Break Conditions
4689 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4690 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4691
4692 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4693 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4694 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4695 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4696 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4697 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4698 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4699 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4700
4701 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4702 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4703 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4704 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4705 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4706
4707 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4708 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4709 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4710 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4711 one.
4712
4713 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4714 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4715 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4716 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4717 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4718 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4719 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4720 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4721 conditions for the
4722 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4723 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4724
4725 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4726 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4727 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4728 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4729 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4730 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4731
4732 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4733 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4734 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4735 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4736 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4737
4738 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4739 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4740 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4741 with the @code{condition} command.
4742
4743 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4744 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4745 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4746 catchpoint.
4747
4748 @table @code
4749 @kindex condition
4750 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4751 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4752 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4753 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4754 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4755 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4756 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4757 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4758 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4759 prints an error message:
4760
4761 @smallexample
4762 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4763 @end smallexample
4764
4765 @noindent
4766 @value{GDBN} does
4767 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4768 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4769 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4770
4771 @item condition @var{bnum}
4772 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4773 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4774 @end table
4775
4776 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4777 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4778 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4779 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4780 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4781 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4782 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4783 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4784 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4785 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4786 your program reaches it.
4787
4788 @table @code
4789 @kindex ignore
4790 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4791 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4792 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4793 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4794 takes no action.
4795
4796 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4797 a count of zero.
4798
4799 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4800 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4801 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4802 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4803
4804 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4805 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4806 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4807
4808 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4809 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4810 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4811 Variables}.
4812 @end table
4813
4814 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4815
4816
4817 @node Break Commands
4818 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4819
4820 @cindex breakpoint commands
4821 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4822 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4823 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4824 enable other breakpoints.
4825
4826 @table @code
4827 @kindex commands
4828 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4829 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4830 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4831 @itemx end
4832 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4833 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4834 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4835
4836 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4837 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4838
4839 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4840 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4841 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4842 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4843 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4844 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4845 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4846 Expressions}).
4847 @end table
4848
4849 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4850 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4851
4852 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4853 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4854 that resumes execution.
4855
4856 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4857 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4858 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4859 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4860 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4861
4862 @kindex silent
4863 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4864 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4865 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4866 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4867 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4868 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4869
4870 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4871 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4872 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4873
4874 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4875 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4876
4877 @smallexample
4878 break foo if x>0
4879 commands
4880 silent
4881 printf "x is %d\n",x
4882 cont
4883 end
4884 @end smallexample
4885
4886 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4887 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4888 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4889 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4890 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4891 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4892 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4893
4894 @smallexample
4895 break 403
4896 commands
4897 silent
4898 set x = y + 4
4899 cont
4900 end
4901 @end smallexample
4902
4903 @node Dynamic Printf
4904 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4905
4906 @cindex dynamic printf
4907 @cindex dprintf
4908 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4909 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4910 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4911 having to recompile it.
4912
4913 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4914 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4915 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4916 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4917 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4918 redirects to files and so forth.
4919
4920 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4921 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4922 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4923 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4924 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4925 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4926 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4927
4928 @table @code
4929 @kindex dprintf
4930 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4931 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4932 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4933 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4934
4935 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4936 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4937 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4938 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4939 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4940 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4941
4942 @item gdb
4943 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4944 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4945
4946 @item call
4947 @kindex dprintf-style call
4948 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4949 @code{printf}).
4950
4951 @item agent
4952 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4953 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4954 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4955 support running commands on the target.
4956
4957 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4958 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4959 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4960 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4961 command.
4962
4963 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4964 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4965 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4966 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4967 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4968 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4969
4970 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4971 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4972 you could do the following:
4973
4974 @example
4975 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4976 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4977 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4978 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4979 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4980 (gdb) info break
4981 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4982 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4983 continue
4984 (gdb)
4985 @end example
4986
4987 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4988 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4989 the variable settings.
4990
4991 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4992 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4993 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4994 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4995 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4996 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4997
4998 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4999 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5000 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5001
5002 @end table
5003
5004 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5005 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5006 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5007 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5008 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5009 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5010
5011 @node Save Breakpoints
5012 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5013
5014 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5015 breakpoints}} command.
5016
5017 @table @code
5018 @kindex save breakpoints
5019 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5020 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5021 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5022 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5023 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5024 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5025 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5026 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5027 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5028 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5029 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5030 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5031 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5032 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5033 that can no longer be recreated.
5034 @end table
5035
5036 @node Static Probe Points
5037 @subsection Static Probe Points
5038
5039 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5040 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5041 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5042 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5043 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5044
5045 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5046 ELF-compatible systems:
5047
5048 @itemize @bullet
5049
5050 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5051 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5052 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5053 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5054 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5055 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5056 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5057 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5058
5059 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5060 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5061 C@t{++} languages.
5062 @end itemize
5063
5064 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5065 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5066 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5067 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5068 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5069 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5070 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5071 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5072 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5073
5074 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5075 probes}, with optional arguments:
5076
5077 @table @code
5078 @kindex info probes
5079 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5080 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5081 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5082 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5083
5084 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5085 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5086 probes from all providers are listed.
5087
5088 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5089 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5090 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5091
5092 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5093 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5094 given, all object files are considered.
5095
5096 @item info probes all
5097 List the available static probes, from all types.
5098 @end table
5099
5100 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5101 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5102 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5103 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5104 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5105
5106 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5107 commands, with optional arguments:
5108
5109 @table @code
5110 @kindex enable probes
5111 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5112 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5113 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5114 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5115
5116 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5117 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5118 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5119
5120 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5121 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5122 given, all object files are considered.
5123
5124 @kindex disable probes
5125 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5126 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5127 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5128 @end table
5129
5130 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5131 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5132 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5133 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5134 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5135 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5136 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5137 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5138 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5139 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5140 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5141 at the current probe point.
5142
5143 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5144 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5145 an error message.
5146
5147
5148 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5149 @node Error in Breakpoints
5150 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5151
5152 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5153 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5154
5155 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5156 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5157 @smallexample
5158 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5159 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5160 @end smallexample
5161
5162 @noindent
5163 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5164 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5165 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5166
5167 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5168 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5169
5170 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5171 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5172 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5173
5174 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5175 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5176 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5177 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5178
5179 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5180 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5181 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5182 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5183 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5184 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5185 first in the bundle.
5186
5187 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5188 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5189 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5190 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5191 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5192 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5193 is hit.
5194
5195 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5196 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5197
5198 @smallexample
5199 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5200 @end smallexample
5201
5202 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5203 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5204 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5205 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5206 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5207 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5208 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5209 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5210
5211 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5212 adjusted breakpoints:
5213
5214 @smallexample
5215 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5216 to 0x00010410.
5217 @end smallexample
5218
5219 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5220 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5221 frequently than expected.
5222
5223 @node Continuing and Stepping
5224 @section Continuing and Stepping
5225
5226 @cindex stepping
5227 @cindex continuing
5228 @cindex resuming execution
5229 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5230 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5231 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5232 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5233 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5234 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5235 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5236 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5237 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5238 handlers}).)
5239
5240 @table @code
5241 @kindex continue
5242 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5243 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5244 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5245 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5246 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5247 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5248 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5249 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5250 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5251 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5252
5253 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5254 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5255 @code{continue} is ignored.
5256
5257 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5258 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5259 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5260 @code{continue}.
5261 @end table
5262
5263 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5264 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5265 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5266 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5267
5268 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5269 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5270 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5271 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5272 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5273 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5274
5275 @table @code
5276 @kindex step
5277 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5278 @item step
5279 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5280 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5281 abbreviated @code{s}.
5282
5283 @quotation
5284 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5285 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5286 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5287 @c distinction here.
5288 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5289 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5290 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5291 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5292 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5293 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5294 below.
5295 @end quotation
5296
5297 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5298 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5299 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5300 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5301 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5302 called within the line.
5303
5304 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5305 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5306 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5307 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5308 was any debugging information about the routine.
5309
5310 @item step @var{count}
5311 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5312 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5313 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5314
5315 @kindex next
5316 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5317 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5318 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5319 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5320 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5321 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5322 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5323 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5324
5325 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5326
5327
5328 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5329 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5330 @c
5331 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5332 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5333 @c function are executed without stopping.
5334
5335 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5336 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5337 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5338
5339 @kindex set step-mode
5340 @item set step-mode
5341 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5342 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5343 @itemx set step-mode on
5344 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5345 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5346 information rather than stepping over it.
5347
5348 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5349 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5350 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5351
5352 @item set step-mode off
5353 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5354 debug information. This is the default.
5355
5356 @item show step-mode
5357 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5358 source line debug information.
5359
5360 @kindex finish
5361 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5362 @item finish
5363 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5364 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5365 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5366
5367 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5368 ,Returning from a Function}).
5369
5370 @kindex until
5371 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5372 @cindex run until specified location
5373 @item until
5374 @itemx u
5375 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5376 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5377 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5378 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5379 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5380 than the address of the jump.
5381
5382 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5383 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5384 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5385 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5386 through the next iteration.
5387
5388 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5389 stack frame.
5390
5391 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5392 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5393 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5394 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5395 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5396
5397 @smallexample
5398 (@value{GDBP}) f
5399 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5400 206 expand_input();
5401 (@value{GDBP}) until
5402 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5403 @end smallexample
5404
5405 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5406 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5407 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5408 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5409 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5410 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5411 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5412
5413 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5414 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5415 argument.
5416
5417 @item until @var{location}
5418 @itemx u @var{location}
5419 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5420 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5421 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5422 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5423 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5424 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5425 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5426 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5427 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5428 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5429 invocations have returned.
5430
5431 @smallexample
5432 94 int factorial (int value)
5433 95 @{
5434 96 if (value > 1) @{
5435 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5436 98 @}
5437 99 return (value);
5438 100 @}
5439 @end smallexample
5440
5441
5442 @kindex advance @var{location}
5443 @item advance @var{location}
5444 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5445 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5446 @ref{Specify Location}.
5447 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5448 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5449 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5450 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5451
5452
5453 @kindex stepi
5454 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5455 @item stepi
5456 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5457 @itemx si
5458 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5459
5460 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5461 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5462 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5463 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5464
5465 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5466
5467 @need 750
5468 @kindex nexti
5469 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5470 @item nexti
5471 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5472 @itemx ni
5473 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5474 proceed until the function returns.
5475
5476 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5477
5478 @end table
5479
5480 @anchor{range stepping}
5481 @cindex range stepping
5482 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5483 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5484 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5485 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5486 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5487 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5488 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5489 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5490 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5491 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5492 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5493 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5494 if necessary:
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex set range-stepping
5498 @kindex show range-stepping
5499 @item set range-stepping
5500 @itemx show range-stepping
5501 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5502
5503 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5504 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5505 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5506 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5507 default is @code{on}.
5508
5509 @end table
5510
5511 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5512 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5513 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5514
5515 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5516 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5517 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5518
5519 For example, consider the following C function:
5520
5521 @smallexample
5522 101 int func()
5523 102 @{
5524 103 foo(boring());
5525 104 bar(boring());
5526 105 @}
5527 @end smallexample
5528
5529 @noindent
5530 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5531 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5532 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5533 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5534
5535 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5536 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5537 is called from many places.
5538
5539 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5540 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5541 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5542 @code{foo}.
5543
5544 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5545 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5546
5547 @table @code
5548 @kindex skip function
5549 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5550 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5551 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5552 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5553 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5554
5555 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5556 will be skipped.
5557
5558 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5559 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5560
5561 @kindex skip file
5562 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5563 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5564 will be skipped over when stepping.
5565
5566 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5567 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5568 @end table
5569
5570 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5571 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5572
5573 @table @code
5574 @kindex info skip
5575 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5576 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5577 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5578 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5579
5580 @table @emph
5581 @item Identifier
5582 A number identifying this skip.
5583 @item Type
5584 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5585 @item Enabled or Disabled
5586 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5587 @item Address
5588 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5589 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5590 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5591 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5592 address here.
5593 @item What
5594 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5595 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5596 where it is defined.
5597 @end table
5598
5599 @kindex skip delete
5600 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5601 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5602 skips.
5603
5604 @kindex skip enable
5605 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5606 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5607 skips.
5608
5609 @kindex skip disable
5610 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5611 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5612 skips.
5613
5614 @end table
5615
5616 @node Signals
5617 @section Signals
5618 @cindex signals
5619
5620 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5621 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5622 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5623 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5624 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5625 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5626 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5627 requested an alarm).
5628
5629 @cindex fatal signals
5630 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5631 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5632 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5633 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5634 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5635 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5636
5637 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5638 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5639 signal.
5640
5641 @cindex handling signals
5642 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5643 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5644 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5645 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5646 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5647
5648 @table @code
5649 @kindex info signals
5650 @kindex info handle
5651 @item info signals
5652 @itemx info handle
5653 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5654 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5655 the defined types of signals.
5656
5657 @item info signals @var{sig}
5658 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5659
5660 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5661
5662 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5663 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5664 for details about this command.
5665
5666 @kindex handle
5667 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5668 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5669 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5670 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5671 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5672 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5673 say what change to make.
5674 @end table
5675
5676 @c @group
5677 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5678 Their full names are:
5679
5680 @table @code
5681 @item nostop
5682 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5683 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5684
5685 @item stop
5686 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5687 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5688
5689 @item print
5690 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5691
5692 @item noprint
5693 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5694 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5695
5696 @item pass
5697 @itemx noignore
5698 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5699 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5700 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5701
5702 @item nopass
5703 @itemx ignore
5704 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5705 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5706 @end table
5707 @c @end group
5708
5709 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5710 program until you
5711 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5712 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5713 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5714 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5715 program sees that signal when you continue.
5716
5717 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5718 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5719 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5720 erroneous signals.
5721
5722 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5723 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5724 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5725 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5726 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5727 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5728 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5729 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5730 Program a Signal}.
5731
5732 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5733 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5734
5735 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5736 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5737 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5738 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5739 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5740 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5741 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5742 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5743 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5744 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5745 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5746 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5747 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5748
5749 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5750
5751 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5752 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5753 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5754 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5755
5756 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5757 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5758 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5759 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5760
5761 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5762 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5763
5764 @smallexample
5765 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5766 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5767 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5768 (@value{GDBP}) c
5769 Continuing.
5770
5771 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5772 main () sigusr1.c:28
5773 28 p = 0;
5774 (@value{GDBP}) si
5775 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5776 9 @{
5777 @end smallexample
5778
5779 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5780 program to receive the signal first:
5781
5782 @smallexample
5783 (@value{GDBP}) n
5784 28 p = 0;
5785 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5786 (@value{GDBP}) si
5787 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5788 9 @{
5789 (@value{GDBP})
5790 @end smallexample
5791
5792 @cindex extra signal information
5793 @anchor{extra signal information}
5794
5795 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5796 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5797 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5798 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5799 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5800 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5801 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5802 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5803 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5804 system header.
5805
5806 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5807 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5808
5809 @smallexample
5810 @group
5811 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5812 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5813 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5814 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5815 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5816 type = struct @{
5817 int si_signo;
5818 int si_errno;
5819 int si_code;
5820 union @{
5821 int _pad[28];
5822 struct @{...@} _kill;
5823 struct @{...@} _timer;
5824 struct @{...@} _rt;
5825 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5826 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5827 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5828 @} _sifields;
5829 @}
5830 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5831 type = struct @{
5832 void *si_addr;
5833 @}
5834 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5835 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5836 @end group
5837 @end smallexample
5838
5839 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5840
5841 @node Thread Stops
5842 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5843
5844 @cindex stopped threads
5845 @cindex threads, stopped
5846
5847 @cindex continuing threads
5848 @cindex threads, continuing
5849
5850 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5851 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5852 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5853 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5854 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5855 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5856 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5857 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5858 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5859
5860 @menu
5861 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5862 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5863 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5864 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5865 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5866 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5867 @end menu
5868
5869 @node All-Stop Mode
5870 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5871
5872 @cindex all-stop mode
5873
5874 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5875 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5876 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5877 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5878 underfoot.
5879
5880 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5881 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5882 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5883
5884 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5885 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5886 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5887 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5888 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5889 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5890 stops.
5891
5892 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5893 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5894 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5895 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5896
5897 @cindex automatic thread selection
5898 @cindex switching threads automatically
5899 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5900 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5901 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5902 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5903 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5904 thread.
5905
5906 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5907 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5908
5909 @table @code
5910 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5911 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5912 @cindex lock scheduler
5913 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
5914 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5915 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
5916 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
5917 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
5918 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
5919 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
5920 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5921 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
5922 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
5923 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
5924 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
5925 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
5926 @code{on} in replay mode.
5927
5928 @item show scheduler-locking
5929 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5930 @end table
5931
5932 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5933 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5934 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5935 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5936 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5937 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5938 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5939 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5940 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5941 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5942 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5943 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5944 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5945 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5946
5947 @table @code
5948 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5949 @item set schedule-multiple
5950 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5951 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5952 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5953 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5954 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5955 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5956
5957 @item show schedule-multiple
5958 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5959 multiple processes.
5960 @end table
5961
5962 @node Non-Stop Mode
5963 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5964
5965 @cindex non-stop mode
5966
5967 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5968 @c with more details.
5969
5970 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5971 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5972 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5973 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5974 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5975 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5976
5977 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5978 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5979 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5980 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5981 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5982 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5983 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5984 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5985 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5986 independently and simultaneously.
5987
5988 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5989 or attach to your program:
5990
5991 @smallexample
5992 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5993 set pagination off
5994
5995 # Finally, turn it on!
5996 set non-stop on
5997 @end smallexample
5998
5999 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6000
6001 @table @code
6002 @kindex set non-stop
6003 @item set non-stop on
6004 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6005 @item set non-stop off
6006 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6007 @kindex show non-stop
6008 @item show non-stop
6009 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6010 @end table
6011
6012 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6013 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6014 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6015 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6016 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6017 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6018 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6019 default.
6020
6021 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6022 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6023 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6024
6025 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6026 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6027 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6028 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6029 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6030
6031 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6032 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6033 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6034 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6035 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6036
6037 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6038
6039 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6040 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6041 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6042 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6043 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6044 previously current thread.
6045
6046 @node Background Execution
6047 @subsection Background Execution
6048
6049 @cindex foreground execution
6050 @cindex background execution
6051 @cindex asynchronous execution
6052 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6053
6054 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6055 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6056 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6057 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6058 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6059 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6060
6061 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6062 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6063
6064 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6065 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6066 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6067 are:
6068
6069 @table @code
6070 @kindex run&
6071 @item run
6072 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6073
6074 @item attach
6075 @kindex attach&
6076 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6077
6078 @item step
6079 @kindex step&
6080 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6081
6082 @item stepi
6083 @kindex stepi&
6084 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6085
6086 @item next
6087 @kindex next&
6088 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6089
6090 @item nexti
6091 @kindex nexti&
6092 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6093
6094 @item continue
6095 @kindex continue&
6096 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6097
6098 @item finish
6099 @kindex finish&
6100 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6101
6102 @item until
6103 @kindex until&
6104 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6105
6106 @end table
6107
6108 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6109 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6110 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6111 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6112 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6113 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6114
6115 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6116 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6117
6118 @table @code
6119 @kindex interrupt
6120 @item interrupt
6121 @itemx interrupt -a
6122
6123 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6124 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6125 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6126 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6127 @end table
6128
6129 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6130 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6131
6132 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6133 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6134 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6135
6136 @table @code
6137 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6138 @cindex thread breakpoints
6139 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6140 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6141 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6142 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6143 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6144 specify some source line.
6145
6146 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6147 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6148 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6149 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6150 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6151
6152 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6153 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6154 program.
6155
6156 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6157 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6158 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6159
6160 @smallexample
6161 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6162 @end smallexample
6163
6164 @end table
6165
6166 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6167 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6168 thread list. For example:
6169
6170 @smallexample
6171 (@value{GDBP}) c
6172 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6173 @end smallexample
6174
6175 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6176 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6177 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6178 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6179 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6180 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6181 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6182 command.
6183
6184 @node Interrupted System Calls
6185 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6186
6187 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6188 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6189 @cindex premature return from system calls
6190 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6191 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6192 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6193 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6194 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6195 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6196 stop execution.
6197
6198 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6199 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6200 style anyways.
6201
6202 For example, do not write code like this:
6203
6204 @smallexample
6205 sleep (10);
6206 @end smallexample
6207
6208 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6209 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6210
6211 Instead, write this:
6212
6213 @smallexample
6214 int unslept = 10;
6215 while (unslept > 0)
6216 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6217 @end smallexample
6218
6219 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6220 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6221 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6222 @value{GDBN}.
6223
6224 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6225 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6226 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6227 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6228
6229 @node Observer Mode
6230 @subsection Observer Mode
6231
6232 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6233 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6234 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6235 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6236 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6237
6238 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6239 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6240 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6241 mode.
6242
6243 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6244 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6245 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6246 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6247 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6248
6249 @table @code
6250
6251 @kindex observer
6252 @item set observer on
6253 @itemx set observer off
6254 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6255 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6256 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6257 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6258
6259 @item show observer
6260 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6261
6262 @kindex may-write-registers
6263 @item set may-write-registers on
6264 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6265 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6266 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6267 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6268
6269 @item show may-write-registers
6270 Show the current permission to write registers.
6271
6272 @kindex may-write-memory
6273 @item set may-write-memory on
6274 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6275 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6276 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6277 defaults to @code{on}.
6278
6279 @item show may-write-memory
6280 Show the current permission to write memory.
6281
6282 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6283 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6284 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6285 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6286 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6287 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6288
6289 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6290 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6291
6292 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6293 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6294 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6295 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6296 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6297 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6298 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6299
6300 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6301 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6302
6303 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6304 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6305 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6306 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6307 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6308 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6309 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6310
6311 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6312 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6313
6314 @kindex may-interrupt
6315 @item set may-interrupt on
6316 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6317 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6318 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6319 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6320 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6321
6322 @item show may-interrupt
6323 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6324
6325 @end table
6326
6327 @node Reverse Execution
6328 @chapter Running programs backward
6329 @cindex reverse execution
6330 @cindex running programs backward
6331
6332 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6333 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6334 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6335 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6336
6337 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6338 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6339 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6340 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6341 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6342 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6343
6344 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6345 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6346 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6347 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6348 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6349 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6350 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6351 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6352 prior values@footnote{
6353 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6354 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6355 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6356
6357 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6358 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6359 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6360 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6361 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6362 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6363 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6364 }.
6365
6366 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6367 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6368
6369 @table @code
6370 @kindex reverse-continue
6371 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6372 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6373 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6374 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6375 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6376 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6377 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6378
6379 @kindex reverse-step
6380 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6381 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6382 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6383 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6384
6385 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6386 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6387 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6388 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6389 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6390 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6391
6392 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6393 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6394
6395 @kindex reverse-stepi
6396 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6397 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6398 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6399 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6400 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6401 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6402 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6403
6404 @kindex reverse-next
6405 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6406 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6407 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6408 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6409 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6410 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6411 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6412 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6413 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6414 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6415
6416 @kindex reverse-nexti
6417 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6418 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6419 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6420 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6421 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6422 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6423 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6424 frame) is reached.
6425
6426 @kindex reverse-finish
6427 @item reverse-finish
6428 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6429 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6430 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6431 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6432
6433 @kindex set exec-direction
6434 @item set exec-direction
6435 Set the direction of target execution.
6436 @item set exec-direction reverse
6437 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6438 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6439 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6440 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6441 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6442 @item set exec-direction forward
6443 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6444 This is the default.
6445 @end table
6446
6447
6448 @node Process Record and Replay
6449 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6450 @cindex process record and replay
6451 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6452
6453 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6454 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6455 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6456
6457 @cindex replay mode
6458 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6459 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6460 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6461 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6462 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6463 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6464 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6465 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6466 execution log.
6467
6468 @cindex record mode
6469 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6470 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6471 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6472 for future replay.
6473
6474 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6475 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6476 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6477 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6478 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6479 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6480
6481 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6482 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6483 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6484 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6485
6486 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6487 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6488
6489 @table @code
6490 @kindex target record
6491 @kindex target record-full
6492 @kindex target record-btrace
6493 @kindex record
6494 @kindex record full
6495 @kindex record btrace
6496 @kindex record btrace bts
6497 @kindex record btrace pt
6498 @kindex record bts
6499 @kindex record pt
6500 @kindex rec
6501 @kindex rec full
6502 @kindex rec btrace
6503 @kindex rec btrace bts
6504 @kindex rec btrace pt
6505 @kindex rec bts
6506 @kindex rec pt
6507 @item record @var{method}
6508 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6509 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6510 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6511 recording methods are available:
6512
6513 @table @code
6514 @item full
6515 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6516 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6517 execution.
6518
6519 @item btrace @var{format}
6520 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6521 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6522 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6523 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6524 execution.
6525
6526 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6527 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6528 formats are available:
6529
6530 @table @code
6531 @item bts
6532 @cindex branch trace store
6533 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6534 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6535 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6536
6537 @item pt
6538 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6539 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6540 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6541 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6542
6543 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6544 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6545 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6546
6547 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6548 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6549 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6550 buffer-size with care.
6551 @end table
6552
6553 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6554 @end table
6555
6556 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6557 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6558 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6559 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6560
6561 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6562 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6563 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6564 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6565 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6566
6567 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6568 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6569 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6570 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6571 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6572 does not support these two modes.
6573
6574 @kindex record stop
6575 @kindex rec s
6576 @item record stop
6577 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6578 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6579 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6580
6581 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6582 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6583 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6584 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6585 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6586
6587 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6588 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6589 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6590 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6591 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6592
6593 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6594 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6595
6596 @kindex record goto
6597 @item record goto
6598 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6599 ways to specify the location to go to:
6600
6601 @table @code
6602 @item record goto begin
6603 @itemx record goto start
6604 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6605
6606 @item record goto end
6607 Go to the end of the execution log.
6608
6609 @item record goto @var{n}
6610 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6611 @end table
6612
6613 @kindex record save
6614 @item record save @var{filename}
6615 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6616 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6617 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6618
6619 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6620
6621 @kindex record restore
6622 @item record restore @var{filename}
6623 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6624 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6625
6626 @kindex set record full
6627 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6628 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6629 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6630 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6631
6632 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6633 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6634 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6635 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6636 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6637 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6638 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6639 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6640
6641 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6642 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6643 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6644
6645 @kindex show record full
6646 @item show record full insn-number-max
6647 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6648 recording method.
6649
6650 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6651 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6652 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6653 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6654 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6655 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6656 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6657 oldest one to be deleted.
6658
6659 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6660 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6661
6662 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6663 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6664
6665 @item set record full memory-query
6666 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6667 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6668 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6669 case.
6670
6671 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6672 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6673 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6674 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6675 results.
6676
6677 @item show record full memory-query
6678 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6679
6680 @kindex set record btrace
6681 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6682 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6683 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6684 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6685 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6686 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6687 You can use the following command for that:
6688
6689 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6690 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6691 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6692 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6693 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6694 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6695 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6696 position.
6697
6698 @kindex show record btrace
6699 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6700 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6701
6702 @kindex set record btrace bts
6703 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6704 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6705 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6706 format. Default is 64KB.
6707
6708 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6709 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6710 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6711 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6712 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6713 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6714 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6715
6716 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6717 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6718
6719 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6720 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6721
6722 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6723 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6724 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6725
6726 @kindex set record btrace pt
6727 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6728 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6729 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6730 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6731
6732 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6733 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6734 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6735 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6736 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6737 actual buffer size for each thread.
6738
6739 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6740 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6741
6742 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6743 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6744
6745 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6746 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6747 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6748
6749 @kindex info record
6750 @item info record
6751 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6752 method:
6753
6754 @table @code
6755 @item full
6756 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6757 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6758
6759 @itemize @bullet
6760 @item
6761 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6762 @item
6763 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6764 @item
6765 Highest recorded instruction number.
6766 @item
6767 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6768 @item
6769 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6770 @item
6771 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6772 @end itemize
6773
6774 @item btrace
6775 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6776
6777 @itemize @bullet
6778 @item
6779 Recording format.
6780 @item
6781 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6782 @item
6783 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6784 instructions.
6785 @item
6786 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6787 @end itemize
6788
6789 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6790 @itemize @bullet
6791 @item
6792 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6793 @end itemize
6794
6795 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6796 @itemize @bullet
6797 @item
6798 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6799 @end itemize
6800 @end table
6801
6802 @kindex record delete
6803 @kindex rec del
6804 @item record delete
6805 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6806 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6807 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6808 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6809
6810 @kindex record instruction-history
6811 @kindex rec instruction-history
6812 @item record instruction-history
6813 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6814 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6815 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6816 are printed in execution order.
6817
6818 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6819 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6820 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6821
6822 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6823 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6824 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6825 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6826 @code{/p} modifier.
6827
6828 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6829 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6830 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6831
6832 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6833 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6834
6835 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6836 disassemble:
6837
6838 @table @code
6839 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6840 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6841 @var{insn}.
6842
6843 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6844 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6845 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6846 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6847 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6848 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6849
6850 @item record instruction-history
6851 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6852
6853 @item record instruction-history -
6854 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6855
6856 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6857 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6858 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6859 number @var{end} is included.
6860 @end table
6861
6862 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6863
6864 @kindex set record
6865 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6866 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6867 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6868 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6869 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6870
6871 @kindex show record
6872 @item show record instruction-history-size
6873 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6874 instruction-history} command.
6875
6876 @kindex record function-call-history
6877 @kindex rec function-call-history
6878 @item record function-call-history
6879 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6880 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6881 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6882 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6883 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6884 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6885 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6886 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6887 given together.
6888
6889 @smallexample
6890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6891 1 void foo (void)
6892 2 @{
6893 3 @}
6894 4
6895 5 void bar (void)
6896 6 @{
6897 7 ...
6898 8 foo ();
6899 9 ...
6900 10 @}
6901 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6902 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6903 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6904 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6905 @end smallexample
6906
6907 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6908 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6909 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6910 to print:
6911
6912 @table @code
6913 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6914 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6915
6916 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6917 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6918 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6919 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6920 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6921
6922 @item record function-call-history
6923 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6924
6925 @item record function-call-history -
6926 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6927
6928 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6929 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6930 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6931 @end table
6932
6933 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6934
6935 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6936 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6937 Define how many lines to print in the
6938 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6939 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6940
6941 @item show record function-call-history-size
6942 Show how many lines to print in the
6943 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6944 @end table
6945
6946
6947 @node Stack
6948 @chapter Examining the Stack
6949
6950 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6951 stopped and how it got there.
6952
6953 @cindex call stack
6954 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6955 is generated.
6956 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6957 the arguments of the call,
6958 and the local variables of the function being called.
6959 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6960 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6961 stack}.
6962
6963 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6964 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6965
6966 @cindex selected frame
6967 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6968 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6969 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6970 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6971 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6972 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6973
6974 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6975 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6976 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6977
6978 @menu
6979 * Frames:: Stack frames
6980 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6981 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6982 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6983 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6984
6985 @end menu
6986
6987 @node Frames
6988 @section Stack Frames
6989
6990 @cindex frame, definition
6991 @cindex stack frame
6992 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6993 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6994 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6995 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6996 which the function is executing.
6997
6998 @cindex initial frame
6999 @cindex outermost frame
7000 @cindex innermost frame
7001 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7002 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7003 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7004 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7005 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7006 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7007 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7008 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7009
7010 @cindex frame pointer
7011 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7012 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7013 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7014 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7015 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7016 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7017
7018 @cindex frame number
7019 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7020 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7021 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7022 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7023 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7024
7025 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7026 @c underflow problems.
7027 @cindex frameless execution
7028 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7029 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7030 @smallexample
7031 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7032 @end smallexample
7033 generates functions without a frame.)
7034 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7035 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7036 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7037 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7038 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7039 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7040 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7041
7042 @node Backtrace
7043 @section Backtraces
7044
7045 @cindex traceback
7046 @cindex call stack traces
7047 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7048 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7049 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7050 stack.
7051
7052 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7053 @table @code
7054 @kindex backtrace
7055 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7056 @item backtrace
7057 @itemx bt
7058 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7059 frames in the stack.
7060
7061 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7062 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7063
7064 @item backtrace @var{n}
7065 @itemx bt @var{n}
7066 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7067
7068 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7069 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7070 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7071
7072 @item backtrace full
7073 @itemx bt full
7074 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7075 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7076 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7077 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7078
7079 @item backtrace no-filters
7080 @itemx bt no-filters
7081 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7082 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7083 @itemx bt no-filters full
7084 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7085 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7086 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7087 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7088 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7089 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7090 support.
7091 @end table
7092
7093 @kindex where
7094 @kindex info stack
7095 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7096 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7097
7098 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7099 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7100 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7101 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7102 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7103 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7104 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7105 multi-threaded program.
7106
7107 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7108 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7109 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7110 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7111 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7112 line number.
7113
7114 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7115 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7116
7117 @smallexample
7118 @group
7119 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7120 at builtin.c:993
7121 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7122 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7123 at macro.c:71
7124 (More stack frames follow...)
7125 @end group
7126 @end smallexample
7127
7128 @noindent
7129 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7130 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7131 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7132
7133 @noindent
7134 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7135 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7136 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7137 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7138 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7139
7140 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7141 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7142 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7143 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7144 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7145 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7146 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7147 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7148 such a backtrace might look like:
7149
7150 @smallexample
7151 @group
7152 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7153 at builtin.c:993
7154 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7155 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7156 at macro.c:71
7157 (More stack frames follow...)
7158 @end group
7159 @end smallexample
7160
7161 @noindent
7162 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7163 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7164
7165 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7166 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7167 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7168
7169 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7170 @cindex program entry point
7171 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7172 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7173 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7174 @code{main}@footnote{
7175 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7176 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7177 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7178 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7179 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7180 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7181
7182 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7183 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7184
7185 @table @code
7186 @item set backtrace past-main
7187 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7188 @kindex set backtrace
7189 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7190
7191 @item set backtrace past-main off
7192 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7193 default.
7194
7195 @item show backtrace past-main
7196 @kindex show backtrace
7197 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7198
7199 @item set backtrace past-entry
7200 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7201 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7202 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7203 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7204
7205 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7206 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7207 application. This is the default.
7208
7209 @item show backtrace past-entry
7210 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7211
7212 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7213 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7214 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7215 @cindex backtrace limit
7216 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7217 or zero means unlimited levels.
7218
7219 @item show backtrace limit
7220 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7221 @end table
7222
7223 You can control how file names are displayed.
7224
7225 @table @code
7226 @item set filename-display
7227 @itemx set filename-display relative
7228 @cindex filename-display
7229 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7230
7231 @item set filename-display basename
7232 Display only basename of a filename.
7233
7234 @item set filename-display absolute
7235 Display an absolute filename.
7236
7237 @item show filename-display
7238 Show the current way to display filenames.
7239 @end table
7240
7241 @node Selection
7242 @section Selecting a Frame
7243
7244 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7245 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7246 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7247 of the stack frame just selected.
7248
7249 @table @code
7250 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7251 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7252 @item frame @var{n}
7253 @itemx f @var{n}
7254 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7255 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7256 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7257 @code{main}.
7258
7259 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7260 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7261 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7262 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7263 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7264 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7265 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7266 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7267
7268 @kindex up
7269 @item up @var{n}
7270 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7271 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7272 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7273
7274 @kindex down
7275 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7276 @item down @var{n}
7277 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7278 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7279 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7280 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7281 @end table
7282
7283 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7284 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7285 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7286 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7287
7288 @need 1000
7289 For example:
7290
7291 @smallexample
7292 @group
7293 (@value{GDBP}) up
7294 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7295 at env.c:10
7296 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7297 @end group
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7301 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7302 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7303 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7304 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7305 for details.
7306
7307 @table @code
7308 @kindex select-frame
7309 @item select-frame
7310 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7311 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7312 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7313 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7314
7315 @kindex down-silently
7316 @kindex up-silently
7317 @item up-silently @var{n}
7318 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7319 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7320 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7321 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7322 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7323 distracting.
7324 @end table
7325
7326 @node Frame Info
7327 @section Information About a Frame
7328
7329 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7330 stack frame.
7331
7332 @table @code
7333 @item frame
7334 @itemx f
7335 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7336 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7337 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7338 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7339 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7340
7341 @kindex info frame
7342 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7343 @item info frame
7344 @itemx info f
7345 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7346 including:
7347
7348 @itemize @bullet
7349 @item
7350 the address of the frame
7351 @item
7352 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7353 @item
7354 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7355 @item
7356 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7357 @item
7358 the address of the frame's arguments
7359 @item
7360 the address of the frame's local variables
7361 @item
7362 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7363 @item
7364 which registers were saved in the frame
7365 @end itemize
7366
7367 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7368 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7369 the usual conventions.
7370
7371 @item info frame @var{addr}
7372 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7373 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7374 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7375 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7376 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7377 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7378
7379 @kindex info args
7380 @item info args
7381 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7382
7383 @item info locals
7384 @kindex info locals
7385 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7386 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7387 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7388
7389 @end table
7390
7391 @node Frame Filter Management
7392 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7393 @cindex managing frame filters
7394
7395 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7396 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7397
7398 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7399 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7400
7401 @table @code
7402 @kindex info frame-filter
7403 @item info frame-filter
7404 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7405 their name, priority and enabled status.
7406
7407 @kindex disable frame-filter
7408 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7409 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7410 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7411 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7412 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7413 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7414 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7415 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7416 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7417 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7418 may be enabled again later.
7419
7420 @kindex enable frame-filter
7421 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7422 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7423 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7424 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7425 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7426 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7427 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7428 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7429 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7430
7431 Example:
7432
7433 @smallexample
7434 (gdb) info frame-filter
7435
7436 global frame-filters:
7437 Priority Enabled Name
7438 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7439 100 Yes Reverse
7440
7441 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7442 Priority Enabled Name
7443 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7444
7445 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7446 Priority Enabled Name
7447 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7448
7449 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7450 (gdb) info frame-filter
7451
7452 global frame-filters:
7453 Priority Enabled Name
7454 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7455 100 Yes Reverse
7456
7457 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7458 Priority Enabled Name
7459 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7460
7461 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7462 Priority Enabled Name
7463 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7464
7465 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7466 (gdb) info frame-filter
7467
7468 global frame-filters:
7469 Priority Enabled Name
7470 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7471 100 Yes Reverse
7472
7473 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7474 Priority Enabled Name
7475 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7476
7477 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7478 Priority Enabled Name
7479 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7480 @end smallexample
7481
7482 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7483 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7484 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7485 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7486 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7487 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7488 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7489
7490 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7491 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7492 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7493 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7494 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7495 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7496 dictionary resides.
7497
7498 Example:
7499
7500 @smallexample
7501 (gdb) info frame-filter
7502
7503 global frame-filters:
7504 Priority Enabled Name
7505 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7506 100 Yes Reverse
7507
7508 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7509 Priority Enabled Name
7510 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7511
7512 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7513 Priority Enabled Name
7514 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7515
7516 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7517 (gdb) info frame-filter
7518
7519 global frame-filters:
7520 Priority Enabled Name
7521 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7522 50 Yes Reverse
7523
7524 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7525 Priority Enabled Name
7526 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7527
7528 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7529 Priority Enabled Name
7530 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7531 @end smallexample
7532 @end table
7533
7534 @node Source
7535 @chapter Examining Source Files
7536
7537 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7538 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7539 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7540 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7541 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7542 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7543 source files by explicit command.
7544
7545 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7546 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7547 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7548
7549 @menu
7550 * List:: Printing source lines
7551 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7552 * Edit:: Editing source files
7553 * Search:: Searching source files
7554 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7555 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7556 @end menu
7557
7558 @node List
7559 @section Printing Source Lines
7560
7561 @kindex list
7562 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7563 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7564 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7565 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7566 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7567
7568 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7569
7570 @table @code
7571 @item list @var{linenum}
7572 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7573 current source file.
7574
7575 @item list @var{function}
7576 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7577 @var{function}.
7578
7579 @item list
7580 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7581 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7582 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7583 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7584 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7585
7586 @item list -
7587 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7588 @end table
7589
7590 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7591 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7592 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7593
7594 @table @code
7595 @kindex set listsize
7596 @item set listsize @var{count}
7597 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7598 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7599 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7600 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7601
7602 @kindex show listsize
7603 @item show listsize
7604 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7605 @end table
7606
7607 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7608 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7609 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7610 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7611 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7612
7613 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7614 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7615 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7616 to specify some source line.
7617
7618 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7619
7620 @table @code
7621 @item list @var{location}
7622 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7623
7624 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7625 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7626 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7627 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7628 the same source file as the first location.
7629
7630 @item list ,@var{last}
7631 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7632
7633 @item list @var{first},
7634 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7635
7636 @item list +
7637 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7638
7639 @item list -
7640 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7641
7642 @item list
7643 As described in the preceding table.
7644 @end table
7645
7646 @node Specify Location
7647 @section Specifying a Location
7648 @cindex specifying location
7649 @cindex location
7650 @cindex source location
7651
7652 @menu
7653 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7654 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7655 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7656 @end menu
7657
7658 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7659 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7660 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7661 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7662 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7663
7664 @node Linespec Locations
7665 @subsection Linespec Locations
7666 @cindex linespec locations
7667
7668 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7669 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7670 specifying a linespec:
7671
7672 @table @code
7673 @item @var{linenum}
7674 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7675
7676 @item -@var{offset}
7677 @itemx +@var{offset}
7678 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7679 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7680 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7681 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7682 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7683 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7684 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7685 linespec.
7686
7687 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7688 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7689 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7690 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7691 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7692 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7693 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7694
7695 @item @var{function}
7696 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7697 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7698
7699 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7700 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7701
7702 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7703 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7704 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7705 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7706 functions in different source files.
7707
7708 @item @var{label}
7709 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7710 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7711 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7712 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7713
7714 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7715 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7716 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7717 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7718 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7719 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7720
7721 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7722 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7723 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7724 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7725 each one of those probes.
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @node Explicit Locations
7729 @subsection Explicit Locations
7730 @cindex explicit locations
7731
7732 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7733 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7734
7735 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7736 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7737 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7738 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7739 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7740
7741 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7742 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7743 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7744 the symbol table to know.
7745
7746 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7747 following table:
7748
7749 @table @code
7750 @item -source @var{filename}
7751 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7752 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7753 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7754 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7755 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7756
7757 @item -function @var{function}
7758 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7759 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7760 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7761 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7762
7763 @item -label @var{label}
7764 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7765 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7766 selected stack frame.
7767
7768 @item -line @var{number}
7769 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7770 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7771 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7772 relative to the current line.
7773 @end table
7774
7775 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7776 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7777
7778 @node Address Locations
7779 @subsection Address Locations
7780 @cindex address locations
7781
7782 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7783 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7784
7785 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7786 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7787 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7788 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7789 source files.
7790
7791 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7792 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7793 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7794 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7795 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7796 of @var{address}:
7797
7798 @table @code
7799 @item @var{expression}
7800 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7801
7802 @item @var{funcaddr}
7803 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7804 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7805 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7806 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7807 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7808 (although the Pascal form also works).
7809
7810 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7811 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7812
7813 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7814 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7815 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7816 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7817 functions with identical names in different source files.
7818 @end table
7819
7820 @node Edit
7821 @section Editing Source Files
7822 @cindex editing source files
7823
7824 @kindex edit
7825 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7826 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7827 The editing program of your choice
7828 is invoked with the current line set to
7829 the active line in the program.
7830 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7831 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7832
7833 @table @code
7834 @item edit @var{location}
7835 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7836 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7837 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7838 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7839 command most commonly used:
7840
7841 @table @code
7842 @item edit @var{number}
7843 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7844
7845 @item edit @var{function}
7846 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7847 @end table
7848
7849 @end table
7850
7851 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7852 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7853 @footnote{
7854 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7855 following command-line syntax:
7856 @smallexample
7857 ex +@var{number} file
7858 @end smallexample
7859 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7860 the file where to start editing.}.
7861 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7862 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7863 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7864 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7865 @smallexample
7866 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7867 export EDITOR
7868 gdb @dots{}
7869 @end smallexample
7870 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7871 @smallexample
7872 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7873 gdb @dots{}
7874 @end smallexample
7875
7876 @node Search
7877 @section Searching Source Files
7878 @cindex searching source files
7879
7880 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7881 regular expression.
7882
7883 @table @code
7884 @kindex search
7885 @kindex forward-search
7886 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7887 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7888 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7889 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7890 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7891 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7892 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7893 @code{fo}.
7894
7895 @kindex reverse-search
7896 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7897 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7898 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7899 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7900 this command as @code{rev}.
7901 @end table
7902
7903 @node Source Path
7904 @section Specifying Source Directories
7905
7906 @cindex source path
7907 @cindex directories for source files
7908 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7909 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7910 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7911 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7912 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7913 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7914 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7915
7916 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7917 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7918 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7919 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7920 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7921 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7922 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7923 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7924 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7925 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7926 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7927
7928 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7929 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7930 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7931 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7932 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7933 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7934
7935 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7936 source files.
7937
7938 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7939 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7940 each line is in the file.
7941
7942 @kindex directory
7943 @kindex dir
7944 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7945 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7946 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7947
7948 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7949 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7950
7951 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7952 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7953 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7954 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7955 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7956 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7957 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7958 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7959 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7960 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7961 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7962 name to look up the sources.
7963
7964 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7965 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7966 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7967 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7968 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7969 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7970 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7971 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7972
7973 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7974 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7975 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7976 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7977 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7978 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7979 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7980
7981 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7982 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7983 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7984 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7985 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7986 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7987 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7988 command.
7989
7990 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7991 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7992 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7993 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7994 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7995 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7996 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7997
7998 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7999 @cindex default source path substitution
8000 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8001 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8002 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8003 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8004 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8005 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8006 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8007 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8008 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8009 together.
8010
8011 @table @code
8012 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8013 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8014 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8015 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8016 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8017 part of absolute file names) or
8018 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8019 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8020
8021 @kindex cdir
8022 @kindex cwd
8023 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8024 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8025 @cindex compilation directory
8026 @cindex current directory
8027 @cindex working directory
8028 @cindex directory, current
8029 @cindex directory, compilation
8030 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8031 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8032 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8033 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8034 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8035 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8036
8037 @item directory
8038 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8039
8040 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8041 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8042
8043 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8044 @kindex set directories
8045 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8046 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8047
8048 @item show directories
8049 @kindex show directories
8050 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8051
8052 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8053 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8054 @kindex set substitute-path
8055 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8056 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8057 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8058
8059 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8060 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8061
8062 @smallexample
8063 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8064 @end smallexample
8065
8066 @noindent
8067 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8068 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8069 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8070
8071 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8072 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8073 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8074 the substitution.
8075
8076 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8077
8078 @smallexample
8079 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8080 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8081 @end smallexample
8082
8083 @noindent
8084 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8085 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8086 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8087 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8088
8089
8090 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8091 @kindex unset substitute-path
8092 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8093 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8094 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8095
8096 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8097
8098 @item show substitute-path [path]
8099 @kindex show substitute-path
8100 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8101 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8102
8103 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8104 rules.
8105
8106 @end table
8107
8108 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8109 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8110 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8111
8112 @enumerate
8113 @item
8114 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8115
8116 @item
8117 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8118 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8119 directories in one command.
8120 @end enumerate
8121
8122 @node Machine Code
8123 @section Source and Machine Code
8124 @cindex source line and its code address
8125
8126 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8127 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8128 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8129 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8130 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8131 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8132 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8133 well as hex.
8134
8135 @table @code
8136 @kindex info line
8137 @item info line @var{location}
8138 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8139 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8140 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8141 @end table
8142
8143 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8144 the object code for the first line of function
8145 @code{m4_changequote}:
8146
8147 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8148 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8149 @smallexample
8150 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8151 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8152 @end smallexample
8153
8154 @noindent
8155 @cindex code address and its source line
8156 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8157 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8158 @smallexample
8159 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8160 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8161 @end smallexample
8162
8163 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8164 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8165 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8166 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8167 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8168 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8169 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8170 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8171 Variables}).
8172
8173 @table @code
8174 @kindex disassemble
8175 @cindex assembly instructions
8176 @cindex instructions, assembly
8177 @cindex machine instructions
8178 @cindex listing machine instructions
8179 @item disassemble
8180 @itemx disassemble /m
8181 @itemx disassemble /s
8182 @itemx disassemble /r
8183 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8184 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8185 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8186 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8187 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8188 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8189 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8190 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8191 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8192 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8193
8194 @table @code
8195 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8196 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8197 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8198 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8199 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8200 @end table
8201
8202 @noindent
8203 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8204 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8205
8206 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8207 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8208
8209 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8210 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8211 @end table
8212
8213 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8214 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8215
8216 @smallexample
8217 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8218 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8219 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8220 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8221 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8222 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8223 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8224 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8225 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8226 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8227 End of assembler dump.
8228 @end smallexample
8229
8230 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8231 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8232 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8233
8234 @smallexample
8235 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8236 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8237 5 @{
8238 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8239 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8240 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8241 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8242 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8243
8244 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8245 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8246 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8247
8248 7 return 0;
8249 8 @}
8250 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8251 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8252 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8253
8254 End of assembler dump.
8255 @end smallexample
8256
8257 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8258 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8259 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8260 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8261 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8262 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8263 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8264 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8265 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8266
8267 @file{foo.h}:
8268
8269 @smallexample
8270 int
8271 foo (int a)
8272 @{
8273 if (a < 0)
8274 return a * 2;
8275 if (a == 0)
8276 return 1;
8277 return a + 10;
8278 @}
8279 @end smallexample
8280
8281 @file{foo.c}:
8282
8283 @smallexample
8284 #include "foo.h"
8285 volatile int x, y;
8286 int
8287 main ()
8288 @{
8289 x = foo (y);
8290 return 0;
8291 @}
8292 @end smallexample
8293
8294 @smallexample
8295 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8296 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8297 5 @{
8298
8299 6 x = foo (y);
8300 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8301 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8302
8303 7 return 0;
8304 8 @}
8305 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8306 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8307 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8308 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8309
8310 End of assembler dump.
8311 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8312 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8313 foo.c:
8314 5 @{
8315 6 x = foo (y);
8316 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8317
8318 foo.h:
8319 4 if (a < 0)
8320 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8321 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8322
8323 6 if (a == 0)
8324 7 return 1;
8325 8 return a + 10;
8326 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8327 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8328 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8329 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8330
8331 foo.c:
8332 6 x = foo (y);
8333 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8334
8335 7 return 0;
8336 8 @}
8337 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8338 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8339
8340 foo.h:
8341 5 return a * 2;
8342 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8343 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8344 End of assembler dump.
8345 @end smallexample
8346
8347 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8348
8349 @smallexample
8350 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8351 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8352 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8353 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8354 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8355 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8356 End of assembler dump.
8357 @end smallexample
8358
8359 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8360 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8361 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8362 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8363
8364 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8365 mnemonics or other syntax.
8366
8367 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8368 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8369 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8370 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8371 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8372
8373 @table @code
8374 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8375 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8376 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8377 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8378 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8379 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8380
8381 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8382 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8383 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8384 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8385
8386 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8387 @item show disassembly-flavor
8388 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8389 @end table
8390
8391 @table @code
8392 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8393 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8394 @item set disassemble-next-line
8395 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8396 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8397 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8398 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8399 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8400 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8401 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8402 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8403 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8404 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8405 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8406 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8407 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8408 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8409 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8410 instruction.
8411 @end table
8412
8413
8414 @node Data
8415 @chapter Examining Data
8416
8417 @cindex printing data
8418 @cindex examining data
8419 @kindex print
8420 @kindex inspect
8421 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8422 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8423 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8424 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8425 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8426 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8427
8428 @table @code
8429 @item print @var{expr}
8430 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8431 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8432 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8433 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8434 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8435 Formats}.
8436
8437 @item print
8438 @itemx print /@var{f}
8439 @cindex reprint the last value
8440 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8441 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8442 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8443 @end table
8444
8445 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8446 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8447 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8448
8449 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8450 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8451 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8452 Table}.
8453
8454 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8455 @kindex explore
8456 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8457 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8458 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8459 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8460 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8461 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8462 embedded in the higher level data types.
8463
8464 @table @code
8465 @item explore @var{arg}
8466 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8467 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8468 @end table
8469
8470 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8471 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8472 C program as
8473
8474 @smallexample
8475 struct SimpleStruct
8476 @{
8477 int i;
8478 double d;
8479 @};
8480
8481 struct ComplexStruct
8482 @{
8483 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8484 int arr[10];
8485 @};
8486 @end smallexample
8487
8488 @noindent
8489 followed by variable declarations as
8490
8491 @smallexample
8492 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8493 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8494 @end smallexample
8495
8496 @noindent
8497 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8498 @code{explore} command as follows.
8499
8500 @smallexample
8501 (gdb) explore cs
8502 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8503 the following fields:
8504
8505 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8506 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8507
8508 Enter the field number of choice:
8509 @end smallexample
8510
8511 @noindent
8512 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8513 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8514 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8515 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8516 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8517 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8518 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8519 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8520
8521 @smallexample
8522 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8523 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8524 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8525 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8526
8527 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8528 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8529
8530 Press enter to return to parent value:
8531 @end smallexample
8532
8533 @noindent
8534 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8535 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8536 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8537 to explore.
8538
8539 @smallexample
8540 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8541 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8542
8543 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8544
8545 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8546
8547 Press enter to return to parent value:
8548 @end smallexample
8549
8550 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8551 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8552 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8553 level data structure).
8554
8555 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8556 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8557 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8558 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8559 same example as above, your can explore the type
8560 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8561 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8562
8563 @smallexample
8564 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 @noindent
8568 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8569 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8570 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8571 example.
8572
8573 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8574 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8575 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8576 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8577 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8578
8579 @table @code
8580 @item explore value @var{expr}
8581 @cindex explore value
8582 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8583 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8584 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8585 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8586 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8587
8588 @item explore type @var{arg}
8589 @cindex explore type
8590 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8591 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8592 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8593 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8594 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8595 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8596 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8597 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8598 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8599 @end table
8600
8601 @menu
8602 * Expressions:: Expressions
8603 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8604 * Variables:: Program variables
8605 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8606 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8607 * Memory:: Examining memory
8608 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8609 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8610 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8611 * Value History:: Value history
8612 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8613 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8614 * Registers:: Registers
8615 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8616 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8617 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8618 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8619 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8620 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8621 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8622 character set than GDB does
8623 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8624 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8625 @end menu
8626
8627 @node Expressions
8628 @section Expressions
8629
8630 @cindex expressions
8631 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8632 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8633 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8634 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8635 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8636 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8637 @ref{Compilation}.
8638
8639 @cindex arrays in expressions
8640 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8641 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8642 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8643 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8644 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8645 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8646
8647 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8648 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8649 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8650 languages.
8651
8652 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8653 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8654
8655 @cindex casts, in expressions
8656 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8657 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8658 at that address in memory.
8659 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8660
8661 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8662 to programming languages:
8663
8664 @table @code
8665 @item @@
8666 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8667 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8668
8669 @item ::
8670 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8671 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8672
8673 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8674 @cindex type casting memory
8675 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8676 @cindex casts, to view memory
8677 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8678 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8679 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8680 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8681 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8682 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8683 @end table
8684
8685 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8686 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8687 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8688
8689 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8690 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8691 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8692 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8693 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8694 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8695 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8696
8697 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8698 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8699 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8700 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8701 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8702 as well.
8703
8704 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8705 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8706 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8707 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8708 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8709 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8710 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8711 choices.
8712
8713 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8714 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8715 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8716
8717 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8718 @smallexample
8719 @group
8720 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8721 [0] cancel
8722 [1] all
8723 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8724 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8725 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8726 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8727 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8728 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8729 > 2 4 6
8730 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8731 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8732 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8733 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8734 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8735 breakpoints.
8736 (@value{GDBP})
8737 @end group
8738 @end smallexample
8739
8740 @table @code
8741 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8742 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8743 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8744
8745 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8746 is ambiguous.
8747
8748 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8749 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8750 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8751 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8752 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8753 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8754 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8755 in the use of the menu.
8756
8757 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8758 when an ambiguity is detected.
8759
8760 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8761 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8762
8763 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8764 @item show multiple-symbols
8765 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8766 @end table
8767
8768 @node Variables
8769 @section Program Variables
8770
8771 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8772 in your program.
8773
8774 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8775 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8776
8777 @itemize @bullet
8778 @item
8779 global (or file-static)
8780 @end itemize
8781
8782 @noindent or
8783
8784 @itemize @bullet
8785 @item
8786 visible according to the scope rules of the
8787 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8788 @end itemize
8789
8790 @noindent This means that in the function
8791
8792 @smallexample
8793 foo (a)
8794 int a;
8795 @{
8796 bar (a);
8797 @{
8798 int b = test ();
8799 bar (b);
8800 @}
8801 @}
8802 @end smallexample
8803
8804 @noindent
8805 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8806 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8807 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8808 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8809
8810 @cindex variable name conflict
8811 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8812 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8813 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8814 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8815 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8816 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8817 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8818
8819 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8820 @ifnotinfo
8821 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8822 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8823 @end ifnotinfo
8824 @smallexample
8825 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8826 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8827 @end smallexample
8828
8829 @noindent
8830 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8831 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8832 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8833 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8834
8835 @smallexample
8836 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8837 @end smallexample
8838
8839 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8840 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8841 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8842 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8843 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8844
8845 @smallexample
8846 void
8847 foo (int a)
8848 @{
8849 if (a < 10)
8850 bar (a);
8851 else
8852 process (a); /* Stop here */
8853 @}
8854
8855 int
8856 bar (int a)
8857 @{
8858 foo (a + 5);
8859 @}
8860 @end smallexample
8861
8862 @noindent
8863 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8864 here is what you might see
8865 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8866
8867 @smallexample
8868 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8869 $1 = 10
8870 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8871 $2 = 5
8872 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8873 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8874 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8875 $3 = 5
8876 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8877 $4 = 0
8878 @end smallexample
8879
8880 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8881 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8882 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8883 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8884 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8885
8886 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8887 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8888 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8889 @code{some_global}.
8890
8891 @smallexample
8892 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8893 $1 = 23
8894 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8895 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8896 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8897 $2 = 27
8898 @end smallexample
8899
8900 @cindex wrong values
8901 @cindex variable values, wrong
8902 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8903 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8904 @quotation
8905 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8906 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8907 scope, and just before exit.
8908 @end quotation
8909 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8910 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8911 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8912 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8913 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8914 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8915 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8916 variable definitions may be gone.
8917
8918 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8919 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8920 when compiling.
8921
8922 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8923 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8924 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8925 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8926 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8927 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8928 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8929
8930 @smallexample
8931 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8932 @end smallexample
8933
8934 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8935 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8936 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8937 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8938 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8939
8940 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8941 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8942 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8943 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8944
8945 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8946 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8947 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8948 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8949 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8950
8951 @smallexample
8952 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8953 29 i++;
8954 (gdb) next
8955 30 e (i);
8956 (gdb) print i
8957 $1 = 31
8958 (gdb) print i@@entry
8959 $2 = 30
8960 @end smallexample
8961
8962 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8963 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8964 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8965 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8966 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8967 For program code
8968
8969 @smallexample
8970 char var0[] = "A";
8971 signed char var1[] = "A";
8972 @end smallexample
8973
8974 You get during debugging
8975 @smallexample
8976 (gdb) print var0
8977 $1 = "A"
8978 (gdb) print var1
8979 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8980 @end smallexample
8981
8982 @node Arrays
8983 @section Artificial Arrays
8984
8985 @cindex artificial array
8986 @cindex arrays
8987 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8988 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8989 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8990 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8991 program.
8992
8993 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8994 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8995 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8996 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8997 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8998 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8999 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9000 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9001 example. If a program says
9002
9003 @smallexample
9004 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9005 @end smallexample
9006
9007 @noindent
9008 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9009
9010 @smallexample
9011 p *array@@len
9012 @end smallexample
9013
9014 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9015 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9016 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9017 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9018 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9019
9020 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9021 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9022 The value need not be in memory:
9023 @smallexample
9024 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9025 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9026 @end smallexample
9027
9028 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9029 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9030 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9031 @smallexample
9032 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9033 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9034 @end smallexample
9035
9036 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9037 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9038 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9039 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9040 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9041 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9042 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9043 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9044 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9045 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9046
9047 @smallexample
9048 set $i = 0
9049 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9050 @key{RET}
9051 @key{RET}
9052 @dots{}
9053 @end smallexample
9054
9055 @node Output Formats
9056 @section Output Formats
9057
9058 @cindex formatted output
9059 @cindex output formats
9060 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9061 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9062 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9063 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9064 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9065
9066 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9067 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9068 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9069 letters supported are:
9070
9071 @table @code
9072 @item x
9073 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9074 hexadecimal.
9075
9076 @item d
9077 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9078
9079 @item u
9080 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9081
9082 @item o
9083 Print as integer in octal.
9084
9085 @item t
9086 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9087 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9088 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9089 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9090
9091 @item a
9092 @cindex unknown address, locating
9093 @cindex locate address
9094 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9095 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9096 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9097
9098 @smallexample
9099 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9100 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9101 @end smallexample
9102
9103 @noindent
9104 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9105 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9106
9107 @item c
9108 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9109 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9110 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9111 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9112
9113 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9114 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9115 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9116 data.
9117
9118 @item f
9119 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9120 using typical floating point syntax.
9121
9122 @item s
9123 @cindex printing strings
9124 @cindex printing byte arrays
9125 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9126 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9127 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9128 natural types.
9129
9130 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9131 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9132 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9133 array.
9134
9135 @item z
9136 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9137 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9138 to the size of the integer type.
9139
9140 @item r
9141 @cindex raw printing
9142 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9143 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9144 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9145 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9146 pretty-printer which might exist.
9147 @end table
9148
9149 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9150
9151 @smallexample
9152 p/x $pc
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 @noindent
9156 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9157 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9158
9159 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9160 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9161 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9162
9163 @node Memory
9164 @section Examining Memory
9165
9166 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9167 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9168
9169 @cindex examining memory
9170 @table @code
9171 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9172 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9173 @itemx x @var{addr}
9174 @itemx x
9175 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9176 @end table
9177
9178 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9179 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9180 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9181 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9182 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9183
9184 @table @r
9185 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9186 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9187 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9188 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9189 @c 4.1.2.
9190
9191 @item @var{f}, the display format
9192 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9193 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9194 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9195 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9196 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9197
9198 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9199 The unit size is any of
9200
9201 @table @code
9202 @item b
9203 Bytes.
9204 @item h
9205 Halfwords (two bytes).
9206 @item w
9207 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9208 @item g
9209 Giant words (eight bytes).
9210 @end table
9211
9212 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9213 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9214 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9215 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9216 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9217 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9218 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9219 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9220 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9221 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9222 be altered.
9223
9224 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9225 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9226 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9227 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9228 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9229 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9230 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9231 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9232 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9233 a value from memory).
9234 @end table
9235
9236 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9237 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9238 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9239 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9240 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9241
9242 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9243 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9244 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9245 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9246 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9247
9248 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9249 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9250 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9251 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9252 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9253 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9254 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9255 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9256 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9257
9258 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9259 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9260 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9261 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9262 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9263 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9264 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9265
9266 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9267 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9268
9269 @smallexample
9270 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9271 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9272 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9273 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9274 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9275 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9276 @end smallexample
9277
9278 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9279 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9280 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9281 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9282 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9283 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9284 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9285 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9286 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9287
9288 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9289 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9290 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9291
9292 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9293 @cindex addressable memory unit
9294 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9295 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9296 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9297 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9298 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9299 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9300 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9301 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9302 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9303
9304 @cindex remote memory comparison
9305 @cindex target memory comparison
9306 @cindex verify remote memory image
9307 @cindex verify target memory image
9308 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9309 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9310 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9311 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9312 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9313 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9314
9315 @table @code
9316 @kindex compare-sections
9317 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9318 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9319 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9320 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9321 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9322 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9323
9324 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9325 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9326 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9327 @end table
9328
9329 @node Auto Display
9330 @section Automatic Display
9331 @cindex automatic display
9332 @cindex display of expressions
9333
9334 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9335 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9336 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9337 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9338 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9339 The automatic display looks like this:
9340
9341 @smallexample
9342 2: foo = 38
9343 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9344 @end smallexample
9345
9346 @noindent
9347 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9348 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9349 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9350 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9351 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9352 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9353
9354 @table @code
9355 @kindex display
9356 @item display @var{expr}
9357 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9358 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9359
9360 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9361
9362 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9363 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9364 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9365 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9366 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9367
9368 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9369 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9370 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9371 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9372 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9373 @end table
9374
9375 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9376 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9377 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9378
9379 @table @code
9380 @kindex delete display
9381 @kindex undisplay
9382 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9383 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9384 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9385 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9386 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9387 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9388 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9389
9390 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9391 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9392
9393 @kindex disable display
9394 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9395 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9396 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9397 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9398 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9399 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9400 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9401 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9402
9403 @kindex enable display
9404 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9405 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9406 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9407 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9408 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9409 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9410 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9411
9412 @item display
9413 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9414 done when your program stops.
9415
9416 @kindex info display
9417 @item info display
9418 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9419 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9420 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9421 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9422 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9423 @end table
9424
9425 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9426 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9427 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9428 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9429 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9430 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9431 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9432 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9433 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9434 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9435 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9436
9437 @node Print Settings
9438 @section Print Settings
9439
9440 @cindex format options
9441 @cindex print settings
9442 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9443 and symbols are printed.
9444
9445 @noindent
9446 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9447
9448 @table @code
9449 @kindex set print
9450 @item set print address
9451 @itemx set print address on
9452 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9453 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9454 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9455 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9456 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9457 @code{set print address on}:
9458
9459 @smallexample
9460 @group
9461 (@value{GDBP}) f
9462 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9463 at input.c:530
9464 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9465 @end group
9466 @end smallexample
9467
9468 @item set print address off
9469 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9470 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9471
9472 @smallexample
9473 @group
9474 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9475 (@value{GDBP}) f
9476 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9477 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9478 @end group
9479 @end smallexample
9480
9481 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9482 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9483 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9484 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9485
9486 @kindex show print
9487 @item show print address
9488 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9489 @end table
9490
9491 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9492 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9493 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9494 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9495 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9496 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9497 it prints a symbolic address:
9498
9499 @table @code
9500 @item set print symbol-filename on
9501 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9502 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9503 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9504 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9505
9506 @item set print symbol-filename off
9507 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9508 default.
9509
9510 @item show print symbol-filename
9511 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9512 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9513 @end table
9514
9515 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9516 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9517 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9518
9519 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9520 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9521
9522 @table @code
9523 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9524 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9525 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9526 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9527 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9528 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9529 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9530 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9531
9532 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9533 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9534 symbolic address.
9535 @end table
9536
9537 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9538 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9539 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9540 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9541 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9542 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9543 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9544 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9545
9546 @smallexample
9547 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9548 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9549 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9550 @end smallexample
9551
9552 @quotation
9553 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9554 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9555 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9556 @end quotation
9557
9558 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9559 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9560
9561 @table @code
9562 @item set print symbol on
9563 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9564 one exists.
9565
9566 @item set print symbol off
9567 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9568 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9569 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9570
9571 @item show print symbol
9572 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9573 address.
9574 @end table
9575
9576 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9577
9578 @table @code
9579 @item set print array
9580 @itemx set print array on
9581 @cindex pretty print arrays
9582 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9583 but uses more space. The default is off.
9584
9585 @item set print array off
9586 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9587
9588 @item show print array
9589 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9590 arrays.
9591
9592 @cindex print array indexes
9593 @item set print array-indexes
9594 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9595 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9596 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9597 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9598
9599 @item set print array-indexes off
9600 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9601
9602 @item show print array-indexes
9603 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9604 arrays.
9605
9606 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9607 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9608 @cindex number of array elements to print
9609 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9610 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9611 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9612 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9613 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9614 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9615 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9616 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9617
9618 @item show print elements
9619 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9620 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9621
9622 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9623 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9624 @cindex printing frame argument values
9625 @cindex print all frame argument values
9626 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9627 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9628 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9629 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9630 values are:
9631
9632 @table @code
9633 @item all
9634 The values of all arguments are printed.
9635
9636 @item scalars
9637 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9638 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9639 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9640 only scalar arguments are shown:
9641
9642 @smallexample
9643 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9644 at frame-args.c:23
9645 @end smallexample
9646
9647 @item none
9648 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9649 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9650
9651 @smallexample
9652 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9653 at frame-args.c:23
9654 @end smallexample
9655 @end table
9656
9657 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9658 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9659 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9660 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9661 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9662 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9663 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9664 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9665 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9666 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9667
9668 @item show print frame-arguments
9669 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9670
9671 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9672 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9673
9674 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9675 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9676 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9677 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9678 This is the default.
9679
9680 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9681 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9682
9683 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9684 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9685 @kindex set print entry-values
9686 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9687 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9688 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9689 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9690 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9691
9692 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9693 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9694 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9695 @code{no} setting.
9696
9697 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9698 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9699 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9700 this information.
9701
9702 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9703
9704 @table @code
9705 @item no
9706 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9707 point.
9708 @smallexample
9709 #0 equal (val=5)
9710 #0 different (val=6)
9711 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9712 #0 born (val=10)
9713 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9714 @end smallexample
9715
9716 @item only
9717 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9718 values are never printed.
9719 @smallexample
9720 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9721 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9722 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9723 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9724 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9725 @end smallexample
9726
9727 @item preferred
9728 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9729 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9730 value for such parameter.
9731 @smallexample
9732 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9733 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9734 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9735 #0 born (val=10)
9736 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9737 @end smallexample
9738
9739 @item if-needed
9740 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9741 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9742 parameter.
9743 @smallexample
9744 #0 equal (val=5)
9745 #0 different (val=6)
9746 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9747 #0 born (val=10)
9748 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 @item both
9752 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9753 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9754 optimizations.
9755 @smallexample
9756 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9757 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9758 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9759 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9760 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9761 @end smallexample
9762
9763 @item compact
9764 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9765 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9766 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9767 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9768 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9769 @smallexample
9770 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9771 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9772 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9773 #0 born (val=10)
9774 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9775 @end smallexample
9776
9777 @item default
9778 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9779 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9780 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9781 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9782 @smallexample
9783 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9784 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9785 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9786 #0 born (val=10)
9787 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9788 @end smallexample
9789 @end table
9790
9791 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9792 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9793
9794 @item show print entry-values
9795 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9796 entry.
9797
9798 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9799 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9800 @cindex repeated array elements
9801 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9802 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9803 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9804 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9805 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9806 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9807 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9808 is 10.
9809
9810 @item show print repeats
9811 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9812 elements.
9813
9814 @item set print null-stop
9815 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9816 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9817 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9818 contain only short strings.
9819 The default is off.
9820
9821 @item show print null-stop
9822 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9823 @sc{null} character.
9824
9825 @item set print pretty on
9826 @cindex print structures in indented form
9827 @cindex indentation in structure display
9828 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9829 per line, like this:
9830
9831 @smallexample
9832 @group
9833 $1 = @{
9834 next = 0x0,
9835 flags = @{
9836 sweet = 1,
9837 sour = 1
9838 @},
9839 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9840 @}
9841 @end group
9842 @end smallexample
9843
9844 @item set print pretty off
9845 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9846
9847 @smallexample
9848 @group
9849 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9850 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9851 @end group
9852 @end smallexample
9853
9854 @noindent
9855 This is the default format.
9856
9857 @item show print pretty
9858 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9859
9860 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9861 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9862 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9863 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9864 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9865 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9866 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9867 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9868
9869 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9870 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9871 international character sets, and is the default.
9872
9873 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9874 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9875
9876 @item set print union on
9877 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9878 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9879 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9880
9881 @item set print union off
9882 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9883 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9884 instead.
9885
9886 @item show print union
9887 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9888 structures and other unions.
9889
9890 For example, given the declarations
9891
9892 @smallexample
9893 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9894 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9895 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9896 Bug_forms;
9897
9898 struct thing @{
9899 Species it;
9900 union @{
9901 Tree_forms tree;
9902 Bug_forms bug;
9903 @} form;
9904 @};
9905
9906 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9907 @end smallexample
9908
9909 @noindent
9910 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9911
9912 @smallexample
9913 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9914 @end smallexample
9915
9916 @noindent
9917 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9918
9919 @smallexample
9920 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9921 @end smallexample
9922
9923 @noindent
9924 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9925 and in Pascal.
9926 @end table
9927
9928 @need 1000
9929 @noindent
9930 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9931
9932 @table @code
9933 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9934 @item set print demangle
9935 @itemx set print demangle on
9936 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9937 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9938 linkage. The default is on.
9939
9940 @item show print demangle
9941 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9942
9943 @item set print asm-demangle
9944 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9945 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9946 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9947 The default is off.
9948
9949 @item show print asm-demangle
9950 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9951 or demangled form.
9952
9953 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9954 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9955 @kindex set demangle-style
9956 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9957 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9958 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9959
9960 @table @code
9961 @item auto
9962 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9963 This is the default.
9964
9965 @item gnu
9966 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9967
9968 @item hp
9969 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9970
9971 @item lucid
9972 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9973
9974 @item arm
9975 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9976 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9977 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9978 require further enhancement to permit that.
9979
9980 @end table
9981 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9982
9983 @item show demangle-style
9984 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9985
9986 @item set print object
9987 @itemx set print object on
9988 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9989 @cindex display derived types
9990 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9991 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9992 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9993 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9994 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9995 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9996 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9997
9998 @item set print object off
9999 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10000 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10001
10002 @item show print object
10003 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10004
10005 @item set print static-members
10006 @itemx set print static-members on
10007 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10008 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10009
10010 @item set print static-members off
10011 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10012
10013 @item show print static-members
10014 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10015
10016 @item set print pascal_static-members
10017 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10018 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10019 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10020 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10021
10022 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10023 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10024
10025 @item show print pascal_static-members
10026 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10027
10028 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10029 @item set print vtbl
10030 @itemx set print vtbl on
10031 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10032 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10033 @cindex VTBL display
10034 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10035 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10036 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10037
10038 @item set print vtbl off
10039 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10040
10041 @item show print vtbl
10042 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10043 @end table
10044
10045 @node Pretty Printing
10046 @section Pretty Printing
10047
10048 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10049 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10050 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10051
10052 @menu
10053 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10054 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10055 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10056 @end menu
10057
10058 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10059 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10060
10061 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10062 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10063 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10064
10065 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10066 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10067 pretty-printers with their names.
10068 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10069 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10070 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10071 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10072
10073 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10074 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10075 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10076 do anything special.
10077
10078 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10079
10080 @itemize @bullet
10081 @item
10082 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10083 all inferiors.
10084
10085 @item
10086 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10087 when debugging that program.
10088 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10089
10090 @item
10091 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10092 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10093 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10094 @end itemize
10095
10096 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10097 pretty-printers are selected,
10098
10099 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10100 for new types.
10101
10102 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10103 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10104
10105 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10106
10107 @smallexample
10108 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10109 $1 = @{
10110 static npos = 4294967295,
10111 _M_dataplus = @{
10112 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10113 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10114 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10115 @},
10116 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10117 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10118 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10119 @}
10120 @}
10121 @end smallexample
10122
10123 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10124
10125 @smallexample
10126 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10127 $2 = "abcd"
10128 @end smallexample
10129
10130 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10131 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10132 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10133
10134 @table @code
10135 @kindex info pretty-printer
10136 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10137 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10138 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10139
10140 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10141 whose pretty-printers to list.
10142 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10143 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10144 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10145 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10146 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10147
10148 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10149 to list.
10150
10151 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10152 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10153 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10154 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10155
10156 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10157 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10158 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10159 @end table
10160
10161 Example:
10162
10163 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10164 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10165 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10166 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10167
10168 @smallexample
10169 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10170 library1.so:
10171 foo
10172 library2.so:
10173 bar
10174 bar1
10175 bar2
10176 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10177 library2.so:
10178 bar
10179 bar1
10180 bar2
10181 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10182 1 printer disabled
10183 2 of 3 printers enabled
10184 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10185 library1.so:
10186 foo [disabled]
10187 library2.so:
10188 bar
10189 bar1
10190 bar2
10191 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10192 1 printer disabled
10193 1 of 3 printers enabled
10194 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10195 library1.so:
10196 foo [disabled]
10197 library2.so:
10198 bar
10199 bar1 [disabled]
10200 bar2
10201 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10202 1 printer disabled
10203 0 of 3 printers enabled
10204 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10205 library1.so:
10206 foo [disabled]
10207 library2.so:
10208 bar [disabled]
10209 bar1 [disabled]
10210 bar2
10211 @end smallexample
10212
10213 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10214 as can each individual subprinter.
10215
10216 @node Value History
10217 @section Value History
10218
10219 @cindex value history
10220 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10221 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10222 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10223 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10224 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10225 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10226 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10227 symbol table.
10228
10229 @cindex @code{$}
10230 @cindex @code{$$}
10231 @cindex history number
10232 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10233 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10234 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10235 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10236 history number.
10237
10238 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10239 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10240 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10241 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10242 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10243 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10244 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10245
10246 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10247 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10248
10249 @smallexample
10250 p *$
10251 @end smallexample
10252
10253 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10254 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10255
10256 @smallexample
10257 p *$.next
10258 @end smallexample
10259
10260 @noindent
10261 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10262 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10263
10264 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10265 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10266
10267 @smallexample
10268 print x
10269 set x=5
10270 @end smallexample
10271
10272 @noindent
10273 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10274 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10275
10276 @table @code
10277 @kindex show values
10278 @item show values
10279 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10280 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10281 values} does not change the history.
10282
10283 @item show values @var{n}
10284 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10285
10286 @item show values +
10287 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10288 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10289 @end table
10290
10291 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10292 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10293
10294 @node Convenience Vars
10295 @section Convenience Variables
10296
10297 @cindex convenience variables
10298 @cindex user-defined variables
10299 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10300 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10301 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10302 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10303 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10304
10305 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10306 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10307 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10308 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10309 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10310
10311 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10312 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10313 For example:
10314
10315 @smallexample
10316 set $foo = *object_ptr
10317 @end smallexample
10318
10319 @noindent
10320 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10321 @code{object_ptr}.
10322
10323 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10324 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10325 value with another assignment at any time.
10326
10327 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10328 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10329 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10330 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10331
10332 @table @code
10333 @kindex show convenience
10334 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10335 @item show convenience
10336 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10337 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10338 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10339
10340 @kindex init-if-undefined
10341 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10342 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10343 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10344 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10345 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10346 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10347 override default values used in a command script.
10348
10349 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10350 any side-effects do not occur.
10351 @end table
10352
10353 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10354 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10355 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10356
10357 @smallexample
10358 set $i = 0
10359 print bar[$i++]->contents
10360 @end smallexample
10361
10362 @noindent
10363 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10364
10365 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10366 values likely to be useful.
10367
10368 @table @code
10369 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10370 @item $_
10371 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10372 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10373 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10374 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10375 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10376 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10377 to the type of @code{$__}.
10378
10379 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10380 @item $__
10381 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10382 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10383 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10384
10385 @item $_exitcode
10386 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10387 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10388 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10389 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10390
10391 @item $_exitsignal
10392 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10393 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10394 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10395 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10396
10397 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10398 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10399 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10400 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10401 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10402
10403 @smallexample
10404 #include <signal.h>
10405
10406 int
10407 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10408 @{
10409 raise (SIGALRM);
10410 return 0;
10411 @}
10412 @end smallexample
10413
10414 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10415 or signalled would be:
10416
10417 @smallexample
10418 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10419 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10420 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10421 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10422 >echo The program has exited\n
10423 >else
10424 >echo The program has signalled\n
10425 >end
10426 >end
10427 (@value{GDBP}) run
10428 Starting program:
10429
10430 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10431 The program no longer exists.
10432 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10433 The program has signalled
10434 @end smallexample
10435
10436 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10437 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10438 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10439 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10440
10441 @smallexample
10442 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10443 The program has exited
10444 @end smallexample
10445
10446 @item $_exception
10447 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10448 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10449
10450 @item $_probe_argc
10451 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10452 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10453
10454 @item $_sdata
10455 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10456 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10457 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10458 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10459 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10460
10461 @item $_siginfo
10462 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10463 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10464 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10465 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10466 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10467
10468 @item $_tlb
10469 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10470 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10471 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10472 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10473 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10474 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10475
10476 @item $_inferior
10477 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10478 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10479
10480 @item $_thread
10481 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10482
10483 @item $_gthread
10484 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10485
10486 @end table
10487
10488 @node Convenience Funs
10489 @section Convenience Functions
10490
10491 @cindex convenience functions
10492 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10493 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10494 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10495 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10496 @value{GDBN}.
10497
10498 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10499 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10500
10501 @table @code
10502
10503 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10504 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10505 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10506 returns zero.
10507
10508 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10509 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10510 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10511 it is @code{void}:
10512
10513 @smallexample
10514 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10515 $1 = void
10516 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10517 $2 = 1
10518 (@value{GDBP}) run
10519 Starting program: ./a.out
10520 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10521 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10522 $3 = 0
10523 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10524 $4 = 0
10525 @end smallexample
10526
10527 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10528 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10529 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10530 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10531 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10532 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10533 anymore.
10534
10535 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10536 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10537
10538 @smallexample
10539 void
10540 foo (void)
10541 @{
10542 @}
10543 @end smallexample
10544
10545 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10546
10547 @smallexample
10548 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10549 $1 = void
10550 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10551 $2 = 1
10552 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10553 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10554 $3 = void
10555 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10556 $4 = 1
10557 @end smallexample
10558
10559 @end table
10560
10561 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10562 @code{Python} support.
10563
10564 @table @code
10565
10566 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10567 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10568 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10569 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10570 Otherwise it returns zero.
10571
10572 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10573 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10574 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10575 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10576 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10577 regular expression support.
10578
10579 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10580 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10581 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10582 Otherwise it returns zero.
10583
10584 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10585 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10586 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10587
10588 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10589 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10590 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10591 Otherwise it returns zero.
10592
10593 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10594 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10595 The default is 1.
10596
10597 Example:
10598
10599 @smallexample
10600 (gdb) backtrace
10601 #0 bottom_func ()
10602 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10603 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10604 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10605 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10606 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10607 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10608 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10609 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10610 $1 = 1
10611 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10612 $1 = 1
10613 @end smallexample
10614
10615 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10616 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10617 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10618 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10619
10620 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10621 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10622 The default is 1.
10623
10624 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10625 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10626 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10627 Otherwise it returns zero.
10628
10629 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10630 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10631 The default is 1.
10632
10633 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10634 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10635 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10636 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10637
10638 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10639 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10640 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10641 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10642
10643 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10644 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10645 The default is 1.
10646
10647 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10648 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10649 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10650 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10651
10652 @end table
10653
10654 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10655 convenience functions.
10656
10657 @table @code
10658 @item help function
10659 @kindex help function
10660 @cindex show all convenience functions
10661 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10662 @end table
10663
10664 @node Registers
10665 @section Registers
10666
10667 @cindex registers
10668 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10669 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10670 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10671 your machine.
10672
10673 @table @code
10674 @kindex info registers
10675 @item info registers
10676 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10677 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10678
10679 @kindex info all-registers
10680 @cindex floating point registers
10681 @item info all-registers
10682 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10683 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10684
10685 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10686 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10687 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10688 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10689 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10690 @end table
10691
10692 @anchor{standard registers}
10693 @cindex stack pointer register
10694 @cindex program counter register
10695 @cindex process status register
10696 @cindex frame pointer register
10697 @cindex standard registers
10698 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10699 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10700 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10701 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10702 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10703 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10704 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10705 you could print the program counter in hex with
10706
10707 @smallexample
10708 p/x $pc
10709 @end smallexample
10710
10711 @noindent
10712 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10713
10714 @smallexample
10715 x/i $pc
10716 @end smallexample
10717
10718 @noindent
10719 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10720 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10721 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10722 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10723 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10724 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10725 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10726
10727 @smallexample
10728 set $sp += 4
10729 @end smallexample
10730
10731 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10732 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10733 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10734 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10735 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10736 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10737 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10738
10739 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10740 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10741 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10742 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10743 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10744 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10745 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10746
10747 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10748 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10749 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10750 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10751 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10752 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10753 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10754 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10755 prints the data in both formats.
10756
10757 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10758 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10759 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10760 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10761 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10762 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10763 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10764
10765 @smallexample
10766 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10767 $1 = @{
10768 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10769 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10770 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10771 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10772 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10773 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10774 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10775 @}
10776 @end smallexample
10777
10778 @noindent
10779 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10780 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10781 value to a @code{struct} member:
10782
10783 @smallexample
10784 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10785 @end smallexample
10786
10787 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10788 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10789 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10790 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10791 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10792 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10793
10794 @cindex caller-saved registers
10795 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10796 @cindex volatile registers
10797 @cindex <not saved> values
10798 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10799 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10800 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10801 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10802 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10803 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10804 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10805 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10806 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10807 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10808 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10809 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10810 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10811 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10812 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10813 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10814 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10815 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10816 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10817 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10818 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10819 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10820 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10821
10822 @node Floating Point Hardware
10823 @section Floating Point Hardware
10824 @cindex floating point
10825
10826 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10827 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10828
10829 @table @code
10830 @kindex info float
10831 @item info float
10832 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10833 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10834 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10835 the ARM and x86 machines.
10836 @end table
10837
10838 @node Vector Unit
10839 @section Vector Unit
10840 @cindex vector unit
10841
10842 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10843 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10844
10845 @table @code
10846 @kindex info vector
10847 @item info vector
10848 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10849 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10850 @end table
10851
10852 @node OS Information
10853 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10854 @cindex OS information
10855
10856 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10857 you debug your program.
10858
10859 @cindex auxiliary vector
10860 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10861 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10862 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10863 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10864 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10865 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10866 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10867 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10868 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10869 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10870 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10871 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10872
10873 @table @code
10874 @kindex info auxv
10875 @item info auxv
10876 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10877 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10878 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10879 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10880 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10881 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10882 an unrecognized tag.
10883 @end table
10884
10885 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10886 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10887 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10888 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10889 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10890 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10891 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10892
10893 @table @code
10894 @kindex info os
10895 @item info os @var{infotype}
10896
10897 Display OS information of the requested type.
10898
10899 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10900
10901 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10902 @table @code
10903 @kindex info os cpus
10904 @item cpus
10905 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10906 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10907 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10908 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10909 kernel initialization.
10910
10911 @kindex info os files
10912 @item files
10913 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10914 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10915 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10916 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10917
10918 @kindex info os modules
10919 @item modules
10920 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10921 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10922 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10923 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10924 in memory.
10925
10926 @kindex info os msg
10927 @item msg
10928 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10929 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10930 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10931 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10932 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10933 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10934 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10935 the message queue was last changed.
10936
10937 @kindex info os processes
10938 @item processes
10939 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10940 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10941 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10942 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10943 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10944 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10945
10946 @kindex info os procgroups
10947 @item procgroups
10948 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10949 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10950 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10951 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10952 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10953 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10954 and the process group leader is listed first.
10955
10956 @kindex info os semaphores
10957 @item semaphores
10958 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10959 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10960 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10961 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10962 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10963
10964 @kindex info os shm
10965 @item shm
10966 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10967 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10968 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10969 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10970 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10971 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10972 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10973
10974 @kindex info os sockets
10975 @item sockets
10976 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10977 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10978 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10979 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10980 connection.
10981
10982 @kindex info os threads
10983 @item threads
10984 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10985 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10986 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10987 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10988 process is not listed.
10989 @end table
10990
10991 @item info os
10992 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10993 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10994 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10995 types, this command will report an error.
10996 @end table
10997
10998 @node Memory Region Attributes
10999 @section Memory Region Attributes
11000 @cindex memory region attributes
11001
11002 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11003 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11004 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11005 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11006 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11007 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11008 user can override the fetched regions.
11009
11010 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11011 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11012 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11013 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11014 all memory.
11015
11016 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11017 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11018
11019 @table @code
11020 @kindex mem
11021 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11022 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11023 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11024 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11025 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11026 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11027
11028 @item mem auto
11029 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11030 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11031
11032 @kindex delete mem
11033 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11034 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11035 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11036
11037 @kindex disable mem
11038 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11039 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11040 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11041 It may be enabled again later.
11042
11043 @kindex enable mem
11044 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11045 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11046
11047 @kindex info mem
11048 @item info mem
11049 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11050 for each region:
11051
11052 @table @emph
11053 @item Memory Region Number
11054 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11055 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11056 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11057
11058 @item Lo Address
11059 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11060
11061 @item Hi Address
11062 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11063
11064 @item Attributes
11065 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11066 @end table
11067 @end table
11068
11069
11070 @subsection Attributes
11071
11072 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11073 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11074 write accesses to a memory region.
11075
11076 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11077 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11078 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11079
11080 @table @code
11081 @item ro
11082 Memory is read only.
11083 @item wo
11084 Memory is write only.
11085 @item rw
11086 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11087 @end table
11088
11089 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11090 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11091 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11092 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11093 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11094
11095 @table @code
11096 @item 8
11097 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11098 @item 16
11099 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11100 @item 32
11101 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11102 @item 64
11103 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11104 @end table
11105
11106 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11107 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11108 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11109 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11110 @c
11111 @c @table @code
11112 @c @item hwbreak
11113 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11114 @c @item swbreak (default)
11115 @c @end table
11116
11117 @subsubsection Data Cache
11118 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11119 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11120 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11121 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11122 registers.
11123
11124 @table @code
11125 @item cache
11126 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11127 @item nocache
11128 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11129 @end table
11130
11131 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11132 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11133 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11134 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11135 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11136
11137 @table @code
11138 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11139 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11140 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11141 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11142 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11143 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11144 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11145 The default value is @code{on}.
11146 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11147 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11148 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11149 @end table
11150
11151
11152 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11153 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11154 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11155 @c
11156 @c @table @code
11157 @c @item verify
11158 @c @item noverify (default)
11159 @c @end table
11160
11161 @node Dump/Restore Files
11162 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11163 @cindex dump/restore files
11164 @cindex append data to a file
11165 @cindex dump data to a file
11166 @cindex restore data from a file
11167
11168 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11169 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11170 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11171 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11172 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11173 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11174 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11175
11176 @table @code
11177
11178 @kindex dump
11179 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11180 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11181 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11182 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11183
11184 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11185 @table @code
11186 @item binary
11187 Raw binary form.
11188 @item ihex
11189 Intel hex format.
11190 @item srec
11191 Motorola S-record format.
11192 @item tekhex
11193 Tektronix Hex format.
11194 @item verilog
11195 Verilog Hex format.
11196 @end table
11197
11198 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11199 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11200 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11201 form.
11202
11203 @kindex append
11204 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11205 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11206 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11207 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11208 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11209
11210 @kindex restore
11211 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11212 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11213 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11214 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11215 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11216
11217 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11218 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11219 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11220 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11221 from that location.
11222
11223 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11224 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11225 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11226 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11227
11228 @end table
11229
11230 @node Core File Generation
11231 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11232 @cindex dump core from inferior
11233
11234 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11235 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11236 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11237 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11238 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11239 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11240 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11241
11242 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11243 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11244 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11245
11246 @table @code
11247 @kindex gcore
11248 @kindex generate-core-file
11249 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11250 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11251 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11252 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11253 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11254 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11255
11256 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11257 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11258
11259 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11260 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11261 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11262
11263 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11264 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11265 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11266 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11267 Enable or disable the use of the file
11268 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11269 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11270 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11271 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11272
11273 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11274 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11275 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11276 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11277 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11278 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11279 about the bits that can be set in the
11280 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11281 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11282
11283 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11284 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11285 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11286 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11287 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11288 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11289 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11290 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11291 @end table
11292
11293 @node Character Sets
11294 @section Character Sets
11295 @cindex character sets
11296 @cindex charset
11297 @cindex translating between character sets
11298 @cindex host character set
11299 @cindex target character set
11300
11301 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11302 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11303 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11304 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11305 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11306 @dfn{target character set}.
11307
11308 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11309 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11310 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11311 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11312 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11313 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11314 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11315 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11316 character and string literals in expressions.
11317
11318 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11319 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11320 target-charset} command, described below.
11321
11322 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11323 support:
11324
11325 @table @code
11326 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11327 @kindex set target-charset
11328 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11329 list of supported target character sets, type
11330 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11331
11332 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11333 @kindex set host-charset
11334 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11335
11336 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11337 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11338 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11339 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11340 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11341
11342 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11343 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11344 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11345
11346 @item set charset @var{charset}
11347 @kindex set charset
11348 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11349 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11350 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11351 for both host and target.
11352
11353 @item show charset
11354 @kindex show charset
11355 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11356
11357 @item show host-charset
11358 @kindex show host-charset
11359 Show the name of the current host character set.
11360
11361 @item show target-charset
11362 @kindex show target-charset
11363 Show the name of the current target character set.
11364
11365 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11366 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11367 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11368 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11369 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11370 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11371
11372 @item show target-wide-charset
11373 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11374 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11375 @end table
11376
11377 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11378 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11379 @file{charset-test.c}:
11380
11381 @smallexample
11382 #include <stdio.h>
11383
11384 char ascii_hello[]
11385 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11386 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11387 char ibm1047_hello[]
11388 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11389 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11390
11391 main ()
11392 @{
11393 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11394 @}
11395 @end smallexample
11396
11397 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11398 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11399 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11400
11401 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11402
11403 @smallexample
11404 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11405 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11406 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11407 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11408 @dots{}
11409 (@value{GDBP})
11410 @end smallexample
11411
11412 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11413 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11414 strings:
11415
11416 @smallexample
11417 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11418 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11419 (@value{GDBP})
11420 @end smallexample
11421
11422 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11423 initial character set:
11424 @smallexample
11425 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11426 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11427 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11428 (@value{GDBP})
11429 @end smallexample
11430
11431 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11432 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11433 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11434 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11435 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11436
11437 @smallexample
11438 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11439 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11440 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11441 $2 = 72 'H'
11442 (@value{GDBP})
11443 @end smallexample
11444
11445 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11446 literals you use in expressions:
11447
11448 @smallexample
11449 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11450 $3 = 43 '+'
11451 (@value{GDBP})
11452 @end smallexample
11453
11454 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11455 character.
11456
11457 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11458 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11459 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11460
11461 @smallexample
11462 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11463 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11464 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11465 $5 = 200 '\310'
11466 (@value{GDBP})
11467 @end smallexample
11468
11469 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11470 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11471
11472 @smallexample
11473 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11474 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11475 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11476 @end smallexample
11477
11478 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11479 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11480 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11481 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11482 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11483
11484 @smallexample
11485 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11486 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11487 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11488 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11489 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11490 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11491 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11492 $7 = 72 '\110'
11493 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11494 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11495 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11496 $9 = 200 'H'
11497 (@value{GDBP})
11498 @end smallexample
11499
11500 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11501 string literals you use in expressions:
11502
11503 @smallexample
11504 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11505 $10 = 78 '+'
11506 (@value{GDBP})
11507 @end smallexample
11508
11509 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11510 character.
11511
11512 @node Caching Target Data
11513 @section Caching Data of Targets
11514 @cindex caching data of targets
11515
11516 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11517 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11518 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11519 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11520 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11521 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11522 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11523 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11524 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11525 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11526 is executing.
11527 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11528 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11529 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11530 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11531 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11532 in the code segment.
11533 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11534 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11535
11536 @table @code
11537 @kindex set remotecache
11538 @item set remotecache on
11539 @itemx set remotecache off
11540 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11541 with old scripts.
11542
11543 @kindex show remotecache
11544 @item show remotecache
11545 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11546
11547 @kindex set stack-cache
11548 @item set stack-cache on
11549 @itemx set stack-cache off
11550 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11551 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11552
11553 @kindex show stack-cache
11554 @item show stack-cache
11555 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11556
11557 @kindex set code-cache
11558 @item set code-cache on
11559 @itemx set code-cache off
11560 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11561 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11562 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11563
11564 @kindex show code-cache
11565 @item show code-cache
11566 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11567 accesses.
11568
11569 @kindex info dcache
11570 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11571 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11572 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11573 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11574 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11575 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11576
11577 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11578 printed in hex.
11579
11580 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11581 @cindex dcache size
11582 @kindex set dcache size
11583 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11584
11585 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11586 @cindex dcache line-size
11587 @kindex set dcache line-size
11588 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11589 Must be a power of 2.
11590
11591 @item show dcache size
11592 @kindex show dcache size
11593 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11594
11595 @item show dcache line-size
11596 @kindex show dcache line-size
11597 Show default size of dcache lines.
11598
11599 @end table
11600
11601 @node Searching Memory
11602 @section Search Memory
11603 @cindex searching memory
11604
11605 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11606 @code{find} command.
11607
11608 @table @code
11609 @kindex find
11610 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11611 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11612 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11613 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11614 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11615 @end table
11616
11617 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11618 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11619
11620 @table @r
11621 @item @var{s}, search query size
11622 The size of each search query value.
11623
11624 @table @code
11625 @item b
11626 bytes
11627 @item h
11628 halfwords (two bytes)
11629 @item w
11630 words (four bytes)
11631 @item g
11632 giant words (eight bytes)
11633 @end table
11634
11635 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11636 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11637 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11638
11639 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11640 value's type in the current language.
11641 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11642 pattern as a mixture of types.
11643 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11644 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11645 which is typically four bytes.
11646
11647 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11648 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11649 @end table
11650
11651 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11652 (@code{"}).
11653 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11654 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11655
11656 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11657 number of matches found.
11658
11659 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11660 @samp{$_}.
11661 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11662
11663 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11664
11665 @smallexample
11666 void
11667 hello ()
11668 @{
11669 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11670 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11671 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11672 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11673 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11674 @}
11675 @end smallexample
11676
11677 @noindent
11678 you get during debugging:
11679
11680 @smallexample
11681 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11682 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11683 1 pattern found
11684 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11685 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11686 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11687 2 patterns found
11688 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11689 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11690 1 pattern found
11691 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11692 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11693 1 pattern found
11694 (gdb) print $numfound
11695 $1 = 1
11696 (gdb) print $_
11697 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11698 @end smallexample
11699
11700 @node Optimized Code
11701 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11702 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11703 @cindex debugging optimized code
11704
11705 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11706 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11707 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11708 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11709 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11710 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11711 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11712
11713 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11714 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11715 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11716 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11717
11718 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11719 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11720 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11721 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11722 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11723 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11724
11725 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11726 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11727 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11728 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11729 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11730
11731 @menu
11732 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11733 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11734 @end menu
11735
11736 @node Inline Functions
11737 @section Inline Functions
11738 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11739
11740 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11741 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11742 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11743 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11744 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11745 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11746 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11747 @code{info frame} command.
11748
11749 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11750 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11751 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11752 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11753 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11754 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11755 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11756 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11757 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11758 local variables in the caller.
11759
11760 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11761 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11762 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11763 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11764 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11765 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11766 instructions are executed.
11767
11768 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11769 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11770 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11771 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11772
11773 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11774 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11775
11776 @itemize @bullet
11777 @item
11778 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11779 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11780 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11781 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11782 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11783 or inside the inlined function instead.
11784
11785 @item
11786 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11787 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11788 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11789 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11790
11791 @end itemize
11792
11793 @node Tail Call Frames
11794 @section Tail Call Frames
11795 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11796
11797 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11798 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11799 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11800 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11801 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11802
11803 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11804 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11805 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11806 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11807 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11808 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11809 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11810
11811 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11812 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11813 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11814 this information.
11815
11816 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11817 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11818
11819 @smallexample
11820 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11821 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11822 (gdb) info frame
11823 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11824 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11825 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11826 source language c++.
11827 Arglist at unknown address.
11828 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11829 @end smallexample
11830
11831 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11832 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11833 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11834 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11835 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11836 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11837
11838 @table @code
11839 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11840 @item set debug entry-values
11841 @kindex set debug entry-values
11842 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11843 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11844 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11845 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11846 result.
11847
11848 @item show debug entry-values
11849 @kindex show debug entry-values
11850 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11851 values at function entry and tail calls.
11852 @end table
11853
11854 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11855 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11856 reference by variable @code{x}):
11857
11858 @smallexample
11859 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11860 void (*x) (void) = c;
11861 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11862 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11863 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11864
11865 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11866 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11867 a () at t.c:3
11868 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11869 (gdb) bt
11870 #0 a () at t.c:3
11871 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11872 @end smallexample
11873
11874 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11875
11876 @smallexample
11877 int i;
11878 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11879 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11880 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11881 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11882 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11883 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11884 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11885 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11886
11887 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11888 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11889 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11890 (gdb) bt
11891 #0 f () at t.c:2
11892 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11893 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11894 @end smallexample
11895
11896 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11897 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11898
11899 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11900 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11901 @set ARROW @click{}
11902 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11903 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11904 @end ifset
11905 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11906 @set ARROW ->
11907 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11908 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11909 @end ifclear
11910
11911 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11912 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11913 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11914
11915 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11916 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11917 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11918 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11919 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11920 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11921
11922 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11923 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11924 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11925 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11926 omitted.
11927
11928 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11929 entry may fail:
11930
11931 @smallexample
11932 int v;
11933 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11934 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11935 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11936 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11937 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11938 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11939
11940 (gdb) bt
11941 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11942 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11943 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11944 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11945 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11946 @end smallexample
11947
11948 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11949 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11950 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11951 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11952 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11953
11954 @node Macros
11955 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11956
11957 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11958 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11959 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11960 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11961 where it was defined.
11962
11963 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11964 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11965 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11966 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11967
11968 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11969 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11970 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11971 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11972 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11973 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11974 see @ref{List}.
11975
11976 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11977 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11978 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11979
11980 @table @code
11981
11982 @kindex macro expand
11983 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11984 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11985 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11986 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11987 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11988 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11989 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11990 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11991 it can be any string of tokens.
11992
11993 @kindex macro exp1
11994 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11995 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11996 @cindex expand macro once
11997 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11998 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11999 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12000 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12001 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12002 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12003 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12004 can be any string of tokens.
12005
12006 @kindex info macro
12007 @cindex macro definition, showing
12008 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12009 @cindex macros, from debug info
12010 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12011 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12012 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12013 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12014 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12015 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12016
12017 @kindex info macros
12018 @item info macros @var{location}
12019 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12020 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12021 command-line where those definitions were established.
12022
12023 @kindex macro define
12024 @cindex user-defined macros
12025 @cindex defining macros interactively
12026 @cindex macros, user-defined
12027 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12028 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12029 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12030 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12031 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12032 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12033 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12034 @var{arglist}.
12035
12036 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12037 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12038 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12039 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12040 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12041
12042 @kindex macro undef
12043 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12044 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12045 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12046 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12047 in the program being debugged.
12048
12049 @kindex macro list
12050 @item macro list
12051 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12052 @end table
12053
12054 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12055 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12056 show our source files:
12057
12058 @smallexample
12059 $ cat sample.c
12060 #include <stdio.h>
12061 #include "sample.h"
12062
12063 #define M 42
12064 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12065
12066 main ()
12067 @{
12068 #define N 28
12069 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12070 #undef N
12071 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12072 #define N 1729
12073 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12074 @}
12075 $ cat sample.h
12076 #define Q <
12077 $
12078 @end smallexample
12079
12080 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12081 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12082 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12083 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12084 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12085 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12086 information.
12087
12088 @smallexample
12089 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12090 $
12091 @end smallexample
12092
12093 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12094
12095 @smallexample
12096 $ gdb -nw sample
12097 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12098 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12099 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12100 (@value{GDBP})
12101 @end smallexample
12102
12103 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12104 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12105 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12106
12107 @smallexample
12108 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12109 3
12110 4 #define M 42
12111 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12112 6
12113 7 main ()
12114 8 @{
12115 9 #define N 28
12116 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12117 11 #undef N
12118 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12119 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12120 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12121 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12122 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12123 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12124 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12125 #define Q <
12126 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12127 expands to: (42 + 1)
12128 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12129 expands to: once (M + 1)
12130 (@value{GDBP})
12131 @end smallexample
12132
12133 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12134 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12135 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12136 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12137
12138 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12139 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12140
12141 @smallexample
12142 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12143 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12144 (@value{GDBP}) run
12145 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12146
12147 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12148 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12149 (@value{GDBP})
12150 @end smallexample
12151
12152 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12153
12154 @smallexample
12155 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12156 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12157 #define N 28
12158 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12159 expands to: 28 < 42
12160 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12161 $1 = 1
12162 (@value{GDBP})
12163 @end smallexample
12164
12165 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12166 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12167 thereof) in force at each point:
12168
12169 @smallexample
12170 (@value{GDBP}) next
12171 Hello, world!
12172 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12173 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12174 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12175 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12176 (@value{GDBP}) next
12177 We're so creative.
12178 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12179 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12180 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12181 #define N 1729
12182 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12183 expands to: 1729 < 42
12184 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12185 $2 = 0
12186 (@value{GDBP})
12187 @end smallexample
12188
12189 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12190 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12191 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12192 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12193
12194 @smallexample
12195 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12196 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12197 -D__STDC__=1
12198 (@value{GDBP})
12199 @end smallexample
12200
12201
12202 @node Tracepoints
12203 @chapter Tracepoints
12204 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12205 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12206
12207 @cindex tracepoints
12208 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12209 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12210 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12211 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12212 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12213 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12214 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12215
12216 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12217 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12218 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12219 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12220 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12221 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12222 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12223 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12224 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12225 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12226 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12227
12228 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12229 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12230 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12231 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12232 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12233 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12234 Packets}.
12235
12236 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12237 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12238 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12239
12240 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12241
12242 @menu
12243 * Set Tracepoints::
12244 * Analyze Collected Data::
12245 * Tracepoint Variables::
12246 * Trace Files::
12247 @end menu
12248
12249 @node Set Tracepoints
12250 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12251
12252 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12253 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12254 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12255 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12256 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12257 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12258 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12259
12260 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12261 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12262 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12263 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12264 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12265 tracepoint was hit.
12266
12267 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12268 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12269 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12270 either.
12271
12272 @cindex fast tracepoints
12273 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12274 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12275 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12276
12277 @cindex static tracepoints
12278 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12279 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12280 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12281 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12282 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12283 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12284 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12285 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12286 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12287 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12288 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12289 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12290 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12291 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12292 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12293 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12294 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12295 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12296 static tracepoint marker.
12297
12298 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12299 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12300
12301 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12302 conditions and actions.
12303
12304 @menu
12305 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12306 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12307 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12308 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12309 * Trace State Variables::
12310 * Tracepoint Actions::
12311 * Listing Tracepoints::
12312 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12313 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12314 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12315 @end menu
12316
12317 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12318 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12319
12320 @table @code
12321 @cindex set tracepoint
12322 @kindex trace
12323 @item trace @var{location}
12324 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12325 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12326 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12327 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12328 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12329 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12330 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12331 in tracing}).
12332 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12333 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12334 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12335 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12336 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12337 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12338 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12339 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12340 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12341 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12342 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12343 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12344
12345 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12346
12347 @smallexample
12348 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12349
12350 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12351
12352 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12353
12354 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12355
12356 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12357 @end smallexample
12358
12359 @noindent
12360 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12361
12362 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12363 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12364 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12365 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12366 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12367 information on tracepoint conditions.
12368
12369 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12370 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12371 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12372 @kindex ftrace
12373 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12374 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12375 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12376 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12377 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12378 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12379 message.
12380
12381 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12382 @code{trace}.
12383
12384 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12385 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12386 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12387 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12388 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12389 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12390 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12391 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12392
12393 @example
12394 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12395 @end example
12396
12397 @noindent
12398 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12399 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12400
12401 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12402 @cindex set static tracepoint
12403 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12404 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12405 @kindex strace
12406 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12407 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12408 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12409 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12410 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12411
12412 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12413 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12414 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12415 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12416 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12417 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12418 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12419 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12420 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12421 tracing engine:
12422
12423 @smallexample
12424 main ()
12425 @{
12426 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12427 @}
12428 @end smallexample
12429
12430 @noindent
12431 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12432 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12433
12434 @smallexample
12435 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12436 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12437 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12438 Data: "str %s"
12439 [etc...]
12440 @end smallexample
12441
12442 @noindent
12443 so you may probe the marker above with:
12444
12445 @smallexample
12446 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12447 @end smallexample
12448
12449 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12450 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12451 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12452 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12453 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12454 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12455 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12456 the @samp{Data:} field.
12457
12458 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12459 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12460 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12461
12462 @vindex $tpnum
12463 @cindex last tracepoint number
12464 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12465 @cindex tracepoint number
12466 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12467 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12468
12469 @kindex delete tracepoint
12470 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12471 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12472 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12473 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12474 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12475
12476 Examples:
12477
12478 @smallexample
12479 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12480
12481 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12482 @end smallexample
12483
12484 @noindent
12485 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12486 @end table
12487
12488 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12489 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12490
12491 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12492
12493 @table @code
12494 @kindex disable tracepoint
12495 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12496 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12497 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12498 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12499 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12500 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12501 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12502 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12503 next trace experiment.
12504
12505 @kindex enable tracepoint
12506 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12507 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12508 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12509 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12510 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12511 next time a trace experiment is run.
12512 @end table
12513
12514 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12515 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12516
12517 @table @code
12518 @kindex passcount
12519 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12520 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12521 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12522 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12523 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12524 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12525 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12526 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12527 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12528 user.
12529
12530 Examples:
12531
12532 @smallexample
12533 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12534 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12535
12536 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12537 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12538 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12539 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12540 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12541 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12544 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12545 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12546 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12547 @end smallexample
12548 @end table
12549
12550 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12551 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12552 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12553 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12554
12555 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12556 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12557 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12558 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12559 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12560 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12561 is true.
12562
12563 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12564 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12565 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12566 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12567 just as with breakpoints.
12568
12569 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12570 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12571 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12572 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12573 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12574 accesses, and so forth.
12575
12576 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12577 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12578 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12579 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12580 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12581 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12582 search through.
12583
12584 @smallexample
12585 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12586 @end smallexample
12587
12588 @node Trace State Variables
12589 @subsection Trace State Variables
12590 @cindex trace state variables
12591
12592 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12593 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12594 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12595 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12596 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12597 integers.
12598
12599 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12600 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12601 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12602 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12603
12604 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12605 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12606 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12607 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12608 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12609 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12610 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12611 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12612 variable with the same name.
12613
12614 @table @code
12615
12616 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12617 @kindex tvariable
12618 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12619 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12620 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12621 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12622 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12623 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12624 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12625 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12626 value. The default initial value is 0.
12627
12628 @item info tvariables
12629 @kindex info tvariables
12630 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12631 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12632 currently running.
12633
12634 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12635 @kindex delete tvariable
12636 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12637 are specified.
12638
12639 @end table
12640
12641 @node Tracepoint Actions
12642 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12643
12644 @table @code
12645 @kindex actions
12646 @cindex tracepoint actions
12647 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12648 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12649 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12650 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12651 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12652 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12653 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12654 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12655 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12656 @code{while-stepping}.
12657
12658 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12659 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12660 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12661
12662 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12663 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12664 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12665
12666 @smallexample
12667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12668
12669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12670
12671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12672 @end smallexample
12673
12674 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12675 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12676 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12677 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12678 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12679 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12680 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12681 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12682
12683 @smallexample
12684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12686 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12687 > collect bar,baz
12688 > collect $regs
12689 > while-stepping 12
12690 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12691 > end
12692 end
12693 @end smallexample
12694
12695 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12696 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12697 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12698 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12699 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12700 special arguments are supported:
12701
12702 @table @code
12703 @item $regs
12704 Collect all registers.
12705
12706 @item $args
12707 Collect all function arguments.
12708
12709 @item $locals
12710 Collect all local variables.
12711
12712 @item $_ret
12713 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12714 of a backtrace.
12715
12716 @item $_probe_argc
12717 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12718 tracepoint is located.
12719 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12720
12721 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12722 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12723 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12724 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12725
12726 @item $_sdata
12727 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12728 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12729 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12730 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12731 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12732 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12733 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12734 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12735 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12736
12737 @smallexample
12738 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12739 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12740 @end smallexample
12741
12742 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12743 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12744 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12745 @value{GDBN}.
12746 @end table
12747
12748 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12749 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12750 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12751
12752 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12753 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12754 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12755 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12756 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12757 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12758 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12759 @samp{mystr}.
12760
12761 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12762 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12763
12764 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12765 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12766 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12767 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12768 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12769 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12770 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12771 action were used.
12772
12773 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12774 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12775 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12776 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12777 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12778 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12779
12780 @smallexample
12781 > while-stepping 12
12782 > collect $regs, myglobal
12783 > end
12784 >
12785 @end smallexample
12786
12787 @noindent
12788 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12789 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12790 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12791 @code{stepping}.
12792
12793 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12794 @kindex set default-collect
12795 @cindex default collection action
12796 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12797 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12798 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12799 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12800 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12801 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12802
12803 @item show default-collect
12804 @kindex show default-collect
12805 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12806 tracepoint hit.
12807
12808 @end table
12809
12810 @node Listing Tracepoints
12811 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12812
12813 @table @code
12814 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12815 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12816 @cindex information about tracepoints
12817 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12818 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12819 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12820 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12821 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12822 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12823
12824 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12825 tracing:
12826
12827 @itemize @bullet
12828 @item
12829 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12830
12831 @item
12832 the state about installed on target of each location
12833 @end itemize
12834
12835 @smallexample
12836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12837 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12838 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12839 while-stepping 20
12840 collect globfoo, $regs
12841 end
12842 collect globfoo2
12843 end
12844 pass count 1200
12845 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12846 collect $eip
12847 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12848 installed on target
12849 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12850 installed on target
12851 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12852 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12853 not installed on target
12854 (@value{GDBP})
12855 @end smallexample
12856
12857 @noindent
12858 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12859 @end table
12860
12861 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12862 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12863
12864 @table @code
12865 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12866 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12867 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12868 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12869 program.
12870
12871 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12872
12873 @table @emph
12874 @item Count
12875 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12876 stable identifier.
12877 @item ID
12878 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12879 @item Enabled or Disabled
12880 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12881 that are not enabled.
12882 @item Address
12883 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12884 @item What
12885 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12886 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12887 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12888 will be left blank.
12889 @end table
12890
12891 @noindent
12892 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12893
12894 @table @emph
12895 @item Data
12896 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12897 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12898 marker call.
12899 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12900 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12901 @end table
12902
12903 @smallexample
12904 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12905 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12906 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12907 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12908 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12909 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12910 Data: str %s
12911 (@value{GDBP})
12912 @end smallexample
12913 @end table
12914
12915 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12916 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12917
12918 @table @code
12919 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12920 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12921 @cindex collected data discarded
12922 @item tstart
12923 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12924 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12925 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12926 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12927 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12928 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12929 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12930 information, and so forth.
12931
12932 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12933 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12934 @item tstop
12935 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12936 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12937 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12938 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12939 needs to be stopped quickly.
12940
12941 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12942 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12943 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12944
12945 @kindex tstatus
12946 @cindex status of trace data collection
12947 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12948 @item tstatus
12949 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12950 collection.
12951 @end table
12952
12953 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12954
12955 @smallexample
12956 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12957 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12958 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12959 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12960 > while-stepping 11
12961 > collect $regs
12962 > end
12963 > end
12964 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12965 [time passes @dots{}]
12966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12967 @end smallexample
12968
12969 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12970 @cindex disconnected tracing
12971 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12972 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12973 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12974 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12975 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12976 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12977 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12978 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12979
12980 @table @code
12981 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12982 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12983 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12984 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12985 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12986 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12987 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12988 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12989
12990 @item show disconnected-tracing
12991 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12992 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12993
12994 @end table
12995
12996 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12997 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12998 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12999 it will continue after reconnection.
13000
13001 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13002 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13003 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13004 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13005 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13006 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13007 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13008 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13009 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13010 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13011
13012 @cindex circular trace buffer
13013 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13014 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13015 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13016 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13017 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13018 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13019 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13020 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13021 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13022 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13023 the next run.
13024
13025 @table @code
13026 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13027 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13028 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13029 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13030 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13031 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13032 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13033
13034 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13035 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13036 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13037 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13038 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13039 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13040
13041 @end table
13042
13043 @table @code
13044 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13045 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13046 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13047 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13048 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13049 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13050 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13051 likes. This is also the default.
13052
13053 @item show trace-buffer-size
13054 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13055 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13056 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13057 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13058 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13059 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13060 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13061 @end table
13062
13063 @table @code
13064 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13065 @kindex set trace-user
13066
13067 @item show trace-user
13068 @kindex show trace-user
13069
13070 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13071 @kindex set trace-notes
13072 Set the trace run's notes.
13073
13074 @item show trace-notes
13075 @kindex show trace-notes
13076 Show the trace run's notes.
13077
13078 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13079 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13080 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13081 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13082 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13083
13084 @item show trace-stop-notes
13085 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13086 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13087
13088 @end table
13089
13090 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13091 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13092
13093 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13094 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13095 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13096 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13097 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13098 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13099 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13100 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13101 mentioned here.
13102
13103 @itemize @bullet
13104
13105 @item
13106 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13107 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13108 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13109 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13110 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13111 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13112 cannot be collected either.
13113
13114 @item
13115 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13116 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13117 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13118 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13119 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13120 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13121 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13122 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13123 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13124 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13125
13126 @item
13127 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13128 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13129 in a misleading way.
13130
13131 @item
13132 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13133 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13134 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13135 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13136 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13137 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13138 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13139 by @code{ptr}.
13140
13141 @item
13142 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13143 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13144 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13145 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13146 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13147 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13148 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13149 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13150 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13151 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13152 invalid address.
13153
13154 @item
13155 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13156 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13157 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13158 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13159 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13160 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13161 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13162 it to zero.
13163
13164 @end itemize
13165
13166 @node Analyze Collected Data
13167 @section Using the Collected Data
13168
13169 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13170 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13171 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13172 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13173 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13174 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13175 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13176 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13177 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13178 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13179 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13180 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13181 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13182 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13183 the buffer will fail.
13184
13185 @menu
13186 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13187 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13188 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13189 @end menu
13190
13191 @node tfind
13192 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13193
13194 @kindex tfind
13195 @cindex select trace snapshot
13196 @cindex find trace snapshot
13197 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13198 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13199 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13200 snapshot is selected.
13201
13202 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13203
13204 @table @code
13205 @item tfind start
13206 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13207 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13208
13209 @item tfind none
13210 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13211
13212 @item tfind end
13213 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13214
13215 @item tfind
13216 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
13217
13218 @item tfind -
13219 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13220 retracing earlier steps.
13221
13222 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13223 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13224 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13225 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13226 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13227
13228 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13229 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13230 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13231 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13232 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13233
13234 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13235 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13236 addresses (exclusive).
13237
13238 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13239 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13240 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13241
13242 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13243 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13244 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13245 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13246 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13247 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13248 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13249 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13250 @end table
13251
13252 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13253 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13254 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13255 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13256 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13257 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13258 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13259 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13260 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13261 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13262 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13263 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13264 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13265 tracepoint as the current one.
13266
13267 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13268 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13269 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13270 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13271 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13272
13273 @smallexample
13274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13276 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13277 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13278 > tfind
13279 > end
13280
13281 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13282 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13283 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13284 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13285 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13286 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13287 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13288 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13289 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13290 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13291 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13292 @end smallexample
13293
13294 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13295 the buffer:
13296
13297 @smallexample
13298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13299 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13300 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13301 > tfind line
13302 > end
13303
13304 Frame 0, X = 1
13305 Frame 7, X = 2
13306 Frame 13, X = 255
13307 @end smallexample
13308
13309 @node tdump
13310 @subsection @code{tdump}
13311 @kindex tdump
13312 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13313 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13314
13315 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13316 the current trace snapshot.
13317
13318 @smallexample
13319 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13320 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13321 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13322 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13323 > end
13324
13325 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13326
13327 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13328 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13329 at gdb_test.c:444
13330 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13331
13332 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13333 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13334 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13335 d1 0x18 24
13336 d2 0x80 128
13337 d3 0x33 51
13338 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13339 d5 0x22 34
13340 d6 0xe0 224
13341 d7 0x380035 3670069
13342 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13343 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13344 a2 0x100 256
13345 a3 0x322000 3284992
13346 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13347 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13348 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13349 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13350 ps 0x0 0
13351 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13352 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13353 fpstatus 0x0 0
13354 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13355 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13356 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13357 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13358 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13359 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13360 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13361 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13362 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13363
13364 (@value{GDBP})
13365 @end smallexample
13366
13367 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13368 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13369 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13370 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13371
13372 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13373 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13374 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13375 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13376 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13377 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13378 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13379 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13380 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13381 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13382
13383 @node save tracepoints
13384 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13385 @kindex save tracepoints
13386 @kindex save-tracepoints
13387 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13388
13389 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13390 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13391 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13392 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13393 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13394 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13395
13396 @node Tracepoint Variables
13397 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13398 @cindex tracepoint variables
13399 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13400
13401 @table @code
13402 @vindex $trace_frame
13403 @item (int) $trace_frame
13404 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13405 snapshot is selected.
13406
13407 @vindex $tracepoint
13408 @item (int) $tracepoint
13409 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13410
13411 @vindex $trace_line
13412 @item (int) $trace_line
13413 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13414
13415 @vindex $trace_file
13416 @item (char []) $trace_file
13417 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13418
13419 @vindex $trace_func
13420 @item (char []) $trace_func
13421 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13422 @end table
13423
13424 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13425 use @code{output} instead.
13426
13427 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13428 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13429 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13430 which are managed by the target.
13431
13432 @smallexample
13433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13434
13435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13436 > output $trace_file
13437 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13438 > tfind
13439 > end
13440 @end smallexample
13441
13442 @node Trace Files
13443 @section Using Trace Files
13444 @cindex trace files
13445
13446 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13447 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13448 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13449 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13450 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13451
13452 @table @code
13453
13454 @kindex tsave
13455 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13456 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13457 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13458 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13459 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13460 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13461 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13462 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13463 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13464 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13465 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13466 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13467 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13468 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13469 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13470
13471 @kindex target tfile
13472 @kindex tfile
13473 @kindex target ctf
13474 @kindex ctf
13475 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13476 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13477 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13478 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13479 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13480 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13481 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13482 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13483 the host.
13484
13485 @smallexample
13486 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13487 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13488 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13489 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13490 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13491 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13492 i = 0
13493 a = 0
13494 b = 1 '\001'
13495 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13496 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13497 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13498 $1 = 1
13499 @end smallexample
13500
13501 @end table
13502
13503 @node Overlays
13504 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13505 @cindex overlays
13506
13507 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13508 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13509 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13510 use overlays.
13511
13512 @menu
13513 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13514 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13515 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13516 mapped by asking the inferior.
13517 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13518 @end menu
13519
13520 @node How Overlays Work
13521 @section How Overlays Work
13522 @cindex mapped overlays
13523 @cindex unmapped overlays
13524 @cindex load address, overlay's
13525 @cindex mapped address
13526 @cindex overlay area
13527
13528 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13529 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13530 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13531 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13532 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13533
13534 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13535 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13536 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13537 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13538 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13539 largest overlay as well.
13540
13541 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13542 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13543 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13544 there.
13545
13546 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13547 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13548 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13549
13550 @smallexample
13551 @group
13552 Data Instruction Larger
13553 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13554 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13555 | | | | | |
13556 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13557 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13558 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13559 | and heap | | | | | |
13560 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13561 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13562 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13563 | | | | | |
13564 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13565 address | | | | | |
13566 | overlay | <-' | | |
13567 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13568 | | <---. | | load address
13569 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13570 | | | |
13571 +-----------+ | |
13572 +-----------+
13573 | |
13574 +-----------+
13575
13576 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13577 @end group
13578 @end smallexample
13579
13580 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13581 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13582 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13583 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13584 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13585 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13586 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13587 program and the overlay area.
13588
13589 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13590 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13591 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13592 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13593 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13594 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13595 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13596
13597 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13598 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13599 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13600
13601 @itemize @bullet
13602
13603 @item
13604 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13605 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13606 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13607 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13608
13609 @item
13610 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13611 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13612 your program's performance.
13613
13614 @item
13615 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13616 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13617 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13618 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13619 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13620 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13621 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13622
13623 @item
13624 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13625 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13626 instruction and data spaces.
13627
13628 @end itemize
13629
13630 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13631 improved in many ways:
13632
13633 @itemize @bullet
13634
13635 @item
13636 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13637 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13638 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13639 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13640 area in the usual way.
13641
13642 @item
13643 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13644 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13645
13646 @item
13647 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13648 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13649 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13650 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13651 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13652 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13653 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13654
13655 @end itemize
13656
13657
13658 @node Overlay Commands
13659 @section Overlay Commands
13660
13661 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13662 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13663 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13664 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13665 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13666 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13667
13668 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13669 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13670
13671 @table @code
13672 @item overlay off
13673 @kindex overlay
13674 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13675 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13676 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13677 overlay support is disabled.
13678
13679 @item overlay manual
13680 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13681 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13682 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13683 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13684 commands described below.
13685
13686 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13687 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13688 @cindex map an overlay
13689 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13690 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13691 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13692 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13693 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13694 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13695
13696 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13697 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13698 @cindex unmap an overlay
13699 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13700 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13701 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13702 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13703
13704 @item overlay auto
13705 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13706 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13707 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13708 Overlay Debugging}.
13709
13710 @item overlay load-target
13711 @itemx overlay load
13712 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13713 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13714 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13715 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13716 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13717 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13718
13719 @item overlay list-overlays
13720 @itemx overlay list
13721 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13722 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13723 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13724
13725 @end table
13726
13727 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13728 of the function the address falls in:
13729
13730 @smallexample
13731 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13732 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13733 @end smallexample
13734 @noindent
13735 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13736 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13737 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13738 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13739
13740 @smallexample
13741 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13742 No sections are mapped.
13743 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13744 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13745 @end smallexample
13746 @noindent
13747 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13748 name normally:
13749
13750 @smallexample
13751 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13752 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13753 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13754 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13755 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13756 @end smallexample
13757
13758 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13759 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13760 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13761 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13762 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13763
13764 @itemize @bullet
13765 @item
13766 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13767 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13768 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13769 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13770 @item
13771 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13772 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13773 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13774 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13775 breakpoints properly.
13776 @end itemize
13777
13778
13779 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13780 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13781 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13782
13783 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13784 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13785 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13786 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13787 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13788 current state of the overlays.
13789
13790 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13791 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13792
13793 @table @asis
13794
13795 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13796 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13797
13798 @smallexample
13799 struct
13800 @{
13801 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13802 unsigned long vma;
13803
13804 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13805 unsigned long size;
13806
13807 /* The overlay's load address. */
13808 unsigned long lma;
13809
13810 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13811 zero otherwise. */
13812 unsigned long mapped;
13813 @}
13814 @end smallexample
13815
13816 @item @code{_novlys}:
13817 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13818 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13819
13820 @end table
13821
13822 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13823 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13824 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13825 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13826 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13827 currently mapped.
13828
13829 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13830 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13831 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13832 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13833 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13834 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13835 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13836 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13837 are not being executed.
13838
13839 @node Overlay Sample Program
13840 @section Overlay Sample Program
13841 @cindex overlay example program
13842
13843 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13844 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13845 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13846 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13847 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13848 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13849 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13850
13851 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13852 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13853 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13854 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13855
13856 @table @file
13857 @item overlays.c
13858 The main program file.
13859 @item ovlymgr.c
13860 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13861 @item foo.c
13862 @itemx bar.c
13863 @itemx baz.c
13864 @itemx grbx.c
13865 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13866 @item d10v.ld
13867 @itemx m32r.ld
13868 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13869 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13870 @end table
13871
13872 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13873 cross-compiler like this:
13874
13875 @smallexample
13876 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13877 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13878 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13879 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13880 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13881 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13882 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13883 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13884 @end smallexample
13885
13886 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13887 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13888 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13889
13890
13891 @node Languages
13892 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13893 @cindex languages
13894
13895 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13896 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13897 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13898 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13899 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13900 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13901
13902 @cindex working language
13903 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13904 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13905 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13906 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13907 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13908 language}.
13909
13910 @menu
13911 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13912 * Show:: Displaying the language
13913 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13914 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13915 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13916 @end menu
13917
13918 @node Setting
13919 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13920
13921 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13922 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13923 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13924 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13925 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13926 are printed, etc.
13927
13928 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13929 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13930 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13931 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13932 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13933 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13934 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13935 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13936 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13937 Displaying the Language}.
13938
13939 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13940 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13941 another language. In that case, make the
13942 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13943 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13944 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13945
13946 @menu
13947 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13948 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13949 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13950 @end menu
13951
13952 @node Filenames
13953 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13954
13955 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13956 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13957
13958 @table @file
13959 @item .ada
13960 @itemx .ads
13961 @itemx .adb
13962 @itemx .a
13963 Ada source file.
13964
13965 @item .c
13966 C source file
13967
13968 @item .C
13969 @itemx .cc
13970 @itemx .cp
13971 @itemx .cpp
13972 @itemx .cxx
13973 @itemx .c++
13974 C@t{++} source file
13975
13976 @item .d
13977 D source file
13978
13979 @item .m
13980 Objective-C source file
13981
13982 @item .f
13983 @itemx .F
13984 Fortran source file
13985
13986 @item .mod
13987 Modula-2 source file
13988
13989 @item .s
13990 @itemx .S
13991 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13992 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13993 @end table
13994
13995 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13996 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13997
13998 @node Manually
13999 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14000
14001 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14002 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14003 your program.
14004
14005 @kindex set language
14006 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14007 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14008 a language, such as
14009 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14010 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14011
14012 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14013 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14014 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14015 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14016 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14017 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14018 command such as:
14019
14020 @smallexample
14021 print a = b + c
14022 @end smallexample
14023
14024 @noindent
14025 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14026 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14027 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14028 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14029
14030 @node Automatically
14031 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14032
14033 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14034 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14035 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14036 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14037 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14038 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14039 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14040 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14041 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14042
14043 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14044 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14045 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14046 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14047 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14048
14049 @node Show
14050 @section Displaying the Language
14051
14052 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14053 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14054
14055 @table @code
14056 @item show language
14057 @anchor{show language}
14058 @kindex show language
14059 Display the current working language. This is the
14060 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14061 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14062
14063 @item info frame
14064 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14065 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14066 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14067 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14068 information listed here.
14069
14070 @item info source
14071 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14072 Display the source language of this source file.
14073 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14074 information listed here.
14075 @end table
14076
14077 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14078 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14079 with a language explicitly:
14080
14081 @table @code
14082 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14083 @kindex set extension-language
14084 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14085 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14086
14087 @item info extensions
14088 @kindex info extensions
14089 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14090 @end table
14091
14092 @node Checks
14093 @section Type and Range Checking
14094
14095 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14096 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14097 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14098 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14099 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14100 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14101 errors when your program is running.
14102
14103 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14104 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14105 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14106 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14107
14108 @menu
14109 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14110 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14111 @end menu
14112
14113 @cindex type checking
14114 @cindex checks, type
14115 @node Type Checking
14116 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14117
14118 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14119 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14120 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14121 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14122
14123 @smallexample
14124 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14125
14126 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14127 $1 = 2
14128 @exdent but
14129 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14130 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14131 @end smallexample
14132
14133 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14134 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14135
14136 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14137 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14138 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14139 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14140 expressions like the second example above.
14141
14142 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14143 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14144 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14145 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14146 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14147 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14148
14149 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14150
14151 @kindex set check type
14152 @kindex show check type
14153 @table @code
14154 @item set check type on
14155 @itemx set check type off
14156 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14157 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14158 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14159
14160 @item show check type
14161 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14162 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14163 @end table
14164
14165 @cindex range checking
14166 @cindex checks, range
14167 @node Range Checking
14168 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14169
14170 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14171 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14172 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14173 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14174 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14175
14176 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14177 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14178 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14179 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14180
14181 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14182 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14183 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14184 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14185 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14186 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14187
14188 @smallexample
14189 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14190 @end smallexample
14191
14192 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14193 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14194 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14195
14196 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14197
14198 @kindex set check range
14199 @kindex show check range
14200 @table @code
14201 @item set check range auto
14202 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14203 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14204 each language.
14205
14206 @item set check range on
14207 @itemx set check range off
14208 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14209 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14210 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14211 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14212
14213 @item set check range warn
14214 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14215 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14216 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14217 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14218 systems).
14219
14220 @item show range
14221 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14222 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14223 @end table
14224
14225 @node Supported Languages
14226 @section Supported Languages
14227
14228 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14229 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14230 @c This is false ...
14231 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14232 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14233 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14234 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14235 language.
14236
14237 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14238 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14239 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14240 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14241 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14242 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14243 language reference or tutorial.
14244
14245 @menu
14246 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14247 * D:: D
14248 * Go:: Go
14249 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14250 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14251 * Fortran:: Fortran
14252 * Pascal:: Pascal
14253 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14254 * Ada:: Ada
14255 @end menu
14256
14257 @node C
14258 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14259
14260 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14261 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14262
14263 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14264 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14265 together.
14266
14267 @cindex C@t{++}
14268 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14269 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14270 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14271 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14272 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14273 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14274 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14275
14276 @menu
14277 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14278 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14279 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14280 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14281 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14282 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14283 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14284 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14285 @end menu
14286
14287 @node C Operators
14288 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14289
14290 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14291
14292 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14293 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14294 often defined on groups of types.
14295
14296 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14297
14298 @itemize @bullet
14299
14300 @item
14301 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14302 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14303
14304 @item
14305 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14306 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14307
14308 @item
14309 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14310
14311 @item
14312 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14313
14314 @end itemize
14315
14316 @noindent
14317 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14318 in order of increasing precedence:
14319
14320 @table @code
14321 @item ,
14322 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14323 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14324 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14325
14326 @item =
14327 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14328 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14329
14330 @item @var{op}=
14331 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14332 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14333 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14334 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14335 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14336
14337 @item ?:
14338 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14339 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14340 should be of an integral type.
14341
14342 @item ||
14343 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14344
14345 @item &&
14346 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14347
14348 @item |
14349 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14350
14351 @item ^
14352 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14353
14354 @item &
14355 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14356
14357 @item ==@r{, }!=
14358 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14359 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14360
14361 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14362 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14363 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14364 and non-zero for true.
14365
14366 @item <<@r{, }>>
14367 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14368
14369 @item @@
14370 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14371
14372 @item +@r{, }-
14373 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14374 pointer types.
14375
14376 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14377 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14378 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14379 integral types.
14380
14381 @item ++@r{, }--
14382 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14383 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14384 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14385 operation takes place.
14386
14387 @item *
14388 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14389 @code{++}.
14390
14391 @item &
14392 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14393
14394 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14395 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14396 to examine the address
14397 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14398 stored.
14399
14400 @item -
14401 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14402 precedence as @code{++}.
14403
14404 @item !
14405 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14406 @code{++}.
14407
14408 @item ~
14409 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14410 @code{++}.
14411
14412
14413 @item .@r{, }->
14414 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14415 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14416 pointer based on the stored type information.
14417 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14418
14419 @item .*@r{, }->*
14420 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14421
14422 @item []
14423 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14424 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14425
14426 @item ()
14427 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14428
14429 @item ::
14430 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14431 and @code{class} types.
14432
14433 @item ::
14434 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14435 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14436 above.
14437 @end table
14438
14439 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14440 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14441 predefined meaning.
14442
14443 @node C Constants
14444 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14445
14446 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14447
14448 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14449 following ways:
14450
14451 @itemize @bullet
14452 @item
14453 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14454 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14455 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14456 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14457 @code{long} value.
14458
14459 @item
14460 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14461 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14462 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14463 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14464 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14465 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14466 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14467 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14468 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14469 constant.
14470
14471 @item
14472 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14473 integral equivalents.
14474
14475 @item
14476 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14477 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14478 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14479 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14480 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14481 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14482 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14483 @samp{\n} for newline.
14484
14485 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14486 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14487 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14488 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14489
14490 @item
14491 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14492 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14493 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14494 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14495 characters.
14496
14497 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14498 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14499 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14500
14501 @item
14502 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14503 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14504
14505 @item
14506 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14507 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14508 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14509 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14510 @end itemize
14511
14512 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14513 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14514
14515 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14516 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14517
14518 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14519 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14520 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14521 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14522 @quotation
14523 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14524 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14525 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14526 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14527 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14528 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14529 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14530 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14531 @end quotation
14532
14533 @enumerate
14534
14535 @cindex member functions
14536 @item
14537 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14538
14539 @smallexample
14540 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14541 @end smallexample
14542
14543 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14544 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14545 @item
14546 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14547 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14548 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14549 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14550 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14551
14552 @cindex call overloaded functions
14553 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14554 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14555 @item
14556 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14557 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14558 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14559 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14560 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14561 default arguments.
14562
14563 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14564 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14565 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14566 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14567 number of function arguments.
14568
14569 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14570 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14571 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14572
14573 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14574 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14575 @smallexample
14576 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14577 @end smallexample
14578
14579 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14580 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14581
14582 @cindex reference declarations
14583 @item
14584 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14585 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14586 dereferenced.
14587
14588 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14589 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14590 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14591 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14592 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14593
14594 @item
14595 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14596 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14597 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14598 necessary, for example in an expression like
14599 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14600 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14601 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14602
14603 @item
14604 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14605 specification.
14606 @end enumerate
14607
14608 @node C Defaults
14609 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14610
14611 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14612
14613 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14614 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14615 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14616 selects the working language.
14617
14618 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14619 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14620 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14621 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14622 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14623 for further details.
14624
14625 @node C Checks
14626 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14627
14628 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14629
14630 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14631 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14632 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14633 constants to pointers.
14634
14635 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14636 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14637 that is not itself an array.
14638
14639 @node Debugging C
14640 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14641
14642 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14643 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14644 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14645 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14646
14647 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14648 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14649 ,Expressions}.
14650
14651 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14652 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14653
14654 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14655
14656 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14657 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14658
14659 @table @code
14660 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14661 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14662 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14663 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14664 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14665 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14666
14667 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14668 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14669 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14670 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14671 classes.
14672 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14673
14674 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14675 @item catch throw
14676 @itemx catch rethrow
14677 @itemx catch catch
14678 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14679 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14680
14681 @cindex inheritance
14682 @item ptype @var{typename}
14683 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14684 @var{typename}.
14685 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14686
14687 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14688 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14689 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14690 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14691 multiple inheritance is in use.
14692
14693 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14694 @item demangle @var{name}
14695 Demangle @var{name}.
14696 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14697
14698 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14699 @item set print demangle
14700 @itemx show print demangle
14701 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14702 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14703 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14704 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14705 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14706
14707 @item set print object
14708 @itemx show print object
14709 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14710 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14711
14712 @item set print vtbl
14713 @itemx show print vtbl
14714 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14715 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14716 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14717 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14718
14719 @kindex set overload-resolution
14720 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14721 @item set overload-resolution on
14722 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14723 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14724 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14725 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14726 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14727 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14728
14729 @item set overload-resolution off
14730 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14731 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14732 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14733 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14734 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14735 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14736 argument types.
14737
14738 @kindex show overload-resolution
14739 @item show overload-resolution
14740 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14741
14742 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14743 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14744 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14745 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14746 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14747 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14748 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14749 @end table
14750
14751 @node Decimal Floating Point
14752 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14753 @cindex decimal floating point format
14754
14755 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14756 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14757 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14758 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14759
14760 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14761 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14762 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14763 configured target.
14764
14765 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14766 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14767 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14768
14769 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14770 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14771 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14772
14773 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14774 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14775 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14776
14777 @node D
14778 @subsection D
14779
14780 @cindex D
14781 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14782 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14783 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14784
14785 @node Go
14786 @subsection Go
14787
14788 @cindex Go (programming language)
14789 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14790 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14791
14792 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14793
14794 @table @code
14795 @cindex current Go package
14796 @item The current Go package
14797 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14798 specifying global variables and functions.
14799
14800 For example, given the program:
14801
14802 @example
14803 package main
14804 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14805 func main () @{
14806 // ...
14807 @}
14808 @end example
14809
14810 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14811
14812 @example
14813 (gdb) p myglob
14814 (gdb) p main.myglob
14815 @end example
14816
14817 @cindex builtin Go types
14818 @item Builtin Go types
14819 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14820 as a string.
14821
14822 @cindex builtin Go functions
14823 @item Builtin Go functions
14824 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14825 function and handles it internally.
14826
14827 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14828 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14829 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14830 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14831 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14832 @end table
14833
14834 @node Objective-C
14835 @subsection Objective-C
14836
14837 @cindex Objective-C
14838 This section provides information about some commands and command
14839 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14840 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14841 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14842
14843 @menu
14844 * Method Names in Commands::
14845 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14846 @end menu
14847
14848 @node Method Names in Commands
14849 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14850
14851 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14852 names as line specifications:
14853
14854 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14855 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14856 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14857 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14858 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14859 @itemize
14860 @item @code{clear}
14861 @item @code{break}
14862 @item @code{info line}
14863 @item @code{jump}
14864 @item @code{list}
14865 @end itemize
14866
14867 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14868
14869 @smallexample
14870 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14871 @end smallexample
14872
14873 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14874 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14875 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14876 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14877 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14878 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14879 debugged, enter:
14880
14881 @smallexample
14882 break -[Fruit create]
14883 @end smallexample
14884
14885 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14886 enter:
14887
14888 @smallexample
14889 list +[NSText initialize]
14890 @end smallexample
14891
14892 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14893 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14894 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14895 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14896
14897 @smallexample
14898 break create
14899 @end smallexample
14900
14901 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14902 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14903 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14904 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14905 none apply.
14906
14907 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14908 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14909
14910 @smallexample
14911 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14912 @end smallexample
14913
14914 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14915 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14916 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14917 @kindex print-object
14918 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14919
14920 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14921
14922 @smallexample
14923 print -[@var{object} hash]
14924 @end smallexample
14925
14926 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14927 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14928 @noindent
14929 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14930 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14931 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14932 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14933 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14934 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14935
14936 @node OpenCL C
14937 @subsection OpenCL C
14938
14939 @cindex OpenCL C
14940 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14941
14942 @menu
14943 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14944 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14945 * OpenCL C Operators::
14946 @end menu
14947
14948 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14949 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14950
14951 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14952 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14953 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14954 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14955 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14956
14957 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14958 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14959
14960 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14961 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14962 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14963 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14964
14965 @node OpenCL C Operators
14966 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14967
14968 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14969 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14970 vector data types.
14971
14972 @node Fortran
14973 @subsection Fortran
14974 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14975
14976 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14977 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14978
14979 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14980 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14981 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14982 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14983 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14984 underscore.
14985
14986 @menu
14987 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14988 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14989 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14990 @end menu
14991
14992 @node Fortran Operators
14993 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14994
14995 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14996
14997 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14998 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14999 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15000
15001 @table @code
15002 @item **
15003 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15004 of the second one.
15005
15006 @item :
15007 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15008 represent a section of array.
15009
15010 @item %
15011 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15012 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15013 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15014 union type.
15015 @end table
15016
15017 @node Fortran Defaults
15018 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15019
15020 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15021
15022 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15023 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15024 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15025 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15026
15027 @node Special Fortran Commands
15028 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15029
15030 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15031
15032 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15033 such as displaying common blocks.
15034
15035 @table @code
15036 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15037 @kindex info common
15038 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15039 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15040 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15041 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15042 printed.
15043 @end table
15044
15045 @node Pascal
15046 @subsection Pascal
15047
15048 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15049 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15050 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15051 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15052 syntax.
15053
15054 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15055 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15056 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15057
15058 @node Modula-2
15059 @subsection Modula-2
15060
15061 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15062
15063 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15064 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15065 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15066 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15067 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15068 table.
15069
15070 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15071 @menu
15072 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15073 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15074 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15075 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15076 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15077 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15078 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15079 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15080 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15081 @end menu
15082
15083 @node M2 Operators
15084 @subsubsection Operators
15085 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15086
15087 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15088 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15089 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15090 following definitions hold:
15091
15092 @itemize @bullet
15093
15094 @item
15095 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15096 their subranges.
15097
15098 @item
15099 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15100
15101 @item
15102 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15103
15104 @item
15105 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15106 @var{type}}.
15107
15108 @item
15109 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15110
15111 @item
15112 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15113
15114 @item
15115 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15116 @end itemize
15117
15118 @noindent
15119 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15120 increasing precedence:
15121
15122 @table @code
15123 @item ,
15124 Function argument or array index separator.
15125
15126 @item :=
15127 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15128 @var{value}.
15129
15130 @item <@r{, }>
15131 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15132 types.
15133
15134 @item <=@r{, }>=
15135 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15136 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15137 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15138
15139 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15140 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15141 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15142 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15143 comment character.
15144
15145 @item IN
15146 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15147 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15148
15149 @item OR
15150 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15151
15152 @item AND@r{, }&
15153 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15154
15155 @item @@
15156 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15157
15158 @item +@r{, }-
15159 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15160 and difference on set types.
15161
15162 @item *
15163 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15164 on set types.
15165
15166 @item /
15167 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15168 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15169
15170 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15171 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15172 precedence as @code{*}.
15173
15174 @item -
15175 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15176
15177 @item ^
15178 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15179
15180 @item NOT
15181 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15182 @code{^}.
15183
15184 @item .
15185 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15186 precedence as @code{^}.
15187
15188 @item []
15189 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15190
15191 @item ()
15192 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15193 as @code{^}.
15194
15195 @item ::@r{, }.
15196 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15197 @end table
15198
15199 @quotation
15200 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15201 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15202 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15203 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15204 @end quotation
15205
15206
15207 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15208 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15209 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15210
15211 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15212 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15213
15214 @table @var
15215
15216 @item a
15217 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15218
15219 @item c
15220 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15221
15222 @item i
15223 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15224
15225 @item m
15226 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15227 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15228 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15229
15230 @item n
15231 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15232
15233 @item r
15234 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15235
15236 @item t
15237 represents a type.
15238
15239 @item v
15240 represents a variable.
15241
15242 @item x
15243 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15244 explanation of the function for details.
15245 @end table
15246
15247 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15248
15249 @table @code
15250 @item ABS(@var{n})
15251 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15252
15253 @item CAP(@var{c})
15254 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15255 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15256
15257 @item CHR(@var{i})
15258 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15259
15260 @item DEC(@var{v})
15261 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15262
15263 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15264 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15265 new value.
15266
15267 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15268 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15269 set.
15270
15271 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15272 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15273
15274 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15275 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15276
15277 @item INC(@var{v})
15278 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15279
15280 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15281 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15282 new value.
15283
15284 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15285 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15286 there. Returns the new set.
15287
15288 @item MAX(@var{t})
15289 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15290
15291 @item MIN(@var{t})
15292 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15293
15294 @item ODD(@var{i})
15295 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15296
15297 @item ORD(@var{x})
15298 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15299 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15300 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15301 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15302
15303 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15304 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15305 variable or a type.
15306
15307 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15308 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15309
15310 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15311 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15312 variable or a type.
15313
15314 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15315 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15316 @end table
15317
15318 @quotation
15319 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15320 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15321 an error.
15322 @end quotation
15323
15324 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15325 @node M2 Constants
15326 @subsubsection Constants
15327
15328 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15329 ways:
15330
15331 @itemize @bullet
15332
15333 @item
15334 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15335 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15336 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15337 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15338
15339 @item
15340 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15341 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15342 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15343 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15344 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15345 digits.
15346
15347 @item
15348 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15349 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15350 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15351 followed by a @samp{C}.
15352
15353 @item
15354 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15355 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15356 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15357 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15358 sequences.
15359
15360 @item
15361 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15362
15363 @item
15364 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15365 @code{FALSE}.
15366
15367 @item
15368 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15369
15370 @item
15371 Set constants are not yet supported.
15372 @end itemize
15373
15374 @node M2 Types
15375 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15376 @cindex Modula-2 types
15377
15378 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15379 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15380 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15381 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15382 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15383 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15384
15385 The first example contains the following section of code:
15386
15387 @smallexample
15388 VAR
15389 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15390 r: [20..40] ;
15391 @end smallexample
15392
15393 @noindent
15394 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15395 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15396
15397 @smallexample
15398 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15399 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15400 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15401 SET OF CHAR
15402 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15403 21
15404 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15405 [20..40]
15406 @end smallexample
15407
15408 @noindent
15409 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15410
15411 @smallexample
15412 VAR
15413 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15414 @end smallexample
15415
15416 @noindent
15417 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15418
15419 @smallexample
15420 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15421 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15422 @end smallexample
15423
15424 @noindent
15425 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15426 expressions using the debugger.
15427
15428 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15429 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15430
15431 @smallexample
15432 VAR
15433 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15434 @end smallexample
15435
15436 @smallexample
15437 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15438 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15439 @end smallexample
15440
15441 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15442 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15443 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15444 above.
15445
15446 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15447
15448 @smallexample
15449 TYPE
15450 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15451 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15452 VAR
15453 s: t ;
15454 BEGIN
15455 s := blue ;
15456 @end smallexample
15457
15458 @noindent
15459 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15460 and value of a variable.
15461
15462 @smallexample
15463 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15464 $1 = blue
15465 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15466 type = [blue..yellow]
15467 @end smallexample
15468
15469 @noindent
15470 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15471 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15472 their @code{C} counterparts.
15473
15474 @smallexample
15475 VAR
15476 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15477 BEGIN
15478 s[1] := 1 ;
15479 @end smallexample
15480
15481 @smallexample
15482 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15483 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15484 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15485 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15486 @end smallexample
15487
15488 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15489 pointer types as shown in this example:
15490
15491 @smallexample
15492 VAR
15493 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15494 BEGIN
15495 NEW(s) ;
15496 s^[1] := 1 ;
15497 @end smallexample
15498
15499 @noindent
15500 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15501
15502 @smallexample
15503 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15504 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15505 @end smallexample
15506
15507 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15508 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15509 types:
15510
15511 @smallexample
15512 TYPE
15513 foo = RECORD
15514 f1: CARDINAL ;
15515 f2: CHAR ;
15516 f3: myarray ;
15517 END ;
15518
15519 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15520 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15521 VAR
15522 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15523 @end smallexample
15524
15525 @noindent
15526 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15527 below.
15528
15529 @smallexample
15530 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15531 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15532 f1 : CARDINAL;
15533 f2 : CHAR;
15534 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15535 END
15536 @end smallexample
15537
15538 @node M2 Defaults
15539 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15540 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15541
15542 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15543 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15544 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15545 selected the working language.
15546
15547 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15548 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15549 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15550 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15551
15552 @node Deviations
15553 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15554 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15555
15556 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15557 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15558
15559 @itemize @bullet
15560 @item
15561 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15562 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15563 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15564 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15565 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15566 returned a pointer.)
15567
15568 @item
15569 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15570 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15571 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15572 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15573
15574 @item
15575 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15576 argument.
15577
15578 @item
15579 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15580 @end itemize
15581
15582 @node M2 Checks
15583 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15584 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15585
15586 @quotation
15587 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15588 range checking.
15589 @end quotation
15590 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15591
15592 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15593
15594 @itemize @bullet
15595 @item
15596 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15597 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15598
15599 @item
15600 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15601 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15602 @end itemize
15603
15604 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15605 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15606
15607 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15608 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15609
15610 @node M2 Scope
15611 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15612 @cindex scope
15613 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15614 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15615 @ifinfo
15616 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15617 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15618 @end ifinfo
15619 @ifnotinfo
15620 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15621 @end ifnotinfo
15622
15623 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15624 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15625 similar syntax:
15626
15627 @smallexample
15628
15629 @var{module} . @var{id}
15630 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15631 @end smallexample
15632
15633 @noindent
15634 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15635 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15636 identifier within your program, except another module.
15637
15638 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15639 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15640 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15641 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15642
15643 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15644 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15645 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15646 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15647 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15648 @var{module}.
15649
15650 @node GDB/M2
15651 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15652
15653 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15654 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15655 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15656 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15657 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15658 analogue in Modula-2.
15659
15660 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15661 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15662 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15663 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15664 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15665 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15666
15667 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15668 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15669 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15670
15671 @node Ada
15672 @subsection Ada
15673 @cindex Ada
15674
15675 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15676 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15677 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15678 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15679 to be difficult.
15680
15681
15682 @cindex expressions in Ada
15683 @menu
15684 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15685 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15686 in @value{GDBN}.
15687 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15688 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15689 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15690 subprograms.
15691 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15692 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15693 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15694 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15695 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15696 Profile
15697 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15698 @end menu
15699
15700 @node Ada Mode Intro
15701 @subsubsection Introduction
15702 @cindex Ada mode, general
15703
15704 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15705 syntax, with some extensions.
15706 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15707
15708 @itemize @bullet
15709 @item
15710 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15711 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15712 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15713 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15714
15715 @item
15716 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15717 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15718
15719 @item
15720 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15721 @end itemize
15722
15723 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15724 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15725 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15726 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15727 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15728
15729 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15730 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15731 was translated from an Ada source file.
15732
15733 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15734 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15735 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15736 middle (to allow based literals).
15737
15738 @node Omissions from Ada
15739 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15740 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15741
15742 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15743
15744 @itemize @bullet
15745 @item
15746 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15747
15748 @itemize @minus
15749 @item
15750 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15751 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15752
15753 @item
15754 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15755
15756 @item
15757 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15758
15759 @item
15760 @t{'Tag}.
15761
15762 @item
15763 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15764 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15765
15766 @item
15767 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15768 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15769
15770 @item
15771 @t{'Address}.
15772 @end itemize
15773
15774 @item
15775 The names in
15776 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15777 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15778 not currently available.
15779
15780 @item
15781 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15782 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15783 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15784 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15785 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15786 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15787 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15788 indeterminate values.
15789
15790 @item
15791 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15792 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15793 are not implemented.
15794
15795 @item
15796 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15797 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15798 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15799 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15800 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15801
15802 @smallexample
15803 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15804 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15805 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15806 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15807 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15808 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15809 @end smallexample
15810
15811 Changing a
15812 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15813 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15814 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15815 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15816 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15817 declared to have a type such as:
15818
15819 @smallexample
15820 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15821 Id : Integer;
15822 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15823 end record;
15824 @end smallexample
15825
15826 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15827 assignments:
15828
15829 @smallexample
15830 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15831 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15832 @end smallexample
15833
15834 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15835 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15836 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15837 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15838 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15839 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15840 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15841 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15842
15843 @item
15844 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15845
15846 @item
15847 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15848 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15849 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15850 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15851 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15852 the proper resolution.
15853
15854 @item
15855 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15856
15857 @item
15858 Entry calls are not implemented.
15859
15860 @item
15861 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15862 formats are not supported.
15863
15864 @item
15865 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15866
15867 @item
15868 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15869 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15870 context.
15871 Should your program
15872 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15873 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15874 @end itemize
15875
15876 @node Additions to Ada
15877 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15878 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15879
15880 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15881 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15882
15883 @itemize @bullet
15884 @item
15885 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15886 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15887 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15888 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15889 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15890 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15891 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15892 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15893
15894 @item
15895 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15896 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15897 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15898
15899 @item
15900 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15901 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15902
15903 @item
15904 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15905 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15906 @end itemize
15907
15908 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15909 additions specific to Ada:
15910
15911 @itemize @bullet
15912 @item
15913 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15914 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15915
15916 @smallexample
15917 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15918 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15919 @end smallexample
15920
15921 @item
15922 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15923 the value of its right-hand operand.
15924 This allows, for example,
15925 complex conditional breaks:
15926
15927 @smallexample
15928 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15929 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15930 @end smallexample
15931
15932 @item
15933 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15934 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15935 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15936 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15937 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15938 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15939 in strings. For example,
15940 @smallexample
15941 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15942 @end smallexample
15943 @noindent
15944 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15945 after each period.
15946
15947 @item
15948 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15949 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15950 to write
15951
15952 @smallexample
15953 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15954 @end smallexample
15955
15956 @item
15957 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15958 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15959 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15960 of 3 might print as
15961
15962 @smallexample
15963 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15964 @end smallexample
15965
15966 @noindent
15967 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15968 clause.
15969
15970 @item
15971 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15972 multi-character subsequence of
15973 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15974 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15975 in place of @t{a'length}.
15976
15977 @item
15978 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15979 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15980 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15981 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15982 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15983 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15984 For example,
15985 @smallexample
15986 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15987 @end smallexample
15988
15989 @item
15990 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15991 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15992 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15993 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15994 object.
15995
15996 @end itemize
15997
15998 @node Overloading support for Ada
15999 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16000 @cindex overloading, Ada
16001
16002 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16003 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16004 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16005 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16006 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16007 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16008
16009 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16010 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16011 use, for instance:
16012
16013 @smallexample
16014 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16015 Multiple matches for f
16016 [0] cancel
16017 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16018 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16019 >
16020 @end smallexample
16021
16022 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16023 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16024 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16025
16026 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16027 case:
16028
16029 @table @code
16030
16031 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16032 @item set ada print-signatures
16033 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16034 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16035 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16036
16037 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16038 @item show ada print-signatures
16039 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16040 overloads selection menu.
16041 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16042
16043 @end table
16044
16045 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16046 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16047
16048 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16049 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16050 before reaching the main procedure.
16051 As defined in the Ada Reference
16052 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16053 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16054 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16055 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16056
16057 @node Ada Exceptions
16058 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16059
16060 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16061
16062 @table @code
16063 @kindex info exceptions
16064 @item info exceptions
16065 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16066 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16067 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16068 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16069 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16070 @end table
16071
16072 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16073 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16074 argument.
16075
16076 @smallexample
16077 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16078 All defined Ada exceptions:
16079 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16080 program_error: 0x613d20
16081 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16082 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16083 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16084 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16085 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16086 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16087 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16088 @end smallexample
16089
16090 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16091 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16092
16093 @node Ada Tasks
16094 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16095 @cindex Ada, tasking
16096
16097 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16098 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16099
16100 @table @code
16101 @kindex info tasks
16102 @item info tasks
16103 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16104
16105
16106 @smallexample
16107 @iftex
16108 @leftskip=0.5cm
16109 @end iftex
16110 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16111 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16112 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16113 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16114 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16115 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16116
16117 @end smallexample
16118
16119 @noindent
16120 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16121 task currently being inspected.
16122
16123 @table @asis
16124 @item ID
16125 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16126
16127 @item TID
16128 The Ada task ID.
16129
16130 @item P-ID
16131 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16132
16133 @item Pri
16134 The base priority of the task.
16135
16136 @item State
16137 Current state of the task.
16138
16139 @table @code
16140 @item Unactivated
16141 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16142 executing.
16143
16144 @item Runnable
16145 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16146 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16147
16148 @item Terminated
16149 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16150 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16151 terminated themselves.
16152
16153 @item Child Activation Wait
16154 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16155
16156 @item Accept Statement
16157 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16158
16159 @item Waiting on entry call
16160 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16161
16162 @item Async Select Wait
16163 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16164 select statement.
16165
16166 @item Delay Sleep
16167 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16168 alternative open.
16169
16170 @item Child Termination Wait
16171 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16172 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16173 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16174
16175 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16176 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16177 finish terminating.
16178
16179 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16180 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16181 @end table
16182
16183 @item Name
16184 Name of the task in the program.
16185
16186 @end table
16187
16188 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16189 @item info task @var{taskno}
16190 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16191 the following example:
16192 @smallexample
16193 @iftex
16194 @leftskip=0.5cm
16195 @end iftex
16196 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16197 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16198 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16199 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16200 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16201 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16202 Name: task_1
16203 Thread: 0x807f378
16204 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16205 Base Priority: 15
16206 State: Runnable
16207 @end smallexample
16208
16209 @item task
16210 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16211 @cindex current Ada task ID
16212 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16213
16214 @smallexample
16215 @iftex
16216 @leftskip=0.5cm
16217 @end iftex
16218 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16219 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16220 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16221 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16222 (@value{GDBP}) task
16223 [Current task is 2]
16224 @end smallexample
16225
16226 @item task @var{taskno}
16227 @cindex Ada task switching
16228 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16229 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16230 from the current task to the given task.
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 @iftex
16234 @leftskip=0.5cm
16235 @end iftex
16236 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16237 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16238 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16239 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16240 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16241 [Switching to task 1]
16242 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16243 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16244 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16245 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16246 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16247 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16248 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16249 @end smallexample
16250
16251 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16252 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16253 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16254 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16255 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16256 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16257 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16258 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16259 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16260
16261 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16262 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16263 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16264 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16265 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16266
16267 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16268 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16269 program.
16270
16271 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16272 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16273 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16274
16275 For example,
16276
16277 @smallexample
16278 @iftex
16279 @leftskip=0.5cm
16280 @end iftex
16281 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16282 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16283 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16284 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16285 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16286 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16287 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16288 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16289 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16290 Continuing.
16291 task # 1 running
16292 task # 2 running
16293
16294 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16295 15 flush;
16296 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16297 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16298 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16299 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16300 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16301 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16302 @end smallexample
16303 @end table
16304
16305 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16306 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16307 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16308
16309 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16310 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16311 the platform being used.
16312 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16313 switching is not supported.
16314
16315 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16316 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16317 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16318 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16319 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16320 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16321
16322 @node Ravenscar Profile
16323 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16324 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16325
16326 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16327 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16328 requirements.
16329
16330 @table @code
16331 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16332 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16333 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16334 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16335 Profile. This is the default.
16336
16337 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16338 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16339 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16340 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16341 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16342 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16343 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16344
16345 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16346 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16347 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16348 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16349
16350 @end table
16351
16352 @node Ada Glitches
16353 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16354 @cindex Ada, problems
16355
16356 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16357 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16358 @value{GDBN},
16359 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16360 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16361
16362 @itemize @bullet
16363 @item
16364 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16365 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16366
16367 @item
16368 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16369 argument lists are treated as positional).
16370
16371 @item
16372 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16373
16374 @item
16375 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16376 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16377 the host machine.
16378
16379 @item
16380 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16381 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16382 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16383 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16384 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16385 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16386 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16387 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16388 you can usually resolve the confusion
16389 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16390 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16391 @end itemize
16392
16393 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16394 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16395 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16396 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16397 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16398 enabled.
16399
16400 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16401 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16402 @table @code
16403
16404 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16405 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16406 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16407 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16408 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16409 This is the default.
16410
16411 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16412 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16413 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16414 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16415 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16416 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16417 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16418
16419 @end table
16420
16421 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16422 @cindex GNAT encoding
16423 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16424 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16425 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16426 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16427 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16428 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16429
16430 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16431 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16432 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16433 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16434 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16435 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16436 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16437 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16438
16439 @table @code
16440
16441 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16442 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16443 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16444 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16445
16446 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16447 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16448 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16449
16450 @end table
16451
16452 @node Unsupported Languages
16453 @section Unsupported Languages
16454
16455 @cindex unsupported languages
16456 @cindex minimal language
16457 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16458 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16459 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16460 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16461 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16462 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16463
16464 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16465 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16466 language.
16467
16468 @node Symbols
16469 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16470
16471 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16472 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16473 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16474 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16475 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16476 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16477 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16478
16479 @cindex symbol names
16480 @cindex names of symbols
16481 @cindex quoting names
16482 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16483 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16484 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16485 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16486 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16487 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16488 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16489 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16490
16491 @smallexample
16492 p 'foo.c'::x
16493 @end smallexample
16494
16495 @noindent
16496 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16497
16498 @table @code
16499 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16500 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16501 @kindex set case-sensitive
16502 @item set case-sensitive on
16503 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16504 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16505 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16506 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16507 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16508 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16509 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16510 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16511 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16512 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16513 case-insensitive matches.
16514
16515 @kindex show case-sensitive
16516 @item show case-sensitive
16517 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16518 lookups.
16519
16520 @kindex set print type methods
16521 @item set print type methods
16522 @itemx set print type methods on
16523 @itemx set print type methods off
16524 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16525 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16526 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16527 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16528 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16529 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16530
16531 @kindex show print type methods
16532 @item show print type methods
16533 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16534 classes.
16535
16536 @kindex set print type typedefs
16537 @item set print type typedefs
16538 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16539 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16540
16541 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16542 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16543 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16544 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16545 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16546 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16547 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16548 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16549 types.
16550
16551 @kindex show print type typedefs
16552 @item show print type typedefs
16553 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16554 printing classes.
16555
16556 @kindex info address
16557 @cindex address of a symbol
16558 @item info address @var{symbol}
16559 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16560 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16561 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16562 is always stored.
16563
16564 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16565 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16566 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16567
16568 @kindex info symbol
16569 @cindex symbol from address
16570 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16571 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16572 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16573 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16574 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16575
16576 @smallexample
16577 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16578 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16579 @end smallexample
16580
16581 @noindent
16582 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16583 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16584
16585 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16586 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16587
16588 @smallexample
16589 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16590 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16591 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16592 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16593 @end smallexample
16594
16595 @kindex demangle
16596 @cindex demangle
16597 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16598 Demangle @var{name}.
16599 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16600 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16601
16602 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16603 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16604
16605 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16606 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16607
16608 @kindex whatis
16609 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16610 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16611 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16612 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16613
16614 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16615 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16616 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16617
16618 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16619 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16620 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16621 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16622 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16623 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16624 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16625 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16626 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16627
16628 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16629 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16630 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16631 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16632 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16633 unroll it.
16634
16635 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16636 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16637 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16638
16639 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16640 Available flags are:
16641
16642 @table @code
16643 @item r
16644 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16645 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16646 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16647
16648 @item m
16649 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16650
16651 @item M
16652 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16653 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16654
16655 @item t
16656 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16657 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16658 names are substituted when printing other types.
16659
16660 @item T
16661 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16662 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16663 @end table
16664
16665 @kindex ptype
16666 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16667 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16668 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16669 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16670
16671 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16672 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16673 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16674 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16675 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16676 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16677 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16678 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16679
16680 For example, for this variable declaration:
16681
16682 @smallexample
16683 typedef double real_t;
16684 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16685 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16686 complex_t var;
16687 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16688 @end smallexample
16689
16690 @noindent
16691 the two commands give this output:
16692
16693 @smallexample
16694 @group
16695 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16696 type = complex_t
16697 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16698 type = struct complex @{
16699 real_t real;
16700 double imag;
16701 @}
16702 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16703 type = struct complex
16704 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16705 type = struct complex
16706 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16707 type = struct complex @{
16708 real_t real;
16709 double imag;
16710 @}
16711 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16712 type = real_t *
16713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16714 type = double *
16715 @end group
16716 @end smallexample
16717
16718 @noindent
16719 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16720 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16721
16722 @cindex incomplete type
16723 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16724 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16725 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16726 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16727 given these declarations:
16728
16729 @smallexample
16730 struct foo;
16731 struct foo *fooptr;
16732 @end smallexample
16733
16734 @noindent
16735 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16736
16737 @smallexample
16738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16739 $1 = <incomplete type>
16740 @end smallexample
16741
16742 @noindent
16743 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16744 completely specified.
16745
16746 @kindex info types
16747 @item info types @var{regexp}
16748 @itemx info types
16749 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16750 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16751 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16752 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16753 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16754 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16755 name is @code{value}.
16756
16757 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16758 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16759 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16760
16761 @kindex info type-printers
16762 @item info type-printers
16763 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16764 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16765 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16766 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16767 type printers.
16768
16769 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16770
16771 @kindex enable type-printer
16772 @kindex disable type-printer
16773 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16774 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16775 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16776
16777 @kindex info scope
16778 @cindex local variables
16779 @item info scope @var{location}
16780 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16781 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16782 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16783 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16784 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16785
16786 @smallexample
16787 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16788 Scope for command_line_handler:
16789 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16790 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16791 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16792 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16793 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16794 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16795 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16796 @end smallexample
16797
16798 @noindent
16799 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16800 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16801 collect}.
16802
16803 @kindex info source
16804 @item info source
16805 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16806 the function containing the current point of execution:
16807 @itemize @bullet
16808 @item
16809 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16810 @item
16811 the directory it was compiled in,
16812 @item
16813 its length, in lines,
16814 @item
16815 which programming language it is written in,
16816 @item
16817 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16818 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16819 @item
16820 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16821 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16822 @item
16823 whether the debugging information includes information about
16824 preprocessor macros.
16825 @end itemize
16826
16827
16828 @kindex info sources
16829 @item info sources
16830 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16831 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16832 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16833
16834 @kindex info functions
16835 @item info functions
16836 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16837
16838 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16839 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16840 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16841 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16842 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16843 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16844 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16845 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16846
16847 @kindex info variables
16848 @item info variables
16849 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16850 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16851
16852 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16853 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16854 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16855 @var{regexp}.
16856
16857 @kindex info classes
16858 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16859 @item info classes
16860 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16861 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16862 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16863 expression.
16864
16865 @kindex info selectors
16866 @item info selectors
16867 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16868 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16869 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16870 expression.
16871
16872 @ignore
16873 This was never implemented.
16874 @kindex info methods
16875 @item info methods
16876 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16877 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16878 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16879 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16880 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16881 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16882 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16883 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16884 @end ignore
16885
16886 @cindex opaque data types
16887 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16888 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16889 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16890 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16891 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16892 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16893 another source file. The default is on.
16894
16895 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16896 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16897
16898 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16899 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16900 is printed as follows:
16901 @smallexample
16902 @{<no data fields>@}
16903 @end smallexample
16904
16905 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16906 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16907 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16908
16909 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16910 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16911 @item set print symbol-loading
16912 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16913 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16914 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16915 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16916 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16917 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16918 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16919 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16920 can be annoying.
16921 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16922 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16923 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16924 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16925
16926 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16927 @item show print symbol-loading
16928 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16929 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16930
16931 @kindex maint print symbols
16932 @cindex symbol dump
16933 @kindex maint print psymbols
16934 @cindex partial symbol dump
16935 @kindex maint print msymbols
16936 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16937 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16938 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16939 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16940 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16941 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16942 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16943 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16944 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16945 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16946 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16947 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16948 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16949 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16950 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16951 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16952 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16953 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16954
16955 @kindex maint info symtabs
16956 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16957 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16958 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16959 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16960 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16961 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16962 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16963
16964 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16965 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16966 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16967 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16968 structure in more detail. For example:
16969
16970 @smallexample
16971 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16972 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16973 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16974 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16975 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16976 readin no
16977 fullname (null)
16978 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16979 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16980 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16981 dependencies (none)
16982 @}
16983 @}
16984 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16985 (@value{GDBP})
16986 @end smallexample
16987 @noindent
16988 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16989 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16990 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16991 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16992 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16993
16994 @smallexample
16995 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16996 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16997 line 1574.
16998 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16999 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17000 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17001 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17002 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17003 dirname (null)
17004 fullname (null)
17005 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17006 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17007 debugformat DWARF 2
17008 @}
17009 @}
17010 (@value{GDBP})
17011 @end smallexample
17012
17013 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17014 @cindex symbol cache size
17015 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17016 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17017 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17018 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17019 with different sizes.
17020
17021 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17022 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17023 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17024
17025 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17026 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17027 @item maint print symbol-cache
17028 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17029 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17030
17031 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17032 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17033 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17034 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17035 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17036
17037 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17038 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17039 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17040 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17041 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17042 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17043
17044 @end table
17045
17046 @node Altering
17047 @chapter Altering Execution
17048
17049 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17050 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17051 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17052 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17053 program.
17054
17055 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17056 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17057 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17058
17059 @menu
17060 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17061 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17062 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17063 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17064 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17065 * Patching:: Patching your program
17066 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17067 @end menu
17068
17069 @node Assignment
17070 @section Assignment to Variables
17071
17072 @cindex assignment
17073 @cindex setting variables
17074 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17075 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17076
17077 @smallexample
17078 print x=4
17079 @end smallexample
17080
17081 @noindent
17082 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17083 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17084 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17085 information on operators in supported languages.
17086
17087 @kindex set variable
17088 @cindex variables, setting
17089 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17090 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17091 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17092 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17093 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17094
17095 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17096 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17097 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17098 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17099 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17100 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17101 command @code{set width}:
17102
17103 @smallexample
17104 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17105 type = double
17106 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17107 $4 = 13
17108 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17109 Invalid syntax in expression.
17110 @end smallexample
17111
17112 @noindent
17113 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17114 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17115
17116 @smallexample
17117 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17118 @end smallexample
17119
17120 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17121 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17122 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17123 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17124 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17125 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17126
17127 @smallexample
17128 @group
17129 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17130 type = double
17131 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17132 $1 = 1
17133 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17134 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17135 $2 = 1
17136 (@value{GDBP}) r
17137 The program being debugged has been started already.
17138 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17139 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17140 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17141 Invalid bfd target.
17142 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17143 The current BFD target is "=4".
17144 @end group
17145 @end smallexample
17146
17147 @noindent
17148 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17149 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17150 @code{g}, use
17151
17152 @smallexample
17153 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17154 @end smallexample
17155
17156 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17157 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17158 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17159 same length or shorter.
17160 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17161 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17162
17163 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17164 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17165 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17166 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17167 and representation in memory), and
17168
17169 @smallexample
17170 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17171 @end smallexample
17172
17173 @noindent
17174 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17175
17176 @node Jumping
17177 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17178
17179 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17180 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17181 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17182
17183 @table @code
17184 @kindex jump
17185 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17186 @item jump @var{location}
17187 @itemx j @var{location}
17188 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17189 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17190 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17191 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17192 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17193
17194 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17195 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17196 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17197 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17198 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17199 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17200 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17201 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17202 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17203 @end table
17204
17205 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17206 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17207 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17208 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17209 example,
17210
17211 @smallexample
17212 set $pc = 0x485
17213 @end smallexample
17214
17215 @noindent
17216 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17217 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17218 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17219
17220 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17221 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17222 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17223 detail.
17224
17225 @c @group
17226 @node Signaling
17227 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17228 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17229
17230 @table @code
17231 @kindex signal
17232 @item signal @var{signal}
17233 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17234 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17235 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17236 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17237
17238 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17239 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17240 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17241 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17242 signal.
17243
17244 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17245 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17246 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17247 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17248 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17249 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17250 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17251 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17252
17253 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17254 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17255 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17256 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17257 passes the signal directly to your program.
17258
17259 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17260 after executing the command.
17261
17262 @kindex queue-signal
17263 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17264 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17265 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17266 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17267 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17268 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17269 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17270 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17271 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17272
17273 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17274 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17275 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17276 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17277 @code{continue} command.
17278
17279 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17280 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17281 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17282 (@pxref{Signals}).
17283 @end table
17284 @c @end group
17285
17286 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17287 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17288
17289 @node Returning
17290 @section Returning from a Function
17291
17292 @table @code
17293 @cindex returning from a function
17294 @kindex return
17295 @item return
17296 @itemx return @var{expression}
17297 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17298 command. If you give an
17299 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17300 value.
17301 @end table
17302
17303 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17304 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17305 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17306 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17307
17308 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17309 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17310 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17311 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17312 of functions.
17313
17314 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17315 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17316 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17317 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17318 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17319
17320 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17321 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17322 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17323 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17324 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17325 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17326 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17327 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17328 assignment into the right register(s).
17329
17330 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17331 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17332 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17333 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17334 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17335 into a @code{long long int}:
17336
17337 @smallexample
17338 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17339 29 return 31;
17340 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17341 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17342 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17343 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17344 (@value{GDBP})
17345 @end smallexample
17346
17347 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17348 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17349 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17350 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17351 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17352 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17353 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17354 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17355
17356 @smallexample
17357 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17358 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17359 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17360 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17361 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17362 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17363 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17364 (@value{GDBP})
17365 @end smallexample
17366
17367 @node Calling
17368 @section Calling Program Functions
17369
17370 @table @code
17371 @cindex calling functions
17372 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17373 @item print @var{expr}
17374 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17375 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17376 debugged.
17377
17378 @kindex call
17379 @item call @var{expr}
17380 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17381 returned values.
17382
17383 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17384 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17385 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17386 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17387 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17388 value history.
17389 @end table
17390
17391 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17392 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17393 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17394 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17395
17396 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17397 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17398 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17399 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17400 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17401 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17402 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17403 in that case is controlled by the
17404 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17405
17406 @table @code
17407 @item set unwindonsignal
17408 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17409 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17410 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17411 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17412 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17413 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17414 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17415 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17416 received.
17417
17418 @item show unwindonsignal
17419 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17420 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17421 @value{GDBN}.
17422
17423 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17424 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17425 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17426 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17427 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17428 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17429 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17430 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17431 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17432 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17433
17434 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17435 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17436 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17437 @value{GDBN}.
17438
17439 @end table
17440
17441 @cindex weak alias functions
17442 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17443 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17444 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17445 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17446 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17447 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17448 function instead.
17449
17450 @node Patching
17451 @section Patching Programs
17452
17453 @cindex patching binaries
17454 @cindex writing into executables
17455 @cindex writing into corefiles
17456
17457 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17458 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17459 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17460 patching your program's binary.
17461
17462 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17463 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17464 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17465 repairs.
17466
17467 @table @code
17468 @kindex set write
17469 @item set write on
17470 @itemx set write off
17471 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17472 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17473 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17474
17475 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17476 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17477 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17478
17479 @item show write
17480 @kindex show write
17481 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17482 as well as reading.
17483 @end table
17484
17485 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17486 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17487 @cindex injecting code
17488 @cindex writing into executables
17489 @cindex compiling code
17490
17491 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17492 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17493 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17494 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17495
17496 @table @code
17497 @kindex compile code
17498 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17499 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17500 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17501 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17502 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17503 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17504 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17505 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17506 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17507 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17508 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17509 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17510
17511 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17512 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17513 E.g.:
17514
17515 @smallexample
17516 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17517 @end smallexample
17518
17519 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17520 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17521 from actual source code. E.g.:
17522
17523 @smallexample
17524 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17525 @end smallexample
17526
17527 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17528 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17529 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17530 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17531 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17532 editor.
17533
17534 @smallexample
17535 compile code
17536 >printf ("hello\n");
17537 >printf ("world\n");
17538 >end
17539 @end smallexample
17540
17541 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17542 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17543 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17544 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17545 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17546 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17547 inferior symbols otherwise.
17548
17549 @kindex compile file
17550 @item compile file @var{filename}
17551 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17552 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17553
17554 @smallexample
17555 compile file /home/user/example.c
17556 @end smallexample
17557 @end table
17558
17559 @table @code
17560 @item compile print @var{expr}
17561 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17562 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17563 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17564 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17565 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17566 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17567 Formats}.
17568
17569 @item compile print
17570 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17571 @cindex reprint the last value
17572 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17573 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17574 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17575 multiple-line editor.
17576 @end table
17577
17578 @noindent
17579 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17580
17581 @table @code
17582 @anchor{set debug compile}
17583 @item set debug compile
17584 @cindex compile command debugging info
17585 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17586 injecting the code. The default is off.
17587
17588 @item show debug compile
17589 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17590 compiling and injecting the code.
17591 @end table
17592
17593 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17594
17595 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17596 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17597 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17598 injecting process.
17599
17600 @noindent
17601 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17602
17603 @table @asis
17604 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17605 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17606 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17607 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17608
17609 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17610 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17611 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17612 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17613 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17614 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17615 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17616 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17617
17618 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17619 @end table
17620
17621 @noindent
17622 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17623
17624 @table @code
17625 @item set compile-args
17626 @cindex compile command options override
17627 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17628 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17629 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17630 compilation.
17631
17632 @item show compile-args
17633 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17634 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17635 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17636 @end table
17637
17638 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17639
17640 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17641 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17642 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17643
17644 @table @asis
17645 @item C code examples and caveats
17646 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17647 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17648 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17649 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17650 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17651
17652 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17653 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17654 much like any other normal debugging session.
17655
17656 @smallexample
17657 void function1 (void)
17658 @{
17659 int i = 42;
17660 printf ("function 1\n");
17661 @}
17662
17663 void function2 (void)
17664 @{
17665 int j = 12;
17666 function1 ();
17667 @}
17668
17669 int main(void)
17670 @{
17671 int k = 6;
17672 int *p;
17673 function2 ();
17674 return 0;
17675 @}
17676 @end smallexample
17677
17678 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17679 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17680 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17681
17682 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17683 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17684 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17685 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17686 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17687
17688 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17689 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17690 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17691 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17692 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17693 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17694 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17695 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17696 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17697 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17698
17699 @smallexample
17700 compile code k = 3;
17701 @end smallexample
17702
17703 @noindent
17704 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17705 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17706 @code{compile} command changes it.
17707
17708 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17709 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17710 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17711 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17712 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17713
17714 @smallexample
17715 compile code j = 3;
17716 @end smallexample
17717
17718 @noindent
17719 will result in a compilation error message.
17720
17721 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17722 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17723 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17724
17725 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17726 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17727 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17728 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17729
17730 @smallexample
17731 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17732 @end smallexample
17733
17734 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17735 command has completed:
17736
17737 @smallexample
17738 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17739 @end smallexample
17740
17741 @noindent
17742 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17743 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17744 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17745 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17746 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17747
17748 @smallexample
17749 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17750 @end smallexample
17751
17752 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17753 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17754 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17755 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17756 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17757 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17758 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17759 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17760
17761 @smallexample
17762 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17763 @end smallexample
17764
17765 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17766 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17767 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17768 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17769 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17770 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17771 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17772
17773 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17774 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17775 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17776 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17777 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17778 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17779
17780 @smallexample
17781 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17782 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17783 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17784 Compilation failed.
17785 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17786 42
17787 @end smallexample
17788
17789 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17790 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17791 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17792 will print to the console.
17793 @end table
17794
17795 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17796
17797 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17798 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17799 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17800 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17801 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17802 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17803 target architecture and operating system.
17804
17805 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17806 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17807 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17808 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17809 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17810 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17811 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17812
17813 @node GDB Files
17814 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17815
17816 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17817 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17818 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17819 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17820
17821 @menu
17822 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17823 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
17824 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17825 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17826 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17827 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17828 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17829 @end menu
17830
17831 @node Files
17832 @section Commands to Specify Files
17833
17834 @cindex symbol table
17835 @cindex core dump file
17836
17837 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17838 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17839 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17840 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17841
17842 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17843 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17844 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17845 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17846 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17847 new files are useful.
17848
17849 @table @code
17850 @cindex executable file
17851 @kindex file
17852 @item file @var{filename}
17853 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17854 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17855 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17856 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17857 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17858 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17859 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17860 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17861
17862 @cindex unlinked object files
17863 @cindex patching object files
17864 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17865 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17866 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17867 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17868 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17869 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17870 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17871 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17872
17873 @item file
17874 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17875 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17876
17877 @kindex exec-file
17878 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17879 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17880 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17881 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17882 discard information on the executable file.
17883
17884 @kindex symbol-file
17885 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17886 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17887 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17888 table and program to run from the same file.
17889
17890 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17891 program's symbol table.
17892
17893 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17894 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17895 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17896 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17897 @value{GDBN}.
17898
17899 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17900 executing it once.
17901
17902 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17903 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17904 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17905 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17906 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17907 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17908 optimized code.
17909
17910 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17911 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17912 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17913 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17914 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17915
17916 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17917 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17918 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17919 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17920 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17921 Warnings and Messages}.)
17922
17923 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17924 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17925 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17926 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17927 in stabs format.
17928
17929 @kindex readnow
17930 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17931 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17932 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17933 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17934 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17935 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17936 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17937 entire symbol table available.
17938
17939 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17940 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17941 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17942 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17943 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17944 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17945 @c files.
17946
17947 @kindex core-file
17948 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17949 @itemx core
17950 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17951 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17952 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17953 executable file itself for other parts.
17954
17955 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17956 to be used.
17957
17958 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17959 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17960 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17961 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17962 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17963
17964 @kindex add-symbol-file
17965 @cindex dynamic linking
17966 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17967 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17968 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17969 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17970 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17971 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17972 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17973 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17974 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17975 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17976 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17977 @var{address} as an expression.
17978
17979 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17980 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17981 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17982 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17983
17984 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17985
17986 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17987 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17988 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17989 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17990 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17991 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17992 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17993 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17994 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17995
17996 @itemize @bullet
17997 @item
17998 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17999 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18000 @item
18001 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18002 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18003 @item
18004 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18005 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18006 @end itemize
18007
18008 @noindent
18009 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18010 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18011 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18012 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18013 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18014 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18015 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18016 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18017 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18018 way.
18019
18020 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18021
18022 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18023 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18024 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18025 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18026 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18027 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18028
18029 @smallexample
18030 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18031 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18032 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18033 (y or n) y
18034 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18035 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18036 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18037 (gdb)
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040
18041 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18042
18043 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18044 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18045 @cindex load symbols from memory
18046 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18047 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18048 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18049 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18050 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18051 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18052 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18053 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18054 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18055
18056 @kindex section
18057 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18058 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18059 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18060 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18061 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18062 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18063 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18064 their addresses.
18065
18066 @kindex info files
18067 @kindex info target
18068 @item info files
18069 @itemx info target
18070 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18071 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18072 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18073 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18074 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18075 current ones.
18076
18077 @kindex maint info sections
18078 @item maint info sections
18079 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18080 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18081 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18082 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18083 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18084 may be arbitrarily combined):
18085
18086 @table @code
18087 @item ALLOBJ
18088 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18089 @item @var{sections}
18090 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18091 @item @var{section-flags}
18092 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18093 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18094 @table @code
18095 @item ALLOC
18096 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18097 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18098 @item LOAD
18099 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18100 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18101 @item RELOC
18102 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18103 @item READONLY
18104 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18105 @item CODE
18106 Section contains executable code only.
18107 @item DATA
18108 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18109 @item ROM
18110 Section will reside in ROM.
18111 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18112 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18113 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18114 Section is not empty.
18115 @item NEVER_LOAD
18116 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18117 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18118 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18119 COFF shared library information.
18120 @item IS_COMMON
18121 Section contains common symbols.
18122 @end table
18123 @end table
18124 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18125 @cindex read-only sections
18126 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18127 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18128 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18129 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18130 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18131 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18132 enhancement to debugging performance.
18133
18134 The default is off.
18135
18136 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18137 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18138 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18139 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18140
18141 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18142 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18143 @end table
18144
18145 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18146 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18147 name and remembers it that way.
18148
18149 @cindex shared libraries
18150 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18151 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18152 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18153 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18154
18155 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18156 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18157
18158 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18159 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18160 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18161 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18162 debugging a core file).
18163
18164 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18165 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18166 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18167
18168 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18169 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18170 particularly large or there are many of them.
18171
18172 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18173 commands:
18174
18175 @table @code
18176 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18177 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18178 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18179 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18180 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18181 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18182 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18183 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18184
18185 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18186 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18187 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18188 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18189 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18190 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18191 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18192 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18193 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18194
18195 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18196 @item show auto-solib-add
18197 Display the current autoloading mode.
18198 @end table
18199
18200 @cindex load shared library
18201 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18202 command:
18203
18204 @table @code
18205 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18206 @kindex info share
18207 @item info share @var{regex}
18208 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18209 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18210 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18211 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18212
18213 @kindex info dll
18214 @item info dll @var{regex}
18215 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18216
18217 @kindex sharedlibrary
18218 @kindex share
18219 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18220 @itemx share @var{regex}
18221 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18222 Unix regular expression.
18223 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18224 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18225 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18226 loaded.
18227
18228 @item nosharedlibrary
18229 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18230 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18231 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18232 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18233 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18234 discarded.
18235 @end table
18236
18237 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18238 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18239 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18240 Catchpoints}).
18241
18242 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18243 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18244 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18245 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18246
18247 @table @code
18248 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18249 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18250 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18251 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18252 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18253 shared library.
18254
18255 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18256 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18257 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18258 library events happen.
18259 @end table
18260
18261 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18262 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18263 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18264 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18265 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18266 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18267 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18268 not.
18269
18270 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18271 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18272 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18273 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18274 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18275
18276 @table @code
18277 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18278 @cindex system root, alternate
18279 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18280 @kindex set sysroot
18281 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18282 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18283 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18284 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18285 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18286 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18287 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18288 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18289 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18290 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18291 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18292 @var{path}.
18293
18294 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18295 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18296 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18297 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18298 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18299 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18300 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18301 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18302 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18303 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18304 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18305 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18306 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18307 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18308
18309 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18310 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18311 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18312 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18313 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18314
18315 @smallexample
18316 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18317 @end smallexample
18318
18319 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18320 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18321 system:
18322
18323 @smallexample
18324 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18325 @end smallexample
18326
18327 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18328 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18329 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18330 colons:
18331
18332 @smallexample
18333 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18334 @end smallexample
18335
18336 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18337 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18338 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18339 @samp{z}):
18340
18341 @smallexample
18342 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18343 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18344 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18345 @end smallexample
18346
18347 @noindent
18348 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18349 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18350 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18351
18352 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18353 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18354
18355 @smallexample
18356 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18357 @end smallexample
18358
18359 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18360 if you don't want or need to.
18361
18362 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18363 sysroot}.
18364
18365 @cindex default system root
18366 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18367 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18368 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18369 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18370 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18371 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18372 location.
18373
18374 @kindex show sysroot
18375 @item show sysroot
18376 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18377
18378 @kindex set solib-search-path
18379 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18380 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18381 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18382 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18383 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18384 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18385 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18386 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18387 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18388 of shared library symbols.
18389
18390 @kindex show solib-search-path
18391 @item show solib-search-path
18392 Display the current shared library search path.
18393
18394 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18395 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18396 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18397 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18398 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18399
18400 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18401 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18402 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18403 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18404 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18405 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18406 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18407 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18408 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18409 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18410 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18411 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18412 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18413 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18414 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18415 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18416 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18417 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18418 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18419 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18420 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18421 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18422
18423 @table @code
18424 @item unix
18425 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18426 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18427 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18428 the forward slash.
18429
18430 @item dos-based
18431 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18432 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18433 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18434 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18435 considered directory separators.
18436
18437 @item auto
18438 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18439 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18440 This is the default.
18441 @end table
18442 @end table
18443
18444 @cindex file name canonicalization
18445 @cindex base name differences
18446 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18447 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18448 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18449 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18450 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18451 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18452 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18453 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18454 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18455 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18456 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18457 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18458 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18459 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18460 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18461
18462 @table @code
18463 @item set basenames-may-differ
18464 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18465 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18466
18467 @item show basenames-may-differ
18468 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18469 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18470 @end table
18471
18472 @node File Caching
18473 @section File Caching
18474 @cindex caching of opened files
18475 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18476
18477 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18478 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18479 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18480 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18481
18482 @table @code
18483 @kindex maint info bfds
18484 @item maint info bfds
18485 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18486 @value{GDBN}.
18487
18488 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18489 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18490 @kindex bfd caching
18491 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18492 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18493 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18494 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18495 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18496 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18497 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18498 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18499 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18500
18501 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18502 @kindex bfd caching
18503 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18504 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18505
18506 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18507 @kindex bfd caching
18508 @item show debug bfd-cache
18509 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18510 @end table
18511
18512 @node Separate Debug Files
18513 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18514 @cindex separate debugging information files
18515 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18516 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18517 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18518 @cindex global debugging information directories
18519 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18520 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18521
18522 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18523 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18524 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18525 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18526 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18527 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18528 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18529
18530 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18531 file:
18532
18533 @itemize @bullet
18534 @item
18535 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18536 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18537 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18538 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18539 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18540 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18541 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18542 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18543
18544 @item
18545 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18546 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18547 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18548 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18549 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18550 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18551 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18552 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18553 below.
18554 @end itemize
18555
18556 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18557 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18558
18559 @itemize @bullet
18560 @item
18561 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18562 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18563 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18564 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18565 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18566
18567 @item
18568 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18569 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18570 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18571 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18572 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18573 hex characters, not 10.)
18574 @end itemize
18575
18576 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18577 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18578 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18579 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18580 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18581 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18582
18583 @itemize @minus
18584 @item
18585 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18586 @item
18587 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18588 @item
18589 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18590 @item
18591 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18592 @end itemize
18593
18594 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18595 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18596 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18597 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18598 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18599
18600 @table @code
18601
18602 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18603 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18604 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18605 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18606 concatenating them by a path separator.
18607
18608 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18609 @item show debug-file-directory
18610 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18611 information files.
18612
18613 @end table
18614
18615 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18616 @cindex debug link sections
18617 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18618 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18619
18620 @itemize
18621 @item
18622 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18623 a zero byte,
18624 @item
18625 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18626 boundary within the section, and
18627 @item
18628 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18629 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18630 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18631 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18632 @end itemize
18633
18634 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18635 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18636 described above.
18637
18638 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18639 @cindex build ID sections
18640 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18641 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18642 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18643 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18644 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18645 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18646 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18647 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18648 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18649
18650 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18651 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18652 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18653 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18654 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18655 in an ordinary executable.
18656
18657 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18658 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18659 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18660 following commands:
18661
18662 @smallexample
18663 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18664 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18665 @end smallexample
18666
18667 @noindent
18668 These commands remove the debugging
18669 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18670 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18671 two files:
18672
18673 @itemize @bullet
18674 @item
18675 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18676 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18677
18678 @smallexample
18679 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18680 @end smallexample
18681
18682 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18683 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18684 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18685 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18686
18687 @item
18688 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18689 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18690 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18691 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18692 @end itemize
18693
18694 @noindent
18695
18696 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18697 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18698 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18699
18700 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18701 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18702 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18703 @c different ways!
18704 @ifhtml
18705 @display
18706 @html
18707 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18708 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18709 @end html
18710 @end display
18711 @end ifhtml
18712 @ifnothtml
18713 @display
18714 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18715 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18716 @end display
18717 @end ifnothtml
18718
18719 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18720 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18721 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18722 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18723 CRC.
18724
18725 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18726 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18727 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18728 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18729 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18730
18731 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18732 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18733 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18734 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18735 @code{0xffffffff}.
18736
18737 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18738 @smallexample
18739 unsigned long
18740 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18741 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18742 @{
18743 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18744 @{
18745 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18746 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18747 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18748 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18749 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18750 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18751 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18752 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18753 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18754 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18755 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18756 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18757 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18758 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18759 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18760 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18761 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18762 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18763 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18764 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18765 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18766 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18767 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18768 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18769 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18770 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18771 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18772 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18773 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18774 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18775 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18776 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18777 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18778 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18779 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18780 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18781 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18782 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18783 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18784 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18785 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18786 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18787 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18788 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18789 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18790 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18791 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18792 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18793 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18794 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18795 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18796 0x2d02ef8d
18797 @};
18798 unsigned char *end;
18799
18800 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18801 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18802 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18803 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18804 @}
18805 @end smallexample
18806
18807 @noindent
18808 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18809
18810 @node MiniDebugInfo
18811 @section Debugging information in a special section
18812 @cindex separate debug sections
18813 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18814
18815 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18816 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18817 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18818 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18819
18820 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18821 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18822 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18823 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18824 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18825 debugging information might be included in the section.
18826
18827 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18828 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18829 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18830
18831 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18832 standard utilities:
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18836 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18837 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18838 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18839
18840 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18841 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18842 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18843 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18844 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18845 | sort > funcsyms
18846
18847 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18848 # table.
18849 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18850
18851 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18852 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18853
18854 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18855 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18856 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18857 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18858
18859 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18860 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18861
18862 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18863 # original binary.
18864 xz mini_debuginfo
18865 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18866 @end smallexample
18867
18868 @node Index Files
18869 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18870 @cindex index files
18871 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18872
18873 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18874 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18875 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18876 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18877 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18878 startup.
18879
18880 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18881 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18882 using @command{objcopy}.
18883
18884 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18885
18886 @table @code
18887 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18888 @kindex save gdb-index
18889 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18890 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18891 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18892 @var{directory}.
18893 @end table
18894
18895 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18896 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18897
18898 @smallexample
18899 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18900 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18901 @end smallexample
18902
18903 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18904 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18905 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18906 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18907 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18908 The default is @code{off}.
18909 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18910 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18911
18912 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18913 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18914
18915 @smallexample
18916 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18917 @end smallexample
18918
18919 Instead you must do, for example,
18920
18921 @smallexample
18922 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18923 @end smallexample
18924
18925 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18926 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18927 currently work for programs using Ada.
18928
18929 @node Symbol Errors
18930 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18931
18932 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18933 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18934 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18935 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18936 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18937 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18938 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18939 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18940 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18941 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18942 Messages}).
18943
18944 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18945
18946 @table @code
18947 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18948
18949 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18950 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18951 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18952 in its outer scope blocks.
18953
18954 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18955 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18956 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18957 function.
18958
18959 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18960
18961 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18962 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18963 do so.
18964
18965 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18966 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18967 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18968 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18969 Messages}.)
18970
18971 @item bad block start address patched
18972
18973 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18974 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18975 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18976
18977 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18978 starting on the previous source line.
18979
18980 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18981
18982 @cindex foo
18983 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18984 larger than the size of the string table.
18985
18986 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18987 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18988 with this name.
18989
18990 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18991
18992 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18993 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18994 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18995
18996 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18997 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18998 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18999 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19000 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19001 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19002
19003 @item stub type has NULL name
19004
19005 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19006
19007 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19008 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19009 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19010 it.
19011
19012 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19013
19014 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19015
19016 @end table
19017
19018 @node Data Files
19019 @section GDB Data Files
19020
19021 @cindex prefix for data files
19022 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19023 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19024
19025 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19026 is currently using.
19027
19028 @table @code
19029 @kindex set data-directory
19030 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19031 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19032 to @var{directory}.
19033
19034 @kindex show data-directory
19035 @item show data-directory
19036 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19037 @end table
19038
19039 @cindex default data directory
19040 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19041 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19042 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19043 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19044 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19045 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19046 location.
19047
19048 The data directory may also be specified with the
19049 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19050 @xref{Mode Options}.
19051
19052 @node Targets
19053 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19054
19055 @cindex debugging target
19056 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19057
19058 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19059 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19060 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19061 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19062 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19063 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19064 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19065 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19066
19067 @cindex target architecture
19068 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19069 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19070 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19071 command.
19072
19073 @table @code
19074 @kindex set architecture
19075 @kindex show architecture
19076 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19077 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19078 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19079 supported architectures.
19080
19081 @item show architecture
19082 Show the current target architecture.
19083
19084 @item set processor
19085 @itemx processor
19086 @kindex set processor
19087 @kindex show processor
19088 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19089 and @code{show architecture}.
19090 @end table
19091
19092 @menu
19093 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19094 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19095 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19096 @end menu
19097
19098 @node Active Targets
19099 @section Active Targets
19100
19101 @cindex stacking targets
19102 @cindex active targets
19103 @cindex multiple targets
19104
19105 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19106 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19107 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19108 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19109 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19110 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19111 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19112 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19113 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19114
19115 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19116 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19117 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19118 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19119
19120 @node Target Commands
19121 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19122
19123 @table @code
19124 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19125 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19126 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19127 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19128 protocol of the target machine.
19129
19130 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19131 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19132 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19133
19134 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19135 after executing the command.
19136
19137 @kindex help target
19138 @item help target
19139 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19140 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19141 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19142
19143 @item help target @var{name}
19144 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19145 select it.
19146
19147 @kindex set gnutarget
19148 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19149 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19150 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19151 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19152 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19153 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19154
19155 @quotation
19156 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19157 you must know the actual BFD name.
19158 @end quotation
19159
19160 @noindent
19161 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19162
19163 @kindex show gnutarget
19164 @item show gnutarget
19165 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19166 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19167 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19168 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19169 @end table
19170
19171 @cindex common targets
19172 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19173 configuration):
19174
19175 @table @code
19176 @kindex target
19177 @item target exec @var{program}
19178 @cindex executable file target
19179 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19180 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19181
19182 @item target core @var{filename}
19183 @cindex core dump file target
19184 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19185 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19186
19187 @item target remote @var{medium}
19188 @cindex remote target
19189 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19190 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19191 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19192
19193 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19194 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19195
19196 @smallexample
19197 target remote /dev/ttya
19198 @end smallexample
19199
19200 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19201 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19202 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19203 clobbered by the download.
19204
19205 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19206 @cindex built-in simulator target
19207 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19208 In general,
19209 @smallexample
19210 target sim
19211 load
19212 run
19213 @end smallexample
19214 @noindent
19215 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19216 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19217 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19218 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19219 Processors}.
19220
19221 @item target native
19222 @cindex native target
19223 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19224 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19225 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19226 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19227
19228 @end table
19229
19230 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19231 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19232
19233 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19234 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19235 various aspects of this process.
19236
19237 @table @code
19238
19239 @item set hash
19240 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19241 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19242 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19243 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19244 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19245 monitor.
19246
19247 @item show hash
19248 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19249 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19250
19251 @item set debug monitor
19252 @kindex set debug monitor
19253 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19254 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19255 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19256
19257 @item show debug monitor
19258 @kindex show debug monitor
19259 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19260 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19261 @end table
19262
19263 @table @code
19264
19265 @kindex load @var{filename}
19266 @item load @var{filename}
19267 @anchor{load}
19268 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19269 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19270 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19271 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19272 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19273 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19274
19275 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19276 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19277 target is @dots{}}''
19278
19279 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19280 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19281 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19282 specifies a fixed address.
19283 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19284
19285 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19286 load programs into flash memory.
19287
19288 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19289 @end table
19290
19291 @node Byte Order
19292 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19293
19294 @cindex choosing target byte order
19295 @cindex target byte order
19296
19297 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19298 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19299 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19300 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19301 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19302 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19303
19304 @table @code
19305 @kindex set endian
19306 @item set endian big
19307 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19308
19309 @item set endian little
19310 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19311
19312 @item set endian auto
19313 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19314 executable.
19315
19316 @item show endian
19317 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19318
19319 @end table
19320
19321 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19322 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19323 target system.
19324
19325
19326 @node Remote Debugging
19327 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19328 @cindex remote debugging
19329
19330 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19331 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19332 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19333 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19334 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19335
19336 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19337 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19338 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19339 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19340 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19341 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19342
19343 Other remote targets may be available in your
19344 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19345
19346 @menu
19347 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19348 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19349 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19350 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19351 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19352 @end menu
19353
19354 @node Connecting
19355 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19356 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19357 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19358 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19359 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19360 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19361 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19362
19363 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19364 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19365 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19366 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19367
19368 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19369
19370 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19371 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19372 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19373 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19374
19375 @table @asis
19376
19377 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19378 @item Result of detach or program exit
19379 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19380 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19381 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19382
19383 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19384 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19385 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19386 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19387
19388 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19389 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19390 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19391 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19392
19393 @item Specifying the program to debug
19394 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19395 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19396 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19397 target.
19398
19399 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19400 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19401 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19402
19403 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19404 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19405 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19406 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19407
19408 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19409 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19410 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19411 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19412 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19413 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19414 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19415 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19416 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19417
19418 @item The @code{run} command
19419 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19420 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19421 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19422 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19423 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19424
19425 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19426 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19427 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19428 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19429 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19430
19431 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19432 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19433 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19434 @code{target remote} mode.
19435
19436 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19437 @item Attaching
19438 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19439 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19440 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19441
19442 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19443 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19444 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19445 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19446 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19447
19448 @end table
19449
19450 @anchor{Host and target files}
19451 @subsection Host and Target Files
19452 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19453 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19454
19455 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19456 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19457 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19458 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19459 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19460
19461 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19462 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19463 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19464 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19465 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19466
19467 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19468 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19469 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19470 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19471 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19472 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19473 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19474 target libraries.
19475
19476 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19477 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19478 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19479 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19480 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19481 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19482 programs.
19483
19484 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19485 @cindex remote connection commands
19486 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19487 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19488 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19489 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19490 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19491 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19492 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19493
19494 @table @code
19495
19496 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19497 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19498 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19499 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19500 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19501
19502 @smallexample
19503 target remote /dev/ttyb
19504 @end smallexample
19505
19506 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19507 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19508 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19509 @code{target} command.
19510
19511 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19512 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19513 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19514 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19515 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19516 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19517 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19518 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19519 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19520 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19521 target.
19522
19523 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19524 @code{manyfarms}:
19525
19526 @smallexample
19527 target remote manyfarms:2828
19528 @end smallexample
19529
19530 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19531 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19532 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19533 port 1234 on your local machine:
19534
19535 @smallexample
19536 target remote :1234
19537 @end smallexample
19538 @noindent
19539
19540 Note that the colon is still required here.
19541
19542 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19543 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19544 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19545 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19546 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19547
19548 @smallexample
19549 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19550 @end smallexample
19551
19552 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19553 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19554 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19555 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19556
19557 @item target remote | @var{command}
19558 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19559 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19560 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19561 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19562 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19563 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19564 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19565 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19566 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19567
19568 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19569 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19570 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19571
19572 @end table
19573
19574 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19575 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19576 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19577 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19578 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19579 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19580 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19581
19582 @smallexample
19583 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19584 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19585 @end smallexample
19586
19587 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19588 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19589 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19590 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19591
19592 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19593 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19594
19595 @table @code
19596 @kindex detach (remote)
19597 @item detach
19598 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19599 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19600 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19601 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19602 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19603 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19604 still connected to the target.
19605
19606 @kindex disconnect
19607 @item disconnect
19608 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19609 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19610 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19611 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19612 another target.
19613
19614 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19615 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19616 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19617 @kindex monitor
19618 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19619 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19620 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19621 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19622 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19623 and implement.
19624 @end table
19625
19626 @node File Transfer
19627 @section Sending files to a remote system
19628 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19629 @cindex file transfer
19630 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19631
19632 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19633 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19634 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19635 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19636 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19637 the only way to upload or download files.
19638
19639 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19640
19641 @table @code
19642 @kindex remote put
19643 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19644 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19645 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19646
19647 @kindex remote get
19648 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19649 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19650 on the host system.
19651
19652 @kindex remote delete
19653 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19654 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19655
19656 @end table
19657
19658 @node Server
19659 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19660
19661 @kindex gdbserver
19662 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19663 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19664 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19665 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19666 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19667
19668 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19669 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19670 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19671 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19672 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19673 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19674 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19675 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19676 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19677 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19678 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19679 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19680 choice for debugging.
19681
19682 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19683 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19684 protocol.
19685
19686 @quotation
19687 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19688 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19689 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19690 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19691 @code{gdbserver}.
19692 @end quotation
19693
19694 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
19695 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19696 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19697 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19698
19699 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19700 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19701 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19702 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19703 system does all the symbol handling.
19704
19705 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19706 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19707 syntax is:
19708
19709 @smallexample
19710 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19711 @end smallexample
19712
19713 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19714 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19715 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19716 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19717 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19718 @file{/dev/com1}:
19719
19720 @smallexample
19721 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19722 @end smallexample
19723
19724 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19725 with it.
19726
19727 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19728
19729 @smallexample
19730 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19731 @end smallexample
19732
19733 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19734 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19735 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19736 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19737 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19738 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19739 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19740 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19741 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19742 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19743 @code{target remote} command.
19744
19745 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19746 with ssh:
19747
19748 @smallexample
19749 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19750 @end smallexample
19751
19752 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19753 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19754 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19755 You could elide it if you want to.
19756
19757 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19758 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19759 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19760 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19761
19762 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
19763 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19764 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19765 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19766
19767 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19768 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19769
19770 @smallexample
19771 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19772 @end smallexample
19773
19774 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
19775 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19776
19777 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
19778 @value{GDBN} attach command
19779 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
19780
19781 @pindex pidof
19782 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19783 @code{pidof} utility:
19784
19785 @smallexample
19786 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19787 @end smallexample
19788
19789 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19790 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19791 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19792
19793 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19794
19795 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
19796 port.
19797
19798 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19799 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19800 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19801 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19802 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19803 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19804 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19805 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19806
19807 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19808 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19809 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19810
19811 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19812 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19813 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19814 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19815 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19816 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19817 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19818 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19819 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19820 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19821 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19822 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19823
19824 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19825 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19826
19827 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
19828 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
19829 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
19830 program. For more information,
19831 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
19832
19833 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19834 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19835 status information about the debugging process.
19836 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19837 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19838 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19839 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19840
19841 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19842 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19843 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19844 Possible options are:
19845
19846 @table @code
19847 @item none
19848 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19849 @item all
19850 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19851 @item timestamps
19852 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19853 @end table
19854
19855 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19856 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19857
19858 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19859 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19860 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19861 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19862 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19863
19864 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19865 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19866 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19867 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19868
19869 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19870 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19871 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19872 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19873
19874 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19875 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19876 environment:
19877
19878 @smallexample
19879 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19880 @end smallexample
19881
19882 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19883
19884 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
19885 @itemize
19886
19887 @item
19888 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19889
19890 @item
19891 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
19892 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
19893 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
19894 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
19895 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
19896 @code{--with-sysroot}).
19897
19898 @item
19899 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19900 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19901 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19902 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19903 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19904 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
19905 program is already on the target.
19906
19907 @end itemize
19908
19909 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19910 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19911 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19912
19913 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19914 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19915 Here are the available commands.
19916
19917 @table @code
19918 @item monitor help
19919 List the available monitor commands.
19920
19921 @item monitor set debug 0
19922 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19923 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19924
19925 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19926 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19927 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19928 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19929
19930 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19931 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19932 Possible options are:
19933
19934 @table @code
19935 @item none
19936 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19937 @item all
19938 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19939 @item timestamps
19940 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19941 @end table
19942
19943 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19944 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19945
19946 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19947 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19948 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19949 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19950 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19951 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19952
19953 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19954 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19955
19956 @item monitor exit
19957 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19958 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19959 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19960 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19961 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19962
19963 @end table
19964
19965 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19966 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19967
19968 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19969 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19970
19971 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19972 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19973 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19974 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19975 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19976 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19977 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19978 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19979 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19980 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19981 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19982 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19983
19984 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19985
19986 @table @code
19987 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19988
19989 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19990 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19991 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19992
19993 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19994
19995 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19996 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19997 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19998 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19999 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20000 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20001
20002 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20003
20004 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20005 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20006 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20007 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20008 command for that. For example:
20009
20010 @smallexample
20011 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20012 @end smallexample
20013
20014 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20015 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20016 @end table
20017
20018 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20019 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20020 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20021 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20022 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20023 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20024 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20025 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20026 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20027 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20028
20029 @smallexample
20030 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20031 @end smallexample
20032
20033 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20034
20035 @smallexample
20036 $ gdb myprogram
20037 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20038 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20039 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20040 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20041 @end smallexample
20042
20043 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20044 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20045 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20046 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20047 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20048 tracing.
20049
20050 @node Remote Configuration
20051 @section Remote Configuration
20052
20053 @kindex set remote
20054 @kindex show remote
20055 This section documents the configuration options available when
20056 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20057 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20058 system-call-allowed}.
20059
20060 @table @code
20061 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20062 @cindex address size for remote targets
20063 @cindex bits in remote address
20064 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20065 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20066 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20067 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20068
20069 @item show remoteaddresssize
20070 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20071
20072 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20073 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20074 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20075 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20076 remote targets.
20077
20078 @item show serial baud
20079 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20080
20081 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20082 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20083 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20084
20085 @item show serial parity
20086 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20087
20088 @item set remotebreak
20089 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20090 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20091 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20092 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20093 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20094 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20095 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20096 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20097
20098 @item show remotebreak
20099 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20100 interrupt the remote program.
20101
20102 @item set remoteflow on
20103 @itemx set remoteflow off
20104 @kindex set remoteflow
20105 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20106 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20107
20108 @item show remoteflow
20109 @kindex show remoteflow
20110 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20111
20112 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20113 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20114 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20115 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20116 @code{ascii}.
20117
20118 @item show remotelogbase
20119 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20120 protocol.
20121
20122 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20123 @cindex record serial communications on file
20124 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20125 default is not to record at all.
20126
20127 @item show remotelogfile.
20128 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20129 serial communications.
20130
20131 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20132 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20133 @cindex remote timeout
20134 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20135 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20136
20137 @item show remotetimeout
20138 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20139 responses.
20140
20141 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20142 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20143 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20144 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20145 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20146 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20147 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20148 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20149
20150 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20151 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20152 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20153 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20154 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20155 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20156 as unlimited.
20157
20158 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20159 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20160 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20161
20162 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20163 @itemx show remote exec-file
20164 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20165 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20166 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20167 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20168 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20169 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20170
20171 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20172 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20173 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20174 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20175 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20176 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20177 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20178 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20179 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20180 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20181
20182 @item show interrupt-sequence
20183 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20184 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20185 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20186 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20187
20188 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20189 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20190 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20191 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20192 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20193 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20194
20195 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20196 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20197 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20198
20199 @kindex set tcp
20200 @kindex show tcp
20201 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20202 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20203 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20204 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20205 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20206 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20207 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20208 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20209 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20210
20211 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20212 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20213
20214 @item show tcp auto-retry
20215 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20216
20217 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20218 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20219 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20220 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20221 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20222 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20223 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20224 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20225 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20226 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20227 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20228
20229 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20230 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20231 @end table
20232
20233 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20234 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20235 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20236 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20237 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20238 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20239 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20240 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20241 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20242
20243 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20244 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20245 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20246 @value{GDBN} developers.
20247
20248 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20249 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20250 are:
20251
20252 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20253 @item Command Name
20254 @tab Remote Packet
20255 @tab Related Features
20256
20257 @item @code{fetch-register}
20258 @tab @code{p}
20259 @tab @code{info registers}
20260
20261 @item @code{set-register}
20262 @tab @code{P}
20263 @tab @code{set}
20264
20265 @item @code{binary-download}
20266 @tab @code{X}
20267 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20268
20269 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20270 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20271 @tab @code{info auxv}
20272
20273 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20274 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20275 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20276
20277 @item @code{attach}
20278 @tab @code{vAttach}
20279 @tab @code{attach}
20280
20281 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20282 @tab @code{vCont}
20283 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20284
20285 @item @code{run}
20286 @tab @code{vRun}
20287 @tab @code{run}
20288
20289 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20290 @tab @code{Z0}
20291 @tab @code{break}
20292
20293 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20294 @tab @code{Z1}
20295 @tab @code{hbreak}
20296
20297 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20298 @tab @code{Z2}
20299 @tab @code{watch}
20300
20301 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20302 @tab @code{Z3}
20303 @tab @code{rwatch}
20304
20305 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20306 @tab @code{Z4}
20307 @tab @code{awatch}
20308
20309 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20310 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20311 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20312
20313 @item @code{target-features}
20314 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20315 @tab @code{set architecture}
20316
20317 @item @code{library-info}
20318 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20319 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20320
20321 @item @code{memory-map}
20322 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20323 @tab @code{info mem}
20324
20325 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20326 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20327 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20328
20329 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20330 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20331 @tab @code{info spu}
20332
20333 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20334 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20335 @tab @code{info spu}
20336
20337 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20338 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20339 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20340
20341 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20342 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20343 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20344
20345 @item @code{threads}
20346 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20347 @tab @code{info threads}
20348
20349 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20350 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20351 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20352
20353 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20354 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20355 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20356
20357 @item @code{search-memory}
20358 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20359 @tab @code{find}
20360
20361 @item @code{supported-packets}
20362 @tab @code{qSupported}
20363 @tab Remote communications parameters
20364
20365 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20366 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20367 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20368
20369 @item @code{pass-signals}
20370 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20371 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20372
20373 @item @code{program-signals}
20374 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20375 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20376
20377 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20378 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20379 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20380
20381 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20382 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20383 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20384
20385 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20386 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20387 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20388
20389 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20390 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20391 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20392
20393 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20394 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20395 @tab @code{remote delete}
20396
20397 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20398 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20399 @tab Host I/O
20400
20401 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20402 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20403 @tab Host I/O
20404
20405 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20406 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20407 @tab Host I/O
20408
20409 @item @code{noack-packet}
20410 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20411 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20412
20413 @item @code{osdata}
20414 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20415 @tab @code{info os}
20416
20417 @item @code{query-attached}
20418 @tab @code{qAttached}
20419 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20420
20421 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20422 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20423 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20424
20425 @item @code{trace-status}
20426 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20427 @tab @code{tstatus}
20428
20429 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20430 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20431 @tab Traceframe info
20432
20433 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20434 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20435 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20436
20437 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20438 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20439 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20440
20441 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20442 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20443 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20444
20445 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20446 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20447 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20448
20449 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20450 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20451 @tab @code{break}
20452
20453 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20454 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20455 @tab @code{hbreak}
20456
20457 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20458 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20459 @tab @code{fork}
20460
20461 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20462 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20463 @tab @code{vfork}
20464
20465 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20466 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20467 @tab @code{exec}
20468
20469 @item @code{thread-events}
20470 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20471 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20472
20473 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20474 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20475 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20476
20477 @end multitable
20478
20479 @node Remote Stub
20480 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20481
20482 @cindex debugging stub, example
20483 @cindex remote stub, example
20484 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20485 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20486 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20487 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20488 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20489 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20490 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20491 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20492
20493 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20494 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20495 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20496 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20497 program, you need:
20498
20499 @enumerate
20500 @item
20501 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20502 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20503 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20504
20505 @item
20506 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20507 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20508
20509 @item
20510 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20511 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20512 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20513 documentation.
20514 @end enumerate
20515
20516 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20517 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20518 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20519
20520 @table @emph
20521 @item On the host,
20522 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20523 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20524 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20525
20526 @item On the target,
20527 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20528 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20529 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20530
20531 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20532 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20533 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20534 @end table
20535
20536 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20537 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20538 @sc{sparc} boards.
20539
20540 @cindex remote serial stub list
20541 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20542
20543 @table @code
20544
20545 @item i386-stub.c
20546 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20547 @cindex Intel
20548 @cindex i386
20549 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20550
20551 @item m68k-stub.c
20552 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20553 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20554 @cindex m680x0
20555 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20556
20557 @item sh-stub.c
20558 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20559 @cindex Renesas
20560 @cindex SH
20561 For Renesas SH architectures.
20562
20563 @item sparc-stub.c
20564 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20565 @cindex Sparc
20566 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20567
20568 @item sparcl-stub.c
20569 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20570 @cindex Fujitsu
20571 @cindex SparcLite
20572 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20573
20574 @end table
20575
20576 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20577 recently added stubs.
20578
20579 @menu
20580 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20581 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20582 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20583 @end menu
20584
20585 @node Stub Contents
20586 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20587
20588 @cindex remote serial stub
20589 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20590 subroutines:
20591
20592 @table @code
20593 @item set_debug_traps
20594 @findex set_debug_traps
20595 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20596 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20597 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20598 program's startup code.
20599
20600 @item handle_exception
20601 @findex handle_exception
20602 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20603 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20604 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20605 run when a trap is triggered.
20606
20607 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20608 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20609 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20610 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20611 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20612 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20613 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20614 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20615 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20616 machine.
20617
20618 @item breakpoint
20619 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20620 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20621 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20622 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20623 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20624 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20625 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20626 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20627 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20628 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20629 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20630
20631 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20632 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20633 start of your debugging session.
20634 @end table
20635
20636 @node Bootstrapping
20637 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20638
20639 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20640 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20641 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20642 debugging target machine.
20643
20644 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20645 serial port.
20646
20647 @table @code
20648 @item int getDebugChar()
20649 @findex getDebugChar
20650 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20651 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20652 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20653
20654 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20655 @findex putDebugChar
20656 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20657 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20658 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20659 @end table
20660
20661 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20662 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20663 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20664 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20665 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20666 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20667 remote system to stop.
20668
20669 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20670 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20671 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20672 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20673
20674 Other routines you need to supply are:
20675
20676 @table @code
20677 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20678 @findex exceptionHandler
20679 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20680 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20681 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20682 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20683 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20684 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20685 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20686 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20687 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20688 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20689 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20690 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20691 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20692
20693 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20694 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20695 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20696 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20697 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20698
20699 @item void flush_i_cache()
20700 @findex flush_i_cache
20701 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20702 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20703 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20704
20705 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20706 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20707 @end table
20708
20709 @noindent
20710 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20711
20712 @table @code
20713 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20714 @findex memset
20715 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20716 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20717 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20718 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20719 @end table
20720
20721 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20722 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20723 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20724 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20725
20726
20727 @node Debug Session
20728 @subsection Putting it All Together
20729
20730 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20731 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20732 steps.
20733
20734 @enumerate
20735 @item
20736 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20737 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20738 @display
20739 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20740 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20741 @end display
20742
20743 @item
20744 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20745 procedure is called:
20746
20747 @smallexample
20748 set_debug_traps();
20749 breakpoint();
20750 @end smallexample
20751
20752 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20753 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20754 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20755 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20756 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20757 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20758 progress.
20759
20760 @item
20761 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20762 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20763
20764 @smallexample
20765 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20766 @end smallexample
20767
20768 @noindent
20769 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20770 function in your program, that function is called when
20771 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20772 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20773 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20774
20775 @item
20776 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20777 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20778
20779 @item
20780 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20781 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20782
20783 @item
20784 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20785 @c document that. FIXME.
20786 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20787 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20788
20789 @item
20790 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20791 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20792
20793 @end enumerate
20794
20795 @node Configurations
20796 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20797
20798 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20799 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20800 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20801
20802 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20803 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20804 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20805 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20806 are quite different from each other.
20807
20808 @menu
20809 * Native::
20810 * Embedded OS::
20811 * Embedded Processors::
20812 * Architectures::
20813 @end menu
20814
20815 @node Native
20816 @section Native
20817
20818 This section describes details specific to particular native
20819 configurations.
20820
20821 @menu
20822 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20823 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20824 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20825 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20826 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20827 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20828 @end menu
20829
20830 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20831 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20832
20833 @cindex libkvm
20834 @cindex kernel memory image
20835 @cindex kernel crash dump
20836
20837 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20838 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20839 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20840 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20841 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20842 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20843 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20844 @code{kvm} target:
20845
20846 @smallexample
20847 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20848 @end smallexample
20849
20850 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20851 argument:
20852
20853 @smallexample
20854 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20855 @end smallexample
20856
20857 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20858 available:
20859
20860 @table @code
20861 @kindex kvm
20862 @item kvm pcb
20863 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20864
20865 @item kvm proc
20866 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20867 modern FreeBSD systems.
20868 @end table
20869
20870 @node SVR4 Process Information
20871 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20872 @cindex /proc
20873 @cindex examine process image
20874 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20875
20876 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20877 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20878 process using file-system subroutines.
20879
20880 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20881 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20882 information about the process running your program, or about any
20883 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20884 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
20885
20886 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20887 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20888
20889 @table @code
20890 @kindex info proc
20891 @cindex process ID
20892 @item info proc
20893 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20894 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20895 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20896 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20897 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20898 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20899 executable file's absolute file name.
20900
20901 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20902 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20903 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20904 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20905 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20906 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20907
20908 @item info proc cmdline
20909 @cindex info proc cmdline
20910 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20911 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20912
20913 @item info proc cwd
20914 @cindex info proc cwd
20915 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20916 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20917
20918 @item info proc exe
20919 @cindex info proc exe
20920 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20921 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20922
20923 @item info proc mappings
20924 @cindex memory address space mappings
20925 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20926 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20927 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20928 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20929 memory access rights to that range.
20930
20931 @item info proc stat
20932 @itemx info proc status
20933 @cindex process detailed status information
20934 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20935 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20936 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20937 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20938 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20939 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20940 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20941
20942 @item info proc all
20943 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20944 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20945
20946 @ignore
20947 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20948 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20949 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20950 @kindex info proc times
20951 @item info proc times
20952 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20953 its children.
20954
20955 @kindex info proc id
20956 @item info proc id
20957 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20958 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20959 @end ignore
20960
20961 @item set procfs-trace
20962 @kindex set procfs-trace
20963 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20964 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20965
20966 @item show procfs-trace
20967 @kindex show procfs-trace
20968 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20969
20970 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20971 @kindex set procfs-file
20972 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20973 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20974 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20975 standard output.
20976
20977 @item show procfs-file
20978 @kindex show procfs-file
20979 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20980
20981 @item proc-trace-entry
20982 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20983 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20984 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20985 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20986 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20987 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20988 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20989 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20990 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20991
20992 @item info pidlist
20993 @kindex info pidlist
20994 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20995 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20996 processes and all the threads within each process.
20997
20998 @item info meminfo
20999 @kindex info meminfo
21000 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21001 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21002 @end table
21003
21004 @node DJGPP Native
21005 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21006 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21007 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21008 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21009
21010 @cindex DPMI
21011 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21012 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21013 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21014 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21015
21016 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21017 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21018 subsection describes those commands.
21019
21020 @table @code
21021 @kindex info dos
21022 @item info dos
21023 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21024 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21025
21026 @kindex sysinfo
21027 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21028 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21029 @item info dos sysinfo
21030 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21031 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21032 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21033
21034 @cindex GDT
21035 @cindex LDT
21036 @cindex IDT
21037 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21038 @cindex descriptor tables display
21039 @item info dos gdt
21040 @itemx info dos ldt
21041 @itemx info dos idt
21042 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21043 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21044 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21045 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21046 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21047 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21048 rights.
21049
21050 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21051 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21052 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21053 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21054 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21055
21056 @cindex garbled pointers
21057 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21058 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21059 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21060 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21061 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21062 debugged program's data segment:
21063
21064 @smallexample
21065 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21066 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21067 @end smallexample
21068
21069 @noindent
21070 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21071 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21072
21073 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21074 @item info dos pde
21075 @itemx info dos pte
21076 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21077 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21078 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21079 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21080 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21081 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21082 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21083 that is currently in use.
21084
21085 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21086 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21087 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21088 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21089 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21090 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21091 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21092
21093 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21094 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21095 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21096 controller.
21097
21098 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21099
21100 @cindex physical address from linear address
21101 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21102 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21103 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21104 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21105 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21106 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21107 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21108
21109 @smallexample
21110 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21111 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21112 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21113 @end smallexample
21114
21115 @noindent
21116 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21117 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21118 attributes of that page.
21119
21120 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21121 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21122 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21123 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21124 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21125 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21126
21127 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21128 transfer buffer:
21129
21130 @smallexample
21131 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21132 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21133 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 @noindent
21137 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21138 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21139 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21140 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21141 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21142
21143 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21144 @end table
21145
21146 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21147 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21148 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21149 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21150
21151 @table @code
21152 @kindex set com1base
21153 @kindex set com1irq
21154 @kindex set com2base
21155 @kindex set com2irq
21156 @kindex set com3base
21157 @kindex set com3irq
21158 @kindex set com4base
21159 @kindex set com4irq
21160 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21161 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21162 port.
21163
21164 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21165 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21166 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21167
21168 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21169 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21170 other 3 COM ports.
21171
21172 @kindex show com1base
21173 @kindex show com1irq
21174 @kindex show com2base
21175 @kindex show com2irq
21176 @kindex show com3base
21177 @kindex show com3irq
21178 @kindex show com4base
21179 @kindex show com4irq
21180 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21181 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21182 lines used by the COM ports.
21183
21184 @item info serial
21185 @kindex info serial
21186 @cindex DOS serial port status
21187 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21188 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21189 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21190 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21191 @end table
21192
21193
21194 @node Cygwin Native
21195 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21196 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21197 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21198 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21199
21200 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21201 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21202
21203 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21204 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21205 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21206 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21207 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21208 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21209 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21210 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21211
21212 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21213 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21214 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21215
21216 @table @code
21217 @kindex info w32
21218 @item info w32
21219 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21220 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21221
21222 @item info w32 selector
21223 This command displays information returned by
21224 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21225 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21226 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21227 Without argument, this command displays information
21228 about the six segment registers.
21229
21230 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21231 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21232 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21233 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21234
21235 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21236 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21237 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21238 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21239 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21240 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21241 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21242 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21243 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21244 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21245 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21246
21247 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21248 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21249 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21250 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21251
21252 @kindex set new-console
21253 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21254 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21255 be started in a new console on next start.
21256 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21257 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21258
21259 @kindex show new-console
21260 @item show new-console
21261 Displays whether a new console is used
21262 when the debuggee is started.
21263
21264 @kindex set new-group
21265 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21266 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21267 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21268 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21269 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21270
21271 @kindex show new-group
21272 @item show new-group
21273 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21274
21275 @kindex set debugevents
21276 @item set debugevents
21277 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21278 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21279 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21280 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21281 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21282
21283 @kindex set debugexec
21284 @item set debugexec
21285 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21286 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21287
21288 @kindex set debugexceptions
21289 @item set debugexceptions
21290 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21291 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21292
21293 @kindex set debugmemory
21294 @item set debugmemory
21295 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21296 and writes by the debugger.
21297
21298 @kindex set shell
21299 @item set shell
21300 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21301 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21302
21303 @kindex show shell
21304 @item show shell
21305 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21306
21307 @end table
21308
21309 @menu
21310 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21311 @end menu
21312
21313 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21314 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21315 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21316 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21317
21318 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21319 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21320 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21321 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21322 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21323 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21324 ``minimal symbols''.
21325
21326 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21327 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21328 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21329 program run once to completion.
21330
21331 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21332
21333 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21334 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21335 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21336 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21337 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21338 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21339 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21340 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21341 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21342
21343 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21344 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21345 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21346 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21347 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21348 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21349
21350 @smallexample
21351 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21352 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21353
21354 Non-debugging symbols:
21355 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21356 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21357 @end smallexample
21358
21359 @smallexample
21360 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21361 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21362
21363 Non-debugging symbols:
21364 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21365 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21366 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21367 [etc...]
21368 @end smallexample
21369
21370 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21371
21372 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21373 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21374 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21375 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21376 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21377 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21378 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21379
21380 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21381 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21382 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21383 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21384 problem:
21385
21386 @smallexample
21387 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21388 $1 = 268572168
21389 @end smallexample
21390
21391 @smallexample
21392 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21393 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21394 @end smallexample
21395
21396 And two possible solutions:
21397
21398 @smallexample
21399 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21400 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21401 @end smallexample
21402
21403 @smallexample
21404 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21405 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21406 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21407 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21408 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21409 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21410 @end smallexample
21411
21412 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21413 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21414 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21415 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21416 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21417
21418 @smallexample
21419 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21420 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21421 @end smallexample
21422
21423 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21424 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21425 safe.
21426
21427 @node Hurd Native
21428 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21429 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21430
21431 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21432 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21433
21434 @table @code
21435 @item set signals
21436 @itemx set sigs
21437 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21438 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21439 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21440 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21441 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21442 @code{signals}.
21443
21444 @item show signals
21445 @itemx show sigs
21446 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21447 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21448 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21449
21450 @item set signal-thread
21451 @itemx set sigthread
21452 @kindex set signal-thread
21453 @kindex set sigthread
21454 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21455 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21456 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21457 signal-thread}.
21458
21459 @item show signal-thread
21460 @itemx show sigthread
21461 @kindex show signal-thread
21462 @kindex show sigthread
21463 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21464 delivered a signal.
21465
21466 @item set stopped
21467 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21468 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21469 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21470 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21471
21472 @item show stopped
21473 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21474 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21475 stopped.
21476
21477 @item set exceptions
21478 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21479 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21480 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21481 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21482 trapping on.
21483
21484 @item show exceptions
21485 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21486 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21487
21488 @item set task pause
21489 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21490 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21491 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21492 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21493 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21494 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21495 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21496 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21497 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21498
21499 @item show task pause
21500 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21501 Show the current state of task suspension.
21502
21503 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21504 @cindex task suspend count
21505 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21506 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21507 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21508
21509 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21510 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21511
21512 @item set task exception-port
21513 @itemx set task excp
21514 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21515 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21516 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21517 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21518
21519 @item set noninvasive
21520 @cindex noninvasive task options
21521 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21522 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21523 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21524 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21525
21526 @item info send-rights
21527 @itemx info receive-rights
21528 @itemx info port-rights
21529 @itemx info port-sets
21530 @itemx info dead-names
21531 @itemx info ports
21532 @itemx info psets
21533 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21534 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21535 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21536 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21537 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21538 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21539 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21540 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21541 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21542
21543 @item set thread pause
21544 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21545 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21546 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21547 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21548 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21549 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21550 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21551 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21552 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21553 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21554 only the current thread.
21555
21556 @item show thread pause
21557 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21558 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21559
21560 @item set thread run
21561 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21562
21563 @item show thread run
21564 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21565
21566 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21567 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21568 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21569 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21570 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21571 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21572 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21573
21574 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21575 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21576 detaching.
21577
21578 @item set thread exception-port
21579 @itemx set thread excp
21580 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21581 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21582 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21583
21584 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21585 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21586 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21587 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21588
21589 @item set thread default
21590 @itemx show thread default
21591 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21592 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21593 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21594 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21595 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21596 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21597 the non-default commands.
21598 @end table
21599
21600 @node Darwin
21601 @subsection Darwin
21602 @cindex Darwin
21603
21604 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21605
21606 @table @code
21607 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21608 @kindex set debug darwin
21609 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21610 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21611
21612 @item show debug darwin
21613 @kindex show debug darwin
21614 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21615
21616 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21617 @kindex set debug mach-o
21618 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21619 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21620 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21621 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21622 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21623 usage.
21624
21625 @item show debug mach-o
21626 @kindex show debug mach-o
21627 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21628
21629 @item set mach-exceptions on
21630 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21631 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21632 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21633 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21634 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21635 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21636
21637 @item show mach-exceptions
21638 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21639 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21640 @end table
21641
21642
21643 @node Embedded OS
21644 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21645
21646 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21647 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21648 architectures.
21649
21650 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21651 various real-time operating systems.
21652
21653 @node Embedded Processors
21654 @section Embedded Processors
21655
21656 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21657 configurations.
21658
21659 @cindex send command to simulator
21660 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21661 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21662
21663 @table @code
21664 @item sim @var{command}
21665 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21666 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21667 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21668 acceptable commands.
21669 @end table
21670
21671
21672 @menu
21673 * ARM:: ARM
21674 * M32R/SDI:: Renesas M32R/SDI
21675 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21676 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21677 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21678 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21679 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21680 * CRIS:: CRIS
21681 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21682 @end menu
21683
21684 @node ARM
21685 @subsection ARM
21686
21687 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21688
21689 @table @code
21690 @item set arm disassembler
21691 @kindex set arm
21692 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21693 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21694
21695 @item show arm disassembler
21696 @kindex show arm
21697 Show the current disassembly style.
21698
21699 @item set arm apcs32
21700 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21701 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21702
21703 @item show arm apcs32
21704 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21705
21706 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21707 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21708 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21709
21710 @table @code
21711 @item auto
21712 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21713 @item softfpa
21714 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21715 processors.
21716 @item fpa
21717 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21718 @item softvfp
21719 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21720 @item vfp
21721 VFP co-processor.
21722 @end table
21723
21724 @item show arm fpu
21725 Show the current type of the FPU.
21726
21727 @item set arm abi
21728 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21729
21730 @item show arm abi
21731 Show the currently used ABI.
21732
21733 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21734 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21735 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21736 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21737 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21738 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21739 register).
21740
21741 @item show arm fallback-mode
21742 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21743
21744 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21745 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21746 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21747 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21748 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21749
21750 @item show arm force-mode
21751 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21752
21753 @item set debug arm
21754 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21755 target support subsystem.
21756
21757 @item show debug arm
21758 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21759 @end table
21760
21761 @table @code
21762 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21763 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21764
21765 @table @code
21766 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21767 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21768 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21769 The default value is @code{all}.
21770
21771 @table @code
21772 @item none
21773 @item demon
21774 @item angel
21775 @item redboot
21776 @item all
21777 @end table
21778 @end table
21779 @end table
21780
21781 @node M32R/SDI
21782 @subsection Renesas M32R/SDI
21783
21784 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21785
21786 @table @code
21787 @item sdireset
21788 @kindex sdireset
21789 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21790 This command resets the SDI connection.
21791
21792 @item sdistatus
21793 @kindex sdistatus
21794 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21795
21796 @item debug_chaos
21797 @kindex debug_chaos
21798 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21799 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21800
21801 @item use_debug_dma
21802 @kindex use_debug_dma
21803 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21804
21805 @item use_mon_code
21806 @kindex use_mon_code
21807 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21808
21809 @item use_ib_break
21810 @kindex use_ib_break
21811 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21812
21813 @item use_dbt_break
21814 @kindex use_dbt_break
21815 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21816 @end table
21817
21818 @node M68K
21819 @subsection M68k
21820
21821 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21822
21823 @node MicroBlaze
21824 @subsection MicroBlaze
21825 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21826 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21827
21828 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21829 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21830 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21831 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21832 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21833 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21834 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21835 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21836 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21837 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21838 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21839
21840 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21841
21842 @table @code
21843 @item target remote :1234
21844 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21845 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21846
21847 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21848 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21849 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21850
21851 @item load
21852 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21853
21854 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21855 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21856
21857 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21858 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21859 @end table
21860
21861 @node MIPS Embedded
21862 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21863
21864 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21865 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21866 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21867 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21868
21869 @need 1000
21870 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21871
21872 @table @code
21873 @item target mips @var{port}
21874 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21875 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21876 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21877 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21878 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21879 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21880 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21881
21882 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21883 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21884 debugger:
21885
21886 @smallexample
21887 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21888 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21889 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21890 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21891 (@value{GDBP}) run
21892 @end smallexample
21893
21894 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21895 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21896 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21897 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21898 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21899
21900 @item target pmon @var{port}
21901 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21902 PMON ROM monitor.
21903
21904 @item target ddb @var{port}
21905 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21906 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21907
21908 @item target lsi @var{port}
21909 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21910 LSI variant of PMON.
21911
21912 @end table
21913
21914
21915 @noindent
21916 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21917
21918 @table @code
21919 @item set mipsfpu double
21920 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21921 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21922 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21923 @itemx show mipsfpu
21924 @kindex set mipsfpu
21925 @kindex show mipsfpu
21926 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21927 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21928 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21929 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21930 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21931 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21932 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21933 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21934 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21935 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21936 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21937 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21938 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21939
21940 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21941 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21942 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21943
21944 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21945 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21946
21947 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21948 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21949 @itemx show timeout
21950 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21951 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21952 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21953 @kindex set timeout
21954 @kindex show timeout
21955 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21956 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21957 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21958 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21959 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21960 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21961 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21962 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21963 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21964 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21965
21966 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21967 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21968 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21969 to run before stopping.
21970
21971 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21972 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21973 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21974 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21975 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21976 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21977
21978 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21979 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21980 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21981 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21982
21983 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21984 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21985 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21986 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21987 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21988 @table @asis
21989 @item pmon target
21990 @samp{PMON}
21991 @item ddb target
21992 @samp{NEC010}
21993 @item lsi target
21994 @samp{PMON>}
21995 @end table
21996
21997 @item show monitor-prompt
21998 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21999 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
22000 remote monitor.
22001
22002 @item set monitor-warnings
22003 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22004 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
22005 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
22006 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
22007 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
22008
22009 @item show monitor-warnings
22010 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22011 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
22012
22013 @item pmon @var{command}
22014 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
22015 @cindex send PMON command
22016 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
22017 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
22018 @end table
22019
22020 @node PowerPC Embedded
22021 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22022
22023 @cindex DVC register
22024 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22025 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22026
22027 @smallexample
22028 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22029 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22030 @end smallexample
22031
22032 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22033 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22034 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22035 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22036 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22037 or newer.
22038
22039 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22040 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22041 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22042 watching variables of scalar types.
22043
22044 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22045 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22046
22047 @smallexample
22048 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22049 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22050 @end smallexample
22051
22052 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22053 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22054
22055 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22056 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22057 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22058 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22059 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22060 use the @code{break-range} command.
22061
22062 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22063
22064 @table @code
22065 @kindex break-range
22066 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22067 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22068 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22069 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22070 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22071 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22072 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22073 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22074 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22075
22076 @kindex set powerpc
22077 @item set powerpc soft-float
22078 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22079 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22080 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22081 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22082
22083 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22084 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22085 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22086 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22087 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22088 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22089 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22090 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22091
22092 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22093 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22094 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22095 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22096 address of its first byte.
22097
22098 @end table
22099
22100 @node AVR
22101 @subsection Atmel AVR
22102 @cindex AVR
22103
22104 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22105 following AVR-specific commands:
22106
22107 @table @code
22108 @item info io_registers
22109 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22110 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22111 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22112 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22113 @end table
22114
22115 @node CRIS
22116 @subsection CRIS
22117 @cindex CRIS
22118
22119 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22120 following CRIS-specific commands:
22121
22122 @table @code
22123 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22124 @cindex CRIS version
22125 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22126 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22127 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22128
22129 @item show cris-version
22130 Show the current CRIS version.
22131
22132 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22133 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22134 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22135 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22136 @code{R59}.
22137
22138 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22139 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22140
22141 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22142 @cindex CRIS mode
22143 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22144 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22145 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22146
22147 @item show cris-mode
22148 Show the current CRIS mode.
22149 @end table
22150
22151 @node Super-H
22152 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22153 @cindex Super-H
22154
22155 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22156 commands:
22157
22158 @table @code
22159 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22160 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22161 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22162 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22163 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22164 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22165 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22166 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22167 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22168 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22169 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22170 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22171
22172 @item show sh calling-convention
22173 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22174 Show the current calling convention setting.
22175
22176 @end table
22177
22178
22179 @node Architectures
22180 @section Architectures
22181
22182 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22183 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22184
22185 @menu
22186 * AArch64::
22187 * i386::
22188 * Alpha::
22189 * MIPS::
22190 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22191 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22192 * PowerPC::
22193 * Nios II::
22194 @end menu
22195
22196 @node AArch64
22197 @subsection AArch64
22198 @cindex AArch64 support
22199
22200 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22201 following special commands:
22202
22203 @table @code
22204 @item set debug aarch64
22205 @kindex set debug aarch64
22206 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22207 messages are to be displayed.
22208
22209 @item show debug aarch64
22210 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22211
22212 @end table
22213
22214 @node i386
22215 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22216
22217 @table @code
22218 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22219 @kindex set struct-convention
22220 @cindex struct return convention
22221 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22222 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22223 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22224 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22225 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22226 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22227 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22228 be returned in a register.
22229
22230 @item show struct-convention
22231 @kindex show struct-convention
22232 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22233 from functions.
22234 @end table
22235
22236
22237 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22238 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22239
22240 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22241 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22242 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22243 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22244 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22245 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22246 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22247
22248 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22249 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22250 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22251 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22252 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22253 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22254
22255 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22256 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22257 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22258
22259 @smallexample
22260 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22261 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22262 @end smallexample
22263
22264 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22265 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22266 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22267 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22268 the pointer.
22269
22270 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22271 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22272 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22273 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22274 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22275
22276 @table @code
22277 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22278 @kindex show mpx bound
22279 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22280
22281 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22282 @kindex set mpx bound
22283 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22284 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22285 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22286 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22287 @end table
22288
22289 @node Alpha
22290 @subsection Alpha
22291
22292 See the following section.
22293
22294 @node MIPS
22295 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22296
22297 @cindex stack on Alpha
22298 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22299 @cindex Alpha stack
22300 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22301 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22302 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22303 find the beginning of a function.
22304
22305 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22306 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22307 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22308 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22309 commands:
22310
22311 @table @code
22312 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22313 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22314 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22315 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22316 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22317 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22318 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22319 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22320
22321 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22322 Display the current limit.
22323 @end table
22324
22325 @noindent
22326 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22327 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22328
22329 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22330 programs:
22331
22332 @table @code
22333 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22334 @kindex set mips abi
22335 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22336 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22337 values of @var{arg} are:
22338
22339 @table @samp
22340 @item auto
22341 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22342 default).
22343 @item o32
22344 @item o64
22345 @item n32
22346 @item n64
22347 @item eabi32
22348 @item eabi64
22349 @end table
22350
22351 @item show mips abi
22352 @kindex show mips abi
22353 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22354
22355 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22356 @kindex set mips compression
22357 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22358 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22359 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22360 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22361 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22362 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22363 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22364 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22365 provided by the executable.
22366
22367 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22368 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22369 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22370 identified as such.
22371
22372 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22373 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22374 implicitly from an executable.
22375
22376 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22377 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22378 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22379 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22380 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22381
22382 @item show mips compression
22383 @kindex show mips compression
22384 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22385 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22386
22387 @item set mipsfpu
22388 @itemx show mipsfpu
22389 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22390
22391 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22392 @kindex set mips mask-address
22393 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22394 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22395 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22396 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22397 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22398
22399 @item show mips mask-address
22400 @kindex show mips mask-address
22401 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22402 not.
22403
22404 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22405 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22406 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22407 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22408 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22409 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22410
22411 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22412 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22413 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22414
22415 @item set debug mips
22416 @kindex set debug mips
22417 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22418 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22419
22420 @item show debug mips
22421 @kindex show debug mips
22422 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22423 @end table
22424
22425
22426 @node HPPA
22427 @subsection HPPA
22428 @cindex HPPA support
22429
22430 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22431 following special commands:
22432
22433 @table @code
22434 @item set debug hppa
22435 @kindex set debug hppa
22436 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22437 messages are to be displayed.
22438
22439 @item show debug hppa
22440 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22441
22442 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22443 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22444 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22445 given @var{address}.
22446
22447 @end table
22448
22449
22450 @node SPU
22451 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22452 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22453 @cindex SPU
22454
22455 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22456 it provides the following special commands:
22457
22458 @table @code
22459 @item info spu event
22460 @kindex info spu
22461 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22462 and pending event status.
22463
22464 @item info spu signal
22465 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22466 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22467 notification channels.
22468
22469 @item info spu mailbox
22470 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22471 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22472 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22473
22474 @item info spu dma
22475 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22476 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22477 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22478
22479 @item info spu proxydma
22480 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22481 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22482 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22483
22484 @end table
22485
22486 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22487 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22488 special commands:
22489
22490 @table @code
22491 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22492 @kindex set spu
22493 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22494 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22495 function. The default is @code{off}.
22496
22497 @item show spu stop-on-load
22498 @kindex show spu
22499 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22500
22501 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22502 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22503 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22504 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22505 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22506 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22507
22508 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22509 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22510
22511 @end table
22512
22513 @node PowerPC
22514 @subsection PowerPC
22515 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22516
22517 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22518 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22519 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22520 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22521 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22522
22523 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22524 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22525 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22526
22527 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22528 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22529
22530 @node Nios II
22531 @subsection Nios II
22532 @cindex Nios II architecture
22533
22534 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22535 it provides the following special commands:
22536
22537 @table @code
22538
22539 @item set debug nios2
22540 @kindex set debug nios2
22541 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22542 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22543
22544 @item show debug nios2
22545 @kindex show debug nios2
22546 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22547 @end table
22548
22549 @node Controlling GDB
22550 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22551
22552 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22553 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22554 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22555 described here.
22556
22557 @menu
22558 * Prompt:: Prompt
22559 * Editing:: Command editing
22560 * Command History:: Command history
22561 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22562 * Numbers:: Numbers
22563 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22564 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22565 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22566 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22567 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22568 @end menu
22569
22570 @node Prompt
22571 @section Prompt
22572
22573 @cindex prompt
22574
22575 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22576 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22577 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22578 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22579 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22580 which one you are talking to.
22581
22582 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22583 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22584 or a prompt that does not.
22585
22586 @table @code
22587 @kindex set prompt
22588 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22589 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22590
22591 @kindex show prompt
22592 @item show prompt
22593 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22594 @end table
22595
22596 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22597 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22598 are:
22599
22600 @table @code
22601 @kindex set extended-prompt
22602 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22603 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22604 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22605 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22606 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22607 is displayed.
22608
22609 For example:
22610
22611 @smallexample
22612 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22613 @end smallexample
22614
22615 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22616 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22617
22618 @kindex show extended-prompt
22619 @item show extended-prompt
22620 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22621 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22622 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22623 @end table
22624
22625 @node Editing
22626 @section Command Editing
22627 @cindex readline
22628 @cindex command line editing
22629
22630 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22631 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22632 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22633 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22634 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22635 debugging sessions.
22636
22637 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22638 command @code{set}.
22639
22640 @table @code
22641 @kindex set editing
22642 @cindex editing
22643 @item set editing
22644 @itemx set editing on
22645 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22646
22647 @item set editing off
22648 Disable command line editing.
22649
22650 @kindex show editing
22651 @item show editing
22652 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22653 @end table
22654
22655 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22656 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22657 @end ifset
22658 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22659 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22660 @end ifclear
22661 for more details about the Readline
22662 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22663 encouraged to read that chapter.
22664
22665 @node Command History
22666 @section Command History
22667 @cindex command history
22668
22669 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22670 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22671 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22672 history facility.
22673
22674 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22675 package, to provide the history facility.
22676 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22677 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22678 @end ifset
22679 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22680 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22681 @end ifclear
22682 for the detailed description of the History library.
22683
22684 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22685 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22686 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22687 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22688 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22689 pressed on a line by itself.
22690
22691 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22692 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22693 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22694 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22695
22696 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22697 history.
22698
22699 @table @code
22700 @cindex history substitution
22701 @cindex history file
22702 @kindex set history filename
22703 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22704 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22705 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22706 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22707 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22708 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22709 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22710 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22711 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22712 is not set.
22713
22714 @cindex save command history
22715 @kindex set history save
22716 @item set history save
22717 @itemx set history save on
22718 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22719 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22720
22721 @item set history save off
22722 Stop recording command history in a file.
22723
22724 @cindex history size
22725 @kindex set history size
22726 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22727 @item set history size @var{size}
22728 @itemx set history size unlimited
22729 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22730 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22731 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22732 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22733 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22734 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22735
22736 @cindex remove duplicate history
22737 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22738 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22739 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22740 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22741 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22742 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22743 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22744 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22745 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22746
22747 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22748 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22749
22750 @end table
22751
22752 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22753 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22754 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22755 @end ifset
22756 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22757 @xref{Event Designators},
22758 @end ifclear
22759 for more details.
22760
22761 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22762 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22763 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22764 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22765 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22766 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22767 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22768 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22769
22770 The commands to control history expansion are:
22771
22772 @table @code
22773 @item set history expansion on
22774 @itemx set history expansion
22775 @kindex set history expansion
22776 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22777
22778 @item set history expansion off
22779 Disable history expansion.
22780
22781 @c @group
22782 @kindex show history
22783 @item show history
22784 @itemx show history filename
22785 @itemx show history save
22786 @itemx show history size
22787 @itemx show history expansion
22788 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22789 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22790 @c @end group
22791 @end table
22792
22793 @table @code
22794 @kindex show commands
22795 @cindex show last commands
22796 @cindex display command history
22797 @item show commands
22798 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22799
22800 @item show commands @var{n}
22801 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22802
22803 @item show commands +
22804 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22805 @end table
22806
22807 @node Screen Size
22808 @section Screen Size
22809 @cindex size of screen
22810 @cindex screen size
22811 @cindex pagination
22812 @cindex page size
22813 @cindex pauses in output
22814
22815 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22816 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22817 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22818 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22819 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22820 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22821 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22822 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22823
22824 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22825 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22826 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22827 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22828 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22829 width} commands:
22830
22831 @table @code
22832 @kindex set height
22833 @kindex set width
22834 @kindex show width
22835 @kindex show height
22836 @item set height @var{lpp}
22837 @itemx set height unlimited
22838 @itemx show height
22839 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22840 @itemx set width unlimited
22841 @itemx show width
22842 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22843 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22844 commands display the current settings.
22845
22846 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22847 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22848 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22849 buffer.
22850
22851 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22852 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22853
22854 @item set pagination on
22855 @itemx set pagination off
22856 @kindex set pagination
22857 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22858 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22859 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22860 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22861
22862 @item show pagination
22863 @kindex show pagination
22864 Show the current pagination mode.
22865 @end table
22866
22867 @node Numbers
22868 @section Numbers
22869 @cindex number representation
22870 @cindex entering numbers
22871
22872 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22873 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22874 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22875 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22876 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22877 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22878 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22879 both input and output with the commands described below.
22880
22881 @table @code
22882 @kindex set input-radix
22883 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22884 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22885 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22886 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22887 example, any of
22888
22889 @smallexample
22890 set input-radix 012
22891 set input-radix 10.
22892 set input-radix 0xa
22893 @end smallexample
22894
22895 @noindent
22896 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22897 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22898 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22899 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22900 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22901 change the radix.
22902
22903 @kindex set output-radix
22904 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22905 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22906 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22907 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22908
22909 @kindex show input-radix
22910 @item show input-radix
22911 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22912
22913 @kindex show output-radix
22914 @item show output-radix
22915 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22916
22917 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22918 @itemx show radix
22919 @kindex set radix
22920 @kindex show radix
22921 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22922 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22923 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22924 default value of 10.
22925
22926 @end table
22927
22928 @node ABI
22929 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22930
22931 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22932 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22933 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22934 current ABI.
22935
22936 @cindex OS ABI
22937 @kindex set osabi
22938 @kindex show osabi
22939 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22940
22941 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22942 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22943 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22944 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22945 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22946 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22947 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22948 platform provides.
22949
22950 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22951 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22952 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22953 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22954
22955 @table @code
22956 @item show osabi
22957 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22958
22959 @item set osabi
22960 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22961
22962 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22963 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22964 @end table
22965
22966 @cindex float promotion
22967
22968 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22969 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22970 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22971 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22972 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22973 @code{double} and then passed.
22974
22975 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22976 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22977 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22978
22979 @table @code
22980 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22981 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22982 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22983 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22984 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22985
22986 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22987 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22988 functions.
22989
22990 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22991 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22992 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22993 @end table
22994
22995 @kindex set cp-abi
22996 @kindex show cp-abi
22997 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22998 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22999 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23000 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23001 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23002 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23003 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23004 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23005 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23006 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23007 ``auto''.
23008
23009 @table @code
23010 @item show cp-abi
23011 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23012
23013 @item set cp-abi
23014 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23015
23016 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23017 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23018 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23019 @end table
23020
23021 @node Auto-loading
23022 @section Automatically loading associated files
23023 @cindex auto-loading
23024
23025 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23026 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23027 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23028 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23029 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23030 sources).
23031
23032 @menu
23033 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23034 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23035
23036 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23037 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23038 @end menu
23039
23040 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23041 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23042 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23043
23044 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23045 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23046 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23047
23048 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23049 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23050
23051 @table @code
23052 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23053 @kindex set auto-load off
23054 @item set auto-load off
23055 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23056 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23057 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23058 @smallexample
23059 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23060 @end smallexample
23061
23062 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23063 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23064 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23065 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23066 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23067 @code{set auto-load no}.
23068
23069 @anchor{show auto-load}
23070 @kindex show auto-load
23071 @item show auto-load
23072 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23073 or disabled.
23074
23075 @smallexample
23076 (gdb) show auto-load
23077 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23078 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23079 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23080 is on.
23081 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23082 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23083 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23084 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23085 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23086 @end smallexample
23087
23088 @anchor{info auto-load}
23089 @kindex info auto-load
23090 @item info auto-load
23091 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23092 not.
23093
23094 @smallexample
23095 (gdb) info auto-load
23096 gdb-scripts:
23097 Loaded Script
23098 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23099 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23100 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23101 loaded.
23102 python-scripts:
23103 Loaded Script
23104 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23105 @end smallexample
23106 @end table
23107
23108 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23109
23110 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23111 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23112 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23113 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23114 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23115 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23116 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23117 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23118 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23119 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23120 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23121 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23122 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23123 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23124 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23125 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23126 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23127 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23128 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23129 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23130 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23131 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23132 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23133 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23134 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23135 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23136 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23137 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23138 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23139 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23140 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23141 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23142 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23143 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23144 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23145 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23146 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23147 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23148 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23149 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23150 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23151 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23152 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23153 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23154 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23155 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23156 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23157 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23158 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23159 @end multitable
23160
23161 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23162 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23163 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23164
23165 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23166 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23167 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23168
23169 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23170 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23171
23172 @table @code
23173 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23174 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23175 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23176 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23177 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23178
23179 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23180 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23181 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23182 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23183 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23184
23185 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23186 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23187 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23188 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23189 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23190 @end table
23191
23192 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23193 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23194 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23195
23196 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23197
23198 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23199 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23200
23201 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23202 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23203 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23204 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23205 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23206 library.
23207
23208 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23209 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23210
23211 @table @code
23212 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23213 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23214 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23215 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23216
23217 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23218 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23219 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23220 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23221 enabled or disabled.
23222
23223 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23224 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23225 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23226 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23227 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23228 @end table
23229
23230 @node Auto-loading safe path
23231 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23232 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23233
23234 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23235 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23236 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23237 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23238 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23239
23240 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23241 get loaded:
23242
23243 @smallexample
23244 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23245 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23246 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23247 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23248 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23249 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23250 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23251 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23252 @end smallexample
23253
23254 @noindent
23255 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23256 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23257
23258 @smallexample
23259 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23260 @end smallexample
23261
23262 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23263
23264 @table @code
23265 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23266 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23267 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23268 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23269 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23270 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23271 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23272 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23273 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23274 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23275
23276 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23277 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23278 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23279
23280 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23281 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23282 @item show auto-load safe-path
23283 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23284 scripts.
23285
23286 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23287 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23288 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23289 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23290 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23291 by the host platform path separator in use.
23292 @end table
23293
23294 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23295 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23296 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23297 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23298 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23299
23300 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23301 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23302 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23303 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23304 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23305 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23306 init file in the current directory
23307 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23308
23309 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23310 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23311
23312 @table @asis
23313 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23314 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23315 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23316 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23317
23318 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23319 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23320 @value{GDBN} session.
23321
23322 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23323 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23324 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23325 from trusted sources.
23326
23327 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23328 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23329 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23330 trusted sources.
23331 @end table
23332
23333 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23334 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23335
23336 @table @asis
23337 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23338 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23339
23340 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23341 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23342 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23343 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23344 @end table
23345
23346 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23347 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23348 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23349 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23350 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23351 recommended to be entered.
23352
23353 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23354 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23355 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23356
23357 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23358 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23359 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23360 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23361 be printed.
23362
23363 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23364 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23365 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23366
23367 @smallexample
23368 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23369 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23370 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23371 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23372 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23373 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23374 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23375 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23376 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23377 @end smallexample
23378
23379 @table @code
23380 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23381 @kindex set debug auto-load
23382 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23383 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23384
23385 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23386 @kindex show debug auto-load
23387 @item show debug auto-load
23388 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23389 on or off.
23390 @end table
23391
23392 @node Messages/Warnings
23393 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23394
23395 @cindex verbose operation
23396 @cindex optional warnings
23397 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23398 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23399 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23400 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23401
23402 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23403 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23404 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23405
23406 @table @code
23407 @kindex set verbose
23408 @item set verbose on
23409 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23410
23411 @item set verbose off
23412 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23413
23414 @kindex show verbose
23415 @item show verbose
23416 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23417 @end table
23418
23419 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23420 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23421 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23422 Symbol Files}).
23423
23424 @table @code
23425
23426 @kindex set complaints
23427 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23428 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23429 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23430 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23431 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23432
23433 @kindex show complaints
23434 @item show complaints
23435 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23436
23437 @end table
23438
23439 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23440 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23441 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23442 you try to run a program which is already running:
23443
23444 @smallexample
23445 (@value{GDBP}) run
23446 The program being debugged has been started already.
23447 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23448 @end smallexample
23449
23450 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23451 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23452
23453 @table @code
23454
23455 @kindex set confirm
23456 @cindex flinching
23457 @cindex confirmation
23458 @cindex stupid questions
23459 @item set confirm off
23460 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23461 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23462 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23463
23464 @item set confirm on
23465 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23466
23467 @kindex show confirm
23468 @item show confirm
23469 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23470
23471 @end table
23472
23473 @cindex command tracing
23474 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23475 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23476 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23477 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23478
23479 @table @code
23480 @kindex set trace-commands
23481 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23482 @item set trace-commands on
23483 Enable command tracing.
23484 @item set trace-commands off
23485 Disable command tracing.
23486 @item show trace-commands
23487 Display the current state of command tracing.
23488 @end table
23489
23490 @node Debugging Output
23491 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23492 @cindex optional debugging messages
23493
23494 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23495 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23496 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23497 section documents those commands.
23498
23499 @table @code
23500 @kindex set exec-done-display
23501 @item set exec-done-display
23502 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23503 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23504 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23505 @kindex show exec-done-display
23506 @item show exec-done-display
23507 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23508 notification.
23509 @kindex set debug
23510 @cindex ARM AArch64
23511 @item set debug aarch64
23512 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23513 The default is off.
23514 @kindex show debug
23515 @item show debug aarch64
23516 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23517 ARM AArch64.
23518 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23519 @cindex architecture debugging info
23520 @item set debug arch
23521 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23522 @item show debug arch
23523 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23524 @item set debug aix-solib
23525 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23526 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23527 support module. The default is off.
23528 @item show debug aix-thread
23529 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23530 @item set debug aix-thread
23531 @cindex AIX threads
23532 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23533 module.
23534 @item show debug aix-thread
23535 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23536 @item set debug check-physname
23537 @cindex physname
23538 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23539 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23540 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23541 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23542 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23543 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23544 @item show debug check-physname
23545 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23546 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23547 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23548 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23549 exported symbols. The default is off.
23550 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23551 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23552 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23553 @item set debug dwarf-die
23554 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23555 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23556 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23557 A value of zero turns off the display.
23558 @item show debug dwarf-die
23559 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23560 @item set debug dwarf-line
23561 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23562 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23563 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23564 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23565 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23566 @item show debug dwarf-line
23567 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23568 @item set debug dwarf-read
23569 @cindex DWARF Reading
23570 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23571 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23572 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23573 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23574 @item show debug dwarf-read
23575 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23576 @item set debug displaced
23577 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23578 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23579 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23580 @item show debug displaced
23581 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23582 related to displaced stepping.
23583 @item set debug event
23584 @cindex event debugging info
23585 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23586 default is off.
23587 @item show debug event
23588 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23589 info.
23590 @item set debug expression
23591 @cindex expression debugging info
23592 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23593 expression parsing. The default is off.
23594 @item show debug expression
23595 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23596 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23597 @item set debug frame
23598 @cindex frame debugging info
23599 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23600 default is off.
23601 @item show debug frame
23602 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23603 info.
23604 @item set debug gnu-nat
23605 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23606 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23607 @item show debug gnu-nat
23608 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23609 @item set debug infrun
23610 @cindex inferior debugging info
23611 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23612 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23613 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23614 @item show debug infrun
23615 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23616 @item set debug jit
23617 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23618 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23619 @item show debug jit
23620 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23621 @item set debug lin-lwp
23622 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23623 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23624 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23625 @item show debug lin-lwp
23626 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23627 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23628 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23629 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23630 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23631 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23632 @item set debug mach-o
23633 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23634 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23635 processing. The default is off.
23636 @item show debug mach-o
23637 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23638 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23639 @item set debug notification
23640 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23641 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23642 The default is off.
23643 @item show debug notification
23644 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23645 @item set debug observer
23646 @cindex observer debugging info
23647 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23648 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23649 @item show debug observer
23650 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23651 @item set debug overload
23652 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23653 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23654 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23655 is off.
23656 @item show debug overload
23657 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23658 debugging info.
23659 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23660 @cindex debug expression parser
23661 @item set debug parser
23662 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23663 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23664 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23665 details. The default is off.
23666 @item show debug parser
23667 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23668 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23669 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23670 @cindex debug remote protocol
23671 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23672 @cindex display remote packets
23673 @item set debug remote
23674 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23675 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23676 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23677 @item show debug remote
23678 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23679 @item set debug serial
23680 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23681 default is off.
23682 @item show debug serial
23683 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23684 info.
23685 @item set debug solib-frv
23686 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23687 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23688 @item show debug solib-frv
23689 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23690 messages.
23691 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23692 @cindex symbol lookup
23693 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23694 The default is 0 (off).
23695 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23696 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23697 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23698 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23699 @item set debug symfile
23700 @cindex symbol file functions
23701 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23702 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23703 @item show debug symfile
23704 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23705 @item set debug symtab-create
23706 @cindex symbol table creation
23707 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23708 The default is 0 (off).
23709 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23710 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23711 @item show debug symtab-create
23712 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23713 @item set debug target
23714 @cindex target debugging info
23715 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23716 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23717 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23718 value of large memory transfers.
23719 @item show debug target
23720 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23721 info.
23722 @item set debug timestamp
23723 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23724 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23725 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23726 message.
23727 @item show debug timestamp
23728 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23729 debugging info.
23730 @item set debug varobj
23731 @cindex variable object debugging info
23732 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23733 info. The default is off.
23734 @item show debug varobj
23735 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23736 debugging info.
23737 @item set debug xml
23738 @cindex XML parser debugging
23739 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23740 @item show debug xml
23741 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23742 @end table
23743
23744 @node Other Misc Settings
23745 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23746 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23747
23748 @table @code
23749 @kindex set interactive-mode
23750 @item set interactive-mode
23751 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23752 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23753 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23754 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23755 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23756 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23757 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23758 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23759
23760 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23761 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23762 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23763 inside a cygwin window.
23764
23765 @kindex show interactive-mode
23766 @item show interactive-mode
23767 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23768 @end table
23769
23770 @node Extending GDB
23771 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23772 @cindex extending GDB
23773
23774 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23775 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23776 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23777 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23778 being debugged.
23779
23780 @menu
23781 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23782 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23783 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23784 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23785 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23786 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23787 @end menu
23788
23789 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23790 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23791 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23792 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23793 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23794 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23795
23796 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23797 setting:
23798
23799 @table @code
23800 @kindex set script-extension
23801 @kindex show script-extension
23802 @item set script-extension off
23803 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23804
23805 @item set script-extension soft
23806 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23807 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23808 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23809 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23810
23811 @item set script-extension strict
23812 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23813 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23814 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23815
23816 @item show script-extension
23817 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23818
23819 @end table
23820
23821 @node Sequences
23822 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23823
23824 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23825 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23826 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23827 files.
23828
23829 @menu
23830 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23831 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23832 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23833 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23834 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23835 @end menu
23836
23837 @node Define
23838 @subsection User-defined Commands
23839
23840 @cindex user-defined command
23841 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23842 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23843 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23844 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23845 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23846 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23847
23848 @smallexample
23849 define adder
23850 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23851 end
23852 @end smallexample
23853
23854 @noindent
23855 To execute the command use:
23856
23857 @smallexample
23858 adder 1 2 3
23859 @end smallexample
23860
23861 @noindent
23862 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23863 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23864 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23865 functions calls.
23866
23867 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23868 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23869 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23870 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23871
23872 @smallexample
23873 define adder
23874 if $argc == 2
23875 print $arg0 + $arg1
23876 end
23877 if $argc == 3
23878 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23879 end
23880 end
23881 @end smallexample
23882
23883 @table @code
23884
23885 @kindex define
23886 @item define @var{commandname}
23887 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23888 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23889 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23890 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23891 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23892 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23893
23894 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23895 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23896 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23897
23898 @kindex document
23899 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23900 @item document @var{commandname}
23901 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23902 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23903 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23904 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23905 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23906 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23907
23908 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23909 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23910 does not change the documentation.
23911
23912 @kindex dont-repeat
23913 @cindex don't repeat command
23914 @item dont-repeat
23915 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23916 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23917 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23918
23919 @kindex help user-defined
23920 @item help user-defined
23921 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23922 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23923 included (if any).
23924
23925 @kindex show user
23926 @item show user
23927 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23928 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23929 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23930 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23931 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23932
23933 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23934 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23935 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23936 @item show max-user-call-depth
23937 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23938 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23939 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23940 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23941 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23942 @end table
23943
23944 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23945 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23946
23947 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23948 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23949 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23950
23951 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23952 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23953 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23954 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23955
23956 @node Hooks
23957 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23958 @cindex command hooks
23959 @cindex hooks, for commands
23960 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23961
23962 @kindex hook
23963 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23964 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23965 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23966 before that command.
23967
23968 @cindex hooks, post-command
23969 @kindex hookpost
23970 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23971 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23972 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23973 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23974 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23975
23976 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23977 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23978
23979 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23980 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23981
23982 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23983 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23984 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23985 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23986 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23987
23988 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23989 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23990 you could define:
23991
23992 @smallexample
23993 define hook-stop
23994 handle SIGALRM nopass
23995 end
23996
23997 define hook-run
23998 handle SIGALRM pass
23999 end
24000
24001 define hook-continue
24002 handle SIGALRM pass
24003 end
24004 @end smallexample
24005
24006 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24007 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24008 you could define:
24009
24010 @smallexample
24011 define hook-echo
24012 echo <<<---
24013 end
24014
24015 define hookpost-echo
24016 echo --->>>\n
24017 end
24018
24019 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24020 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24021 (@value{GDBP})
24022
24023 @end smallexample
24024
24025 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24026 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24027 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24028 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24029 @c or not?
24030 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24031 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24032 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24033
24034 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24035 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24036 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24037
24038 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24039 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24040
24041 @node Command Files
24042 @subsection Command Files
24043
24044 @cindex command files
24045 @cindex scripting commands
24046 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24047 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24048 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24049 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24050 terminal.
24051
24052 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24053 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24054 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24055 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24056 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24057
24058 @table @code
24059 @kindex source
24060 @cindex execute commands from a file
24061 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24062 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24063 @end table
24064
24065 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24066 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24067 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24068 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24069 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24070
24071 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24072 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24073 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24074 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24075 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24076 is not relevant to scripts.
24077
24078 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24079 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24080 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24081 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24082 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24083 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24084 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24085 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24086 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24087 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24088 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24089 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24090 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24091 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24092
24093 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24094 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24095 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24096
24097 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24098 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24099 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24100 when called from command files.
24101
24102 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24103 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24104 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24105 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24106 the next command.
24107
24108 @smallexample
24109 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24110 @end smallexample
24111
24112 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24113 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24114 would be directed to @file{log}.
24115
24116 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24117 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24118 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24119 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24120 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24121 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24122 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24123 conditionally, etc.
24124
24125 @table @code
24126 @kindex if
24127 @kindex else
24128 @item if
24129 @itemx else
24130 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24131 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24132 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24133 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24134 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24135 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24136 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24137
24138 @kindex while
24139 @item while
24140 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24141 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24142 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24143 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24144 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24145 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24146
24147 @kindex loop_break
24148 @item loop_break
24149 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24150 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24151 line.
24152
24153 @kindex loop_continue
24154 @item loop_continue
24155 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24156 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24157 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24158 the controlling expression.
24159
24160 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24161 @item end
24162 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24163 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24164 @end table
24165
24166
24167 @node Output
24168 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24169
24170 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24171 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24172 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24173 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24174 want.
24175
24176 @table @code
24177 @kindex echo
24178 @item echo @var{text}
24179 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24180 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24181 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24182 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24183 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24184 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24185 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24186 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24187 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24188 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24189 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24190
24191 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24192 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24193
24194 @smallexample
24195 echo This is some text\n\
24196 which is continued\n\
24197 onto several lines.\n
24198 @end smallexample
24199
24200 produces the same output as
24201
24202 @smallexample
24203 echo This is some text\n
24204 echo which is continued\n
24205 echo onto several lines.\n
24206 @end smallexample
24207
24208 @kindex output
24209 @item output @var{expression}
24210 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24211 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24212 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24213 on expressions.
24214
24215 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24216 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24217 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24218 Formats}, for more information.
24219
24220 @kindex printf
24221 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24222 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24223 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24224 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24225 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24226 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24227 executing the code below:
24228
24229 @smallexample
24230 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24231 @end smallexample
24232
24233 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24234 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24235 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24236 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24237 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24238 printed.
24239
24240 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24241
24242 @smallexample
24243 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24244 @end smallexample
24245
24246 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24247 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24248 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24249
24250 @itemize @bullet
24251 @item
24252 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24253
24254 @item
24255 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24256 width.
24257
24258 @item
24259 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24260 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24261
24262 @item
24263 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24264 supported.
24265
24266 @item
24267 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24268
24269 @item
24270 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24271 @end itemize
24272
24273 @noindent
24274 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24275 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24276 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24277 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24278
24279 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24280 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24281 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24282 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24283 supported.
24284
24285 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24286 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24287 together with a floating point specifier.
24288 letters:
24289
24290 @itemize @bullet
24291 @item
24292 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24293
24294 @item
24295 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24296
24297 @item
24298 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24299 @end itemize
24300
24301 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24302 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24303 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24304
24305 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24306 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24307
24308 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24309 @smallexample
24310 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24311 @end smallexample
24312
24313 @kindex eval
24314 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24315 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24316 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24317
24318 @end table
24319
24320 @node Auto-loading sequences
24321 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24322 @cindex native script auto-loading
24323
24324 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24325 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24326 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24327 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24328
24329 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24330 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24331
24332 @table @code
24333 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24334 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24335 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24336 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24337
24338 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24339 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24340 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24341 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24342 disabled.
24343
24344 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24345 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24346 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24347 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24348 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24349 auto-loaded.
24350 @end table
24351
24352 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24353 matching names are printed.
24354
24355 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24356 @include python.texi
24357
24358 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24359 @include guile.texi
24360
24361 @node Auto-loading extensions
24362 @section Auto-loading extensions
24363 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24364
24365 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24366 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24367 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24368 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24369 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24370
24371 @menu
24372 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24373 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24374 * Which flavor to choose?::
24375 @end menu
24376
24377 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24378 debugging commands and features.
24379
24380 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24381 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24382 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24383 for more information.
24384 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24385 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24386
24387 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24388 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24389
24390 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24391 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24392 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24393 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24394 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24395
24396 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24397 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24398 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24399 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24400
24401 @table @code
24402 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24403 GDB's own command language
24404 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24405 Python
24406 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24407 Guile
24408 @end table
24409
24410 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24411 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24412 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24413 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24414 script in the specified extension language.
24415
24416 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24417 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24418
24419 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24420 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24421
24422 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24423 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24424 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24425 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24426 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24427 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24428
24429 @table @code
24430 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24431 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24432 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24433 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24434 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24435 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24436
24437 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24438 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24439
24440 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24441 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24442 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24443 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24444
24445 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24446 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24447 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24448 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24449 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24450 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24451 platform.
24452
24453 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24454 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24455 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24456
24457 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24458 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24459 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24460 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24461
24462 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24463 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24464 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24465 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24466 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24467 @end table
24468
24469 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24470 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24471 @var{objfile} is opened.
24472 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24473 is evaluated more than once.
24474
24475 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24476 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24477 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24478
24479 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24480 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24481 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24482 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24483 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24484 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24485 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24486
24487 The following entries are supported:
24488
24489 @table @code
24490 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24491 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24492 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24493 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24494 @end table
24495
24496 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24497
24498 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24499 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24500 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24501 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24502 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24503
24504 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24505 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24506
24507 @example
24508 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24509 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24510 asm("\
24511 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24512 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24513 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24514 .popsection \n\
24515 ");
24516 @end example
24517
24518 @noindent
24519 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24520 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24521
24522 @example
24523 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24524 @end example
24525
24526 The script name may include directories if desired.
24527
24528 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24529 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24530
24531 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24532 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24533 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24534 will remove duplicates.
24535
24536 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24537
24538 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24539 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24540 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24541 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24542 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24543 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24544 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24545 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24546 on its name.
24547
24548 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24549 testsuite.
24550
24551 @example
24552 #include "symcat.h"
24553 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24554 asm(
24555 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24556 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24557 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24558 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24559 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24560 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24561 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24562 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24563 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24564 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24565 ".byte 0\n"
24566 ".popsection\n"
24567 );
24568 @end example
24569
24570 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24571 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24572 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24573 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24574
24575 @node Which flavor to choose?
24576 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24577
24578 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24579 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24580
24581 @noindent
24582 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24583
24584 @itemize @bullet
24585 @item
24586 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24587
24588 @item
24589 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24590
24591 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24592 in the source search path.
24593 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24594 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24595
24596 @item
24597 Doesn't require source code additions.
24598 @end itemize
24599
24600 @noindent
24601 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24602
24603 @itemize @bullet
24604 @item
24605 Works with static linking.
24606
24607 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24608 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24609 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24610 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24611 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24612
24613 @item
24614 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24615
24616 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24617 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24618
24619 @item
24620 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24621
24622 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24623 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24624 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24625 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24626 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24627 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24628 @end itemize
24629
24630 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24631 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24632
24633 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24634 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24635 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24636
24637 @subsection Python comes first
24638
24639 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24640 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24641 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24642 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24643 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24644 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24645 pretty-printed form of a value).
24646 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24647 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24648 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24649
24650 @node Aliases
24651 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24652 @cindex aliases for commands
24653
24654 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24655 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24656 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24657 that involves less typing.
24658
24659 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24660 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24661 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24662
24663 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24664 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24665 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24666
24667 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24668
24669 @table @code
24670
24671 @kindex alias
24672 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24673
24674 @end table
24675
24676 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24677 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24678 underscores.
24679
24680 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24681 that is being aliased.
24682
24683 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24684 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24685 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24686
24687 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24688 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24689
24690 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24691 of a command so that there is less to type.
24692 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24693 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24694 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24695 The following will accomplish this.
24696
24697 @smallexample
24698 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24699 @end smallexample
24700
24701 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24702 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24703 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24704 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24705
24706 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24707 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24708 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24709 of a command.
24710
24711 @smallexample
24712 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24713 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24714 (gdb) set p elms 20
24715 (gdb) show p elms
24716 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24717 @end smallexample
24718
24719 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24720 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24721 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24722
24723 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24724 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24725
24726 @smallexample
24727 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24728 @end smallexample
24729
24730 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24731 alias for a more complex command.
24732 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24733
24734 @smallexample
24735 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24736 (gdb) spe 20
24737 @end smallexample
24738
24739 @node Interpreters
24740 @chapter Command Interpreters
24741 @cindex command interpreters
24742
24743 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24744 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24745 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24746
24747 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24748 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24749 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24750 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24751
24752 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24753 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24754 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24755 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24756
24757 @table @code
24758 @item console
24759 @cindex console interpreter
24760 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24761 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24762 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24763
24764 @item mi
24765 @cindex mi interpreter
24766 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24767 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24768 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24769 Interface}.
24770
24771 @item mi2
24772 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24773 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24774
24775 @item mi1
24776 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24777 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24778
24779 @end table
24780
24781 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24782 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24783 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24784 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24785 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24786 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24787 the IDE inoperable!
24788
24789 @kindex interpreter-exec
24790 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24791 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24792 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24793 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24794
24795 @smallexample
24796 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24797 @end smallexample
24798
24799 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24800 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24801
24802 @node TUI
24803 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24804 @cindex TUI
24805 @cindex Text User Interface
24806
24807 @menu
24808 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24809 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24810 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24811 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24812 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24813 @end menu
24814
24815 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24816 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24817 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24818 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24819 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24820 is available.
24821
24822 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24823 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24824 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24825 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24826 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24827 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24828
24829 @node TUI Overview
24830 @section TUI Overview
24831
24832 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24833
24834 @table @emph
24835 @item command
24836 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24837 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24838 managed using readline.
24839
24840 @item source
24841 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24842 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24843
24844 @item assembly
24845 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24846
24847 @item register
24848 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24849 when their values change.
24850 @end table
24851
24852 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24853 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24854 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24855 indicates the breakpoint type:
24856
24857 @table @code
24858 @item B
24859 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24860
24861 @item b
24862 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24863
24864 @item H
24865 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24866
24867 @item h
24868 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24869 @end table
24870
24871 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24872
24873 @table @code
24874 @item +
24875 Breakpoint is enabled.
24876
24877 @item -
24878 Breakpoint is disabled.
24879 @end table
24880
24881 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24882 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24883 changes.
24884
24885 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24886 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24887 layouts:
24888
24889 @itemize @bullet
24890 @item
24891 source only,
24892
24893 @item
24894 assembly only,
24895
24896 @item
24897 source and assembly,
24898
24899 @item
24900 source and registers, or
24901
24902 @item
24903 assembly and registers.
24904 @end itemize
24905
24906 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24907
24908 @table @emph
24909 @item target
24910 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24911 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24912
24913 @item process
24914 Gives the current process or thread number.
24915 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24916
24917 @item function
24918 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24919 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24920 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24921 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24922
24923 @item line
24924 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24925 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24926
24927 @item pc
24928 Indicates the current program counter address.
24929 @end table
24930
24931 @node TUI Keys
24932 @section TUI Key Bindings
24933 @cindex TUI key bindings
24934
24935 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24936 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24937 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24938 @end ifset
24939 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24940 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24941 @end ifclear
24942 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24943 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24944
24945 @table @kbd
24946 @kindex C-x C-a
24947 @item C-x C-a
24948 @kindex C-x a
24949 @itemx C-x a
24950 @kindex C-x A
24951 @itemx C-x A
24952 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24953 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24954 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24955 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24956 The screen is then refreshed.
24957
24958 @kindex C-x 1
24959 @item C-x 1
24960 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24961 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24962 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24963
24964 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24965
24966 @kindex C-x 2
24967 @item C-x 2
24968 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24969 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24970 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24971 previous layout and the new one.
24972
24973 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24974
24975 @kindex C-x o
24976 @item C-x o
24977 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24978 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24979 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24980
24981 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24982
24983 @kindex C-x s
24984 @item C-x s
24985 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24986 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24987 @end table
24988
24989 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24990
24991 @table @asis
24992 @kindex PgUp
24993 @item @key{PgUp}
24994 Scroll the active window one page up.
24995
24996 @kindex PgDn
24997 @item @key{PgDn}
24998 Scroll the active window one page down.
24999
25000 @kindex Up
25001 @item @key{Up}
25002 Scroll the active window one line up.
25003
25004 @kindex Down
25005 @item @key{Down}
25006 Scroll the active window one line down.
25007
25008 @kindex Left
25009 @item @key{Left}
25010 Scroll the active window one column left.
25011
25012 @kindex Right
25013 @item @key{Right}
25014 Scroll the active window one column right.
25015
25016 @kindex C-L
25017 @item @kbd{C-L}
25018 Refresh the screen.
25019 @end table
25020
25021 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25022 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25023 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25024 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25025 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25026
25027 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25028 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25029 @cindex TUI single key mode
25030
25031 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25032 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25033 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25034
25035 @table @kbd
25036 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25037 @item c
25038 continue
25039
25040 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25041 @item d
25042 down
25043
25044 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25045 @item f
25046 finish
25047
25048 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25049 @item n
25050 next
25051
25052 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25053 @item q
25054 exit the SingleKey mode.
25055
25056 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25057 @item r
25058 run
25059
25060 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25061 @item s
25062 step
25063
25064 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25065 @item u
25066 up
25067
25068 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25069 @item v
25070 info locals
25071
25072 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25073 @item w
25074 where
25075 @end table
25076
25077 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25078 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25079 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25080 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25081 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25082 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25083
25084
25085 @node TUI Commands
25086 @section TUI-specific Commands
25087 @cindex TUI commands
25088
25089 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25090 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25091 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25092 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25093
25094 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25095 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25096 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25097 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25098 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25099
25100 @table @code
25101 @item tui enable
25102 @kindex tui enable
25103 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25104 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25105 otherwise a default layout is used.
25106
25107 @item tui disable
25108 @kindex tui disable
25109 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25110
25111 @item info win
25112 @kindex info win
25113 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25114
25115 @item layout @var{name}
25116 @kindex layout
25117 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25118 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25119 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25120
25121 @table @code
25122 @item next
25123 Display the next layout.
25124
25125 @item prev
25126 Display the previous layout.
25127
25128 @item src
25129 Display the source and command windows.
25130
25131 @item asm
25132 Display the assembly and command windows.
25133
25134 @item split
25135 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25136
25137 @item regs
25138 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25139 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25140 register, assembler, and command windows.
25141 @end table
25142
25143 @item focus @var{name}
25144 @kindex focus
25145 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25146 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25147
25148 @table @code
25149 @item next
25150 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25151
25152 @item prev
25153 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25154
25155 @item src
25156 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25157
25158 @item asm
25159 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25160
25161 @item regs
25162 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25163
25164 @item cmd
25165 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25166 @end table
25167
25168 @item refresh
25169 @kindex refresh
25170 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25171
25172 @item tui reg @var{group}
25173 @kindex tui reg
25174 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25175 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25176 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25177 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25178 following groups are available on most targets:
25179 @table @code
25180 @item next
25181 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25182 through all of the available register groups.
25183
25184 @item prev
25185 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25186 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25187 @var{next}.
25188
25189 @item general
25190 Display the general registers.
25191 @item float
25192 Display the floating point registers.
25193 @item system
25194 Display the system registers.
25195 @item vector
25196 Display the vector registers.
25197 @item all
25198 Display all registers.
25199 @end table
25200
25201 @item update
25202 @kindex update
25203 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25204
25205 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25206 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25207 @kindex winheight
25208 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25209 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25210 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25211 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25212 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25213
25214 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25215 @kindex tabset
25216 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25217 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25218 assembly windows.
25219 @end table
25220
25221 @node TUI Configuration
25222 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25223 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25224
25225 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25226
25227 @table @code
25228 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25229 @kindex set tui border-kind
25230 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25231 The possible values are the following:
25232 @table @code
25233 @item space
25234 Use a space character to draw the border.
25235
25236 @item ascii
25237 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25238
25239 @item acs
25240 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25241 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25242 @end table
25243
25244 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25245 @kindex set tui border-mode
25246 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25247 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25248 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25249 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25250 @table @code
25251 @item normal
25252 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25253
25254 @item standout
25255 Use standout mode.
25256
25257 @item reverse
25258 Use reverse video mode.
25259
25260 @item half
25261 Use half bright mode.
25262
25263 @item half-standout
25264 Use half bright and standout mode.
25265
25266 @item bold
25267 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25268
25269 @item bold-standout
25270 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25271 @end table
25272 @end table
25273
25274 @node Emacs
25275 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25276
25277 @cindex Emacs
25278 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25279 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25280 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25281 @value{GDBN}.
25282
25283 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25284 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25285 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25286 created Emacs buffer.
25287 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25288
25289 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25290 things:
25291
25292 @itemize @bullet
25293 @item
25294 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25295 the GUD buffer.
25296
25297 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25298 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25299
25300 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25301 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25302 in this way.
25303
25304 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25305 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25306 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25307 stop.
25308
25309 @item
25310 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25311
25312 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25313 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25314 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25315 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25316 and the source.
25317
25318 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25319 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25320 @end itemize
25321
25322 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25323 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25324 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25325 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25326
25327 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25328 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25329 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25330 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25331 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25332 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25333 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25334 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25335 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25336
25337 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25338 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25339 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25340 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25341
25342 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25343 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25344 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25345 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25346 one you want.
25347
25348 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25349 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25350
25351 @table @kbd
25352 @item C-h m
25353 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25354
25355 @item C-c C-s
25356 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25357 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25358
25359 @item C-c C-n
25360 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25361 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25362 to show the current file and location.
25363
25364 @item C-c C-i
25365 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25366 display window accordingly.
25367
25368 @item C-c C-f
25369 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25370 @code{finish} command.
25371
25372 @item C-c C-r
25373 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25374 command.
25375
25376 @item C-c <
25377 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25378 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25379 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25380
25381 @item C-c >
25382 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25383 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25384 @end table
25385
25386 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25387 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25388
25389 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25390 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25391 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25392 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25393 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25394 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25395 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25396
25397 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25398 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25399 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25400 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25401 frame.
25402
25403 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25404 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25405 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25406 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25407 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25408 to correspond properly with the code.
25409
25410 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25411 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25412 Emacs Manual}).
25413
25414 @node GDB/MI
25415 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25416
25417 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25418
25419 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25420 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25421 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25422 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25423 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25424 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25425
25426 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25427 in the form of a reference manual.
25428
25429 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25430 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25431 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25432
25433 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25434
25435 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25436 This chapter uses the following notation:
25437
25438 @itemize @bullet
25439 @item
25440 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25441
25442 @item
25443 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25444 it may or may not be given.
25445
25446 @item
25447 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25448 may repeat zero or more times.
25449
25450 @item
25451 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25452 may repeat one or more times.
25453
25454 @item
25455 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25456 @end itemize
25457
25458 @ignore
25459 @heading Dependencies
25460 @end ignore
25461
25462 @menu
25463 * GDB/MI General Design::
25464 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25465 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25466 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25467 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25468 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25469 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25470 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25471 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25472 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25473 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25474 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25475 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25476 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25477 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25478 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25479 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25480 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25481 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25482 @ignore
25483 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25484 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25485 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25486 @end ignore
25487 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25488 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25489 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25490 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25491 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25492 @end menu
25493
25494 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25495 @node GDB/MI General Design
25496 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25497 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25498
25499 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25500 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25501 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25502 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25503 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25504 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25505 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25506 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25507 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25508 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25509
25510 The important examples of notifications are:
25511 @itemize @bullet
25512
25513 @item
25514 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25515 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25516 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25517 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25518 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25519 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25520 command itself was successfully executed.
25521
25522 @item
25523 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25524 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25525 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25526 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25527 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25528 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25529
25530 @item
25531 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25532 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25533 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25534 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25535 orthogonal frontend design.
25536
25537 @end itemize
25538
25539 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25540 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25541 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25542 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25543 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25544 the user interface.
25545
25546
25547 @menu
25548 * Context management::
25549 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25550 * Thread groups::
25551 @end menu
25552
25553 @node Context management
25554 @subsection Context management
25555
25556 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25557
25558 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25559 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25560 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25561 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25562 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25563 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25564 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25565 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25566 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25567
25568 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25569 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25570 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25571 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25572 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25573 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25574 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25575 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25576 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25577 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25578 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25579
25580 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25581 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25582 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25583 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25584 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25585 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25586 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25587 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25588 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25589 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25590
25591 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25592 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25593 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25594 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25595 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25596 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25597 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25598 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25599 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25600 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25601 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25602 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25603 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25604 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25605 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25606 @samp{--frame} options.
25607
25608 @subsubsection Language
25609
25610 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25611 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25612 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25613 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25614 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25615 For instance:
25616
25617 @smallexample
25618 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25619 ^done,value="4"
25620 (gdb)
25621 @end smallexample
25622
25623 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25624 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25625 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25626
25627 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25628 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25629
25630 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25631 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25632 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25633 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25634 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25635 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25636 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25637 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25638 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25639
25640 @table @code
25641 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25642 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25643 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25644
25645 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25646 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25647 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25648
25649 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25650 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25651 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25652 MI commands even while the target is running.
25653
25654 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25655 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25656 @end table
25657
25658 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25659 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25660 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25661 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25662 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25663 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25664
25665 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25666 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25667 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25668 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25669 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25670 are running.
25671
25672 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25673 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25674 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25675 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25676 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25677 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25678 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25679 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25680 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25681 @samp{--thread} option).
25682
25683 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25684 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25685 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25686 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25687
25688 @node Thread groups
25689 @subsection Thread groups
25690 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25691 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25692 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25693 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25694 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25695
25696 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25697 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25698 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25699 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25700 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25701 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25702 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25703 into processes.
25704
25705 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25706 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25707 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25708 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25709 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25710 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25711 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25712 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25713 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25714 the members of specific thread group.
25715
25716 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25717 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25718 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25719 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25720 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25721 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25722 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25723 after attaching to that thread group.
25724
25725 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25726 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25727 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25728 such thread groups.
25729
25730 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25731 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25732 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25733
25734 @menu
25735 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25736 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25737 @end menu
25738
25739 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25740 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25741
25742 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25743 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25744 @table @code
25745 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25746 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25747
25748 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25749 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25750 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25751
25752 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25753 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25754 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25755
25756 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25757 "any sequence of digits"
25758
25759 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25760 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25761
25762 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25763 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25764
25765 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25766 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25767
25768 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25769 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25770 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25771
25772 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25773 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25774
25775 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25776 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25777 @end table
25778
25779 @noindent
25780 Notes:
25781
25782 @itemize @bullet
25783 @item
25784 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25785 output is described below.
25786
25787 @item
25788 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25789 finishes.
25790
25791 @item
25792 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25793 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25794 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25795 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25796 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25797 @end itemize
25798
25799 Pragmatics:
25800
25801 @itemize @bullet
25802 @item
25803 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25804
25805 @item
25806 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25807 @end itemize
25808
25809 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25810 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25811
25812 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25813 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25814 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25815 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25816 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25817 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25818
25819 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25820 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25821 @var{token}.
25822
25823 @table @code
25824 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25825 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25826
25827 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25828 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25829
25830 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25831 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25832
25833 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25834 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25835
25836 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25837 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25838
25839 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25840 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25841
25842 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25843 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25844
25845 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25846 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25847
25848 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25849 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25850
25851 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25852 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25853 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25854
25855 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25856 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25857
25858 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25859 @code{ @var{string} }
25860
25861 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25862 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25863
25864 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25865 @code{@var{c-string}}
25866
25867 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25868 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25869
25870 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25871 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25872 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25873
25874 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25875 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25876
25877 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25878 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25879
25880 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25881 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25882
25883 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25884 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25885
25886 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25887 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25888
25889 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25890 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25891 @end table
25892
25893 @noindent
25894 Notes:
25895
25896 @itemize @bullet
25897 @item
25898 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25899
25900 @item
25901 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25902 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25903 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25904 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25905 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25906 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25907 prior command.
25908
25909 @item
25910 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25911 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25912 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25913 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25914
25915 @item
25916 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25917 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25918 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25919 @samp{*}.
25920
25921 @item
25922 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25923 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25924 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25925 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25926
25927 @item
25928 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25929 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25930 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25931 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25932
25933 @item
25934 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25935 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25936 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25937
25938 @item
25939 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25940 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25941 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25942 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25943
25944 @item
25945 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25946 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25947 @var{values}.
25948
25949
25950 @end itemize
25951
25952 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25953 details about the various output records.
25954
25955 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25956 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25957 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25958
25959 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25960 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25961
25962 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25963 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25964 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25965 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25966 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25967 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25968
25969 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25970 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25971 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25972
25973 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25974 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25975 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25976 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25977
25978 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25979 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25980
25981 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25982 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25983 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25984 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25985 might change.
25986
25987 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25988 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25989 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25990 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25991
25992 @itemize @bullet
25993 @item
25994 New MI commands may be added.
25995
25996 @item
25997 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25998
25999 @item
26000 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26001 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26002
26003 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26004 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26005
26006 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26007 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26008 @end itemize
26009
26010 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26011 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26012 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26013 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26014 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26015
26016 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26017 @c version?
26018
26019 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26020 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26021 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26022 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26023 @cindex mailing lists
26024
26025 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26026 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26027 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26028
26029 @menu
26030 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26031 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26032 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26033 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26034 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26035 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26036 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26037 @end menu
26038
26039 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26040 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26041
26042 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26043 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26044 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26045 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26046
26047 @table @code
26048 @findex ^done
26049 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26050 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26051 values.
26052
26053 @item "^running"
26054 @findex ^running
26055 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26056 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26057 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26058 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26059 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26060 which threads are resumed.
26061
26062 @item "^connected"
26063 @findex ^connected
26064 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26065
26066 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26067 @findex ^error
26068 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26069 the corresponding error message.
26070
26071 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26072 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26073 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26074
26075 @table @samp
26076 @item "undefined-command"
26077 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26078 @end table
26079
26080 @item "^exit"
26081 @findex ^exit
26082 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26083
26084 @end table
26085
26086 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26087 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26088
26089 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26090 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26091 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26092 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26093 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26094
26095 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26096 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26097 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26098 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26099 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26100
26101 @table @code
26102 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26103 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26104 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26105
26106 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26107 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26108 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26109 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26110
26111 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26112 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26113 internals.
26114 @end table
26115
26116 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26117 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26118
26119 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26120 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26121 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26122 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26123 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26124 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26125
26126 The following is the list of possible async records:
26127
26128 @table @code
26129
26130 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26131 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26132 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26133 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26134 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26135 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26136 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26137 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26138 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26139 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26140 it run freely.
26141
26142 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26143 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26144 following values:
26145
26146 @table @code
26147 @item breakpoint-hit
26148 A breakpoint was reached.
26149 @item watchpoint-trigger
26150 A watchpoint was triggered.
26151 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26152 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26153 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26154 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26155 @item function-finished
26156 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26157 @item location-reached
26158 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26159 @item watchpoint-scope
26160 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26161 @item end-stepping-range
26162 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26163 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26164 @item exited-signalled
26165 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26166 @item exited
26167 The inferior exited.
26168 @item exited-normally
26169 The inferior exited normally.
26170 @item signal-received
26171 A signal was received by the inferior.
26172 @item solib-event
26173 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26174 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26175 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26176 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26177 @item fork
26178 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26179 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26180 @item vfork
26181 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26182 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26183 @item syscall-entry
26184 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26185 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26186 @item syscall-return
26187 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26188 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26189 @item exec
26190 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26191 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26192 @end table
26193
26194 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26195 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26196 Depending on whether all-stop
26197 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26198 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26199 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26200 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26201 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26202 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26203 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26204 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26205 if such information is not available.
26206
26207 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26208 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26209 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26210 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26211 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26212 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26213 cannot be used in any way.
26214
26215 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26216 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26217 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26218 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26219 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26220 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26221
26222 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26223 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26224 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26225 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26226 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26227 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26228
26229 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26230 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26231 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26232 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26233 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26234
26235 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26236 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26237 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26238 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26239 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26240 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26241 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26242
26243 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26244 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26245 that thread.
26246
26247 @item =library-loaded,...
26248 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26249 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26250 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26251 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26252 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26253 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26254 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26255 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26256 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26257 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26258 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26259 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26260 thread groups.
26261
26262 @item =library-unloaded,...
26263 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26264 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26265 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26266 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26267 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26268 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26269 thread groups.
26270
26271 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26272 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26273 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26274 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26275 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26276
26277 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26278 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26279 initial value @var{initial}.
26280
26281 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26282 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26283 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26284 trace state variables are deleted.
26285
26286 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26287 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26288 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26289 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26290 value of trace state variable is known.
26291
26292 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26293 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26294 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26295 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26296 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26297 user.
26298
26299 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26300 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26301 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26302
26303 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26304 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26305
26306 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26307 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26308 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26309 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26310 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26311
26312 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26313 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26314 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26315 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26316 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26317 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26318
26319 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26320 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26321 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26322 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26323 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26324 executable code.
26325 @end table
26326
26327 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26328 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26329
26330 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26331 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26332 following fields:
26333
26334 @table @code
26335 @item number
26336 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26337 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26338 @samp{1.2}.
26339
26340 @item type
26341 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26342 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26343
26344 @item catch-type
26345 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26346 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26347
26348 @item disp
26349 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26350 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26351 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26352
26353 @item enabled
26354 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26355 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26356 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26357
26358 @item addr
26359 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26360 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26361 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26362 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26363 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26364
26365 @item func
26366 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26367 If not known, this field is not present.
26368
26369 @item filename
26370 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26371 If not known, this field is not present.
26372
26373 @item fullname
26374 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26375 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26376
26377 @item line
26378 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26379 If not known, this field is not present.
26380
26381 @item at
26382 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26383 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26384 by a symbol name.
26385
26386 @item pending
26387 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26388 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26389
26390 @item evaluated-by
26391 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26392 @samp{target}.
26393
26394 @item thread
26395 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26396 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26397
26398 @item task
26399 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26400 field will hold the task identifier.
26401
26402 @item cond
26403 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26404
26405 @item ignore
26406 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26407
26408 @item enable
26409 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26410
26411 @item traceframe-usage
26412 FIXME.
26413
26414 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26415 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26416
26417 @item mask
26418 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26419
26420 @item pass
26421 A tracepoint's pass count.
26422
26423 @item original-location
26424 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26425 This field is optional.
26426
26427 @item times
26428 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26429
26430 @item installed
26431 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26432 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26433 is not.
26434
26435 @item what
26436 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26437
26438 @end table
26439
26440 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26441 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26442
26443 @smallexample
26444 -> -break-insert main
26445 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26446 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26447 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26448 times="0"@}
26449 <- (gdb)
26450 @end smallexample
26451
26452 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26453 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26454
26455 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26456 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26457 fields:
26458
26459 @table @code
26460 @item level
26461 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26462 zero. This field is always present.
26463
26464 @item func
26465 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26466 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26467
26468 @item addr
26469 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26470
26471 @item file
26472 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26473 address. This field may be absent.
26474
26475 @item line
26476 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26477 may be absent.
26478
26479 @item from
26480 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26481 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26482
26483 @end table
26484
26485 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26486 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26487
26488 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26489 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26490
26491 @table @code
26492 @item id
26493 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26494 always present.
26495
26496 @item target-id
26497 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26498
26499 @item details
26500 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26501 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26502 frontend. This field is optional.
26503
26504 @item state
26505 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26506 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26507
26508 @item core
26509 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26510 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26511 @end table
26512
26513 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26514 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26515
26516 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26517 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26518 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26519 the @code{exception-name} field.
26520
26521 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26522 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26523 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26524 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26525
26526 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26527 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26528 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26529 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26530
26531 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26532 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26533
26534 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26535
26536 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26537 information of the breakpoint.
26538
26539 @smallexample
26540 -> -break-insert main
26541 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26542 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26543 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26544 times="0"@}
26545 <- (gdb)
26546 @end smallexample
26547
26548 @subheading Program Execution
26549
26550 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26551 reason that execution stopped.
26552
26553 @smallexample
26554 -> -exec-run
26555 <- ^running
26556 <- (gdb)
26557 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26558 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26559 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26560 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26561 <- (gdb)
26562 -> -exec-continue
26563 <- ^running
26564 <- (gdb)
26565 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26566 <- (gdb)
26567 @end smallexample
26568
26569 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26570
26571 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26572
26573 @smallexample
26574 -> (gdb)
26575 <- -gdb-exit
26576 <- ^exit
26577 @end smallexample
26578
26579 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26580 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26581 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26582 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26583 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26584 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26585
26586 @subheading A Bad Command
26587
26588 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26589
26590 @smallexample
26591 -> -rubbish
26592 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26593 <- (gdb)
26594 @end smallexample
26595
26596
26597 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26598 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26599 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26600
26601 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26602 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26603
26604 @subheading Motivation
26605
26606 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26607
26608 @subheading Introduction
26609
26610 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26611
26612 @subheading Commands
26613
26614 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26615
26616 @subsubheading Synopsis
26617
26618 @smallexample
26619 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26620 @end smallexample
26621
26622 @subsubheading Result
26623
26624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26625
26626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26627
26628 @subsubheading Example
26629
26630 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26631 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26632
26633
26634 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26635 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26636 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26637
26638 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26639 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26640 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26641 breakpoints.
26642
26643 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26644 @findex -break-after
26645
26646 @subsubheading Synopsis
26647
26648 @smallexample
26649 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26653 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26654 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26655 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26656
26657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26658
26659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26660
26661 @subsubheading Example
26662
26663 @smallexample
26664 (gdb)
26665 -break-insert main
26666 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26667 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26668 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26669 times="0"@}
26670 (gdb)
26671 -break-after 1 3
26672 ~
26673 ^done
26674 (gdb)
26675 -break-list
26676 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26677 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26678 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26679 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26680 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26681 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26682 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26683 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26684 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26685 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26686 (gdb)
26687 @end smallexample
26688
26689 @ignore
26690 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26691 @findex -break-catch
26692 @end ignore
26693
26694 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26695 @findex -break-commands
26696
26697 @subsubheading Synopsis
26698
26699 @smallexample
26700 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26701 @end smallexample
26702
26703 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26704 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26705 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26706 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26707 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26708 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26709
26710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26711
26712 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26713
26714 @subsubheading Example
26715
26716 @smallexample
26717 (gdb)
26718 -break-insert main
26719 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26720 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26721 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26722 times="0"@}
26723 (gdb)
26724 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26725 ^done
26726 (gdb)
26727 @end smallexample
26728
26729 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26730 @findex -break-condition
26731
26732 @subsubheading Synopsis
26733
26734 @smallexample
26735 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26736 @end smallexample
26737
26738 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26739 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26740 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26741 command below).
26742
26743 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26744
26745 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26746
26747 @subsubheading Example
26748
26749 @smallexample
26750 (gdb)
26751 -break-condition 1 1
26752 ^done
26753 (gdb)
26754 -break-list
26755 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26756 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26757 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26758 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26759 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26760 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26761 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26762 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26763 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26764 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26765 (gdb)
26766 @end smallexample
26767
26768 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26769 @findex -break-delete
26770
26771 @subsubheading Synopsis
26772
26773 @smallexample
26774 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26775 @end smallexample
26776
26777 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26778 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26779
26780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26781
26782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26783
26784 @subsubheading Example
26785
26786 @smallexample
26787 (gdb)
26788 -break-delete 1
26789 ^done
26790 (gdb)
26791 -break-list
26792 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26793 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26794 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26795 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26796 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26797 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26798 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26799 body=[]@}
26800 (gdb)
26801 @end smallexample
26802
26803 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26804 @findex -break-disable
26805
26806 @subsubheading Synopsis
26807
26808 @smallexample
26809 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26810 @end smallexample
26811
26812 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26813 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26814
26815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26816
26817 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26818
26819 @subsubheading Example
26820
26821 @smallexample
26822 (gdb)
26823 -break-disable 2
26824 ^done
26825 (gdb)
26826 -break-list
26827 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26828 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26829 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26830 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26831 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26832 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26833 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26834 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26835 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26836 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26837 (gdb)
26838 @end smallexample
26839
26840 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26841 @findex -break-enable
26842
26843 @subsubheading Synopsis
26844
26845 @smallexample
26846 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26847 @end smallexample
26848
26849 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26850
26851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26852
26853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26854
26855 @subsubheading Example
26856
26857 @smallexample
26858 (gdb)
26859 -break-enable 2
26860 ^done
26861 (gdb)
26862 -break-list
26863 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26864 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26865 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26866 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26867 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26868 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26869 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26870 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26871 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26872 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26873 (gdb)
26874 @end smallexample
26875
26876 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26877 @findex -break-info
26878
26879 @subsubheading Synopsis
26880
26881 @smallexample
26882 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26883 @end smallexample
26884
26885 @c REDUNDANT???
26886 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26887
26888 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26889 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26890 table.
26891
26892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26893
26894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26895
26896 @subsubheading Example
26897 N.A.
26898
26899 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26900 @findex -break-insert
26901 @anchor{-break-insert}
26902
26903 @subsubheading Synopsis
26904
26905 @smallexample
26906 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26907 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26908 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26909 @end smallexample
26910
26911 @noindent
26912 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26913
26914 @table @var
26915 @item linespec location
26916 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
26917
26918 @item explicit location
26919 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
26920 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
26921 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
26922
26923 @table @samp
26924 @item --source @var{filename}
26925 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
26926 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
26927
26928 @item --function @var{function}
26929 The name of a function or method.
26930
26931 @item --label @var{label}
26932 The name of a label.
26933
26934 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
26935 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
26936 @end table
26937
26938 @item address location
26939 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
26940 @end table
26941
26942 @noindent
26943 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26944
26945 @table @samp
26946 @item -t
26947 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26948 @item -h
26949 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26950 @item -f
26951 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26952 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26953 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26954 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26955 cannot be parsed.
26956 @item -d
26957 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26958 @item -a
26959 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26960 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26961 @item -c @var{condition}
26962 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26963 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26964 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26965 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26966 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
26967 @var{thread-id}.
26968 @end table
26969
26970 @subsubheading Result
26971
26972 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26973 resulting breakpoint.
26974
26975 Note: this format is open to change.
26976 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26977
26978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26979
26980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26981 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26982
26983 @subsubheading Example
26984
26985 @smallexample
26986 (gdb)
26987 -break-insert main
26988 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26989 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26990 times="0"@}
26991 (gdb)
26992 -break-insert -t foo
26993 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26994 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26995 times="0"@}
26996 (gdb)
26997 -break-list
26998 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26999 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27000 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27001 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27002 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27003 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27004 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27005 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27006 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27007 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27008 times="0"@},
27009 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27010 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27011 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27012 times="0"@}]@}
27013 (gdb)
27014 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27015 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27016 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27017 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27018 @c times="0"@}
27019 @c (gdb)
27020 @end smallexample
27021
27022 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27023 @findex -dprintf-insert
27024
27025 @subsubheading Synopsis
27026
27027 @smallexample
27028 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27029 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27030 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27031 [ @var{argument} ]
27032 @end smallexample
27033
27034 @noindent
27035 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27036 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27037
27038 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27039
27040 @table @samp
27041 @item -t
27042 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27043 @item -f
27044 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27045 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27046 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27047 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27048 cannot be parsed.
27049 @item -d
27050 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27051 @item -c @var{condition}
27052 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27053 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27054 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27055 to @var{ignore-count}.
27056 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27057 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27058 @var{thread-id}.
27059 @end table
27060
27061 @subsubheading Result
27062
27063 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27064 resulting breakpoint.
27065
27066 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27067
27068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27069
27070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27071
27072 @subsubheading Example
27073
27074 @smallexample
27075 (gdb)
27076 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27077 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27078 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27079 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27080 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27081 original-location="foo"@}
27082 (gdb)
27083 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27084 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27085 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27086 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27087 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27088 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27089 (gdb)
27090 @end smallexample
27091
27092 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27093 @findex -break-list
27094
27095 @subsubheading Synopsis
27096
27097 @smallexample
27098 -break-list
27099 @end smallexample
27100
27101 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27102
27103 @table @samp
27104 @item Number
27105 number of the breakpoint
27106 @item Type
27107 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27108 @item Disposition
27109 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27110 or @samp{nokeep}
27111 @item Enabled
27112 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27113 @item Address
27114 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27115 @item What
27116 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27117 name, line number
27118 @item Thread-groups
27119 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27120 @item Times
27121 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27122 @end table
27123
27124 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27125 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27126
27127 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27128
27129 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27130
27131 @subsubheading Example
27132
27133 @smallexample
27134 (gdb)
27135 -break-list
27136 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27137 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27138 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27139 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27140 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27141 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27142 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27143 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27144 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27145 times="0"@},
27146 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27147 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27148 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27149 (gdb)
27150 @end smallexample
27151
27152 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27153
27154 @smallexample
27155 (gdb)
27156 -break-list
27157 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27158 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27159 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27160 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27161 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27162 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27163 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27164 body=[]@}
27165 (gdb)
27166 @end smallexample
27167
27168 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27169 @findex -break-passcount
27170
27171 @subsubheading Synopsis
27172
27173 @smallexample
27174 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27175 @end smallexample
27176
27177 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27178 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27179 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27180 command @samp{passcount}.
27181
27182 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27183 @findex -break-watch
27184
27185 @subsubheading Synopsis
27186
27187 @smallexample
27188 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27189 @end smallexample
27190
27191 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27192 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27193 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27194 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27195 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27196 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27197 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27198 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27199
27200 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27201 breakpoints inserted.
27202
27203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27204
27205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27206 @samp{rwatch}.
27207
27208 @subsubheading Example
27209
27210 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27211
27212 @smallexample
27213 (gdb)
27214 -break-watch x
27215 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27216 (gdb)
27217 -exec-continue
27218 ^running
27219 (gdb)
27220 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27221 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27222 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27223 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27224 (gdb)
27225 @end smallexample
27226
27227 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27228 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27229 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27230
27231 @smallexample
27232 (gdb)
27233 -break-watch C
27234 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27235 (gdb)
27236 -exec-continue
27237 ^running
27238 (gdb)
27239 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27240 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27241 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27242 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27243 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27244 (gdb)
27245 -exec-continue
27246 ^running
27247 (gdb)
27248 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27249 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27250 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27251 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27252 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27253 (gdb)
27254 @end smallexample
27255
27256 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27257 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27258 deleted.
27259
27260 @smallexample
27261 (gdb)
27262 -break-watch C
27263 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27264 (gdb)
27265 -break-list
27266 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27267 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27268 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27269 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27270 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27271 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27272 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27273 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27274 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27275 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27276 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27277 times="1"@},
27278 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27279 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27280 (gdb)
27281 -exec-continue
27282 ^running
27283 (gdb)
27284 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27285 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27286 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27288 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27289 (gdb)
27290 -break-list
27291 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27292 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27293 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27294 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27295 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27296 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27297 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27298 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27299 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27300 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27301 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27302 times="1"@},
27303 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27304 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27305 (gdb)
27306 -exec-continue
27307 ^running
27308 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27309 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27310 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27311 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27312 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27313 (gdb)
27314 -break-list
27315 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27316 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27317 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27318 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27319 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27320 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27321 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27322 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27323 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27324 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27325 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27326 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27327 (gdb)
27328 @end smallexample
27329
27330
27331 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27332 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27333 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27334
27335 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27336 catchpoints.
27337
27338 @menu
27339 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27340 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27341 @end menu
27342
27343 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27344 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27345
27346 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27347 @findex -catch-load
27348
27349 @subsubheading Synopsis
27350
27351 @smallexample
27352 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27353 @end smallexample
27354
27355 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27356 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27357 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27358 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27359 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27360
27361
27362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27363
27364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27365
27366 @subsubheading Example
27367
27368 @smallexample
27369 -catch-load -t foo.so
27370 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27371 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27372 (gdb)
27373 @end smallexample
27374
27375
27376 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27377 @findex -catch-unload
27378
27379 @subsubheading Synopsis
27380
27381 @smallexample
27382 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27383 @end smallexample
27384
27385 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27386 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27387 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27388 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27389 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27390
27391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27392
27393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27394
27395 @subsubheading Example
27396
27397 @smallexample
27398 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27399 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27400 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27401 (gdb)
27402 @end smallexample
27403
27404 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27405 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27406
27407 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27408 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27409
27410 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27411 @findex -catch-assert
27412
27413 @subsubheading Synopsis
27414
27415 @smallexample
27416 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27417 @end smallexample
27418
27419 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27420
27421 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27422
27423 @table @samp
27424 @item -c @var{condition}
27425 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27426 @item -d
27427 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27428 @item -t
27429 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27430 @end table
27431
27432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27433
27434 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27435
27436 @subsubheading Example
27437
27438 @smallexample
27439 -catch-assert
27440 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27441 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27442 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27443 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27444 (gdb)
27445 @end smallexample
27446
27447 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27448 @findex -catch-exception
27449
27450 @subsubheading Synopsis
27451
27452 @smallexample
27453 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27454 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27455 @end smallexample
27456
27457 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27458 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27459 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27460 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27461 catchpoints.
27462
27463 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27464
27465 @table @samp
27466 @item -c @var{condition}
27467 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27468 @item -d
27469 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27470 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27471 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27472 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27473 @item -t
27474 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27475 @item -u
27476 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27477 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27478 @end table
27479
27480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27481
27482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27483 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27484
27485 @subsubheading Example
27486
27487 @smallexample
27488 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27489 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27490 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27491 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27492 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27493 (gdb)
27494 @end smallexample
27495
27496 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27497 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27498 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27499
27500 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27501 @findex -exec-arguments
27502
27503
27504 @subsubheading Synopsis
27505
27506 @smallexample
27507 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27508 @end smallexample
27509
27510 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27511 @samp{-exec-run}.
27512
27513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27514
27515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27516
27517 @subsubheading Example
27518
27519 @smallexample
27520 (gdb)
27521 -exec-arguments -v word
27522 ^done
27523 (gdb)
27524 @end smallexample
27525
27526
27527 @ignore
27528 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27529 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27530
27531 @subsubheading Synopsis
27532
27533 @smallexample
27534 -exec-show-arguments
27535 @end smallexample
27536
27537 Print the arguments of the program.
27538
27539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27540
27541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27542
27543 @subsubheading Example
27544 N.A.
27545 @end ignore
27546
27547
27548 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27549 @findex -environment-cd
27550
27551 @subsubheading Synopsis
27552
27553 @smallexample
27554 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27555 @end smallexample
27556
27557 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27558
27559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27560
27561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27562
27563 @subsubheading Example
27564
27565 @smallexample
27566 (gdb)
27567 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27568 ^done
27569 (gdb)
27570 @end smallexample
27571
27572
27573 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27574 @findex -environment-directory
27575
27576 @subsubheading Synopsis
27577
27578 @smallexample
27579 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27580 @end smallexample
27581
27582 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27583 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27584 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27585 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27586 occurs as normal.
27587 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27588 multiple directories in a single command
27589 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27590 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27591 If blanks are needed as
27592 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27593 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27594 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27595 character must not be used
27596 in any directory name.
27597 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27598
27599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27600
27601 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27602
27603 @subsubheading Example
27604
27605 @smallexample
27606 (gdb)
27607 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27608 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27609 (gdb)
27610 -environment-directory ""
27611 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27612 (gdb)
27613 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27614 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27615 (gdb)
27616 -environment-directory -r
27617 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27618 (gdb)
27619 @end smallexample
27620
27621
27622 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27623 @findex -environment-path
27624
27625 @subsubheading Synopsis
27626
27627 @smallexample
27628 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27629 @end smallexample
27630
27631 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27632 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27633 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27634 supplied in addition to the
27635 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27636 occurs as normal.
27637 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27638 multiple directories in a single command
27639 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27640 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27641 If blanks are needed as
27642 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27643 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27644 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27645 character must not be used
27646 in any directory name.
27647 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27648
27649
27650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27651
27652 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27653
27654 @subsubheading Example
27655
27656 @smallexample
27657 (gdb)
27658 -environment-path
27659 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27660 (gdb)
27661 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27662 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27663 (gdb)
27664 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27665 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27666 (gdb)
27667 @end smallexample
27668
27669
27670 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27671 @findex -environment-pwd
27672
27673 @subsubheading Synopsis
27674
27675 @smallexample
27676 -environment-pwd
27677 @end smallexample
27678
27679 Show the current working directory.
27680
27681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27682
27683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27684
27685 @subsubheading Example
27686
27687 @smallexample
27688 (gdb)
27689 -environment-pwd
27690 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27691 (gdb)
27692 @end smallexample
27693
27694 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27695 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27696 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27697
27698
27699 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27700 @findex -thread-info
27701
27702 @subsubheading Synopsis
27703
27704 @smallexample
27705 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27706 @end smallexample
27707
27708 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27709 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27710 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
27711 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27712 current thread.
27713
27714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27715
27716 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27717 about all threads.
27718
27719 @subsubheading Result
27720
27721 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27722 defined for a given thread:
27723
27724 @table @samp
27725 @item current
27726 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27727
27728 @item id
27729 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27730
27731 @item target-id
27732 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27733
27734 @item details
27735 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27736 field is optional.
27737
27738 @item name
27739 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27740 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27741 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27742 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27743 field is omitted.
27744
27745 @item frame
27746 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27747
27748 @item state
27749 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27750 values:
27751
27752 @table @code
27753 @item stopped
27754 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27755 threads.
27756
27757 @item running
27758 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27759 threads.
27760
27761 @end table
27762
27763 @item core
27764 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27765 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27766
27767 @end table
27768
27769 @subsubheading Example
27770
27771 @smallexample
27772 -thread-info
27773 ^done,threads=[
27774 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27775 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27776 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27777 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27778 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27779 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27780 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27781 state="running"@}],
27782 current-thread-id="1"
27783 (gdb)
27784 @end smallexample
27785
27786 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27787 @findex -thread-list-ids
27788
27789 @subsubheading Synopsis
27790
27791 @smallexample
27792 -thread-list-ids
27793 @end smallexample
27794
27795 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
27796 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
27797 threads.
27798
27799 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27800 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27801
27802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27803
27804 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27805
27806 @subsubheading Example
27807
27808 @smallexample
27809 (gdb)
27810 -thread-list-ids
27811 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27812 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27813 (gdb)
27814 @end smallexample
27815
27816
27817 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27818 @findex -thread-select
27819
27820 @subsubheading Synopsis
27821
27822 @smallexample
27823 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
27824 @end smallexample
27825
27826 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
27827 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
27828 topmost frame for that thread.
27829
27830 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27831 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27832
27833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27834
27835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27836
27837 @subsubheading Example
27838
27839 @smallexample
27840 (gdb)
27841 -exec-next
27842 ^running
27843 (gdb)
27844 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27845 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27846 (gdb)
27847 -thread-list-ids
27848 ^done,
27849 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27850 number-of-threads="3"
27851 (gdb)
27852 -thread-select 3
27853 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27854 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27855 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27856 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27857 (gdb)
27858 @end smallexample
27859
27860 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27861 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27862 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27863
27864 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27865 @findex -ada-task-info
27866
27867 @subsubheading Synopsis
27868
27869 @smallexample
27870 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27871 @end smallexample
27872
27873 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27874 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27875
27876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27877
27878 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27879 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27880
27881 @subsubheading Result
27882
27883 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27884 defined for each Ada task:
27885
27886 @table @samp
27887 @item current
27888 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27889
27890 @item id
27891 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27892
27893 @item task-id
27894 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27895
27896 @item thread-id
27897 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
27898 task.
27899
27900 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27901 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27902 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27903
27904 @item parent-id
27905 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27906 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27907
27908 @item priority
27909 The base priority of the task.
27910
27911 @item state
27912 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27913 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27914
27915 @item name
27916 The name of the task.
27917
27918 @end table
27919
27920 @subsubheading Example
27921
27922 @smallexample
27923 -ada-task-info
27924 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27925 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27926 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27927 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27928 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27929 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27930 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27931 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27932 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27933 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27934 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27935 (gdb)
27936 @end smallexample
27937
27938 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27939 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27940 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27941
27942 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27943 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27944 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27945 other cases.
27946
27947 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27948 @findex -exec-continue
27949
27950 @subsubheading Synopsis
27951
27952 @smallexample
27953 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27954 @end smallexample
27955
27956 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27957 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27958 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27959 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27960 @itemize @bullet
27961 @item
27962 breakpoints or watchpoints
27963 @item
27964 signals or exceptions
27965 @item
27966 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27967 @item
27968 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27969 @end itemize
27970 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27971 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27972 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27973 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27974 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27975 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27976
27977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27978
27979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27980
27981 @subsubheading Example
27982
27983 @smallexample
27984 -exec-continue
27985 ^running
27986 (gdb)
27987 @@Hello world
27988 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27989 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27990 line="13"@}
27991 (gdb)
27992 @end smallexample
27993
27994
27995 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27996 @findex -exec-finish
27997
27998 @subsubheading Synopsis
27999
28000 @smallexample
28001 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28002 @end smallexample
28003
28004 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28005 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28006 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28007 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28008 function was called.
28009
28010 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28011
28012 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28013
28014 @subsubheading Example
28015
28016 Function returning @code{void}.
28017
28018 @smallexample
28019 -exec-finish
28020 ^running
28021 (gdb)
28022 @@hello from foo
28023 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28024 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28025 (gdb)
28026 @end smallexample
28027
28028 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28029 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28030 value itself.
28031
28032 @smallexample
28033 -exec-finish
28034 ^running
28035 (gdb)
28036 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28037 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28038 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28039 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28040 (gdb)
28041 @end smallexample
28042
28043
28044 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28045 @findex -exec-interrupt
28046
28047 @subsubheading Synopsis
28048
28049 @smallexample
28050 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28051 @end smallexample
28052
28053 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28054 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28055 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28056 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28057 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28058
28059 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28060 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28061 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28062 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28063
28064 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28065 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28066 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28067 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28068
28069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28070
28071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28072
28073 @subsubheading Example
28074
28075 @smallexample
28076 (gdb)
28077 111-exec-continue
28078 111^running
28079
28080 (gdb)
28081 222-exec-interrupt
28082 222^done
28083 (gdb)
28084 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28085 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28086 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28087 (gdb)
28088
28089 (gdb)
28090 -exec-interrupt
28091 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28092 (gdb)
28093 @end smallexample
28094
28095 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28096 @findex -exec-jump
28097
28098 @subsubheading Synopsis
28099
28100 @smallexample
28101 -exec-jump @var{location}
28102 @end smallexample
28103
28104 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28105 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28106 different forms of @var{location}.
28107
28108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28109
28110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28111
28112 @subsubheading Example
28113
28114 @smallexample
28115 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28116 *running,thread-id="all"
28117 ^running
28118 @end smallexample
28119
28120
28121 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28122 @findex -exec-next
28123
28124 @subsubheading Synopsis
28125
28126 @smallexample
28127 -exec-next [--reverse]
28128 @end smallexample
28129
28130 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28131 of the next source line is reached.
28132
28133 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28134 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28135 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28136 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28137 source line where the function was called.
28138
28139
28140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28141
28142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28143
28144 @subsubheading Example
28145
28146 @smallexample
28147 -exec-next
28148 ^running
28149 (gdb)
28150 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28151 (gdb)
28152 @end smallexample
28153
28154
28155 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28156 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28157
28158 @subsubheading Synopsis
28159
28160 @smallexample
28161 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28162 @end smallexample
28163
28164 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28165 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28166 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28167 printed as well.
28168
28169 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28170 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28171 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28172 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28173 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28174
28175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28176
28177 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28178
28179 @subsubheading Example
28180
28181 @smallexample
28182 (gdb)
28183 -exec-next-instruction
28184 ^running
28185
28186 (gdb)
28187 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28188 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28189 (gdb)
28190 @end smallexample
28191
28192
28193 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28194 @findex -exec-return
28195
28196 @subsubheading Synopsis
28197
28198 @smallexample
28199 -exec-return
28200 @end smallexample
28201
28202 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28203 Displays the new current frame.
28204
28205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28206
28207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28208
28209 @subsubheading Example
28210
28211 @smallexample
28212 (gdb)
28213 200-break-insert callee4
28214 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28215 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28216 (gdb)
28217 000-exec-run
28218 000^running
28219 (gdb)
28220 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28221 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28222 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28223 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28224 (gdb)
28225 205-break-delete
28226 205^done
28227 (gdb)
28228 111-exec-return
28229 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28230 args=[@{name="strarg",
28231 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28232 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28233 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28234 (gdb)
28235 @end smallexample
28236
28237
28238 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28239 @findex -exec-run
28240
28241 @subsubheading Synopsis
28242
28243 @smallexample
28244 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28245 @end smallexample
28246
28247 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28248 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28249 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28250 the program has exited exceptionally.
28251
28252 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28253 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28254 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28255 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28256 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28257
28258 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28259 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28260 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28261 (@pxref{Starting}).
28262
28263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28264
28265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28266
28267 @subsubheading Examples
28268
28269 @smallexample
28270 (gdb)
28271 -break-insert main
28272 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28273 (gdb)
28274 -exec-run
28275 ^running
28276 (gdb)
28277 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28278 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28279 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28280 (gdb)
28281 @end smallexample
28282
28283 @noindent
28284 Program exited normally:
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 (gdb)
28288 -exec-run
28289 ^running
28290 (gdb)
28291 x = 55
28292 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28293 (gdb)
28294 @end smallexample
28295
28296 @noindent
28297 Program exited exceptionally:
28298
28299 @smallexample
28300 (gdb)
28301 -exec-run
28302 ^running
28303 (gdb)
28304 x = 55
28305 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28306 (gdb)
28307 @end smallexample
28308
28309 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28310 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28311
28312 @smallexample
28313 (gdb)
28314 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28315 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28316 @end smallexample
28317
28318
28319 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28320
28321
28322 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28323 @findex -exec-step
28324
28325 @subsubheading Synopsis
28326
28327 @smallexample
28328 -exec-step [--reverse]
28329 @end smallexample
28330
28331 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28332 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28333 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28334 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28335 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28336 previously executed source line.
28337
28338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28339
28340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28341
28342 @subsubheading Example
28343
28344 Stepping into a function:
28345
28346 @smallexample
28347 -exec-step
28348 ^running
28349 (gdb)
28350 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28351 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28352 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28353 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28354 (gdb)
28355 @end smallexample
28356
28357 Regular stepping:
28358
28359 @smallexample
28360 -exec-step
28361 ^running
28362 (gdb)
28363 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28364 (gdb)
28365 @end smallexample
28366
28367
28368 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28369 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28370
28371 @subsubheading Synopsis
28372
28373 @smallexample
28374 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28375 @end smallexample
28376
28377 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28378 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28379 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28380 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28381 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28382 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28383 as well.
28384
28385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28386
28387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28388
28389 @subsubheading Example
28390
28391 @smallexample
28392 (gdb)
28393 -exec-step-instruction
28394 ^running
28395
28396 (gdb)
28397 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28398 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28399 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28400 (gdb)
28401 -exec-step-instruction
28402 ^running
28403
28404 (gdb)
28405 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28406 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28407 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28408 (gdb)
28409 @end smallexample
28410
28411
28412 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28413 @findex -exec-until
28414
28415 @subsubheading Synopsis
28416
28417 @smallexample
28418 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28419 @end smallexample
28420
28421 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28422 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28423 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28424 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28425
28426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28427
28428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28429
28430 @subsubheading Example
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 (gdb)
28434 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28435 ^running
28436 (gdb)
28437 x = 55
28438 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28439 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28440 (gdb)
28441 @end smallexample
28442
28443 @ignore
28444 @subheading -file-clear
28445 Is this going away????
28446 @end ignore
28447
28448 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28449 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28450 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28451
28452 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28453 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28454
28455 @smallexample
28456 -enable-frame-filters
28457 @end smallexample
28458
28459 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28460 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28461 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28462 request that this functionality be enabled.
28463
28464 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28465
28466 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28467 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28468
28469 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28470 @findex -stack-info-frame
28471
28472 @subsubheading Synopsis
28473
28474 @smallexample
28475 -stack-info-frame
28476 @end smallexample
28477
28478 Get info on the selected frame.
28479
28480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28481
28482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28483 (without arguments).
28484
28485 @subsubheading Example
28486
28487 @smallexample
28488 (gdb)
28489 -stack-info-frame
28490 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28491 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28492 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28493 (gdb)
28494 @end smallexample
28495
28496 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28497 @findex -stack-info-depth
28498
28499 @subsubheading Synopsis
28500
28501 @smallexample
28502 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28503 @end smallexample
28504
28505 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28506 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28507
28508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28509
28510 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28511
28512 @subsubheading Example
28513
28514 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28515
28516 @smallexample
28517 (gdb)
28518 -stack-info-depth
28519 ^done,depth="12"
28520 (gdb)
28521 -stack-info-depth 4
28522 ^done,depth="4"
28523 (gdb)
28524 -stack-info-depth 12
28525 ^done,depth="12"
28526 (gdb)
28527 -stack-info-depth 11
28528 ^done,depth="11"
28529 (gdb)
28530 -stack-info-depth 13
28531 ^done,depth="12"
28532 (gdb)
28533 @end smallexample
28534
28535 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28536 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28537 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28538
28539 @subsubheading Synopsis
28540
28541 @smallexample
28542 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28543 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28544 @end smallexample
28545
28546 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28547 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28548 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28549 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28550 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28551 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28552 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28553 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28554
28555 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28556 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28557 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28558 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28559 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28560 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28561
28562 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28563 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28564 are still displayed, however.
28565
28566 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28567 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28568
28569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28570
28571 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28572 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28573 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28574
28575 @subsubheading Example
28576
28577 @smallexample
28578 (gdb)
28579 -stack-list-frames
28580 ^done,
28581 stack=[
28582 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28583 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28584 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28585 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28586 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28587 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28588 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28589 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28590 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28591 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28592 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28593 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28594 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28595 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28596 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28597 (gdb)
28598 -stack-list-arguments 0
28599 ^done,
28600 stack-args=[
28601 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28602 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28603 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28604 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28605 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28606 (gdb)
28607 -stack-list-arguments 1
28608 ^done,
28609 stack-args=[
28610 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28611 frame=@{level="1",
28612 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28613 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28614 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28615 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28616 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28617 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28618 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28619 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28620 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28621 (gdb)
28622 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28623 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28624 (gdb)
28625 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28626 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28627 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28628 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28629 (gdb)
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28633
28634
28635 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28636 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28637 @findex -stack-list-frames
28638
28639 @subsubheading Synopsis
28640
28641 @smallexample
28642 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28643 @end smallexample
28644
28645 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28646 following info:
28647
28648 @table @samp
28649 @item @var{level}
28650 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28651 @item @var{addr}
28652 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28653 @item @var{func}
28654 Function name.
28655 @item @var{file}
28656 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28657 @item @var{fullname}
28658 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28659 @item @var{line}
28660 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28661 @item @var{from}
28662 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28663 if the frame's function is not known.
28664 @end table
28665
28666 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28667 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28668 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28669 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28670 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28671 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28672 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28673 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28674 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28675
28676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28677
28678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28679
28680 @subsubheading Example
28681
28682 Full stack backtrace:
28683
28684 @smallexample
28685 (gdb)
28686 -stack-list-frames
28687 ^done,stack=
28688 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28689 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28690 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28691 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28692 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28693 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28694 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28695 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28696 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28697 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28698 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28699 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28700 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28701 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28702 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28703 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28704 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28705 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28706 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28707 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28708 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28709 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28710 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28711 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28712 (gdb)
28713 @end smallexample
28714
28715 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28716
28717 @smallexample
28718 (gdb)
28719 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28720 ^done,stack=
28721 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28722 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28723 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28724 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28725 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28726 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28727 (gdb)
28728 @end smallexample
28729
28730 Show a single frame:
28731
28732 @smallexample
28733 (gdb)
28734 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28735 ^done,stack=
28736 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28737 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28738 (gdb)
28739 @end smallexample
28740
28741
28742 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28743 @findex -stack-list-locals
28744 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28745
28746 @subsubheading Synopsis
28747
28748 @smallexample
28749 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28750 @end smallexample
28751
28752 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28753 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28754 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28755 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28756 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28757 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28758 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28759 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28760 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28761 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28762
28763 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28764 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28765 variables are still displayed, however.
28766
28767 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28768 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28769
28770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28771
28772 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28773
28774 @subsubheading Example
28775
28776 @smallexample
28777 (gdb)
28778 -stack-list-locals 0
28779 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28780 (gdb)
28781 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28782 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28783 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28784 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28785 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28786 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28787 (gdb)
28788 @end smallexample
28789
28790 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28791 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28792 @findex -stack-list-variables
28793
28794 @subsubheading Synopsis
28795
28796 @smallexample
28797 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28798 @end smallexample
28799
28800 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28801 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28802 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28803 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28804 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28805 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28806 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28807
28808 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28809 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28810 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28811
28812 @subsubheading Example
28813
28814 @smallexample
28815 (gdb)
28816 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28817 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28818 (gdb)
28819 @end smallexample
28820
28821
28822 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28823 @findex -stack-select-frame
28824
28825 @subsubheading Synopsis
28826
28827 @smallexample
28828 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28829 @end smallexample
28830
28831 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28832 the stack.
28833
28834 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28835 option to every command.
28836
28837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28838
28839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28840 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28841
28842 @subsubheading Example
28843
28844 @smallexample
28845 (gdb)
28846 -stack-select-frame 2
28847 ^done
28848 (gdb)
28849 @end smallexample
28850
28851 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28852 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28853 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28854
28855 @ignore
28856
28857 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28858
28859 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28860 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28861 used by @code{Insight}.
28862
28863 The two main reasons for that are:
28864
28865 @enumerate 1
28866 @item
28867 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28868
28869 @item
28870 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28871 now).
28872 @end enumerate
28873
28874 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28875 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28876 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28877 hints about their use.
28878
28879 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28880 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28881 least, the following operations:
28882
28883 @itemize @bullet
28884 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28885 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28886 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28887 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28888 @end itemize
28889
28890 @end ignore
28891
28892 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28893
28894 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28895
28896 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28897 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28898 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28899 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28900 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28901 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28902 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28903 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28904 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28905 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28906 object, or to change display format.
28907
28908 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28909 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28910 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28911 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28912 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28913 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28914 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28915 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28916 child will be created.
28917
28918 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28919 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28920 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28921 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28922 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28923
28924 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28925 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28926 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28927 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28928 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28929 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28930 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28931 variables that frontend has created.
28932
28933 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28934 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28935 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28936 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28937 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28938 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28939 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28940 implicitly updated.
28941
28942 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28943 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28944 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28945 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28946 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28947 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28948 frame. Consider this example:
28949
28950 @smallexample
28951 void do_work(...)
28952 @{
28953 struct work_state state;
28954
28955 if (...)
28956 do_work(...);
28957 @}
28958 @end smallexample
28959
28960 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28961 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28962 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28963 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28964 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28965
28966 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28967 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28968 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28969 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28970 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28971 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28972
28973 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28974 access this functionality:
28975
28976 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28977 @item @strong{Operation}
28978 @tab @strong{Description}
28979
28980 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28981 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28982 @item @code{-var-create}
28983 @tab create a variable object
28984 @item @code{-var-delete}
28985 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28986 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28987 @tab set the display format of this variable
28988 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28989 @tab show the display format of this variable
28990 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28991 @tab tells how many children this object has
28992 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28993 @tab return a list of the object's children
28994 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28995 @tab show the type of this variable object
28996 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28997 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28998 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28999 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29000 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29001 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29002 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29003 @tab get the value of this variable
29004 @item @code{-var-assign}
29005 @tab set the value of this variable
29006 @item @code{-var-update}
29007 @tab update the variable and its children
29008 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29009 @tab set frozeness attribute
29010 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29011 @tab set range of children to display on update
29012 @end multitable
29013
29014 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29015 how it can be used.
29016
29017 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29018
29019 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29020 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29021
29022 @smallexample
29023 -enable-pretty-printing
29024 @end smallexample
29025
29026 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29027 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29028 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29029 request that this functionality be enabled.
29030
29031 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29032
29033 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29034 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29035
29036 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29037 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29038
29039 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29040 @findex -var-create
29041
29042 @subsubheading Synopsis
29043
29044 @smallexample
29045 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29046 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29047 @end smallexample
29048
29049 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29050 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29051 register.
29052
29053 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29054 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29055 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29056 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29057 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29058
29059 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29060 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29061 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29062 object must be created.
29063
29064 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29065 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29066
29067 @itemize @bullet
29068 @item
29069 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29070
29071 @item
29072 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29073
29074 @item
29075 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29076 @end itemize
29077
29078 @cindex dynamic varobj
29079 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29080 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29081 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29082 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29083 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29084 compatibility for existing clients.
29085
29086 @subsubheading Result
29087
29088 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29089 are:
29090
29091 @table @samp
29092 @item name
29093 The name of the varobj.
29094
29095 @item numchild
29096 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29097 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29098 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29099
29100 @item value
29101 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29102 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29103 will not be interesting.
29104
29105 @item type
29106 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29107 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29108 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29109 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29110 @emph{declared} one.
29111
29112 @item thread-id
29113 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29114 thread's global identifier.
29115
29116 @item has_more
29117 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29118 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29119
29120 @item dynamic
29121 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29122 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29123 then this attribute will not be present.
29124
29125 @item displayhint
29126 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29127 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29128 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29129 @end table
29130
29131 Typical output will look like this:
29132
29133 @smallexample
29134 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29135 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29136 @end smallexample
29137
29138
29139 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29140 @findex -var-delete
29141
29142 @subsubheading Synopsis
29143
29144 @smallexample
29145 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29146 @end smallexample
29147
29148 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29149 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29150
29151 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29152
29153
29154 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29155 @findex -var-set-format
29156
29157 @subsubheading Synopsis
29158
29159 @smallexample
29160 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29161 @end smallexample
29162
29163 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29164 @var{format-spec}.
29165
29166 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29167 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29168
29169 @smallexample
29170 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29171 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29172 @end smallexample
29173
29174 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29175 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29176 for pointers, etc.).
29177
29178 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29179 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29180 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29181 zero-hexadecimal format.
29182
29183 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29184 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29185
29186 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29187 @findex -var-show-format
29188
29189 @subsubheading Synopsis
29190
29191 @smallexample
29192 -var-show-format @var{name}
29193 @end smallexample
29194
29195 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29196
29197 @smallexample
29198 @var{format} @expansion{}
29199 @var{format-spec}
29200 @end smallexample
29201
29202
29203 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29204 @findex -var-info-num-children
29205
29206 @subsubheading Synopsis
29207
29208 @smallexample
29209 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29210 @end smallexample
29211
29212 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29213
29214 @smallexample
29215 numchild=@var{n}
29216 @end smallexample
29217
29218 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29219 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29220 be available.
29221
29222
29223 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29224 @findex -var-list-children
29225
29226 @subsubheading Synopsis
29227
29228 @smallexample
29229 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29230 @end smallexample
29231 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29232
29233 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29234 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29235 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29236 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29237 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29238 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29239 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29240 and unions.
29241
29242 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29243 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29244 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29245 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29246 reported.
29247
29248 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29249 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29250 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29251 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29252 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29253 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29254 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29255 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29256 the visible items.
29257
29258 For each child the following results are returned:
29259
29260 @table @var
29261
29262 @item name
29263 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29264
29265 @item exp
29266 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29267 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29268
29269 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29270 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29271
29272 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29273 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29274 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29275 type and value are not present.
29276
29277 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29278 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29279 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29280
29281 @item numchild
29282 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29283 0.
29284
29285 @item type
29286 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29287 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29288 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29289 @emph{declared} one.
29290
29291 @item value
29292 If values were requested, this is the value.
29293
29294 @item thread-id
29295 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29296 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29297
29298 @item frozen
29299 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29300
29301 @item displayhint
29302 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29303 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29304 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29305
29306 @item dynamic
29307 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29308 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29309 then this attribute will not be present.
29310
29311 @end table
29312
29313 The result may have its own attributes:
29314
29315 @table @samp
29316 @item displayhint
29317 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29318 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29319 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29320
29321 @item has_more
29322 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29323 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29324 @end table
29325
29326 @subsubheading Example
29327
29328 @smallexample
29329 (gdb)
29330 -var-list-children n
29331 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29332 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29333 (gdb)
29334 -var-list-children --all-values n
29335 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29336 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29337 @end smallexample
29338
29339
29340 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29341 @findex -var-info-type
29342
29343 @subsubheading Synopsis
29344
29345 @smallexample
29346 -var-info-type @var{name}
29347 @end smallexample
29348
29349 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29350 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29351 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29352
29353 @smallexample
29354 type=@var{typename}
29355 @end smallexample
29356
29357
29358 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29359 @findex -var-info-expression
29360
29361 @subsubheading Synopsis
29362
29363 @smallexample
29364 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29365 @end smallexample
29366
29367 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29368 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29369 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29370
29371 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29372 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29373
29374 @smallexample
29375 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29376 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29377 @end smallexample
29378
29379 @noindent
29380 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29381 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29382
29383 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29384 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29385 is of limited use.
29386
29387 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29388 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29389
29390 @subsubheading Synopsis
29391
29392 @smallexample
29393 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29394 @end smallexample
29395
29396 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29397 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29398 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29399 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29400 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29401 watchpoint from a variable object.
29402
29403 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29404 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29405
29406 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29407 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29408 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29409 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29410 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29411 @smallexample
29412 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29413 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29414 @end smallexample
29415
29416 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29417 @findex -var-show-attributes
29418
29419 @subsubheading Synopsis
29420
29421 @smallexample
29422 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29423 @end smallexample
29424
29425 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29426
29427 @smallexample
29428 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29429 @end smallexample
29430
29431 @noindent
29432 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29433
29434 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29435 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29436
29437 @subsubheading Synopsis
29438
29439 @smallexample
29440 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29441 @end smallexample
29442
29443 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29444 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29445 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29446 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29447 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29448 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29449 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29450
29451 @smallexample
29452 value=@var{value}
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29456 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29457
29458 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29459 @findex -var-assign
29460
29461 @subsubheading Synopsis
29462
29463 @smallexample
29464 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29465 @end smallexample
29466
29467 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29468 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29469 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29470 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29471
29472 @subsubheading Example
29473
29474 @smallexample
29475 (gdb)
29476 -var-assign var1 3
29477 ^done,value="3"
29478 (gdb)
29479 -var-update *
29480 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29481 (gdb)
29482 @end smallexample
29483
29484 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29485 @findex -var-update
29486
29487 @subsubheading Synopsis
29488
29489 @smallexample
29490 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29491 @end smallexample
29492
29493 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29494 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29495 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29496 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29497 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29498 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29499 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29500 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29501 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29502 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29503 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29504 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29505 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29506
29507 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29508 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29509 diagnostic.
29510
29511 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29512 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29513
29514 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29515 @samp{changelist}.
29516
29517 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29518
29519 @table @samp
29520 @item name
29521 The name of the varobj.
29522
29523 @item value
29524 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29525 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29526
29527 @item in_scope
29528 @anchor{-var-update}
29529 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29530
29531 @table @code
29532 @item "true"
29533 The variable object's current value is valid.
29534
29535 @item "false"
29536 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29537 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29538 scope.
29539
29540 @item "invalid"
29541 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29542 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29543 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29544 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29545 objects.
29546 @end table
29547
29548 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29549 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29550
29551 @item type_changed
29552 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29553 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29554 be @samp{false}.
29555
29556 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29557 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29558 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29559 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29560 unset.
29561
29562 @item new_type
29563 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29564 hold the new type.
29565
29566 @item new_num_children
29567 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29568 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29569
29570 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29571 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29572 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29573 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29574 children which may be available.
29575
29576 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29577 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29578 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29579 only happen at the end of the update range).
29580
29581 @item displayhint
29582 The display hint, if any.
29583
29584 @item has_more
29585 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29586 available outside the varobj's update range.
29587
29588 @item dynamic
29589 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29590 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29591 then this attribute will not be present.
29592
29593 @item new_children
29594 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29595 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29596 be listed in this attribute.
29597 @end table
29598
29599 @subsubheading Example
29600
29601 @smallexample
29602 (gdb)
29603 -var-assign var1 3
29604 ^done,value="3"
29605 (gdb)
29606 -var-update --all-values var1
29607 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29608 type_changed="false"@}]
29609 (gdb)
29610 @end smallexample
29611
29612 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29613 @findex -var-set-frozen
29614 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29615
29616 @subsubheading Synopsis
29617
29618 @smallexample
29619 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29620 @end smallexample
29621
29622 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29623 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29624 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29625 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29626 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29627 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29628 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29629 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29630 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29631 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29632 @code{-var-update} does.
29633
29634 @subsubheading Example
29635
29636 @smallexample
29637 (gdb)
29638 -var-set-frozen V 1
29639 ^done
29640 (gdb)
29641 @end smallexample
29642
29643 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29644 @findex -var-set-update-range
29645 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29646
29647 @subsubheading Synopsis
29648
29649 @smallexample
29650 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29651 @end smallexample
29652
29653 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29654 @code{-var-update}.
29655
29656 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29657 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29658 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29659 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29660
29661 @subsubheading Example
29662
29663 @smallexample
29664 (gdb)
29665 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29666 ^done
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29670 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29671 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29672
29673 @subsubheading Synopsis
29674
29675 @smallexample
29676 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29677 @end smallexample
29678
29679 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29680
29681 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29682 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29683
29684 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29685 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29686 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29687 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29688 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29689 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29690 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29691
29692 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29693 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29694 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29695 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29696
29697 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29698 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29699 can be used to check this.
29700
29701 @subsubheading Example
29702
29703 Resetting the visualizer:
29704
29705 @smallexample
29706 (gdb)
29707 -var-set-visualizer V None
29708 ^done
29709 @end smallexample
29710
29711 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 (gdb)
29715 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29716 ^done
29717 @end smallexample
29718
29719 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29720 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29721
29722 @smallexample
29723 (gdb)
29724 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29725 ^done
29726 @end smallexample
29727
29728 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29729 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29730 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29731
29732 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29733 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29734 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29735 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29736
29737 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29738 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29739
29740 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29741 @c @subheading -data-assign
29742 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29743 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29744 @c set variable
29745 @c @subsubheading Example
29746 @c N.A.
29747
29748 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29749 @findex -data-disassemble
29750
29751 @subsubheading Synopsis
29752
29753 @smallexample
29754 -data-disassemble
29755 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29756 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29757 -- @var{mode}
29758 @end smallexample
29759
29760 @noindent
29761 Where:
29762
29763 @table @samp
29764 @item @var{start-addr}
29765 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29766 @item @var{end-addr}
29767 is the end address
29768 @item @var{filename}
29769 is the name of the file to disassemble
29770 @item @var{linenum}
29771 is the line number to disassemble around
29772 @item @var{lines}
29773 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29774 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29775 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29776 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29777 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29778 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29779 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29780 are displayed.
29781 @item @var{mode}
29782 is one of:
29783 @itemize @bullet
29784 @item 0 disassembly only
29785 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29786 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29787 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29788 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29789 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29790 @end itemize
29791
29792 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29793 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29794 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29795 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29796 @end table
29797
29798 @subsubheading Result
29799
29800 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29801 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29802 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29803
29804 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29805 following fields:
29806
29807 @table @code
29808 @item address
29809 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29810
29811 @item func-name
29812 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29813
29814 @item offset
29815 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29816
29817 @item inst
29818 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29819
29820 @item opcodes
29821 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29822 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29823
29824 @end table
29825
29826 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29827 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29828
29829 @table @code
29830 @item line
29831 The line number within @samp{file}.
29832
29833 @item file
29834 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29835 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29836 used.
29837
29838 @item fullname
29839 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29840 using the source file search path
29841 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29842 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29843
29844 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29845 present in the debug information.
29846
29847 @item line_asm_insn
29848 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29849 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29850 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29851 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29852 @samp{opcodes}.
29853
29854 @end table
29855
29856 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29857 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29858 adjust its format.
29859
29860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29861
29862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29863
29864 @subsubheading Example
29865
29866 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29867
29868 @smallexample
29869 (gdb)
29870 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29871 ^done,
29872 asm_insns=[
29873 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29874 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29875 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29876 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29877 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29878 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29879 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29880 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29881 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29882 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29883 (gdb)
29884 @end smallexample
29885
29886 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29887 @code{main}.
29888
29889 @smallexample
29890 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29891 ^done,asm_insns=[
29892 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29893 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29894 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29895 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29896 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29897 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29898 [@dots{}]
29899 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29900 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29901 (gdb)
29902 @end smallexample
29903
29904 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29905
29906 @smallexample
29907 (gdb)
29908 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29909 ^done,asm_insns=[
29910 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29911 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29912 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29913 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29914 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29915 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29916 (gdb)
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29920
29921 @smallexample
29922 (gdb)
29923 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29924 ^done,asm_insns=[
29925 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29926 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29927 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29928 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29929 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29930 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29931 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29932 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29933 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29934 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29935 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29936 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29937 (gdb)
29938 @end smallexample
29939
29940
29941 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29942 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29943
29944 @subsubheading Synopsis
29945
29946 @smallexample
29947 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29948 @end smallexample
29949
29950 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29951 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29952 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29953
29954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29955
29956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29957 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29958 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29959
29960 @subsubheading Example
29961
29962 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29963 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29964 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29965 output.
29966
29967 @smallexample
29968 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29969 211^done,value="1"
29970 (gdb)
29971 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29972 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29973 (gdb)
29974 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29975 411^done,value="4"
29976 (gdb)
29977 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29978 511^done,value="4"
29979 (gdb)
29980 @end smallexample
29981
29982
29983 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29984 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29985
29986 @subsubheading Synopsis
29987
29988 @smallexample
29989 -data-list-changed-registers
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29993
29994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29995
29996 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29997 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29998
29999 @subsubheading Example
30000
30001 On a PPC MBX board:
30002
30003 @smallexample
30004 (gdb)
30005 -exec-continue
30006 ^running
30007
30008 (gdb)
30009 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30010 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30011 line="5"@}
30012 (gdb)
30013 -data-list-changed-registers
30014 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30015 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30016 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30017 (gdb)
30018 @end smallexample
30019
30020
30021 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30022 @findex -data-list-register-names
30023
30024 @subsubheading Synopsis
30025
30026 @smallexample
30027 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30028 @end smallexample
30029
30030 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30031 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30032 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30033 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30034 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30035 include empty register names.
30036
30037 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30038
30039 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30040 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30041 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30042
30043 @subsubheading Example
30044
30045 For the PPC MBX board:
30046 @smallexample
30047 (gdb)
30048 -data-list-register-names
30049 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30050 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30051 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30052 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30053 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30054 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30055 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30056 (gdb)
30057 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30058 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30059 (gdb)
30060 @end smallexample
30061
30062 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30063 @findex -data-list-register-values
30064
30065 @subsubheading Synopsis
30066
30067 @smallexample
30068 -data-list-register-values
30069 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30070 @end smallexample
30071
30072 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30073 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30074 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30075 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30076 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30077 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30078
30079 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30080
30081 @table @code
30082 @item x
30083 Hexadecimal
30084 @item o
30085 Octal
30086 @item t
30087 Binary
30088 @item d
30089 Decimal
30090 @item r
30091 Raw
30092 @item N
30093 Natural
30094 @end table
30095
30096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30097
30098 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30099 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30100
30101 @subsubheading Example
30102
30103 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30104 don't appear in the actual output):
30105
30106 @smallexample
30107 (gdb)
30108 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30109 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30110 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30111 (gdb)
30112 -data-list-register-values x
30113 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30114 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30115 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30116 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30117 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30118 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30119 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30120 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30121 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30122 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30123 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30124 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30125 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30126 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30127 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30128 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30129 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30130 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30131 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30132 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30133 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30134 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30135 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30136 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30137 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30138 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30139 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30140 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30141 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30142 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30143 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30144 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30145 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30146 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30147 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30148 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30149 (gdb)
30150 @end smallexample
30151
30152
30153 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30154 @findex -data-read-memory
30155
30156 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30157
30158 @subsubheading Synopsis
30159
30160 @smallexample
30161 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30162 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30163 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30164 @end smallexample
30165
30166 @noindent
30167 where:
30168
30169 @table @samp
30170 @item @var{address}
30171 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30172 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30173 quoted using the C convention.
30174
30175 @item @var{word-format}
30176 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30177 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30178 ,Output Formats}).
30179
30180 @item @var{word-size}
30181 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30182
30183 @item @var{nr-rows}
30184 The number of rows in the output table.
30185
30186 @item @var{nr-cols}
30187 The number of columns in the output table.
30188
30189 @item @var{aschar}
30190 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30191 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30192 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30193 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30194
30195 @item @var{byte-offset}
30196 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30197 @end table
30198
30199 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30200 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30201 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30202 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30203 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30204 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30205 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30206 @samp{addr}.
30207
30208 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30209 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30210 @samp{prev-page}.
30211
30212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30213
30214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30215 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30216
30217 @subsubheading Example
30218
30219 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30220 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30221 word. Display each word in hex.
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 (gdb)
30225 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30226 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30227 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30228 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30229 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30230 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30231 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30232 (gdb)
30233 @end smallexample
30234
30235 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30236 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30237
30238 @smallexample
30239 (gdb)
30240 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30241 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30242 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30243 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30244 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30245 (gdb)
30246 @end smallexample
30247
30248 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30249 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30250 used as the non-printable character.
30251
30252 @smallexample
30253 (gdb)
30254 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30255 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30256 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30257 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30258 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30259 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30260 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30261 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30262 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30263 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30264 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30265 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30266 (gdb)
30267 @end smallexample
30268
30269 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30270 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30271
30272 @subsubheading Synopsis
30273
30274 @smallexample
30275 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30276 @var{address} @var{count}
30277 @end smallexample
30278
30279 @noindent
30280 where:
30281
30282 @table @samp
30283 @item @var{address}
30284 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30285 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30286 quoted using the C convention.
30287
30288 @item @var{count}
30289 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30290 literal.
30291
30292 @item @var{offset}
30293 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30294 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30295 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30296 arithmetics itself.
30297
30298 @end table
30299
30300 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30301 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30302 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30303 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30304 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30305 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30306
30307 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30308 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30309 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30310 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30311 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30312 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30313 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30314 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30315
30316 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30317 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30318 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30319 and has the following fields:
30320
30321 @table @code
30322 @item begin
30323 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30324
30325 @item end
30326 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30327
30328 @item offset
30329 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30330 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30331
30332 @item contents
30333 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30334
30335 @end table
30336
30337
30338
30339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30340
30341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30342
30343 @subsubheading Example
30344
30345 @smallexample
30346 (gdb)
30347 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30348 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30349 end="0xbffff15e",
30350 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30351 (gdb)
30352 @end smallexample
30353
30354
30355 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30356 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30357
30358 @subsubheading Synopsis
30359
30360 @smallexample
30361 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30362 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30363 @end smallexample
30364
30365 @noindent
30366 where:
30367
30368 @table @samp
30369 @item @var{address}
30370 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30371 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30372 be quoted using the C convention.
30373
30374 @item @var{contents}
30375 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30376 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30377
30378 @item @var{count}
30379 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30380 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30381 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30382 @var{count} memory units.
30383
30384 @end table
30385
30386 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30387
30388 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30389
30390 @subsubheading Example
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 (gdb)
30394 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30395 ^done
30396 (gdb)
30397 @end smallexample
30398
30399 @smallexample
30400 (gdb)
30401 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30402 ^done
30403 (gdb)
30404 @end smallexample
30405
30406 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30407 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30408 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30409
30410 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30411 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30412
30413 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30414 @findex -trace-find
30415
30416 @subsubheading Synopsis
30417
30418 @smallexample
30419 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30420 @end smallexample
30421
30422 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30423 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30424 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30425
30426 @table @samp
30427
30428 @item none
30429 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30430
30431 @item frame-number
30432 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30433 that index.
30434
30435 @item tracepoint-number
30436 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30437 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30438
30439 @item pc
30440 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30441 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30442 address.
30443
30444 @item pc-inside-range
30445 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30446 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30447 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30448
30449 @item pc-outside-range
30450 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30451 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30452 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30453
30454 @item line
30455 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30456 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30457 the specified location.
30458
30459 @end table
30460
30461 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30462 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30463
30464 @table @samp
30465 @item found
30466 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30467 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30468
30469 @item traceframe
30470 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30471 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30472
30473 @item tracepoint
30474 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30475 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30476
30477 @item frame
30478 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30479 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30480 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30481
30482 @end table
30483
30484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30485
30486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30487
30488 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30489 @findex -trace-define-variable
30490
30491 @subsubheading Synopsis
30492
30493 @smallexample
30494 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30495 @end smallexample
30496
30497 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30498 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30499 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30500 with the @samp{$} character.
30501
30502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30503
30504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30505
30506 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30507 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30508
30509 @subsubheading Synopsis
30510
30511 @smallexample
30512 -trace-frame-collected
30513 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30514 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30515 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30516 [--memory-contents]
30517 @end smallexample
30518
30519 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30520 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30521 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30522 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30523 See the output description table below for more details.
30524
30525 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30526 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30527 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30528 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30529 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30530
30531 For instance, if the actions were
30532 @smallexample
30533 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30534 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30535 @end smallexample
30536
30537 @noindent
30538 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30539 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30540 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30541 objects would be computed expressions.
30542
30543 An example output would be:
30544
30545 @smallexample
30546 (gdb)
30547 -trace-frame-collected
30548 ^done,
30549 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30550 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30551 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30552 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30553 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30554 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30555 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30556 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30557 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30558 ...
30559 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30560 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30561 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30562 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30563 (gdb)
30564 @end smallexample
30565
30566 Where:
30567
30568 @table @code
30569 @item explicit-variables
30570 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30571 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30572 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30573 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30574 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30575 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30576 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30577 arrays, structures and unions.
30578
30579 @item computed-expressions
30580 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30581 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30582 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30583 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30584
30585 @item registers
30586 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30587 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30588 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30589 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30590 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30591
30592 @item tvars
30593 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30594 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30595 current value are returned.
30596
30597 @item memory
30598 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30599 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30600 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30601
30602 @table @code
30603 @item address
30604 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30605
30606 @item length
30607 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30608
30609 @item contents
30610 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30611 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30612
30613 @end table
30614
30615 @end table
30616
30617 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30618
30619 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30620
30621 @subsubheading Example
30622
30623 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30624 @findex -trace-list-variables
30625
30626 @subsubheading Synopsis
30627
30628 @smallexample
30629 -trace-list-variables
30630 @end smallexample
30631
30632 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30633 table has the following fields:
30634
30635 @table @samp
30636 @item name
30637 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30638
30639 @item initial
30640 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30641 field is always present.
30642
30643 @item current
30644 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30645 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30646 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30647 presently running.
30648
30649 @end table
30650
30651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30652
30653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30654
30655 @subsubheading Example
30656
30657 @smallexample
30658 (gdb)
30659 -trace-list-variables
30660 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30661 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30662 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30663 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30664 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30665 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30666 (gdb)
30667 @end smallexample
30668
30669 @subheading -trace-save
30670 @findex -trace-save
30671
30672 @subsubheading Synopsis
30673
30674 @smallexample
30675 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30676 @end smallexample
30677
30678 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30679 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30680 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30681 to perform the save.
30682
30683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30684
30685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30686
30687
30688 @subheading -trace-start
30689 @findex -trace-start
30690
30691 @subsubheading Synopsis
30692
30693 @smallexample
30694 -trace-start
30695 @end smallexample
30696
30697 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30698 have any fields.
30699
30700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30701
30702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30703
30704 @subheading -trace-status
30705 @findex -trace-status
30706
30707 @subsubheading Synopsis
30708
30709 @smallexample
30710 -trace-status
30711 @end smallexample
30712
30713 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30714 the following fields:
30715
30716 @table @samp
30717
30718 @item supported
30719 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30720 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30721 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30722 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30723 started. This field is always present.
30724
30725 @item running
30726 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30727 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30728 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30729
30730 @item stop-reason
30731 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30732 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30733 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30734 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30735 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30736 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30737 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30738 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30739 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30740
30741 @item stopping-tracepoint
30742 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30743 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30744 @samp{passcount}.
30745
30746 @item frames
30747 @itemx frames-created
30748 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30749 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30750 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30751 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30752
30753 @item buffer-size
30754 @itemx buffer-free
30755 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30756 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30757
30758 @item circular
30759 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30760 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30761 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30762 and may fill up.
30763
30764 @item disconnected
30765 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30766 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30767 that the trace run will stop.
30768
30769 @item trace-file
30770 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30771 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30772
30773 @end table
30774
30775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30776
30777 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30778
30779 @subheading -trace-stop
30780 @findex -trace-stop
30781
30782 @subsubheading Synopsis
30783
30784 @smallexample
30785 -trace-stop
30786 @end smallexample
30787
30788 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30789 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30790 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30791
30792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30793
30794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30795
30796
30797 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30798 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30799 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30800
30801
30802 @ignore
30803 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30804 @findex -symbol-info-address
30805
30806 @subsubheading Synopsis
30807
30808 @smallexample
30809 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30810 @end smallexample
30811
30812 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30813
30814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30815
30816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30817
30818 @subsubheading Example
30819 N.A.
30820
30821
30822 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30823 @findex -symbol-info-file
30824
30825 @subsubheading Synopsis
30826
30827 @smallexample
30828 -symbol-info-file
30829 @end smallexample
30830
30831 Show the file for the symbol.
30832
30833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30834
30835 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30836 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30837
30838 @subsubheading Example
30839 N.A.
30840
30841
30842 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30843 @findex -symbol-info-function
30844
30845 @subsubheading Synopsis
30846
30847 @smallexample
30848 -symbol-info-function
30849 @end smallexample
30850
30851 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30852
30853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30854
30855 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30856
30857 @subsubheading Example
30858 N.A.
30859
30860
30861 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30862 @findex -symbol-info-line
30863
30864 @subsubheading Synopsis
30865
30866 @smallexample
30867 -symbol-info-line
30868 @end smallexample
30869
30870 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30871
30872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30873
30874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30875 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30876
30877 @subsubheading Example
30878 N.A.
30879
30880
30881 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30882 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30883
30884 @subsubheading Synopsis
30885
30886 @smallexample
30887 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30888 @end smallexample
30889
30890 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30891
30892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30893
30894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30895
30896 @subsubheading Example
30897 N.A.
30898
30899
30900 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30901 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30902
30903 @subsubheading Synopsis
30904
30905 @smallexample
30906 -symbol-list-functions
30907 @end smallexample
30908
30909 List the functions in the executable.
30910
30911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30912
30913 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30914 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30915
30916 @subsubheading Example
30917 N.A.
30918 @end ignore
30919
30920
30921 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30922 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30923
30924 @subsubheading Synopsis
30925
30926 @smallexample
30927 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30928 @end smallexample
30929
30930 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30931 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30932 ascending PC order.
30933
30934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30935
30936 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30937
30938 @subsubheading Example
30939 @smallexample
30940 (gdb)
30941 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30942 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30943 (gdb)
30944 @end smallexample
30945
30946
30947 @ignore
30948 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30949 @findex -symbol-list-types
30950
30951 @subsubheading Synopsis
30952
30953 @smallexample
30954 -symbol-list-types
30955 @end smallexample
30956
30957 List all the type names.
30958
30959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30960
30961 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30962 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30963
30964 @subsubheading Example
30965 N.A.
30966
30967
30968 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30969 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30970
30971 @subsubheading Synopsis
30972
30973 @smallexample
30974 -symbol-list-variables
30975 @end smallexample
30976
30977 List all the global and static variable names.
30978
30979 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30980
30981 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30982
30983 @subsubheading Example
30984 N.A.
30985
30986
30987 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30988 @findex -symbol-locate
30989
30990 @subsubheading Synopsis
30991
30992 @smallexample
30993 -symbol-locate
30994 @end smallexample
30995
30996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30997
30998 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30999
31000 @subsubheading Example
31001 N.A.
31002
31003
31004 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31005 @findex -symbol-type
31006
31007 @subsubheading Synopsis
31008
31009 @smallexample
31010 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31011 @end smallexample
31012
31013 Show type of @var{variable}.
31014
31015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31016
31017 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31018 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31019
31020 @subsubheading Example
31021 N.A.
31022 @end ignore
31023
31024
31025 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31026 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31027 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31028
31029 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31030 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31031
31032 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31033 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31034
31035 @subsubheading Synopsis
31036
31037 @smallexample
31038 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31039 @end smallexample
31040
31041 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31042 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31043 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31044 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31045 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31046 notification.
31047
31048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31049
31050 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31051
31052 @subsubheading Example
31053
31054 @smallexample
31055 (gdb)
31056 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31057 ^done
31058 (gdb)
31059 @end smallexample
31060
31061
31062 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31063 @findex -file-exec-file
31064
31065 @subsubheading Synopsis
31066
31067 @smallexample
31068 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31069 @end smallexample
31070
31071 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31072 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31073 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31074 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31075 notification.
31076
31077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31078
31079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31080
31081 @subsubheading Example
31082
31083 @smallexample
31084 (gdb)
31085 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31086 ^done
31087 (gdb)
31088 @end smallexample
31089
31090
31091 @ignore
31092 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31093 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31094
31095 @subsubheading Synopsis
31096
31097 @smallexample
31098 -file-list-exec-sections
31099 @end smallexample
31100
31101 List the sections of the current executable file.
31102
31103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31104
31105 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31106 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31107 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31108
31109 @subsubheading Example
31110 N.A.
31111 @end ignore
31112
31113
31114 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31115 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31116
31117 @subsubheading Synopsis
31118
31119 @smallexample
31120 -file-list-exec-source-file
31121 @end smallexample
31122
31123 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31124 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31125 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31126 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31127
31128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31129
31130 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31131
31132 @subsubheading Example
31133
31134 @smallexample
31135 (gdb)
31136 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31137 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31138 (gdb)
31139 @end smallexample
31140
31141
31142 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31143 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31144
31145 @subsubheading Synopsis
31146
31147 @smallexample
31148 -file-list-exec-source-files
31149 @end smallexample
31150
31151 List the source files for the current executable.
31152
31153 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31154 name) of a source file.
31155
31156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31157
31158 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31159 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31160
31161 @subsubheading Example
31162 @smallexample
31163 (gdb)
31164 -file-list-exec-source-files
31165 ^done,files=[
31166 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31167 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31168 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31169 (gdb)
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172 @ignore
31173 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31174 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -file-list-shared-libraries
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 List the shared libraries in the program.
31183
31184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31185
31186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31187
31188 @subsubheading Example
31189 N.A.
31190
31191
31192 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31193 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31194
31195 @subsubheading Synopsis
31196
31197 @smallexample
31198 -file-list-symbol-files
31199 @end smallexample
31200
31201 List symbol files.
31202
31203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31204
31205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31206
31207 @subsubheading Example
31208 N.A.
31209 @end ignore
31210
31211
31212 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31213 @findex -file-symbol-file
31214
31215 @subsubheading Synopsis
31216
31217 @smallexample
31218 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31219 @end smallexample
31220
31221 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31222 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31223 produced, except for a completion notification.
31224
31225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31226
31227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31228
31229 @subsubheading Example
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 (gdb)
31233 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31234 ^done
31235 (gdb)
31236 @end smallexample
31237
31238 @ignore
31239 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31240 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31241 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31242
31243 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31244
31245 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31246
31247 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31248
31249 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31250
31251 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31252
31253 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31254
31255 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31256
31257 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31258
31259 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31260 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31261 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31262
31263 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31264
31265 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31266
31267 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31268
31269 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31270 @end ignore
31271
31272
31273 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31274 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31275 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31276
31277
31278 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31279 @findex -target-attach
31280
31281 @subsubheading Synopsis
31282
31283 @smallexample
31284 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31285 @end smallexample
31286
31287 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31288 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31289 group, the id previously returned by
31290 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31291
31292 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31293
31294 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31295
31296 @subsubheading Example
31297 @smallexample
31298 (gdb)
31299 -target-attach 34
31300 =thread-created,id="1"
31301 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31302 ^done
31303 (gdb)
31304 @end smallexample
31305
31306 @ignore
31307 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31308 @findex -target-compare-sections
31309
31310 @subsubheading Synopsis
31311
31312 @smallexample
31313 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31314 @end smallexample
31315
31316 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31317 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31318
31319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31320
31321 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31322
31323 @subsubheading Example
31324 N.A.
31325 @end ignore
31326
31327
31328 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31329 @findex -target-detach
31330
31331 @subsubheading Synopsis
31332
31333 @smallexample
31334 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31335 @end smallexample
31336
31337 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31338 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31339 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31340
31341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31342
31343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31344
31345 @subsubheading Example
31346
31347 @smallexample
31348 (gdb)
31349 -target-detach
31350 ^done
31351 (gdb)
31352 @end smallexample
31353
31354
31355 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31356 @findex -target-disconnect
31357
31358 @subsubheading Synopsis
31359
31360 @smallexample
31361 -target-disconnect
31362 @end smallexample
31363
31364 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31365 generally not resumed.
31366
31367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31368
31369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31370
31371 @subsubheading Example
31372
31373 @smallexample
31374 (gdb)
31375 -target-disconnect
31376 ^done
31377 (gdb)
31378 @end smallexample
31379
31380
31381 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31382 @findex -target-download
31383
31384 @subsubheading Synopsis
31385
31386 @smallexample
31387 -target-download
31388 @end smallexample
31389
31390 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31391 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31392
31393 @table @samp
31394 @item section
31395 The name of the section.
31396 @item section-sent
31397 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31398 @item section-size
31399 The size of the section.
31400 @item total-sent
31401 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31402 @item total-size
31403 The size of the overall executable to download.
31404 @end table
31405
31406 @noindent
31407 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31408 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31409
31410 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31411 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31412
31413 @table @samp
31414 @item section
31415 The name of the section.
31416 @item section-size
31417 The size of the section.
31418 @item total-size
31419 The size of the overall executable to download.
31420 @end table
31421
31422 @noindent
31423 At the end, a summary is printed.
31424
31425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31426
31427 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31428
31429 @subsubheading Example
31430
31431 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31432 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31433
31434 @smallexample
31435 (gdb)
31436 -target-download
31437 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31438 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31439 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31440 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31441 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31442 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31443 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31444 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31445 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31446 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31447 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31448 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31449 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31450 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31451 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31452 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31453 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31454 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31455 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31456 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31457 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31458 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31459 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31460 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31461 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31462 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31463 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31464 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31465 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31466 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31467 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31468 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31469 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31470 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31471 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31472 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31473 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31474 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31475 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31476 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31477 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31478 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31479 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31480 write-rate="429"
31481 (gdb)
31482 @end smallexample
31483
31484
31485 @ignore
31486 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31487 @findex -target-exec-status
31488
31489 @subsubheading Synopsis
31490
31491 @smallexample
31492 -target-exec-status
31493 @end smallexample
31494
31495 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31496 not, for instance).
31497
31498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31499
31500 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31501
31502 @subsubheading Example
31503 N.A.
31504
31505
31506 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31507 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31508
31509 @subsubheading Synopsis
31510
31511 @smallexample
31512 -target-list-available-targets
31513 @end smallexample
31514
31515 List the possible targets to connect to.
31516
31517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31518
31519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31520
31521 @subsubheading Example
31522 N.A.
31523
31524
31525 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31526 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31527
31528 @subsubheading Synopsis
31529
31530 @smallexample
31531 -target-list-current-targets
31532 @end smallexample
31533
31534 Describe the current target.
31535
31536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31537
31538 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31539 other things).
31540
31541 @subsubheading Example
31542 N.A.
31543
31544
31545 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31546 @findex -target-list-parameters
31547
31548 @subsubheading Synopsis
31549
31550 @smallexample
31551 -target-list-parameters
31552 @end smallexample
31553
31554 @c ????
31555 @end ignore
31556
31557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31558
31559 No equivalent.
31560
31561 @subsubheading Example
31562 N.A.
31563
31564
31565 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31566 @findex -target-select
31567
31568 @subsubheading Synopsis
31569
31570 @smallexample
31571 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31572 @end smallexample
31573
31574 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31575
31576 @table @samp
31577 @item @var{type}
31578 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31579 @item @var{parameters}
31580 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31581 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31582 @end table
31583
31584 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31585 which the target program is, in the following form:
31586
31587 @smallexample
31588 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31589 args=[@var{arg list}]
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31593
31594 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31595
31596 @subsubheading Example
31597
31598 @smallexample
31599 (gdb)
31600 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31601 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31602 (gdb)
31603 @end smallexample
31604
31605 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31606 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31607 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31608
31609
31610 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31611 @findex -target-file-put
31612
31613 @subsubheading Synopsis
31614
31615 @smallexample
31616 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31617 @end smallexample
31618
31619 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31620 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31621
31622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31623
31624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31625
31626 @subsubheading Example
31627
31628 @smallexample
31629 (gdb)
31630 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31631 ^done
31632 (gdb)
31633 @end smallexample
31634
31635
31636 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31637 @findex -target-file-get
31638
31639 @subsubheading Synopsis
31640
31641 @smallexample
31642 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31643 @end smallexample
31644
31645 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31646 on the host system.
31647
31648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31649
31650 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31651
31652 @subsubheading Example
31653
31654 @smallexample
31655 (gdb)
31656 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31657 ^done
31658 (gdb)
31659 @end smallexample
31660
31661
31662 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31663 @findex -target-file-delete
31664
31665 @subsubheading Synopsis
31666
31667 @smallexample
31668 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31669 @end smallexample
31670
31671 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31672
31673 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31674
31675 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31676
31677 @subsubheading Example
31678
31679 @smallexample
31680 (gdb)
31681 -target-file-delete remotefile
31682 ^done
31683 (gdb)
31684 @end smallexample
31685
31686
31687 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31688 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31689 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31690
31691 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31692 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31693
31694 @subsubheading Synopsis
31695
31696 @smallexample
31697 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31698 @end smallexample
31699
31700 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31701 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31702 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31703
31704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31705
31706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31707
31708 @subsubheading Result
31709
31710 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31711 defined for each exception:
31712
31713 @table @samp
31714 @item name
31715 The name of the exception.
31716
31717 @item address
31718 The address of the exception.
31719
31720 @end table
31721
31722 @subsubheading Example
31723
31724 @smallexample
31725 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31726 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31727 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31728 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31729 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31730 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31731 @end smallexample
31732
31733 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31734
31735 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31736 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31737 Catchpoint Commands}.
31738
31739
31740 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31741 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31742 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31743
31744 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31745 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31746 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31747 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31748
31749 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31750 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31751 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31752
31753 @subsubheading Synopsis
31754
31755 @smallexample
31756 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31757 @end smallexample
31758
31759 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31760
31761 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31762 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31763 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31764 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31765 dash.
31766
31767 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31768
31769 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31770
31771 @subsubheading Result
31772
31773 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31774
31775 @table @samp
31776 @item exists
31777 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31778 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31779
31780 @end table
31781
31782 @subsubheading Example
31783
31784 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31785
31786 @smallexample
31787 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31788 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31789 @end smallexample
31790
31791 @noindent
31792 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31793 to the debugger:
31794
31795 @smallexample
31796 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31797 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31798 @end smallexample
31799
31800 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31801 @findex -list-features
31802 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31803
31804 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31805 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31806 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31807 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31808 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31809 startup.
31810
31811 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31812 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31813 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31814 is given below.
31815
31816 Example output:
31817
31818 @smallexample
31819 (gdb) -list-features
31820 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31821 @end smallexample
31822
31823 The current list of features is:
31824
31825 @ftable @samp
31826 @item frozen-varobjs
31827 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31828 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31829 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31830 @item pending-breakpoints
31831 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31832 command.
31833 @item python
31834 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31835 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31836 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31837 @item thread-info
31838 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31839 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31840 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31841 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31842 @item breakpoint-notifications
31843 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31844 CLI will be announced via async records.
31845 @item ada-task-info
31846 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31847 @item language-option
31848 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31849 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31850 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31851 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31852 @item undefined-command-error-code
31853 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31854 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31855 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31856 @item exec-run-start-option
31857 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31858 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31859 @end ftable
31860
31861 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31862 @findex -list-target-features
31863
31864 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31865 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31866 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31867 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31868 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31869 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31870 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31871 Example output:
31872
31873 @smallexample
31874 (gdb) -list-target-features
31875 ^done,result=["async"]
31876 @end smallexample
31877
31878 The current list of features is:
31879
31880 @table @samp
31881 @item async
31882 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31883 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31884 while the target is running.
31885
31886 @item reverse
31887 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31888 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31889
31890 @end table
31891
31892 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31893 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31894 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31895
31896 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31897
31898 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31899 @findex -gdb-exit
31900
31901 @subsubheading Synopsis
31902
31903 @smallexample
31904 -gdb-exit
31905 @end smallexample
31906
31907 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31908
31909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31910
31911 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31912
31913 @subsubheading Example
31914
31915 @smallexample
31916 (gdb)
31917 -gdb-exit
31918 ^exit
31919 @end smallexample
31920
31921
31922 @ignore
31923 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31924 @findex -exec-abort
31925
31926 @subsubheading Synopsis
31927
31928 @smallexample
31929 -exec-abort
31930 @end smallexample
31931
31932 Kill the inferior running program.
31933
31934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31935
31936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31937
31938 @subsubheading Example
31939 N.A.
31940 @end ignore
31941
31942
31943 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31944 @findex -gdb-set
31945
31946 @subsubheading Synopsis
31947
31948 @smallexample
31949 -gdb-set
31950 @end smallexample
31951
31952 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31953 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31954
31955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31956
31957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31958
31959 @subsubheading Example
31960
31961 @smallexample
31962 (gdb)
31963 -gdb-set $foo=3
31964 ^done
31965 (gdb)
31966 @end smallexample
31967
31968
31969 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31970 @findex -gdb-show
31971
31972 @subsubheading Synopsis
31973
31974 @smallexample
31975 -gdb-show
31976 @end smallexample
31977
31978 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31979
31980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31981
31982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31983
31984 @subsubheading Example
31985
31986 @smallexample
31987 (gdb)
31988 -gdb-show annotate
31989 ^done,value="0"
31990 (gdb)
31991 @end smallexample
31992
31993 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31994
31995
31996 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31997 @findex -gdb-version
31998
31999 @subsubheading Synopsis
32000
32001 @smallexample
32002 -gdb-version
32003 @end smallexample
32004
32005 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32006
32007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32008
32009 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32010 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32011
32012 @subsubheading Example
32013
32014 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32015 @c box in TeX.
32016 @smallexample
32017 (gdb)
32018 -gdb-version
32019 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32020 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32021 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32022 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32023 ~ certain conditions.
32024 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32025 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32026 ~ details.
32027 ~This GDB was configured as
32028 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32029 ^done
32030 (gdb)
32031 @end smallexample
32032
32033 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32034 @findex -list-thread-groups
32035
32036 @subheading Synopsis
32037
32038 @smallexample
32039 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32040 @end smallexample
32041
32042 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32043 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32044 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32045 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32046 top-level thread groups.
32047
32048 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32049 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32050 available on the target.
32051
32052 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32053 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32054 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32055 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32056 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32057 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32058 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32059 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32060
32061 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32062 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32063 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32064 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32065 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32066 @samp{threads} field.
32067
32068 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32069 the following caveats:
32070
32071 @itemize @bullet
32072 @item
32073 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32074 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32075 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32076
32077 @item
32078 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32079 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32080 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32081 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32082 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32083 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32084
32085 @end itemize
32086
32087 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32088 have the following fields:
32089
32090 @table @code
32091 @item id
32092 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32093 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32094 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32095
32096 @item type
32097 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32098 valid type.
32099
32100 @item pid
32101 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32102 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32103
32104 @item exit-code
32105 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32106 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32107 only if the process is not running.
32108
32109 @item num_children
32110 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32111 absent for an available thread group.
32112
32113 @item threads
32114 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32115 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32116 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32117
32118 @item cores
32119 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32120 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32121 such information is not available.
32122
32123 @item executable
32124 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32125 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32126 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32127
32128 @end table
32129
32130 @subheading Example
32131
32132 @smallexample
32133 @value{GDBP}
32134 -list-thread-groups
32135 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32136 -list-thread-groups 17
32137 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32138 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32139 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32140 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32141 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32142 -list-thread-groups --available
32143 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32144 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32145 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32146 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32147 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32148 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32149 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32150 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32151 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32152 @end smallexample
32153
32154 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32155 @findex -info-os
32156
32157 @subsubheading Synopsis
32158
32159 @smallexample
32160 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32161 @end smallexample
32162
32163 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32164 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32165 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32166 of data of that type.
32167
32168 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32169 system.
32170
32171 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32172
32173 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32174
32175 @subsubheading Example
32176
32177 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32178 like this:
32179
32180 @smallexample
32181 @value{GDBP}
32182 -info-os
32183 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32184 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32185 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32186 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32187 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32188 col2="CPUs"@},
32189 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32190 col2="File descriptors"@},
32191 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32192 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32193 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32194 col2="Message queues"@},
32195 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32196 col2="Processes"@},
32197 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32198 col2="Process groups"@},
32199 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32200 col2="Semaphores"@},
32201 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32202 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32203 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32204 col2="Sockets"@},
32205 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32206 col2="Threads"@}]
32207 @value{GDBP}
32208 -info-os processes
32209 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32210 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32211 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32212 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32213 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32214 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32215 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32216 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32217 ...
32218 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32219 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32220 (gdb)
32221 @end smallexample
32222
32223 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32224 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32225 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32226 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32227 @code{info os} omits it.)
32228
32229 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32230 @findex -add-inferior
32231
32232 @subheading Synopsis
32233
32234 @smallexample
32235 -add-inferior
32236 @end smallexample
32237
32238 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32239 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32240 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32241 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32242 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32243 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32244
32245 @subheading Example
32246
32247 @smallexample
32248 @value{GDBP}
32249 -add-inferior
32250 ^done,inferior="i3"
32251 @end smallexample
32252
32253 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32254 @findex -interpreter-exec
32255
32256 @subheading Synopsis
32257
32258 @smallexample
32259 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32260 @end smallexample
32261 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32262
32263 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32264
32265 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32266
32267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32268
32269 @subheading Example
32270
32271 @smallexample
32272 (gdb)
32273 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32274 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32275 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32276 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32277 ^done
32278 (gdb)
32279 @end smallexample
32280
32281 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32282 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32283
32284 @subheading Synopsis
32285
32286 @smallexample
32287 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32288 @end smallexample
32289
32290 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32291
32292 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32293
32294 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32295
32296 @subheading Example
32297
32298 @smallexample
32299 (gdb)
32300 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32301 ^done
32302 (gdb)
32303 @end smallexample
32304
32305 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32306 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32307
32308 @subheading Synopsis
32309
32310 @smallexample
32311 -inferior-tty-show
32312 @end smallexample
32313
32314 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32315
32316 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32317
32318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32319
32320 @subheading Example
32321
32322 @smallexample
32323 (gdb)
32324 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32325 ^done
32326 (gdb)
32327 -inferior-tty-show
32328 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32329 (gdb)
32330 @end smallexample
32331
32332 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32333 @findex -enable-timings
32334
32335 @subheading Synopsis
32336
32337 @smallexample
32338 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32339 @end smallexample
32340
32341 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32342 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32343 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32344 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32345
32346 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32347
32348 No equivalent.
32349
32350 @subheading Example
32351
32352 @smallexample
32353 (gdb)
32354 -enable-timings
32355 ^done
32356 (gdb)
32357 -break-insert main
32358 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32359 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32360 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32361 times="0"@},
32362 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32363 (gdb)
32364 -enable-timings no
32365 ^done
32366 (gdb)
32367 -exec-run
32368 ^running
32369 (gdb)
32370 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32371 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32372 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32373 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32374 (gdb)
32375 @end smallexample
32376
32377 @node Annotations
32378 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32379
32380 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32381 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32382 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32383 relatively high level.
32384
32385 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32386 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32387
32388 @ignore
32389 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32390 @end ignore
32391
32392 @menu
32393 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32394 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32395 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32396 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32397 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32398 * Annotations for Running::
32399 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32400 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32401 @end menu
32402
32403 @node Annotations Overview
32404 @section What is an Annotation?
32405 @cindex annotations
32406
32407 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32408 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32409 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32410 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32411 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32412 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32413 cannot contain newline characters.
32414
32415 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32416 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32417 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32418 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32419 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32420 means those three characters as output.
32421
32422 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32423 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32424 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32425 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32426 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32427 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32428 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32429 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32430 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32431
32432 @table @code
32433 @kindex set annotate
32434 @item set annotate @var{level}
32435 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32436 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32437
32438 @item show annotate
32439 @kindex show annotate
32440 Show the current annotation level.
32441 @end table
32442
32443 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32444
32445 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32446
32447 @smallexample
32448 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32449 GNU gdb 6.0
32450 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32451 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32452 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32453 under certain conditions.
32454 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32455 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32456 for details.
32457 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32458
32459 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32460 (@value{GDBP})
32461 ^Z^Zprompt
32462 @kbd{quit}
32463
32464 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32465 $
32466 @end smallexample
32467
32468 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32469 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32470 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32471 output from @value{GDBN}.
32472
32473 @node Server Prefix
32474 @section The Server Prefix
32475 @cindex server prefix
32476
32477 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32478 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32479 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32480 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32481 a transparent manner.
32482
32483 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32484 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32485 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32486 @code{print} command.
32487
32488 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32489 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32490
32491 @node Prompting
32492 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32493
32494 @cindex annotations for prompts
32495 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32496 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32497 over, etc.
32498
32499 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32500 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32501 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32502 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32503 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32504 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32505 features the following annotations:
32506
32507 @smallexample
32508 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32509 ^Z^Zprompt
32510 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32511 @end smallexample
32512
32513 The input types are
32514
32515 @table @code
32516 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32517 @findex prompt annotation
32518 @findex post-prompt annotation
32519 @item prompt
32520 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32521
32522 @findex pre-commands annotation
32523 @findex commands annotation
32524 @findex post-commands annotation
32525 @item commands
32526 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32527 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32528
32529 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32530 @findex overload-choice annotation
32531 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32532 @item overload-choice
32533 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32534
32535 @findex pre-query annotation
32536 @findex query annotation
32537 @findex post-query annotation
32538 @item query
32539 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32540
32541 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32542 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32543 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32544 @item prompt-for-continue
32545 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32546 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32547 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32548 presence of annotations.
32549 @end table
32550
32551 @node Errors
32552 @section Errors
32553 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32554
32555 @findex quit annotation
32556 @smallexample
32557 ^Z^Zquit
32558 @end smallexample
32559
32560 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32561
32562 @findex error annotation
32563 @smallexample
32564 ^Z^Zerror
32565 @end smallexample
32566
32567 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32568
32569 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32570 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32571 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32572 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32573 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32574 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32575 to the top level.
32576
32577 @findex error-begin annotation
32578 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32579
32580 @smallexample
32581 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32582 @end smallexample
32583
32584 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32585 message.
32586
32587 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32588 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32589 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32590
32591 @node Invalidation
32592 @section Invalidation Notices
32593
32594 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32595 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32596 changed.
32597
32598 @table @code
32599 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32600 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32601
32602 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32603 have changed.
32604
32605 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32606 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32607
32608 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32609 deleted a breakpoint.
32610 @end table
32611
32612 @node Annotations for Running
32613 @section Running the Program
32614 @cindex annotations for running programs
32615
32616 @findex starting annotation
32617 @findex stopping annotation
32618 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32619 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32620
32621 @smallexample
32622 ^Z^Zstarting
32623 @end smallexample
32624
32625 is output. When the program stops,
32626
32627 @smallexample
32628 ^Z^Zstopped
32629 @end smallexample
32630
32631 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32632 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32633
32634 @table @code
32635 @findex exited annotation
32636 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32637 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32638 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32639
32640 @findex signalled annotation
32641 @findex signal-name annotation
32642 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32643 @findex signal-string annotation
32644 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32645 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32646 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32647 annotation continues:
32648
32649 @smallexample
32650 @var{intro-text}
32651 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32652 @var{name}
32653 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32654 @var{middle-text}
32655 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32656 @var{string}
32657 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32658 @var{end-text}
32659 @end smallexample
32660
32661 @noindent
32662 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32663 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32664 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32665 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32666 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32667
32668 @findex signal annotation
32669 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32670 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32671 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32672 terminated with it.
32673
32674 @findex breakpoint annotation
32675 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32676 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32677
32678 @findex watchpoint annotation
32679 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32680 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32681 @end table
32682
32683 @node Source Annotations
32684 @section Displaying Source
32685 @cindex annotations for source display
32686
32687 @findex source annotation
32688 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32689
32690 @smallexample
32691 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32692 @end smallexample
32693
32694 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32695 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32696 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32697 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32698 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32699 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32700 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32701 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32702 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32703 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32704 depend on the language).
32705
32706 @node JIT Interface
32707 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32708 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32709 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32710
32711 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32712 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32713 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32714 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32715
32716 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32717 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32718 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32719 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32720 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32721 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32722
32723 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32724 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32725 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32726 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32727 LLVM JIT.
32728
32729 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32730 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32731 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32732 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32733 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32734 out about additional code.
32735
32736 @menu
32737 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32738 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32739 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32740 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32741 @end menu
32742
32743 @node Declarations
32744 @section JIT Declarations
32745
32746 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32747 implement the interface:
32748
32749 @smallexample
32750 typedef enum
32751 @{
32752 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32753 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32754 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32755 @} jit_actions_t;
32756
32757 struct jit_code_entry
32758 @{
32759 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32760 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32761 const char *symfile_addr;
32762 uint64_t symfile_size;
32763 @};
32764
32765 struct jit_descriptor
32766 @{
32767 uint32_t version;
32768 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32769 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32770 uint32_t action_flag;
32771 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32772 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32773 @};
32774
32775 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32776 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32777
32778 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32779 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32780 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32781 @end smallexample
32782
32783 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32784 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32785 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32786
32787 @node Registering Code
32788 @section Registering Code
32789
32790 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32791
32792 @itemize @bullet
32793 @item
32794 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32795 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32796
32797 @item
32798 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32799 file.
32800
32801 @item
32802 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32803
32804 @item
32805 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32806
32807 @item
32808 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32809 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32810 @end itemize
32811
32812 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32813 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32814 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32815 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32816
32817 @node Unregistering Code
32818 @section Unregistering Code
32819
32820 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32821
32822 @itemize @bullet
32823 @item
32824 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32825
32826 @item
32827 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32828
32829 @item
32830 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32831 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32832 @end itemize
32833
32834 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32835 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32836
32837 @node Custom Debug Info
32838 @section Custom Debug Info
32839 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32840 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32841
32842 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32843 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32844 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32845 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32846 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32847 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32848 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32849 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32850 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32851
32852 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32853 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32854 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32855 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32856 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32857 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32858 compiler.
32859
32860 @menu
32861 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32862 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32863 @end menu
32864
32865 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32866 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32867 @kindex jit-reader-load
32868 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32869
32870 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32871 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32872
32873 @table @code
32874 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32875 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32876 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32877 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32878 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32879 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32880 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32881
32882 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32883 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32884 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32885 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32886 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32887
32888 @item jit-reader-unload
32889 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32890
32891 @end table
32892
32893 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32894 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32895 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32896
32897 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32898 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32899
32900 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32901 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32902 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32903 the system include directory.
32904
32905 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32906 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32907 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32908
32909 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32910 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32911
32912 @findex gdb_init_reader
32913 @smallexample
32914 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32915 @end smallexample
32916
32917 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32918
32919 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32920 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32921 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32922 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32923 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32924 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32925
32926 @smallexample
32927 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32928 @{
32929 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32930 int reader_version;
32931
32932 /* For use by the reader. */
32933 void *priv_data;
32934
32935 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32936 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32937 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32938 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32939 @};
32940 @end smallexample
32941
32942 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32943 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32944
32945 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32946 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32947 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32948 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32949 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32950 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32951 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32952 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32953 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32954 target's address space.
32955
32956 @node In-Process Agent
32957 @chapter In-Process Agent
32958 @cindex debugging agent
32959 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32960 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32961 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32962 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32963 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32964 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32965 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32966 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32967 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32968 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32969 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32970 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32971 behavior without interrupting it.
32972
32973 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32974 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32975 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32976 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32977 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32978 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32979 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32980 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32981 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32982
32983 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32984 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32985 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32986 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32987
32988 @anchor{Control Agent}
32989 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32990 debugging with the following commands:
32991
32992 @table @code
32993 @kindex set agent on
32994 @item set agent on
32995 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32996 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32997 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32998 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32999 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33000 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33001
33002 @kindex set agent off
33003 @item set agent off
33004 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33005 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33006
33007 @kindex show agent
33008 @item show agent
33009 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33010 the in-process agent.
33011 @end table
33012
33013 @menu
33014 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33015 @end menu
33016
33017 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33018 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33019 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33020
33021 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33022 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33023 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33024 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33025 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33026 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33027 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33028 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33029 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33030
33031 @menu
33032 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33033 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33034 @end menu
33035
33036 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33037 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33038 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33039
33040 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33041 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33042
33043 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33044 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33045 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33046 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33047
33048 @enumerate
33049 @item
33050 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33051 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33052 @item
33053 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33054 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33055 the other one.
33056 @end enumerate
33057
33058 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33059
33060 @enumerate
33061 @item
33062 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33063 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33064 @anchor{agent expression object}
33065 @item
33066 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33067 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33068 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33069 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33070 @item
33071 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33072 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33073
33074 @end enumerate
33075
33076 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33077 object:
33078
33079 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33080 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33081 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33082 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33083 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33084 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33085 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33086 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33087 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33088 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33089 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33090 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33091 memory address for collecting.
33092 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33093 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33094 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33095 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33096 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33097 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33098 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33099 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33100 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33101 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33102 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33103 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33104 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33105 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33106 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33107 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33108 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33109 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33110 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33111 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33112 @ref{agent expression object}
33113 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33114 @ref{agent expression object}
33115 @item actions @tab variable
33116 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33117 @end multitable
33118
33119 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33120 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33121 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33122
33123 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33124 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33125
33126 @table @samp
33127
33128 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33129 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33130 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33131 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33132 in IPA finally.
33133
33134 Replies:
33135 @table @samp
33136 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33137 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33138 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33139 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33140 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33141 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33142 @item E @var{NN}
33143 for an error
33144
33145 @end table
33146
33147 @item close
33148 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33149 is about to kill inferiors.
33150
33151 @item qTfSTM
33152 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33153 @item qTsSTM
33154 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33155 @item qTSTMat
33156 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33157 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33158 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33159
33160 Replies:
33161 @table @samp
33162 @item E @var{NN}
33163 for an error
33164 @end table
33165 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33166 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33167 @end table
33168
33169 @node GDB Bugs
33170 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33171 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33172 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33173
33174 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33175
33176 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33177 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33178 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33179 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33180
33181 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33182 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33183
33184 @menu
33185 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33186 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33187 @end menu
33188
33189 @node Bug Criteria
33190 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33191 @cindex bug criteria
33192
33193 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33194
33195 @itemize @bullet
33196 @cindex fatal signal
33197 @cindex debugger crash
33198 @cindex crash of debugger
33199 @item
33200 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33201 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33202
33203 @cindex error on valid input
33204 @item
33205 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33206 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33207 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33208
33209 @cindex invalid input
33210 @item
33211 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33212 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33213 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33214 for traditional practice''.
33215
33216 @item
33217 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33218 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33219 @end itemize
33220
33221 @node Bug Reporting
33222 @section How to Report Bugs
33223 @cindex bug reports
33224 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33225
33226 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33227 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33228 contact that organization first.
33229
33230 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33231 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33232 distribution.
33233 @c should add a web page ref...
33234
33235 @ifset BUGURL
33236 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33237 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33238 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33239 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33240 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33241 be used.
33242
33243 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33244 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33245 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33246 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33247
33248 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33249 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33250 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33251 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33252 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33253 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33254 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33255 bug reports to the mailing list.
33256 @end ifset
33257 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33258 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33259 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33260 @end ifclear
33261 @end ifset
33262
33263 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33264 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33265 fact or leave it out, state it!
33266
33267 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33268 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33269 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33270 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33271 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33272 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33273 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33274 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33275 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33276
33277 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33278 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33279 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33280 self-contained.
33281
33282 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33283 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33284 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33285 bugs properly.
33286
33287 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33288
33289 @itemize @bullet
33290 @item
33291 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33292 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33293 version}.
33294
33295 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33296 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33297
33298 @item
33299 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33300 version number.
33301
33302 @item
33303 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33304 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33305 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33306 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33307
33308 @item
33309 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33310 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33311
33312 @item
33313 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33314 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33315 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33316 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33317 those compilers.
33318
33319 @item
33320 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33321 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33322 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33323 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33324
33325 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33326 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33327
33328 @item
33329 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33330 reproduce the bug.
33331
33332 @item
33333 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33334 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33335
33336 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33337 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33338 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33339 a chance to make a mistake.
33340
33341 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33342 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33343 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33344 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33345 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33346 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33347 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33348 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33349
33350 @pindex script
33351 @cindex recording a session script
33352 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33353 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33354 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33355 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33356
33357 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33358 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33359
33360 @item
33361 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33362 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33363 it by context, not by line number.
33364
33365 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33366 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33367
33368 @end itemize
33369
33370 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33371
33372 @itemize @bullet
33373 @item
33374 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33375
33376 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33377 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33378 changes will not affect it.
33379
33380 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33381 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33382 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33383 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33384
33385 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33386 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33387 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33388 less time, and so on.
33389
33390 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33391 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33392
33393 @item
33394 A patch for the bug.
33395
33396 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33397 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33398 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33399 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33400
33401 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33402 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33403 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33404 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33405
33406 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33407 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33408 help us to understand.
33409
33410 @item
33411 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33412
33413 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33414 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33415 @end itemize
33416
33417 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33418 @c and consists of the two following files:
33419 @c rluser.texi
33420 @c hsuser.texi
33421 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33422 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33423 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33424 @include rluser.texi
33425 @include hsuser.texi
33426 @end ifclear
33427
33428 @node In Memoriam
33429 @appendix In Memoriam
33430
33431 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33432 contributors:
33433
33434 @table @code
33435 @item Fred Fish
33436 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33437 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33438 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33439
33440 @item Michael Snyder
33441 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33442 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33443 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33444 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33445 @end table
33446
33447 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33448 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33449
33450 @node Formatting Documentation
33451 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33452
33453 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33454 @cindex reference card
33455 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33456 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33457 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33458 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33459 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33460 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33461
33462 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33463 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33464
33465 @smallexample
33466 make refcard.dvi
33467 @end smallexample
33468
33469 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33470 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33471 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33472 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33473 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33474
33475 @cindex documentation
33476
33477 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33478 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33479 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33480 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33481 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33482 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33483
33484 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33485 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33486 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33487 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33488 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33489 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33490 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33491 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33492
33493 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33494 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33495 @code{makeinfo}.
33496
33497 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33498 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33499 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33500
33501 @smallexample
33502 cd gdb
33503 make gdb.info
33504 @end smallexample
33505
33506 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33507 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33508 Texinfo definitions file.
33509
33510 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33511 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33512 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33513 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33514 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33515 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33516 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33517
33518 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33519 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33520 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33521 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33522 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33523 directory.
33524
33525 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33526 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33527 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33528 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33529
33530 @smallexample
33531 make gdb.dvi
33532 @end smallexample
33533
33534 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33535
33536 @node Installing GDB
33537 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33538 @cindex installation
33539
33540 @menu
33541 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33542 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33543 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33544 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33545 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33546 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33547 @end menu
33548
33549 @node Requirements
33550 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33551 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33552
33553 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33554 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33555
33556 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33557 @table @asis
33558 @item ISO C90 compiler
33559 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33560 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33561
33562 @end table
33563
33564 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33565 @table @asis
33566 @item Expat
33567 @anchor{Expat}
33568 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33569 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33570 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33571 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33572 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33573 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33574
33575 Expat is used for:
33576
33577 @itemize @bullet
33578 @item
33579 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33580 @item
33581 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33582 @item
33583 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33584 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33585 @item
33586 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33587 @item
33588 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33589 @item
33590 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33591 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33592 @end itemize
33593
33594 @item zlib
33595 @cindex compressed debug sections
33596 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33597 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33598 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33599 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33600 information in such binaries.
33601
33602 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33603 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33604 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33605
33606 @item iconv
33607 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33608 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33609 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33610 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33611
33612 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33613 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33614 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33615 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33616
33617 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33618 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33619 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33620
33621 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33622 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33623 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33624 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33625 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33626 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33627 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33628 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33629 @end table
33630
33631 @node Running Configure
33632 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33633 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33634 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33635 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33636 build the @code{gdb} program.
33637 @iftex
33638 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33639 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33640 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33641 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33642 @end iftex
33643
33644 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33645 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33646 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33647
33648 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33649 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33650
33651 @table @code
33652 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33653 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33654
33655 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33656 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33657
33658 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33659 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33660
33661 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33662 @sc{gnu} include files
33663
33664 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33665 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33666
33667 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33668 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33669
33670 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33671 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33672
33673 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33674 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33675
33676 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33677 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33678 @end table
33679
33680 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33681 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33682 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33683
33684 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33685 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33686 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33687 argument.
33688
33689 For example:
33690
33691 @smallexample
33692 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33693 ./configure @var{host}
33694 make
33695 @end smallexample
33696
33697 @noindent
33698 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33699 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33700 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33701 correct value by examining your system.)
33702
33703 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33704 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33705 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33706 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33707
33708 @need 750
33709 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33710 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33711 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33712
33713 @smallexample
33714 sh configure @var{host}
33715 @end smallexample
33716
33717 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33718 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33719 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33720 @file{configure}
33721 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33722 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33723
33724 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33725 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33726 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33727 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33728 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33729 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33730 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33731 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33732 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33733
33734 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33735 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33736 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33737 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33738 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33739
33740 @node Separate Objdir
33741 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33742
33743 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33744 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33745 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33746 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33747 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33748 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33749 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33750 program specified there.
33751
33752 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33753 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33754 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33755 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33756 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33757 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33758
33759 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33760 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33761
33762 @smallexample
33763 @group
33764 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33765 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33766 cd ../gdb-sun4
33767 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33768 make
33769 @end group
33770 @end smallexample
33771
33772 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33773 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33774 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33775 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33776 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33777 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33778
33779 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33780 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33781 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33782 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33783 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33784
33785 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33786 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33787 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33788 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33789 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33790 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33791
33792 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33793 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33794 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33795
33796 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33797 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33798 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33799 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33800 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33801
33802 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33803 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33804 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33805 with each other.
33806
33807 @node Config Names
33808 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33809
33810 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33811 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33812 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33813 of information in the following pattern:
33814
33815 @smallexample
33816 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33817 @end smallexample
33818
33819 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33820 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33821 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33822
33823 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33824 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33825 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33826 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33827 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33828 abbreviations---for example:
33829
33830 @smallexample
33831 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33832 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33833 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33834 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33835 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33836 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33837 % sh config.sub sun4
33838 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33839 % sh config.sub sun3
33840 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33841 % sh config.sub i986v
33842 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33843 @end smallexample
33844
33845 @noindent
33846 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33847 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33848
33849 @node Configure Options
33850 @section @file{configure} Options
33851
33852 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33853 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33854 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33855 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33856
33857 @smallexample
33858 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33859 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33860 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33861 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33862 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33863 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33864 @var{host}
33865 @end smallexample
33866
33867 @noindent
33868 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33869 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33870 @samp{--}.
33871
33872 @table @code
33873 @item --help
33874 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33875
33876 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33877 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33878 @file{@var{dir}}.
33879
33880 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33881 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33882 @file{@var{dir}}.
33883
33884 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33885 @need 2000
33886 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33887 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33888 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33889 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33890 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33891 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33892 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33893 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33894 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33895 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33896 @var{dirname}.
33897
33898 @item --norecursion
33899 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33900 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33901
33902 @item --target=@var{target}
33903 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33904 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33905 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33906
33907 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33908
33909 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33910 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33911
33912 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33913 @end table
33914
33915 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33916 needed for special purposes only.
33917
33918 @node System-wide configuration
33919 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33920 @cindex system-wide init file
33921
33922 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33923 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33924 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33925
33926 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33927
33928 @table @code
33929 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33930 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33931 @var{file}.
33932 @end table
33933
33934 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33935 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33936
33937 @itemize @bullet
33938 @item
33939 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33940 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33941 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33942 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33943 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33944 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33945
33946 @item
33947 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33948 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33949 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33950 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33951 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33952 @end itemize
33953
33954 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33955 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33956 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33957 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33958 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33959 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33960 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33961 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33962 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33963 reread.
33964
33965 @menu
33966 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33967 @end menu
33968
33969 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33970 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33971 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33972
33973 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33974 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33975 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33976 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33977 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33978 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33979
33980 The following scripts are currently available:
33981 @itemize @bullet
33982
33983 @item @file{elinos.py}
33984 @pindex elinos.py
33985 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33986 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33987 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33988 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33989 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33990 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33991
33992 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33993 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33994 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33995 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33996 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33997 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33998
33999 @end itemize
34000
34001 @node Maintenance Commands
34002 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34003 @cindex maintenance commands
34004 @cindex internal commands
34005
34006 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34007 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34008 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34009 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34010 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34011
34012 @table @code
34013 @kindex maint agent
34014 @kindex maint agent-eval
34015 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34016 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34017 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34018 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34019 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34020 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34021 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34022 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34023 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34024 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34025 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34026 addition and return the sum.
34027 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34028 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34029
34030 @kindex maint agent-printf
34031 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34032 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34033 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34034 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34035 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34036
34037 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34038 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34039 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34040 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34041 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34042 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34043 is shown:
34044
34045 @table @code
34046 @item breakpoint
34047 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34048
34049 @item watchpoint
34050 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34051
34052 @item longjmp
34053 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34054 @code{longjmp} calls.
34055
34056 @item longjmp resume
34057 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34058
34059 @item until
34060 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34061
34062 @item finish
34063 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34064
34065 @item shlib events
34066 Shared library events.
34067
34068 @end table
34069
34070 @kindex maint info btrace
34071 @item maint info btrace
34072 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34073
34074 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34075 @item maint btrace packet-history
34076 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34077 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34078 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34079 recording format.
34080
34081 @table @code
34082 @item bts
34083 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34084 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34085
34086 @table @asis
34087 @item Block number
34088 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34089 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34090 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34091 @end table
34092
34093 @item pt
34094 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34095 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34096 information is printed:
34097
34098 @table @asis
34099 @item Packet number
34100 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34101 @item Trace offset
34102 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34103 @item Packet opcode and payload
34104 @end table
34105 @end table
34106
34107 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34108 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34109 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34110 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34111 needed.
34112
34113 @kindex maint btrace clear
34114 @item maint btrace clear
34115 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34116 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34117
34118 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34119 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34120 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34121 buffer.
34122
34123 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34124 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34125 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34126 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34127 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34128 packet history.
34129
34130 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34131 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34132 @cindex displaced stepping support
34133 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34134 @item set displaced-stepping
34135 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34136 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34137 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34138 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34139 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34140 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34141
34142 @table @code
34143 @item set displaced-stepping on
34144 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34145 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34146
34147 @item set displaced-stepping off
34148 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34149 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34150
34151 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34152 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34153 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34154 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34155 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34156 @end table
34157
34158 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34159 @item maint check-psymtabs
34160 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34161 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34162
34163 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34164 @item maint check-symtabs
34165 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34166
34167 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34168 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34169 Expand symbol tables.
34170 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34171 names matching @var{regexp}.
34172
34173 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34174 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34175 @cindex demangler crashes
34176 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34177 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34178 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34179 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34180 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34181 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34182 option to terminate the current session.
34183
34184 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34185 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34186 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34187
34188 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34189 @item maint cplus namespace
34190 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34191
34192 @kindex maint deprecate
34193 @kindex maint undeprecate
34194 @cindex deprecated commands
34195 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34196 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34197 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34198 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34199 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34200 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34201 the replacement as part of the warning.
34202
34203 @kindex maint dump-me
34204 @item maint dump-me
34205 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34206 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34207 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34208 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34209
34210 @kindex maint internal-error
34211 @kindex maint internal-warning
34212 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34213 @cindex demangler crashes
34214 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34215 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34216 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34217
34218 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34219 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34220 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34221 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34222 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34223 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34224 @value{GDBN} session.
34225
34226 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34227 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34228
34229 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34230
34231 @smallexample
34232 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34233 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34234 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34235 debugging may prove unreliable.
34236 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34237 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34238 (@value{GDBP})
34239 @end smallexample
34240
34241 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34242 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34243 @cindex demangler crashes
34244
34245 @kindex maint set internal-error
34246 @kindex maint show internal-error
34247 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34248 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34249 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34250 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34251 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34252 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34253 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34254 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34255 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34256 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34257 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34258 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34259 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34260 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34261 described in the table below.
34262
34263 @table @samp
34264 @item quit
34265 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34266 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34267
34268 @item corefile
34269 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34270 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34271 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34272 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34273 disabled.
34274 @end table
34275
34276 @kindex maint packet
34277 @item maint packet @var{text}
34278 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34279 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34280 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34281 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34282 checksum.
34283
34284 @kindex maint print architecture
34285 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34286 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34287 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34288
34289 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34290 @item maint print c-tdesc
34291 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34292 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34293 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34294
34295 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34296 @item maint print dummy-frames
34297 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34298
34299 @smallexample
34300 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34301 @dots{}
34302 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34303 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34304 58 return (a + b);
34305 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34306 @dots{}
34307 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34308 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34309 (@value{GDBP})
34310 @end smallexample
34311
34312 Takes an optional file parameter.
34313
34314 @kindex maint print registers
34315 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34316 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34317 @kindex maint print register-groups
34318 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34319 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34320 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34321 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34322 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34323 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34324 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34325
34326 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34327 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34328 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34329 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34330 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34331 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34332 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34333 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34334
34335 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34336 write the information.
34337
34338 @kindex maint print reggroups
34339 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34340 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34341 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34342 information.
34343
34344 The register groups info looks like this:
34345
34346 @smallexample
34347 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34348 Group Type
34349 general user
34350 float user
34351 all user
34352 vector user
34353 system user
34354 save internal
34355 restore internal
34356 @end smallexample
34357
34358 @kindex flushregs
34359 @item flushregs
34360 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34361
34362 @kindex maint print objfiles
34363 @cindex info for known object files
34364 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34365 Print a dump of all known object files.
34366 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34367 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34368 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34369
34370 @kindex maint print user-registers
34371 @cindex user registers
34372 @item maint print user-registers
34373 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34374 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34375 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34376 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34377 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34378 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34379 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34380
34381 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34382 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34383 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34384 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34385 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34386 matching @var{regexp}.
34387 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34388 and the full path if known.
34389 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34390
34391 @kindex maint print statistics
34392 @cindex bcache statistics
34393 @item maint print statistics
34394 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34395 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34396 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34397 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34398 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34399 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34400 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34401 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34402 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34403 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34404 lengths.
34405
34406 @kindex maint print target-stack
34407 @cindex target stack description
34408 @item maint print target-stack
34409 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34410 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34411 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34412 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34413 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34414 address.
34415
34416 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34417 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34418
34419 @kindex maint print type
34420 @cindex type chain of a data type
34421 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34422 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34423 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34424 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34425 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34426 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34427
34428 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34429 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34430 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34431 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34432 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34433 information.
34434
34435 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34436 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34437 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34438 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34439 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34440 always see the disassembly form.
34441
34442 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34443
34444 @smallexample
34445 (gdb) info addr argc
34446 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34447 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34448 @end smallexample
34449
34450 For more information on these expressions, see
34451 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34452
34453 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34454 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34455 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34456 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34457 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34458
34459 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34460 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34461 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34462 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34463 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34464 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34465 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34466 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34467 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34468
34469 @kindex maint set profile
34470 @kindex maint show profile
34471 @cindex profiling GDB
34472 @item maint set profile
34473 @itemx maint show profile
34474 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34475
34476 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34477 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34478 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34479 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34480 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34481 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34482 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34483
34484 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34485 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34486
34487 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34488 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34489 @cindex hardware debug registers
34490 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34491 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34492 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34493 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34494 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34495 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34496 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34497
34498 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34499 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34500 @item maint set show-all-tib
34501 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34502 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34503 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34504 command.
34505
34506 @kindex maint set target-async
34507 @kindex maint show target-async
34508 @item maint set target-async
34509 @itemx maint show target-async
34510 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34511 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34512 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34513 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34514
34515 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34516 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34517 @item maint set target-non-stop
34518 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34519
34520 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34521 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34522 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34523 if supported by the target.
34524
34525 @table @code
34526 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34527 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34528 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34529
34530 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34531 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34532 does not indicate support.
34533
34534 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34535 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34536 target supports it.
34537 @end table
34538
34539 @kindex maint set per-command
34540 @kindex maint show per-command
34541 @item maint set per-command
34542 @itemx maint show per-command
34543 @cindex resources used by commands
34544
34545 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34546 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34547
34548 @table @code
34549 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34550 @itemx maint show per-command space
34551 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34552 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34553 took, following the command's own output.
34554 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34555 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34556
34557 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34558 @itemx maint show per-command time
34559 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34560 for each command.
34561 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34562 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34563 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34564 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34565 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34566 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34567 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34568 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34569 spent by the program been debugged.
34570 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34571 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34572
34573 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34574 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34575 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34576 for each command.
34577 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34578
34579 @enumerate a
34580 @item
34581 number of symbol tables
34582 @item
34583 number of primary symbol tables
34584 @item
34585 number of blocks in the blockvector
34586 @end enumerate
34587 @end table
34588
34589 @kindex maint space
34590 @cindex memory used by commands
34591 @item maint space @var{value}
34592 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34593 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34594
34595 @kindex maint time
34596 @cindex time of command execution
34597 @item maint time @var{value}
34598 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34599 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34600
34601 @kindex maint translate-address
34602 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34603 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34604 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34605 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34606 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34607 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34608 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34609
34610 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34611 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34612 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34613
34614 @end table
34615
34616 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34617 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34618
34619 @table @code
34620 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34621 @kindex set watchdog
34622 @cindex watchdog timer
34623 @cindex timeout for commands
34624 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34625 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34626 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34627
34628 @item show watchdog
34629 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34630 @end table
34631
34632 @node Remote Protocol
34633 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34634
34635 @menu
34636 * Overview::
34637 * Packets::
34638 * Stop Reply Packets::
34639 * General Query Packets::
34640 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34641 * Tracepoint Packets::
34642 * Host I/O Packets::
34643 * Interrupts::
34644 * Notification Packets::
34645 * Remote Non-Stop::
34646 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34647 * Examples::
34648 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34649 * Library List Format::
34650 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34651 * Memory Map Format::
34652 * Thread List Format::
34653 * Traceframe Info Format::
34654 * Branch Trace Format::
34655 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34656 @end menu
34657
34658 @node Overview
34659 @section Overview
34660
34661 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34662 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34663 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34664 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34665
34666 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34667 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34668
34669 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34670 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34671 @cindex remote serial protocol
34672 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34673 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34674 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34675 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34676 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34677
34678 @smallexample
34679 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34680 @end smallexample
34681 @noindent
34682
34683 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34684 @noindent
34685 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34686 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34687 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34688
34689 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34690 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34691
34692 @smallexample
34693 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34694 @end smallexample
34695
34696 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34697 @noindent
34698 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34699 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34700 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34701
34702 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34703 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34704 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34705 retransmission):
34706
34707 @smallexample
34708 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34709 <- @code{+}
34710 @end smallexample
34711 @noindent
34712
34713 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34714 once a connection is established.
34715 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34716
34717 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34718 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34719 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34720 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34721 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34722 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34723 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34724
34725 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34726 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34727 exceptions).
34728
34729 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34730 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34731 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34732 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34733
34734 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34735 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34736 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34737
34738 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34739 @anchor{Binary Data}
34740 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34741 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34742 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34743 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34744 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34745 binary data.
34746
34747 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34748 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34749 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34750 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34751 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34752 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34753 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34754 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34755 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34756 (described next).
34757
34758 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34759 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34760 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34761 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34762 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34763 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34764 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34765 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34766 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34767 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34768 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34769 3}} more times.
34770
34771 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34772 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34773 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34774 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34775 @samp{0*"00}.
34776
34777 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34778 error number. That number is not well defined.
34779
34780 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34781 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34782 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34783 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34784 on that response.
34785
34786 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34787 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34788 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34789 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34790 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34791 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34792
34793 @node Packets
34794 @section Packets
34795
34796 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34797 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34798 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34799 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34800
34801 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34802 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34803 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34804 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34805 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34806 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34807 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34808 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34809 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34810 @var{baz}.
34811
34812 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34813 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34814 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34815 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34816 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34817 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34818 pick any thread.
34819
34820 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34821 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34822 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34823 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34824 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34825 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34826 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34827 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34828 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34829 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34830 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34831 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34832 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34833
34834 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34835 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34836 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34837 more information.
34838
34839 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34840 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34841
34842 Here are the packet descriptions.
34843
34844 @table @samp
34845
34846 @item !
34847 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34848 @anchor{extended mode}
34849 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34850 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34851 debugged.
34852
34853 Reply:
34854 @table @samp
34855 @item OK
34856 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34857 @end table
34858
34859 @item ?
34860 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34861 @anchor{? packet}
34862 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34863 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34864 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34865
34866 Reply:
34867 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34868
34869 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34870 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34871 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34872 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34873 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34874
34875 Reply:
34876 @table @samp
34877 @item OK
34878 The arguments were set.
34879 @item E @var{NN}
34880 An error occurred.
34881 @end table
34882
34883 @item b @var{baud}
34884 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34885 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34886 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34887
34888 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34889 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34890 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34891
34892 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34893 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34894 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34895 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34896 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34897
34898 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34899 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34900 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34901 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34902
34903 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34904 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34905
34906 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34907 @anchor{bc}
34908 @item bc
34909 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34910 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34911
34912 Reply:
34913 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34914
34915 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34916 @anchor{bs}
34917 @item bs
34918 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34919 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34920
34921 Reply:
34922 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34923
34924 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34925 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34926 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34927 is omitted, resume at current address.
34928
34929 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34930 packet}.
34931
34932 Reply:
34933 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34934
34935 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34936 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34937 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34938 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34939
34940 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34941 packet}.
34942
34943 Reply:
34944 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34945
34946 @item d
34947 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34948 Toggle debug flag.
34949
34950 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34951 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34952
34953 @item D
34954 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34955 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34956 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34957 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34958 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34959
34960 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34961 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34962 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34963 big-endian hex string.
34964
34965 Reply:
34966 @table @samp
34967 @item OK
34968 for success
34969 @item E @var{NN}
34970 for an error
34971 @end table
34972
34973 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34974 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34975 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34976 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34977 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34978
34979 @item g
34980 @anchor{read registers packet}
34981 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34982 Read general registers.
34983
34984 Reply:
34985 @table @samp
34986 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34987 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34988 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34989 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34990 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34991 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34992 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34993
34994 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34995 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34996 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34997 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34998 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34999 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35000 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35001 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35002
35003 @smallexample
35004 -> @code{g}
35005 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35006 @end smallexample
35007
35008 @item E @var{NN}
35009 for an error.
35010 @end table
35011
35012 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35013 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35014 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35015 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35016
35017 Reply:
35018 @table @samp
35019 @item OK
35020 for success
35021 @item E @var{NN}
35022 for an error
35023 @end table
35024
35025 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35026 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35027 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35028 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35029 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35030 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35031 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35032 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35033 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35034
35035 Reply:
35036 @table @samp
35037 @item OK
35038 for success
35039 @item E @var{NN}
35040 for an error
35041 @end table
35042
35043 @c FIXME: JTC:
35044 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35045 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35046 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35047 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35048 @c described. For example:
35049 @c
35050 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35051 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35052 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35053 @c
35054 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35055 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35056 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35057
35058 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35059 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35060 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35061 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35062 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35063 step starting at that address.
35064
35065 @item I
35066 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35067 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35068 step packet}.
35069
35070 @item k
35071 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35072 Kill request.
35073
35074 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35075
35076 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35077 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35078
35079 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35080
35081 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35082 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35083 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35084
35085 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35086 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35087 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35088
35089 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35090 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35091 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35092 (@pxref{? packet}).
35093
35094 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35095 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35096 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35097 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35098 any particular boundary.
35099
35100 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35101 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35102 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35103 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35104 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35105 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35106 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35107 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35108
35109 Reply:
35110 @table @samp
35111 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35112 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35113 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35114 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35115 @item E @var{NN}
35116 @var{NN} is errno
35117 @end table
35118
35119 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35120 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35121 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35122 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35123 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35124
35125 Reply:
35126 @table @samp
35127 @item OK
35128 for success
35129 @item E @var{NN}
35130 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35131 written).
35132 @end table
35133
35134 @item p @var{n}
35135 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35136 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35137 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35138 register value is encoded.
35139
35140 Reply:
35141 @table @samp
35142 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35143 the register's value
35144 @item E @var{NN}
35145 for an error
35146 @item @w{}
35147 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35148 @end table
35149
35150 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35151 @anchor{write register packet}
35152 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35153 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35154 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35155 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35156
35157 Reply:
35158 @table @samp
35159 @item OK
35160 for success
35161 @item E @var{NN}
35162 for an error
35163 @end table
35164
35165 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35166 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35167 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35168 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35169 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35170 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35171
35172 @item r
35173 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35174 Reset the entire system.
35175
35176 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35177
35178 @item R @var{XX}
35179 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35180 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35181 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35182
35183 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35184
35185 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35186 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35187 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35188 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35189
35190 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35191 packet}.
35192
35193 Reply:
35194 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35195
35196 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35197 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35198 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35199 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35200 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35201
35202 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35203 packet}.
35204
35205 Reply:
35206 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35207
35208 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35209 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35210 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35211 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35212 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35213
35214 @item T @var{thread-id}
35215 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35216 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35217
35218 Reply:
35219 @table @samp
35220 @item OK
35221 thread is still alive
35222 @item E @var{NN}
35223 thread is dead
35224 @end table
35225
35226 @item v
35227 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35228 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35229
35230 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35231 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35232 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35233 The process ID is a
35234 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35235 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35236 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35237
35238 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35239 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35240 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35241 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35242 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35243 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35244 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35245 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35246
35247 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35248
35249 Reply:
35250 @table @samp
35251 @item E @var{nn}
35252 for an error
35253 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35254 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35255 @item OK
35256 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35257 @end table
35258
35259 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35260 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35261 @anchor{vCont packet}
35262 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35263 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35264 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35265 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35266 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35267 Specifying multiple
35268 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35269 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35270
35271 Currently supported actions are:
35272
35273 @table @samp
35274 @item c
35275 Continue.
35276 @item C @var{sig}
35277 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35278 @item s
35279 Step.
35280 @item S @var{sig}
35281 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35282 @item t
35283 Stop.
35284 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35285 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35286 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35287 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35288 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35289 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35290
35291 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35292 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35293 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35294 jumps to @var{start}).
35295
35296 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35297 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35298 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35299
35300 @end table
35301
35302 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35303 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35304 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35305
35306 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35307 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35308 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35309 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35310 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35311 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35312 as an implementation detail.
35313
35314 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35315 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35316 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35317 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35318 @var{thread-id}.
35319
35320 Reply:
35321 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35322
35323 @item vCont?
35324 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35325 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35326
35327 Reply:
35328 @table @samp
35329 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35330 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35331 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35332 @item @w{}
35333 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35334 @end table
35335
35336 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35337 @item vCtrlC
35338 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35339 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35340 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35341 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35342 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35343 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35344 variant.
35345
35346 Reply:
35347 @table @samp
35348 @item E @var{nn}
35349 for an error
35350 @item OK
35351 for success
35352 @end table
35353
35354 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35355 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35356 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35357 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35358
35359 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35360 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35361 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35362 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35363 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35364 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35365 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35366 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35367 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35368 packet is received.
35369
35370 Reply:
35371 @table @samp
35372 @item OK
35373 for success
35374 @item E @var{NN}
35375 for an error
35376 @end table
35377
35378 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35379 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35380 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35381 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35382 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35383 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35384 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35385 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35386 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35387 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35388 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35389 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35390
35391
35392 Reply:
35393 @table @samp
35394 @item OK
35395 for success
35396 @item E.memtype
35397 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35398 @item E @var{NN}
35399 for an error
35400 @end table
35401
35402 @item vFlashDone
35403 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35404 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35405 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35406 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35407 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35408 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35409 request is completed.
35410
35411 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35412 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35413 @anchor{vKill packet}
35414 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35415 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35416 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35417 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35418
35419 Reply:
35420 @table @samp
35421 @item E @var{nn}
35422 for an error
35423 @item OK
35424 for success
35425 @end table
35426
35427 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35428 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35429 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35430 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35431 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35432 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35433 state.
35434
35435 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35436
35437 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35438
35439 Reply:
35440 @table @samp
35441 @item E @var{nn}
35442 for an error
35443 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35444 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35445 @end table
35446
35447 @item vStopped
35448 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35449 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35450
35451 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35452 @anchor{X packet}
35453 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35454 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35455 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35456 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35457 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35458
35459 Reply:
35460 @table @samp
35461 @item OK
35462 for success
35463 @item E @var{NN}
35464 for an error
35465 @end table
35466
35467 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35468 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35469 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35470 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35471 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35472 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35473 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35474
35475 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35476 separately.
35477
35478 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35479 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35480 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35481 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35482 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35483 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35484
35485 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35486 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35487 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35488 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35489 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35490 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35491
35492 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35493 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35494 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35495 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35496 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35497 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35498 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35499 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35500 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35501 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35502
35503 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35504 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35505
35506 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35507 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35508
35509 @table @samp
35510
35511 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35512 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35513 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35514
35515 @end table
35516
35517 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35518 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35519 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35520 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35521 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35522 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35523 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35524
35525 @table @samp
35526
35527 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35528 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35529 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35530
35531 @end table
35532
35533 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35534
35535 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35536 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35537 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35538 target, is not defined.}
35539
35540 Reply:
35541 @table @samp
35542 @item OK
35543 success
35544 @item @w{}
35545 not supported
35546 @item E @var{NN}
35547 for an error
35548 @end table
35549
35550 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35551 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35552 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35553 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35554 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35555 address @var{addr}.
35556
35557 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35558 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35559 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35560
35561 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35562 movement.}
35563
35564 Reply:
35565 @table @samp
35566 @item OK
35567 success
35568 @item @w{}
35569 not supported
35570 @item E @var{NN}
35571 for an error
35572 @end table
35573
35574 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35575 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35576 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35577 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35578 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35579 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35580
35581 Reply:
35582 @table @samp
35583 @item OK
35584 success
35585 @item @w{}
35586 not supported
35587 @item E @var{NN}
35588 for an error
35589 @end table
35590
35591 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35592 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35593 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35594 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35595 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35596 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35597
35598 Reply:
35599 @table @samp
35600 @item OK
35601 success
35602 @item @w{}
35603 not supported
35604 @item E @var{NN}
35605 for an error
35606 @end table
35607
35608 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35609 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35610 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35611 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35612 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35613 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35614
35615 Reply:
35616 @table @samp
35617 @item OK
35618 success
35619 @item @w{}
35620 not supported
35621 @item E @var{NN}
35622 for an error
35623 @end table
35624
35625 @end table
35626
35627 @node Stop Reply Packets
35628 @section Stop Reply Packets
35629 @cindex stop reply packets
35630
35631 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35632 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35633 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35634 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35635 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35636 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35637 @value{GDBN} source code.
35638
35639 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35640 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35641 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35642 components.
35643
35644 @table @samp
35645
35646 @item S @var{AA}
35647 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35648 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35649 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35650
35651 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35652 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35653 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35654 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35655 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35656 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35657 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35658 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35659
35660 @itemize @bullet
35661 @item
35662 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35663 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35664 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35665 two-digit hex number.
35666
35667 @item
35668 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35669 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35670
35671 @item
35672 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35673 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35674
35675 @item
35676 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35677 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35678 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35679 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35680
35681 @item
35682 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35683 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35684 future.
35685 @end itemize
35686
35687 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35688
35689 @table @samp
35690 @item watch
35691 @itemx rwatch
35692 @itemx awatch
35693 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35694 hex.
35695
35696 @item syscall_entry
35697 @itemx syscall_return
35698 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35699 syscall number, in hex.
35700
35701 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35702 @item library
35703 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35704 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35705 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35706
35707 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35708 @item replaylog
35709 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35710 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35711 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35712 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35713 for more information.
35714
35715 @item swbreak
35716 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35717 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35718 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35719 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35720 part must be left empty.
35721
35722 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35723 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35724 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35725 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35726 address.
35727
35728 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35729 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35730 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35731 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35732 indicating support.
35733
35734 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35735
35736 @item hwbreak
35737 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35738 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35739
35740 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35741 apply.
35742
35743 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35744 @item fork
35745 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35746 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35747 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35748 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35749 fork events.
35750
35751 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35752 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35753 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35754 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35755 indicating support.
35756
35757 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35758 @item vfork
35759 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35760 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35761 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35762 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35763 vfork events.
35764
35765 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35766 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35767 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35768 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35769 indicating support.
35770
35771 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35772 @item vforkdone
35773 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35774 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35775 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35776 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35777 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35778
35779 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35780 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35781 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35782 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35783 indicating support.
35784
35785 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35786 @item exec
35787 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35788 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35789 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35790
35791 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35792 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35793 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35794 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35795 indicating support.
35796
35797 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35798 @anchor{thread create event}
35799 @item create
35800 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35801 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35802 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35803 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35804 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35805
35806 @end table
35807
35808 @item W @var{AA}
35809 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35810 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35811 applicable to certain targets.
35812
35813 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35814 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35815 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35816 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35817
35818 @item X @var{AA}
35819 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35820 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35821
35822 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35823 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35824 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35825 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35826
35827 @anchor{thread exit event}
35828 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
35829 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
35830
35831 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
35832 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
35833 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
35834
35835 @item N
35836 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
35837 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
35838 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
35839 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
35840 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
35841 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
35842 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
35843 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
35844 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
35845 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
35846 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
35847 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
35848 support.
35849
35850 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35851 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35852 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35853 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35854 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35855
35856 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35857 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35858 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35859 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35860 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35861 system calls.
35862
35863 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35864 this very system call.
35865
35866 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35867 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35868 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35869 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35870 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35871 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35872
35873 @end table
35874
35875 @node General Query Packets
35876 @section General Query Packets
35877 @cindex remote query requests
35878
35879 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35880 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35881 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35882 sending information to and from the stub.
35883
35884 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35885 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35886 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35887 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35888 conventions:
35889
35890 @itemize @bullet
35891 @item
35892 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35893 @item
35894 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35895 letter.
35896 @item
35897 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35898 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35899 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35900 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35901 @end itemize
35902
35903 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35904 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35905 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35906 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35907 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35908 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35909 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35910 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35911 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35912 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35913 packet.}.
35914
35915 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35916 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35917 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35918 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35919 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35920
35921 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35922
35923 @table @samp
35924
35925 @item QAgent:1
35926 @itemx QAgent:0
35927 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35928 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35929
35930 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35931 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35932 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35933 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35934 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35935 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35936 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35937 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35938 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35939 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35940 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35941
35942 @item qC
35943 @cindex current thread, remote request
35944 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35945 Return the current thread ID.
35946
35947 Reply:
35948 @table @samp
35949 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35950 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35951 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35952 @item @r{(anything else)}
35953 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35954 @end table
35955
35956 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35957 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35958 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35959 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35960 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35961 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35962 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35963 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35964
35965 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35966 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35967 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35968 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35969 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35970 detect trailing zeros.
35971
35972 Reply:
35973 @table @samp
35974 @item E @var{NN}
35975 An error (such as memory fault)
35976 @item C @var{crc32}
35977 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35978 @end table
35979
35980 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35981 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35982 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35983 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35984 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35985 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35986 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35987 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35988 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35989 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35990 randomization.
35991
35992 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35993
35994 Reply:
35995 @table @samp
35996 @item OK
35997 The request succeeded.
35998
35999 @item E @var{nn}
36000 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36001
36002 @item @w{}
36003 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36004 by the stub.
36005 @end table
36006
36007 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36008 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36009 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36010 address space randomization.
36011
36012 @item qfThreadInfo
36013 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36014 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36015 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36016 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36017 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36018 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36019 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36020 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36021 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36022 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36023
36024 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36025
36026 Reply:
36027 @table @samp
36028 @item m @var{thread-id}
36029 A single thread ID
36030 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36031 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36032 @item l
36033 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36034 @end table
36035
36036 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36037 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36038 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36039 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36040 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36041 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36042 fields.
36043
36044 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36045 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36046 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36047 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36048 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36049
36050 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36051 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36052 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36053 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36054 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36055
36056 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36057 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36058
36059 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36060 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36061 information associated with the variable.)
36062
36063 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36064 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36065 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36066 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36067 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36068 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36069
36070 Reply:
36071 @table @samp
36072 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36073 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36074 local storage requested.
36075
36076 @item E @var{nn}
36077 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36078
36079 @item @w{}
36080 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36081 @end table
36082
36083 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36084 @cindex get thread information block address
36085 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36086 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36087
36088 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36089
36090 Reply:
36091 @table @samp
36092 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36093 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36094 thread information block.
36095
36096 @item E @var{nn}
36097 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36098 address could not be retrieved.
36099
36100 @item @w{}
36101 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36102 @end table
36103
36104 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36105 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36106 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36107 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36108 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36109 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36110 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36111
36112 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36113
36114 Reply:
36115 @table @samp
36116 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36117 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36118 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36119 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36120 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36121 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36122 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36123 @end table
36124
36125 @item qOffsets
36126 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36127 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36128 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36129 image.
36130
36131 Reply:
36132 @table @samp
36133 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36134 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36135 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36136 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36137 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36138 segments by the supplied offsets.
36139
36140 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36141 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36142 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36143
36144 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36145 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36146 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36147 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36148 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36149 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36150 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36151 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36152 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36153 @end table
36154
36155 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36156 @cindex thread information, remote request
36157 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36158 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36159 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36160 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36161
36162 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36163 (see below).
36164
36165 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36166
36167 @item QNonStop:1
36168 @itemx QNonStop:0
36169 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36170 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36171 @anchor{QNonStop}
36172 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36173 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36174
36175 Reply:
36176 @table @samp
36177 @item OK
36178 The request succeeded.
36179
36180 @item E @var{nn}
36181 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36182
36183 @item @w{}
36184 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36185 the stub.
36186 @end table
36187
36188 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36189 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36190 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36191 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36192
36193 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36194 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36195 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36196 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36197 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36198 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36199 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36200
36201 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36202 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36203 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36204
36205 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36206 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36207 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36208 report the requested syscalls.
36209
36210 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36211 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36212
36213 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36214 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36215 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36216 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36217
36218 Reply:
36219 @table @samp
36220 @item OK
36221 The request succeeded.
36222
36223 @item E @var{nn}
36224 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36225
36226 @item @w{}
36227 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36228 the stub.
36229 @end table
36230
36231 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36232 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36233 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36234 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36235
36236 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36237 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36238 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36239 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36240 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36241 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36242 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36243 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36244 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36245 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36246 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36247 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36248 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36249
36250 Reply:
36251 @table @samp
36252 @item OK
36253 The request succeeded.
36254
36255 @item E @var{nn}
36256 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36257
36258 @item @w{}
36259 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36260 the stub.
36261 @end table
36262
36263 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36264 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36265 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36266 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36267
36268 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36269 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36270 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36271 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36272 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36273 Others should be silently discarded.
36274
36275 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36276 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36277 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36278 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36279 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36280 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36281 signals.
36282
36283 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36284 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36285
36286 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36287 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36288 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36289 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36290 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36291
36292 Reply:
36293 @table @samp
36294 @item OK
36295 The request succeeded.
36296
36297 @item E @var{nn}
36298 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36299
36300 @item @w{}
36301 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36302 by the stub.
36303 @end table
36304
36305 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36306 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36307 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36308 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36309
36310 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36311 @item QThreadEvents:1
36312 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36313 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36314 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36315
36316 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36317 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36318 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36319 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36320 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36321 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36322 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36323 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36324 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36325 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36326
36327 Reply:
36328 @table @samp
36329 @item OK
36330 The request succeeded.
36331
36332 @item E @var{nn}
36333 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36334
36335 @item @w{}
36336 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36337 the stub.
36338 @end table
36339
36340 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36341 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36342
36343 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36344 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36345 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36346 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36347 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36348 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36349 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36350 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36351 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36352
36353 Reply:
36354 @table @samp
36355 @item OK
36356 A command response with no output.
36357 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36358 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36359 @item E @var{NN}
36360 Indicate a badly formed request.
36361 @item @w{}
36362 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36363 @end table
36364
36365 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36366 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36367 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36368 packets.)
36369
36370 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36371 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36372 @ifnotinfo
36373 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36374 @end ifnotinfo
36375 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36376 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36377 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36378 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36379 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36380
36381 Reply:
36382 @table @samp
36383 @item 0
36384 The pattern was not found.
36385 @item 1,address
36386 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36387 @item E @var{NN}
36388 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36389 @item @w{}
36390 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36391 @end table
36392
36393 @item QStartNoAckMode
36394 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36395 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36396 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36397 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36398
36399 Reply:
36400 @table @samp
36401 @item OK
36402 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36403 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36404 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36405 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36406 @item @w{}
36407 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36408 @end table
36409
36410 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36411 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36412 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36413 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36414 @anchor{qSupported}
36415 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36416 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36417 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36418 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36419 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36420 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36421 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36422 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36423 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36424 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36425 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36426 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36427 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36428 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36429
36430 Reply:
36431 @table @samp
36432 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36433 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36434 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36435 possible forms).
36436 @item @w{}
36437 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36438 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36439 @end table
36440
36441 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36442 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36443 are:
36444
36445 @table @samp
36446 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36447 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36448 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36449 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36450 @item @var{name}+
36451 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36452 need an associated value.
36453 @item @var{name}-
36454 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36455 @item @var{name}?
36456 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36457 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36458 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36459 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36460 @end table
36461
36462 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36463 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36464 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36465 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36466 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36467
36468 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36469 are defined:
36470
36471 @table @samp
36472 @item multiprocess
36473 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36474 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36475 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36476 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36477 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36478
36479 @item xmlRegisters
36480 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36481 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36482 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36483 description.
36484
36485 @item qRelocInsn
36486 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36487 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36488 instruction reply packet}).
36489
36490 @item swbreak
36491 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36492 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36493
36494 @item hwbreak
36495 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36496 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36497
36498 @item fork-events
36499 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36500 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36501 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36502 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36503
36504 @item vfork-events
36505 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36506 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36507 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36508 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36509
36510 @item exec-events
36511 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36512 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36513 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36514 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36515
36516 @item vContSupported
36517 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36518 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36519 @end table
36520
36521 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36522 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36523 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36524 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36525 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36526 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36527 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36528 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36529 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36530 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36531 all the features it supports.
36532
36533 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36534 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36535
36536 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36537 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36538 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36539 form response.
36540
36541 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36542 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36543 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36544 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36545
36546 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36547 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36548 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36549 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36550 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36551
36552 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36553
36554 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36555 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36556 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36557 @item Feature Name
36558 @tab Value Required
36559 @tab Default
36560 @tab Probe Allowed
36561
36562 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36563 @tab Yes
36564 @tab @samp{-}
36565 @tab No
36566
36567 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36568 @tab No
36569 @tab @samp{-}
36570 @tab Yes
36571
36572 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36573 @tab No
36574 @tab @samp{-}
36575 @tab Yes
36576
36577 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36578 @tab No
36579 @tab @samp{-}
36580 @tab Yes
36581
36582 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36583 @tab No
36584 @tab @samp{-}
36585 @tab Yes
36586
36587 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36588 @tab No
36589 @tab @samp{-}
36590 @tab Yes
36591
36592 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36593 @tab No
36594 @tab @samp{-}
36595 @tab Yes
36596
36597 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36598 @tab No
36599 @tab @samp{-}
36600 @tab Yes
36601
36602 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36603 @tab No
36604 @tab @samp{-}
36605 @tab No
36606
36607 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36608 @tab No
36609 @tab @samp{-}
36610 @tab Yes
36611
36612 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36613 @tab No
36614 @tab @samp{-}
36615 @tab Yes
36616
36617 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36618 @tab No
36619 @tab @samp{-}
36620 @tab Yes
36621
36622 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36623 @tab No
36624 @tab @samp{-}
36625 @tab Yes
36626
36627 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36628 @tab No
36629 @tab @samp{-}
36630 @tab Yes
36631
36632 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36633 @tab No
36634 @tab @samp{-}
36635 @tab Yes
36636
36637 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36638 @tab No
36639 @tab @samp{-}
36640 @tab Yes
36641
36642 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36643 @tab No
36644 @tab @samp{-}
36645 @tab Yes
36646
36647 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36648 @tab No
36649 @tab @samp{-}
36650 @tab Yes
36651
36652 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36653 @tab No
36654 @tab @samp{-}
36655 @tab Yes
36656
36657 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36658 @tab Yes
36659 @tab @samp{-}
36660 @tab Yes
36661
36662 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36663 @tab Yes
36664 @tab @samp{-}
36665 @tab Yes
36666
36667 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36668 @tab Yes
36669 @tab @samp{-}
36670 @tab Yes
36671
36672 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36673 @tab Yes
36674 @tab @samp{-}
36675 @tab Yes
36676
36677 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36678 @tab Yes
36679 @tab @samp{-}
36680 @tab Yes
36681
36682 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36683 @tab No
36684 @tab @samp{-}
36685 @tab Yes
36686
36687 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36688 @tab No
36689 @tab @samp{-}
36690 @tab Yes
36691
36692 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36693 @tab No
36694 @tab @samp{-}
36695 @tab Yes
36696
36697 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36698 @tab No
36699 @tab @samp{-}
36700 @tab Yes
36701
36702 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36703 @tab No
36704 @tab @samp{-}
36705 @tab No
36706
36707 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36708 @tab No
36709 @tab @samp{-}
36710 @tab No
36711
36712 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36713 @tab No
36714 @tab @samp{-}
36715 @tab No
36716
36717 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36718 @tab No
36719 @tab @samp{-}
36720 @tab No
36721
36722 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36723 @tab No
36724 @tab @samp{-}
36725 @tab No
36726
36727 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36728 @tab No
36729 @tab @samp{-}
36730 @tab No
36731
36732 @item @samp{QAgent}
36733 @tab No
36734 @tab @samp{-}
36735 @tab No
36736
36737 @item @samp{QAllow}
36738 @tab No
36739 @tab @samp{-}
36740 @tab No
36741
36742 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36743 @tab No
36744 @tab @samp{-}
36745 @tab No
36746
36747 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36748 @tab No
36749 @tab @samp{-}
36750 @tab No
36751
36752 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36753 @tab No
36754 @tab @samp{-}
36755 @tab No
36756
36757 @item @samp{tracenz}
36758 @tab No
36759 @tab @samp{-}
36760 @tab No
36761
36762 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36763 @tab No
36764 @tab @samp{-}
36765 @tab No
36766
36767 @item @samp{swbreak}
36768 @tab No
36769 @tab @samp{-}
36770 @tab No
36771
36772 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36773 @tab No
36774 @tab @samp{-}
36775 @tab No
36776
36777 @item @samp{fork-events}
36778 @tab No
36779 @tab @samp{-}
36780 @tab No
36781
36782 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36783 @tab No
36784 @tab @samp{-}
36785 @tab No
36786
36787 @item @samp{exec-events}
36788 @tab No
36789 @tab @samp{-}
36790 @tab No
36791
36792 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36793 @tab No
36794 @tab @samp{-}
36795 @tab No
36796
36797 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36798 @tab No
36799 @tab @samp{-}
36800 @tab No
36801
36802 @end multitable
36803
36804 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36805
36806 @table @samp
36807 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36808 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36809 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36810 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36811 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36812 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36813 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36814 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36815 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36816 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36817
36818 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36819 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36820 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36821
36822 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36823 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36824 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36825
36826 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36827 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36828 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36829
36830 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36831 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36832 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36833
36834 @item qXfer:features:read
36835 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36836 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36837
36838 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36839 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36840 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36841
36842 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36843 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36844 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36845
36846 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36847 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36848 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36849 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36850
36851 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36852 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36853 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36854
36855 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36856 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36857 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36858
36859 @item qXfer:spu:read
36860 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36861 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36862
36863 @item qXfer:spu:write
36864 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36865 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36866
36867 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36868 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36869 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36870
36871 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36872 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36873 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36874
36875 @item qXfer:threads:read
36876 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36877 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36878
36879 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36880 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36881 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36882
36883 @item qXfer:uib:read
36884 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36885 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36886
36887 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36888 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36889 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36890
36891 @item QNonStop
36892 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36893 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36894
36895 @item QCatchSyscalls
36896 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36897 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
36898
36899 @item QPassSignals
36900 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36901 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36902
36903 @item QStartNoAckMode
36904 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36905 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36906
36907 @item multiprocess
36908 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36909 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36910 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36911 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36912 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36913 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36914 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36915 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36916 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36917 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36918 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36919
36920 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36921 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36922 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36923
36924 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36925 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36926 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36927 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36928
36929 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36930 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36931 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36932
36933 @item ReverseContinue
36934 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36935 (@pxref{bc}).
36936
36937 @item ReverseStep
36938 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36939 (@pxref{bs}).
36940
36941 @item TracepointSource
36942 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36943 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36944
36945 @item QAgent
36946 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36947
36948 @item QAllow
36949 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36950
36951 @item QDisableRandomization
36952 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36953
36954 @item StaticTracepoint
36955 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36956 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36957
36958 @item InstallInTrace
36959 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36960 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36961
36962 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36963 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36964 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36965 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36966
36967 @item QTBuffer:size
36968 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36969 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36970
36971 @item tracenz
36972 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36973 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36974 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36975
36976 @item BreakpointCommands
36977 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36978 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36979 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36980
36981 @item Qbtrace:off
36982 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36983
36984 @item Qbtrace:bts
36985 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36986
36987 @item Qbtrace:pt
36988 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
36989
36990 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36991 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36992
36993 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
36994 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
36995
36996 @item swbreak
36997 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36998 breakpoints.
36999
37000 @item hwbreak
37001 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37002 breakpoints.
37003
37004 @item fork-events
37005 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37006
37007 @item vfork-events
37008 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37009 and vforkdone events.
37010
37011 @item exec-events
37012 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37013
37014 @item vContSupported
37015 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37016 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37017
37018 @item QThreadEvents
37019 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37020
37021 @item no-resumed
37022 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37023
37024 @end table
37025
37026 @item qSymbol::
37027 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37028 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37029 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37030 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37031
37032 Reply:
37033 @table @samp
37034 @item OK
37035 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37036 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37037 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37038 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37039 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37040 below.
37041 @end table
37042
37043 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37044 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37045
37046 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37047 target has previously requested.
37048
37049 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37050 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37051 will be empty.
37052
37053 Reply:
37054 @table @samp
37055 @item OK
37056 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37057 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37058 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37059 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37060 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37061 @end table
37062
37063 @item qTBuffer
37064 @itemx QTBuffer
37065 @itemx QTDisconnected
37066 @itemx QTDP
37067 @itemx QTDPsrc
37068 @itemx QTDV
37069 @itemx qTfP
37070 @itemx qTfV
37071 @itemx QTFrame
37072 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37073
37074 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37075
37076 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37077 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37078 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37079 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37080 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37081 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37082 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37083 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37084 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37085 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37086 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37087
37088 Reply:
37089 @table @samp
37090 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37091 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37092 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37093 the thread's attributes.
37094 @end table
37095
37096 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37097 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37098 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37099 packets.)
37100
37101 @item QTNotes
37102 @itemx qTP
37103 @itemx QTSave
37104 @itemx qTsP
37105 @itemx qTsV
37106 @itemx QTStart
37107 @itemx QTStop
37108 @itemx QTEnable
37109 @itemx QTDisable
37110 @itemx QTinit
37111 @itemx QTro
37112 @itemx qTStatus
37113 @itemx qTV
37114 @itemx qTfSTM
37115 @itemx qTsSTM
37116 @itemx qTSTMat
37117 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37118
37119 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37120 @cindex read special object, remote request
37121 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37122 @anchor{qXfer read}
37123 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37124 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37125 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37126 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37127 additional details about what data to access.
37128
37129 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37130 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37131 formats, listed below.
37132
37133 @table @samp
37134 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37135 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37136 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37137 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37138
37139 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37140 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37141
37142 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37143 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37144
37145 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37146 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37147 packet may have one of the following values:
37148
37149 @table @code
37150 @item all
37151 Returns all available branch trace.
37152
37153 @item new
37154 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37155 the last read request.
37156
37157 @item delta
37158 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37159 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37160 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37161 used to stitch traces together.
37162
37163 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37164 @end table
37165
37166 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37167 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37168
37169 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37170 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37171
37172 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37173 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37174
37175 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37176 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37177
37178 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37179 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37180 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37181 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37182 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37183 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37184 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37185
37186 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37187 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37188
37189 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37190 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37191 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37192 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37193 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37194
37195 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37196 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37197
37198 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37199 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37200 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37201 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37202 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37203
37204 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37205 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37206 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37207
37208 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37209 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37210
37211 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37212 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37213 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37214 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37215 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37216 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37217 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37218 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37219
37220 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37221 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37222
37223 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37224 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37225
37226 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37227 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37228 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37229 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37230
37231 @table @code
37232 @item start=@var{address}
37233 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37234 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37235 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37236 chosen as the starting point.
37237
37238 @item prev=@var{address}
37239 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37240 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37241 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37242 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37243 exists prior to the starting point.
37244
37245 @end table
37246
37247 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37248 ignored.
37249
37250 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37251 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37252 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37253 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37254 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37255
37256 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37257 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37258
37259 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37260 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37261
37262 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37263 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37264 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37265 Action Lists}.
37266
37267 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37268 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37269 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37270
37271 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37272 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37273 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37274 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37275 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37276
37277 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37278 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37279 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37280
37281 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37282 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37283 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37284 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37285 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37286 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37287 in that context to be accessed.
37288
37289 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37290 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37291 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37292
37293 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37294 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37295 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37296 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37297 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37298
37299 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37300 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37301
37302 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37303 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37304
37305 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37306 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37307 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37308
37309 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37310 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37311
37312 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37313 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37314
37315 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37316 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37317
37318 This packet is not probed by default.
37319
37320 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37321 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37322 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37323 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37324 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37325
37326 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37327 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37328
37329 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37330 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37331 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37332 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37333
37334 @end table
37335
37336 Reply:
37337 @table @samp
37338 @item m @var{data}
37339 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37340 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37341 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37342 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37343 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37344 request.
37345
37346 @item l @var{data}
37347 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37348 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37349 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37350
37351 @item l
37352 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37353 There is no more data to be read.
37354
37355 @item E00
37356 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37357
37358 @item E @var{nn}
37359 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37360 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37361
37362 @item @w{}
37363 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37364 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37365 @end table
37366
37367 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37368 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37369 @anchor{qXfer write}
37370 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37371 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37372 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37373 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37374 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37375 to access.
37376
37377 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37378 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37379 formats, listed below.
37380
37381 @table @samp
37382 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37383 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37384 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37385 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37386 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37387
37388 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37389 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37390 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37391
37392 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37393 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37394 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37395 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37396 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37397 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37398 in that context to be accessed.
37399
37400 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37401 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37402 @end table
37403
37404 Reply:
37405 @table @samp
37406 @item @var{nn}
37407 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37408 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37409
37410 @item E00
37411 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37412
37413 @item E @var{nn}
37414 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37415 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37416
37417 @item @w{}
37418 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37419 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37420 @end table
37421
37422 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37423 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37424 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37425 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37426 must respond with an empty packet.
37427
37428 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37429 @cindex query attached, remote request
37430 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37431 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37432 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37433 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37434 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37435 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37436 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37437
37438 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37439 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37440 the @code{quit} command.
37441
37442 Reply:
37443 @table @samp
37444 @item 1
37445 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37446 @item 0
37447 The remote server created a new process.
37448 @item E @var{NN}
37449 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37450 @end table
37451
37452 @item Qbtrace:bts
37453 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37454
37455 Reply:
37456 @table @samp
37457 @item OK
37458 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37459 @item E.errtext
37460 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37461 @end table
37462
37463 @item Qbtrace:pt
37464 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37465
37466 Reply:
37467 @table @samp
37468 @item OK
37469 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37470 @item E.errtext
37471 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37472 @end table
37473
37474 @item Qbtrace:off
37475 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37476
37477 Reply:
37478 @table @samp
37479 @item OK
37480 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37481 @item E.errtext
37482 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37483 @end table
37484
37485 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37486 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37487 btrace recording method in bts format.
37488
37489 Reply:
37490 @table @samp
37491 @item OK
37492 The ring buffer size has been set.
37493 @item E.errtext
37494 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37495 @end table
37496
37497 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37498 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37499 btrace recording method in pt format.
37500
37501 Reply:
37502 @table @samp
37503 @item OK
37504 The ring buffer size has been set.
37505 @item E.errtext
37506 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37507 @end table
37508
37509 @end table
37510
37511 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37512 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37513
37514 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37515 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37516 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37517
37518 @menu
37519 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37520 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37521 @end menu
37522
37523 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37524 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37525
37526 @menu
37527 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37528 @end menu
37529
37530 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37531 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37532 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37533
37534 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37535
37536 @table @r
37537
37538 @item 2
37539 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37540
37541 @item 3
37542 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37543
37544 @item 4
37545 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37546
37547 @end table
37548
37549 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37550 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37551
37552 @menu
37553 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37554 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37555 @end menu
37556
37557 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37558 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37559 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37560
37561 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37562 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37563 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37564 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37565 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37566 most-significant -- least-significant.
37567
37568 @table @r
37569
37570 @item MIPS32
37571 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37572 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37573 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37574
37575 @item MIPS64
37576 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37577 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37578 as @code{MIPS32}.
37579
37580 @end table
37581
37582 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37583 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37584 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37585
37586 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37587
37588 @table @r
37589
37590 @item 2
37591 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37592
37593 @item 3
37594 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37595
37596 @item 4
37597 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37598
37599 @item 5
37600 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37601
37602 @end table
37603
37604 @node Tracepoint Packets
37605 @section Tracepoint Packets
37606 @cindex tracepoint packets
37607 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37608
37609 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37610 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37611
37612 @table @samp
37613
37614 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37615 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37616 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37617 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37618 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37619 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37620 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37621 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37622 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37623 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37624 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37625 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37626 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37627 actions.
37628
37629 Replies:
37630 @table @samp
37631 @item OK
37632 The packet was understood and carried out.
37633 @item qRelocInsn
37634 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37635 @item @w{}
37636 The packet was not recognized.
37637 @end table
37638
37639 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37640 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37641 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37642 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37643 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37644 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37645 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37646
37647 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37648 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37649 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37650 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37651 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37652 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37653 tracepoint actions.
37654
37655 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37656 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37657 following forms:
37658
37659 @table @samp
37660
37661 @item R @var{mask}
37662 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37663 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37664 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37665 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37666 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37667
37668 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37669 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37670 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37671 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37672 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37673 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37674 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37675
37676 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37677 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37678 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37679 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37680 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37681 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37682 packet).
37683
37684 @end table
37685
37686 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37687 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37688 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37689 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37690 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37691 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37692 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37693 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37694
37695 Replies:
37696 @table @samp
37697 @item OK
37698 The packet was understood and carried out.
37699 @item qRelocInsn
37700 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37701 @item @w{}
37702 The packet was not recognized.
37703 @end table
37704
37705 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37706 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37707 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37708 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37709 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37710 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37711 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37712 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37713
37714 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37715 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37716 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37717 fit in a single packet.
37718 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37719 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37720
37721 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37722 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37723 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37724 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37725
37726 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37727 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37728 query packets.
37729
37730 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37731 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37732 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37733 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37734 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37735 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37736 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37737 be found.
37738
37739 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37740 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37741 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37742 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37743 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37744 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37745 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37746 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37747 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37748 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37749 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37750 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37751 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37752 variable.
37753
37754 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37755 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37756 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37757 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37758 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37759
37760 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37761 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37762 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37763 one of the following forms:
37764
37765 @table @samp
37766 @item F @var{f}
37767 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37768 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37769 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37770
37771 @item T @var{t}
37772 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37773 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37774
37775 @end table
37776
37777 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37778 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37779 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37780 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37781
37782 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37783 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37784 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37785 is a hexadecimal number.
37786
37787 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37788 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37789 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37790 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37791 numbers.
37792
37793 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37794 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37795 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37796
37797 @item qTMinFTPILen
37798 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37799 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37800 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37801 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37802 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37803 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37804 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37805 arrange for that.
37806
37807 Replies:
37808
37809 @table @samp
37810 @item 0
37811 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37812 @item @var{length}
37813 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37814 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37815 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37816 regardless of size.
37817 @item E
37818 An error has occurred.
37819 @item @w{}
37820 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37821 @end table
37822
37823 @item QTStart
37824 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37825 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37826 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37827 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37828 instruction reply packet}).
37829
37830 @item QTStop
37831 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37832 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37833
37834 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37835 @anchor{QTEnable}
37836 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37837 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37838 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37839 of data from it will resume.
37840
37841 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37842 @anchor{QTDisable}
37843 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37844 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37845 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37846 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37847
37848 @item QTinit
37849 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37850 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37851
37852 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37853 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37854 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37855 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37856 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37857
37858 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37859 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37860 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37861 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37862
37863 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37864 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37865 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37866 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37867 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37868 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37869
37870 @item qTStatus
37871 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37872 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37873
37874 The reply has the form:
37875
37876 @table @samp
37877
37878 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37879 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37880 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37881 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37882
37883 @end table
37884
37885 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37886 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37887
37888 @table @samp
37889
37890 @item tnotrun:0
37891 No trace has been run yet.
37892
37893 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37894 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37895 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37896 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37897 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37898
37899 @item tfull:0
37900 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37901
37902 @item tdisconnected:0
37903 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37904
37905 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37906 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37907
37908 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37909 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37910 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37911 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37912 is hex encoded.
37913
37914 @item tunknown:0
37915 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37916
37917 @end table
37918
37919 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37920 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37921 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37922 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37923 trace.
37924
37925 @table @samp
37926
37927 @item tframes:@var{n}
37928 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37929
37930 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37931 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37932 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37933
37934 @item tsize:@var{n}
37935 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37936
37937 @item tfree:@var{n}
37938 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37939
37940 @item circular:@var{n}
37941 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37942 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37943 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37944 and may fill up.
37945
37946 @item disconn:@var{n}
37947 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37948 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37949 that the trace run will stop.
37950
37951 @end table
37952
37953 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37954 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37955 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37956 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37957 address @var{addr}.
37958
37959 Replies:
37960 @table @samp
37961 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37962 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37963 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37964 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37965 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37966
37967 @end table
37968
37969 @item qTV:@var{var}
37970 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37971 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37972 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37973
37974 Replies:
37975 @table @samp
37976 @item V@var{value}
37977 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37978 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37979 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37980 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37981 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37982 program is running.
37983
37984 @item U
37985 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37986 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37987 was not collected.
37988 @end table
37989
37990 @item qTfP
37991 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37992 @itemx qTsP
37993 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37994 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37995 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37996 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37997 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37998 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37999
38000 @item qTfV
38001 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38002 @itemx qTsV
38003 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38004 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38005 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38006 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38007 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38008 trace state variables.
38009
38010 @item qTfSTM
38011 @itemx qTsSTM
38012 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38013 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38014 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38015 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38016 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38017 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38018 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38019 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38020
38021 Reply:
38022 @table @samp
38023 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38024 A single marker
38025 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38026 a comma-separated list of markers
38027 @item l
38028 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38029 @item E @var{nn}
38030 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38031 @item @w{}
38032 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38033 stub.
38034 @end table
38035
38036 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38037 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38038
38039 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38040 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38041 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38042 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38043 @dfn{last}).
38044
38045 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38046 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38047 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38048 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38049 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38050 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38051 tracepoint markers.
38052
38053 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38054 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38055 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38056 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38057 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38058 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38059
38060 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38061 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38062 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38063 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38064 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38065 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38066 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38067 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38068 available.
38069
38070 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38071 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38072 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38073
38074 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38075 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38076 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38077 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38078 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38079 use whatever size it prefers.
38080
38081 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38082 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38083 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38084 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38085 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38086
38087 @end table
38088
38089 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38090 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38091 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38092 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38093 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38094 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38095 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38096 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38097 it had executed in the original location.
38098
38099 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38100 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38101 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38102 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38103 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38104 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38105 format of the request is:
38106
38107 @table @samp
38108 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38109
38110 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38111 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38112 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38113 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38114 memory starting at @var{to}.
38115 @end table
38116
38117 Replies:
38118 @table @samp
38119 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38120 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38121 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38122 @item E @var{NN}
38123 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38124 relocating the instruction.
38125 @end table
38126
38127 @node Host I/O Packets
38128 @section Host I/O Packets
38129 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38130 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38131
38132 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38133 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38134 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38135 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38136 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38137 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38138 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38139 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38140 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38141 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38142
38143 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38144 its arguments. They have this format:
38145
38146 @table @samp
38147
38148 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38149 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38150 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38151 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38152 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38153 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38154 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38155 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38156 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38157
38158 @end table
38159
38160 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38161
38162 @table @samp
38163
38164 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38165 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38166 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38167 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38168 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38169 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38170 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38171 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38172 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38173 @var{attachment}.
38174
38175 @item @w{}
38176 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38177
38178 @end table
38179
38180 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38181
38182 @table @samp
38183 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38184 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38185 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38186 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38187 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38188 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38189 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38190
38191 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38192 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38193 -1 if an error occurs.
38194
38195 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38196 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38197 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38198 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38199 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38200 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38201 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38202 @var{count} was zero.
38203
38204 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38205 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38206 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38207 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38208 some characters were escaped.
38209
38210 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38211 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38212 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38213 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38214 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38215 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38216 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38217 error occurred.
38218
38219 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38220 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38221 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38222 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38223 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38224 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38225
38226 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38227 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38228 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38229
38230 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38231 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38232 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38233
38234 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38235 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38236 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38237 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38238 some characters were escaped.
38239
38240 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38241 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38242 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38243 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38244 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38245 inferior(s).
38246
38247 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38248 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38249 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38250 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38251 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38252 operation.
38253
38254 @end table
38255
38256 @node Interrupts
38257 @section Interrupts
38258 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38259 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38260
38261 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38262 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38263 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38264 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38265
38266 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38267 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38268 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38269 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38270 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38271
38272 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38273 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38274 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38275 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38276 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38277 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38278 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38279 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38280
38281 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38282 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38283 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38284
38285 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38286 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38287 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38288 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38289 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38290 @code{0x03}.
38291
38292 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38293 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38294 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38295 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38296 currently-executing threads and processes.
38297 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38298 running program, it should send one of the stop
38299 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38300 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38301 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38302 Interrupts received while the
38303 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38304 it is resumed next time.
38305
38306 @node Notification Packets
38307 @section Notification Packets
38308 @cindex notification packets
38309 @cindex packets, notification
38310
38311 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38312 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38313 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38314 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38315 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38316 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38317 is not a problem.
38318
38319 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38320 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38321 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38322 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38323 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38324 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38325 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38326
38327 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38328 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38329
38330 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38331 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38332 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38333 not they understand it.
38334
38335 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38336 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38337 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38338 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38339 recipients.
38340
38341 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38342 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38343 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38344 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38345 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38346
38347 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38348 @table @samp
38349 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38350 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38351 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38352 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38353 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38354 @item @var{ack}
38355 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38356 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38357 @end table
38358
38359 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38360 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38361
38362 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38363 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38364 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38365 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38366 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38367 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38368 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38369 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38370 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38371 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38372
38373 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38374 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38375 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38376 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38377 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38378 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38379
38380 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38381 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38382 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38383 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38384 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38385
38386 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38387 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38388 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38389 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38390 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38391 normally.
38392
38393 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38394 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38395 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38396 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38397 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38398 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38399 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38400 the process shall be repeated.
38401
38402 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38403 following example:
38404 @smallexample
38405 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38406 @code{...}
38407 -> @code{vStopped}
38408 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38409 -> @code{vStopped}
38410 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38411 -> @code{vStopped}
38412 <- @code{OK}
38413 @end smallexample
38414
38415 The following notifications are defined:
38416 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38417
38418 @item Notification
38419 @tab Ack
38420 @tab Event
38421 @tab Description
38422
38423 @item Stop
38424 @tab vStopped
38425 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38426 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38427 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38428 @value{GDBN}.
38429 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38430
38431 @end multitable
38432
38433 @node Remote Non-Stop
38434 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38435
38436 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38437 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38438 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38439 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38440
38441 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38442 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38443 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38444 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38445 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38446 probe the target state after a mode change.
38447
38448 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38449 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38450 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38451 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38452 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38453 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38454 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38455 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38456 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38457 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38458 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38459
38460 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38461 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38462 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38463 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38464 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38465 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38466 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38467 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38468 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38469 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38470 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38471 @samp{OK}.
38472
38473 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38474 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38475 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38476 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38477 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38478 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38479 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38480 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38481 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38482 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38483 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38484 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38485 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38486
38487 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38488 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38489
38490 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38491 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38492 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38493 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38494 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38495 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38496 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38497
38498 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38499 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38500 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38501 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38502 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38503
38504 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38505 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38506 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38507 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38508
38509 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38510 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38511 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38512 @pxref{qSupported}.
38513 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38514 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38515 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38516 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38517 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38518 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38519 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38520
38521 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38522 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38523 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38524 connection.
38525 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38526 new connection is established,
38527 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38528 for the current connection, once disabled.
38529
38530 @node Examples
38531 @section Examples
38532
38533 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38534 does not get any direct output:
38535
38536 @smallexample
38537 -> @code{R00}
38538 <- @code{+}
38539 @emph{target restarts}
38540 -> @code{?}
38541 <- @code{+}
38542 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38543 -> @code{+}
38544 @end smallexample
38545
38546 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38547
38548 @smallexample
38549 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38550 <- @code{+}
38551 -> @code{s}
38552 <- @code{+}
38553 @emph{time passes}
38554 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38555 -> @code{+}
38556 -> @code{g}
38557 <- @code{+}
38558 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38559 -> @code{+}
38560 @end smallexample
38561
38562 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38563 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38564 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38565
38566 @menu
38567 * File-I/O Overview::
38568 * Protocol Basics::
38569 * The F Request Packet::
38570 * The F Reply Packet::
38571 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38572 * Console I/O::
38573 * List of Supported Calls::
38574 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38575 * Constants::
38576 * File-I/O Examples::
38577 @end menu
38578
38579 @node File-I/O Overview
38580 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38581 @cindex file-i/o overview
38582
38583 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38584 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38585 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38586 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38587 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38588 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38589
38590 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38591 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38592 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38593 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38594 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38595
38596 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38597 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38598 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38599 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38600 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38601 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38602 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38603
38604 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38605 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38606 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38607 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38608 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38609
38610 @smallexample
38611 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38612 <- target requests 'system call X'
38613 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38614 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38615 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38616 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38617 @end smallexample
38618
38619 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38620 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38621 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38622 system are not supported by this protocol.
38623
38624 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38625
38626 @node Protocol Basics
38627 @subsection Protocol Basics
38628 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38629
38630 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38631 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38632 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38633 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38634 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38635 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38636 to call the appropriate host system call:
38637
38638 @itemize @bullet
38639 @item
38640 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38641
38642 @item
38643 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38644 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38645 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38646 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38647
38648 @end itemize
38649
38650 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38651
38652 @itemize @bullet
38653 @item
38654 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38655 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38656 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38657 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38658 packet.
38659
38660 @item
38661 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38662 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38663
38664 @item
38665 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38666
38667 @item
38668 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38669
38670 @item
38671 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38672 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38673 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38674 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38675 packet.
38676
38677 @end itemize
38678
38679 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38680 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38681
38682 @itemize @bullet
38683 @item
38684 Return value.
38685
38686 @item
38687 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38688
38689 @item
38690 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38691
38692 @end itemize
38693
38694 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38695 the latest continue or step action.
38696
38697 @node The F Request Packet
38698 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38699 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38700 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38701
38702 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38703
38704 @table @samp
38705 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38706
38707 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38708 This is just the name of the function.
38709
38710 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38711 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38712 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38713 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38714 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38715 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38716 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38717
38718 @end table
38719
38720
38721
38722 @node The F Reply Packet
38723 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38724 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38725 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38726
38727 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38728
38729 @table @samp
38730
38731 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38732
38733 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38734
38735 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38736 representation.
38737 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38738
38739 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38740 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38741 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38742
38743 @smallexample
38744 F0,0,C
38745 @end smallexample
38746
38747 @noindent
38748 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38749
38750 @smallexample
38751 F-1,4,C
38752 @end smallexample
38753
38754 @noindent
38755 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38756
38757 @end table
38758
38759
38760 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38761 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38762 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38763
38764 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38765 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38766 the target should behave as if it had
38767 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38768 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38769 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38770 packet.
38771
38772 It's important for the target to know in which
38773 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38774
38775 @itemize @bullet
38776 @item
38777 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38778
38779 @item
38780 The system call on the host has been finished.
38781
38782 @end itemize
38783
38784 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38785 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38786 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38787 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38788 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38789 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38790
38791 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38792 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38793 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38794 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38795 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38796 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38797 or the full action has been completed.
38798
38799 @node Console I/O
38800 @subsection Console I/O
38801 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38802
38803 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38804 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38805 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38806 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38807 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38808 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38809 conditions is met:
38810
38811 @itemize @bullet
38812 @item
38813 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38814 @code{read}
38815 system call is treated as finished.
38816
38817 @item
38818 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38819 newline.
38820
38821 @item
38822 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38823 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38824
38825 @end itemize
38826
38827 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38828 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38829 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38830 is stopped at the user's request.
38831
38832
38833 @node List of Supported Calls
38834 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38835 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38836
38837 @menu
38838 * open::
38839 * close::
38840 * read::
38841 * write::
38842 * lseek::
38843 * rename::
38844 * unlink::
38845 * stat/fstat::
38846 * gettimeofday::
38847 * isatty::
38848 * system::
38849 @end menu
38850
38851 @node open
38852 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38853 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38854
38855 @table @asis
38856 @item Synopsis:
38857 @smallexample
38858 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38859 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38860 @end smallexample
38861
38862 @item Request:
38863 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38864
38865 @noindent
38866 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38867
38868 @table @code
38869 @item O_CREAT
38870 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38871 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38872 are concerned.
38873
38874 @item O_EXCL
38875 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38876 an error and open() fails.
38877
38878 @item O_TRUNC
38879 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38880 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38881 truncated to zero length.
38882
38883 @item O_APPEND
38884 The file is opened in append mode.
38885
38886 @item O_RDONLY
38887 The file is opened for reading only.
38888
38889 @item O_WRONLY
38890 The file is opened for writing only.
38891
38892 @item O_RDWR
38893 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38894 @end table
38895
38896 @noindent
38897 Other bits are silently ignored.
38898
38899
38900 @noindent
38901 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38902
38903 @table @code
38904 @item S_IRUSR
38905 User has read permission.
38906
38907 @item S_IWUSR
38908 User has write permission.
38909
38910 @item S_IRGRP
38911 Group has read permission.
38912
38913 @item S_IWGRP
38914 Group has write permission.
38915
38916 @item S_IROTH
38917 Others have read permission.
38918
38919 @item S_IWOTH
38920 Others have write permission.
38921 @end table
38922
38923 @noindent
38924 Other bits are silently ignored.
38925
38926
38927 @item Return value:
38928 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38929 occurred.
38930
38931 @item Errors:
38932
38933 @table @code
38934 @item EEXIST
38935 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38936
38937 @item EISDIR
38938 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38939
38940 @item EACCES
38941 The requested access is not allowed.
38942
38943 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38944 @var{pathname} was too long.
38945
38946 @item ENOENT
38947 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38948
38949 @item ENODEV
38950 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38951
38952 @item EROFS
38953 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38954 write access was requested.
38955
38956 @item EFAULT
38957 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38958
38959 @item ENOSPC
38960 No space on device to create the file.
38961
38962 @item EMFILE
38963 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38964
38965 @item ENFILE
38966 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38967 has been reached.
38968
38969 @item EINTR
38970 The call was interrupted by the user.
38971 @end table
38972
38973 @end table
38974
38975 @node close
38976 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38977 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38978
38979 @table @asis
38980 @item Synopsis:
38981 @smallexample
38982 int close(int fd);
38983 @end smallexample
38984
38985 @item Request:
38986 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38987
38988 @item Return value:
38989 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38990
38991 @item Errors:
38992
38993 @table @code
38994 @item EBADF
38995 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38996
38997 @item EINTR
38998 The call was interrupted by the user.
38999 @end table
39000
39001 @end table
39002
39003 @node read
39004 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39005 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39006
39007 @table @asis
39008 @item Synopsis:
39009 @smallexample
39010 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39011 @end smallexample
39012
39013 @item Request:
39014 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39015
39016 @item Return value:
39017 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39018 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39019 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39020
39021 @item Errors:
39022
39023 @table @code
39024 @item EBADF
39025 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39026 reading.
39027
39028 @item EFAULT
39029 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39030
39031 @item EINTR
39032 The call was interrupted by the user.
39033 @end table
39034
39035 @end table
39036
39037 @node write
39038 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39039 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39040
39041 @table @asis
39042 @item Synopsis:
39043 @smallexample
39044 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39045 @end smallexample
39046
39047 @item Request:
39048 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39049
39050 @item Return value:
39051 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39052 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39053 is returned.
39054
39055 @item Errors:
39056
39057 @table @code
39058 @item EBADF
39059 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39060 writing.
39061
39062 @item EFAULT
39063 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39064
39065 @item EFBIG
39066 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39067 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39068
39069 @item ENOSPC
39070 No space on device to write the data.
39071
39072 @item EINTR
39073 The call was interrupted by the user.
39074 @end table
39075
39076 @end table
39077
39078 @node lseek
39079 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39080 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39081
39082 @table @asis
39083 @item Synopsis:
39084 @smallexample
39085 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39086 @end smallexample
39087
39088 @item Request:
39089 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39090
39091 @var{flag} is one of:
39092
39093 @table @code
39094 @item SEEK_SET
39095 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39096
39097 @item SEEK_CUR
39098 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39099 bytes.
39100
39101 @item SEEK_END
39102 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39103 bytes.
39104 @end table
39105
39106 @item Return value:
39107 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39108 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39109 value of -1 is returned.
39110
39111 @item Errors:
39112
39113 @table @code
39114 @item EBADF
39115 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39116
39117 @item ESPIPE
39118 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39119
39120 @item EINVAL
39121 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39122
39123 @item EINTR
39124 The call was interrupted by the user.
39125 @end table
39126
39127 @end table
39128
39129 @node rename
39130 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39131 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39132
39133 @table @asis
39134 @item Synopsis:
39135 @smallexample
39136 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39137 @end smallexample
39138
39139 @item Request:
39140 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39141
39142 @item Return value:
39143 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39144
39145 @item Errors:
39146
39147 @table @code
39148 @item EISDIR
39149 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39150 directory.
39151
39152 @item EEXIST
39153 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39154
39155 @item EBUSY
39156 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39157 process.
39158
39159 @item EINVAL
39160 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39161 of itself.
39162
39163 @item ENOTDIR
39164 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39165 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39166 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39167
39168 @item EFAULT
39169 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39170
39171 @item EACCES
39172 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39173
39174 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39175
39176 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39177
39178 @item ENOENT
39179 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39180
39181 @item EROFS
39182 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39183
39184 @item ENOSPC
39185 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39186 directory entry.
39187
39188 @item EINTR
39189 The call was interrupted by the user.
39190 @end table
39191
39192 @end table
39193
39194 @node unlink
39195 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39196 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39197
39198 @table @asis
39199 @item Synopsis:
39200 @smallexample
39201 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39202 @end smallexample
39203
39204 @item Request:
39205 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39206
39207 @item Return value:
39208 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39209
39210 @item Errors:
39211
39212 @table @code
39213 @item EACCES
39214 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39215
39216 @item EPERM
39217 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39218
39219 @item EBUSY
39220 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39221 being used by another process.
39222
39223 @item EFAULT
39224 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39225
39226 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39227 @var{pathname} was too long.
39228
39229 @item ENOENT
39230 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39231
39232 @item ENOTDIR
39233 A component of the path is not a directory.
39234
39235 @item EROFS
39236 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39237
39238 @item EINTR
39239 The call was interrupted by the user.
39240 @end table
39241
39242 @end table
39243
39244 @node stat/fstat
39245 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39246 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39247 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39248
39249 @table @asis
39250 @item Synopsis:
39251 @smallexample
39252 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39253 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39254 @end smallexample
39255
39256 @item Request:
39257 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39258 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39259
39260 @item Return value:
39261 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39262
39263 @item Errors:
39264
39265 @table @code
39266 @item EBADF
39267 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39268
39269 @item ENOENT
39270 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39271 path is an empty string.
39272
39273 @item ENOTDIR
39274 A component of the path is not a directory.
39275
39276 @item EFAULT
39277 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39278
39279 @item EACCES
39280 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39281
39282 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39283 @var{pathname} was too long.
39284
39285 @item EINTR
39286 The call was interrupted by the user.
39287 @end table
39288
39289 @end table
39290
39291 @node gettimeofday
39292 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39293 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39294
39295 @table @asis
39296 @item Synopsis:
39297 @smallexample
39298 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39299 @end smallexample
39300
39301 @item Request:
39302 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39303
39304 @item Return value:
39305 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39306
39307 @item Errors:
39308
39309 @table @code
39310 @item EINVAL
39311 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39312
39313 @item EFAULT
39314 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39315 @end table
39316
39317 @end table
39318
39319 @node isatty
39320 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39321 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39322
39323 @table @asis
39324 @item Synopsis:
39325 @smallexample
39326 int isatty(int fd);
39327 @end smallexample
39328
39329 @item Request:
39330 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39331
39332 @item Return value:
39333 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39334
39335 @item Errors:
39336
39337 @table @code
39338 @item EINTR
39339 The call was interrupted by the user.
39340 @end table
39341
39342 @end table
39343
39344 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39345 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39346 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39347 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39348 needed.
39349
39350
39351 @node system
39352 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39353 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39354
39355 @table @asis
39356 @item Synopsis:
39357 @smallexample
39358 int system(const char *command);
39359 @end smallexample
39360
39361 @item Request:
39362 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39363
39364 @item Return value:
39365 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39366 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39367 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39368 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39369 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39370 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39371 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39372
39373 @item Errors:
39374
39375 @table @code
39376 @item EINTR
39377 The call was interrupted by the user.
39378 @end table
39379
39380 @end table
39381
39382 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39383 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39384 the host is simplified before it's returned
39385 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39386 is discarded, and the return value consists
39387 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39388
39389 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39390 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39391 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39392
39393 @table @code
39394 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39395 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39396 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39397 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39398
39399 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39400 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39401 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39402 protocol.
39403 @end table
39404
39405 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39406 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39407 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39408
39409 @menu
39410 * Integral Datatypes::
39411 * Pointer Values::
39412 * Memory Transfer::
39413 * struct stat::
39414 * struct timeval::
39415 @end menu
39416
39417 @node Integral Datatypes
39418 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39419 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39420
39421 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39422 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39423 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39424
39425 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39426 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39427
39428 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39429
39430 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39431 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39432
39433 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39434
39435 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39436 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39437 byte order.
39438
39439 @node Pointer Values
39440 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39441 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39442
39443 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39444 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39445 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39446 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39447
39448 @smallexample
39449 @code{1aaf/12}
39450 @end smallexample
39451
39452 @noindent
39453 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39454 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39455 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39456 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39457
39458 @smallexample
39459 @code{123456/d}
39460 @end smallexample
39461
39462 @node Memory Transfer
39463 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39464 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39465
39466 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39467 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39468 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39469 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39470 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39471 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39472 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39473
39474
39475 @node struct stat
39476 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39477 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39478
39479 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39480 is defined as follows:
39481
39482 @smallexample
39483 struct stat @{
39484 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39485 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39486 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39487 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39488 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39489 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39490 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39491 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39492 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39493 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39494 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39495 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39496 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39497 @};
39498 @end smallexample
39499
39500 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39501 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39502 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39503
39504 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39505 range of values.
39506
39507 @table @code
39508
39509 @item st_dev
39510 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39511
39512 @item st_ino
39513 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39514
39515 @item st_mode
39516 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39517 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39518
39519 @item st_uid
39520 @itemx st_gid
39521 @itemx st_rdev
39522 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39523
39524 @item st_atime
39525 @itemx st_mtime
39526 @itemx st_ctime
39527 These values have a host and file system dependent
39528 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39529 support exact timing values.
39530 @end table
39531
39532 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39533 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39534 continuing.
39535
39536 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39537 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39538 get truncated on the target.
39539
39540 @node struct timeval
39541 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39542 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39543
39544 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39545 is defined as follows:
39546
39547 @smallexample
39548 struct timeval @{
39549 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39550 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39551 @};
39552 @end smallexample
39553
39554 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39555 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39556 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39557
39558 @node Constants
39559 @subsection Constants
39560 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39561
39562 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39563 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39564 values before and after the call as needed.
39565
39566 @menu
39567 * Open Flags::
39568 * mode_t Values::
39569 * Errno Values::
39570 * Lseek Flags::
39571 * Limits::
39572 @end menu
39573
39574 @node Open Flags
39575 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39576 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39577
39578 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39579
39580 @smallexample
39581 O_RDONLY 0x0
39582 O_WRONLY 0x1
39583 O_RDWR 0x2
39584 O_APPEND 0x8
39585 O_CREAT 0x200
39586 O_TRUNC 0x400
39587 O_EXCL 0x800
39588 @end smallexample
39589
39590 @node mode_t Values
39591 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39592 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39593
39594 All values are given in octal representation.
39595
39596 @smallexample
39597 S_IFREG 0100000
39598 S_IFDIR 040000
39599 S_IRUSR 0400
39600 S_IWUSR 0200
39601 S_IXUSR 0100
39602 S_IRGRP 040
39603 S_IWGRP 020
39604 S_IXGRP 010
39605 S_IROTH 04
39606 S_IWOTH 02
39607 S_IXOTH 01
39608 @end smallexample
39609
39610 @node Errno Values
39611 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39612 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39613
39614 All values are given in decimal representation.
39615
39616 @smallexample
39617 EPERM 1
39618 ENOENT 2
39619 EINTR 4
39620 EBADF 9
39621 EACCES 13
39622 EFAULT 14
39623 EBUSY 16
39624 EEXIST 17
39625 ENODEV 19
39626 ENOTDIR 20
39627 EISDIR 21
39628 EINVAL 22
39629 ENFILE 23
39630 EMFILE 24
39631 EFBIG 27
39632 ENOSPC 28
39633 ESPIPE 29
39634 EROFS 30
39635 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39636 EUNKNOWN 9999
39637 @end smallexample
39638
39639 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39640 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39641
39642 @node Lseek Flags
39643 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39644 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39645
39646 @smallexample
39647 SEEK_SET 0
39648 SEEK_CUR 1
39649 SEEK_END 2
39650 @end smallexample
39651
39652 @node Limits
39653 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39654 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39655
39656 All values are given in decimal representation.
39657
39658 @smallexample
39659 INT_MIN -2147483648
39660 INT_MAX 2147483647
39661 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39662 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39663 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39664 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39665 @end smallexample
39666
39667 @node File-I/O Examples
39668 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39669 @cindex file-i/o examples
39670
39671 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39672 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39673
39674 @smallexample
39675 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39676 @emph{request memory read from target}
39677 -> @code{m1234,6}
39678 <- XXXXXX
39679 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39680 -> @code{F6}
39681 @end smallexample
39682
39683 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39684 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39685
39686 @smallexample
39687 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39688 @emph{request memory write to target}
39689 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39690 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39691 -> @code{F6}
39692 @end smallexample
39693
39694 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39695 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39696
39697 @smallexample
39698 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39699 -> @code{F-1,9}
39700 @end smallexample
39701
39702 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39703 host is called:
39704
39705 @smallexample
39706 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39707 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39708 <- @code{T02}
39709 @end smallexample
39710
39711 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39712 host is called:
39713
39714 @smallexample
39715 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39716 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39717 <- @code{T02}
39718 @end smallexample
39719
39720 @node Library List Format
39721 @section Library List Format
39722 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39723
39724 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39725 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39726 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39727 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39728 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39729 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39730 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39731 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39732 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39733 are loaded.
39734
39735 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39736 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39737 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39738 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39739
39740 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39741 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39742 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39743 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39744 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39745 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39746
39747 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39748 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39749
39750 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39751 offset, looks like this:
39752
39753 @smallexample
39754 <library-list>
39755 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39756 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39757 </library>
39758 </library-list>
39759 @end smallexample
39760
39761 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39762 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39763
39764 @smallexample
39765 <library-list>
39766 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39767 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39768 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39769 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39770 </library>
39771 </library-list>
39772 @end smallexample
39773
39774 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39775
39776 @smallexample
39777 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39778 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39779 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39780 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39781 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39782 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39783 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39784 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39785 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39786 @end smallexample
39787
39788 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39789 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39790 section for each library.
39791
39792 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39793 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39794 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39795
39796 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39797 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39798 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39799 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39800
39801 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39802 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39803 target, the following parameters are reported:
39804
39805 @itemize @minus
39806 @item
39807 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39808 @code{struct link_map}.
39809 @item
39810 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39811 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39812 @item
39813 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39814 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39815 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39816 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39817 @item
39818 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39819 @end itemize
39820
39821 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39822 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39823 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39824
39825 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39826 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39827
39828 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39829 looks like this:
39830
39831 @smallexample
39832 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39833 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39834 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39835 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39836 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39837 </library-list-svr>
39838 @end smallexample
39839
39840 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39841
39842 @smallexample
39843 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39844 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39845 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39846 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39847 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39848 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39849 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39850 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39851 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39852 @end smallexample
39853
39854 @node Memory Map Format
39855 @section Memory Map Format
39856 @cindex memory map format
39857
39858 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39859 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39860 memory map.
39861
39862 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39863 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39864 lists memory regions.
39865
39866 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39867 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39868
39869 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39870
39871 @smallexample
39872 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39873 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39874 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39875 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39876 <memory-map>
39877 region...
39878 </memory-map>
39879 @end smallexample
39880
39881 Each region can be either:
39882
39883 @itemize
39884
39885 @item
39886 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39887 bytes from there:
39888
39889 @smallexample
39890 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39891 @end smallexample
39892
39893
39894 @item
39895 A region of read-only memory:
39896
39897 @smallexample
39898 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39899 @end smallexample
39900
39901
39902 @item
39903 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39904 bytes in length:
39905
39906 @smallexample
39907 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39908 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39909 </memory>
39910 @end smallexample
39911
39912 @end itemize
39913
39914 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39915 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39916 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39917
39918 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39919
39920 @smallexample
39921 <!-- ................................................... -->
39922 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39923 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39924 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39925 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39926 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39927 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39928 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39929 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39930 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39931 and its type, or device. -->
39932 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39933 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39934 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39935 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39936 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39937 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39938 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39939 @end smallexample
39940
39941 @node Thread List Format
39942 @section Thread List Format
39943 @cindex thread list format
39944
39945 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39946 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39947 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39948 the following structure:
39949
39950 @smallexample
39951 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39952 <threads>
39953 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
39954 ... description ...
39955 </thread>
39956 </threads>
39957 @end smallexample
39958
39959 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39960 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39961 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39962 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
39963 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
39964 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
39965 auxiliary information.
39966
39967 @node Traceframe Info Format
39968 @section Traceframe Info Format
39969 @cindex traceframe info format
39970
39971 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39972 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39973 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39974 collected in a traceframe.
39975
39976 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39977 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39978
39979 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39980 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39981
39982 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39983
39984 @smallexample
39985 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39986 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39987 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39988 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39989 <traceframe-info>
39990 block...
39991 </traceframe-info>
39992 @end smallexample
39993
39994 Each traceframe block can be either:
39995
39996 @itemize
39997
39998 @item
39999 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40000 @var{length} bytes from there:
40001
40002 @smallexample
40003 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40004 @end smallexample
40005
40006 @item
40007 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40008 collected:
40009
40010 @smallexample
40011 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40012 @end smallexample
40013
40014 @end itemize
40015
40016 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40017
40018 @smallexample
40019 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40020 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40021
40022 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40023 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40024 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40025 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40026 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40027 @end smallexample
40028
40029 @node Branch Trace Format
40030 @section Branch Trace Format
40031 @cindex branch trace format
40032
40033 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40034 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40035 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40036 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40037
40038 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40039 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40040
40041 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40042 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40043
40044 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40045
40046 @smallexample
40047 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40048 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40049 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40050 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40051 <btrace>
40052 block...
40053 </btrace>
40054 @end smallexample
40055
40056 @itemize
40057
40058 @item
40059 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40060 and ending at @var{end}:
40061
40062 @smallexample
40063 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40064 @end smallexample
40065
40066 @end itemize
40067
40068 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40069
40070 @smallexample
40071 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40072 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40073
40074 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40075 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40076 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40077
40078 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40079
40080 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40081
40082 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40083 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40084 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40085 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40086 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40087
40088 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40089 @end smallexample
40090
40091 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40092 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40093 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40094
40095 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40096 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40097 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40098
40099 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40100 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40101
40102 @table @code
40103 @item bts
40104 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40105 @table @code
40106 @item size
40107 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40108 @end table
40109 @item pt
40110 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40111 PT}) format.
40112 @table @code
40113 @item size
40114 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40115 @end table
40116 @end table
40117
40118 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40119 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40120
40121 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40122
40123 @smallexample
40124 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40125 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40126
40127 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40128 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40129
40130 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40131 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40132 @end smallexample
40133
40134 @include agentexpr.texi
40135
40136 @node Target Descriptions
40137 @appendix Target Descriptions
40138 @cindex target descriptions
40139
40140 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40141 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40142 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40143 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40144 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40145 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40146 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40147
40148 @itemize @bullet
40149 @item
40150 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40151 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40152 @item
40153 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40154 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40155 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40156 @item
40157 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40158 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40159 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40160 @end itemize
40161
40162 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40163 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40164 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40165 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40166 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40167
40168 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40169 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40170
40171 @menu
40172 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40173 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40174 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40175 descriptions.
40176 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40177 @end menu
40178
40179 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40180 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40181
40182 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40183 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40184 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40185 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40186 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40187 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40188 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40189 Format}.
40190
40191 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40192 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40193 specify a file are:
40194
40195 @table @code
40196 @cindex set tdesc filename
40197 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40198 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40199
40200 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40201 @item unset tdesc filename
40202 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40203 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40204
40205 @cindex show tdesc filename
40206 @item show tdesc filename
40207 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40208 @end table
40209
40210
40211 @node Target Description Format
40212 @section Target Description Format
40213 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40214
40215 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40216 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40217 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40218 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40219 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40220 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40221 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40222
40223 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40224 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40225 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40226 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40227 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40228
40229 Here is a simple target description:
40230
40231 @smallexample
40232 <target version="1.0">
40233 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40234 </target>
40235 @end smallexample
40236
40237 @noindent
40238 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40239 the x86-64 architecture.
40240
40241 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40242 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40243 are explained further below.
40244
40245 @smallexample
40246 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40247 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40248 <target version="1.0">
40249 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40250 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40251 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40252 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40253 </target>
40254 @end smallexample
40255
40256 @noindent
40257 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40258 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40259 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40260 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40261 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40262 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40263 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40264 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40265 the version mismatch.
40266
40267 @subsection Inclusion
40268 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40269 @cindex XInclude
40270 @ifnotinfo
40271 @cindex <xi:include>
40272 @end ifnotinfo
40273
40274 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40275 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40276 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40277 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40278 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40279
40280 @smallexample
40281 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40282 @end smallexample
40283
40284 @noindent
40285 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40286 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40287 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40288 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40289 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40290 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40291 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40292 original description.
40293
40294 @subsection Architecture
40295 @cindex <architecture>
40296
40297 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40298
40299 @smallexample
40300 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40301 @end smallexample
40302
40303 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40304 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40305
40306 @subsection OS ABI
40307 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40308
40309 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40310 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40311
40312 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40313
40314 @smallexample
40315 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40316 @end smallexample
40317
40318 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40319 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40320
40321 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40322 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40323
40324 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40325 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40326
40327 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40328
40329 @smallexample
40330 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40331 @end smallexample
40332
40333 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40334 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40335
40336 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40337 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40338 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40339 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40340 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40341 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40342 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40343
40344 @smallexample
40345 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40346 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40347 @end smallexample
40348
40349 @subsection Features
40350 @cindex <feature>
40351
40352 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40353 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40354 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40355 has this form:
40356
40357 @smallexample
40358 <feature name="@var{name}">
40359 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40360 @var{reg}@dots{}
40361 </feature>
40362 @end smallexample
40363
40364 @noindent
40365 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40366 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40367 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40368 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40369
40370 @subsection Types
40371
40372 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40373 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40374 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40375 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40376 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40377
40378 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40379 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40380 Types must be defined before they are used.
40381
40382 @cindex <vector>
40383 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40384 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40385 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40386 @var{count}:
40387
40388 @smallexample
40389 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40390 @end smallexample
40391
40392 @cindex <union>
40393 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40394 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40395 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40396 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40397
40398 @smallexample
40399 <union id="@var{id}">
40400 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40401 @dots{}
40402 </union>
40403 @end smallexample
40404
40405 @cindex <struct>
40406 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40407 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40408 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40409 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40410 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40411 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40412 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40413 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40414
40415 @smallexample
40416 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40417 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40418 @dots{}
40419 </struct>
40420 @end smallexample
40421
40422 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40423 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40424
40425 @smallexample
40426 <struct id="@var{id}">
40427 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40428 @dots{}
40429 </struct>
40430 @end smallexample
40431
40432 @cindex <flags>
40433 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40434 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40435 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40436 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40437 are supported.
40438
40439 @smallexample
40440 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40441 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40442 @dots{}
40443 </flags>
40444 @end smallexample
40445
40446 @subsection Registers
40447 @cindex <reg>
40448
40449 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40450
40451 @smallexample
40452 <reg name="@var{name}"
40453 bitsize="@var{size}"
40454 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40455 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40456 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40457 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40458 @end smallexample
40459
40460 @noindent
40461 The components are as follows:
40462
40463 @table @var
40464
40465 @item name
40466 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40467
40468 @item bitsize
40469 The register's size, in bits.
40470
40471 @item regnum
40472 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40473 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40474 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40475 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40476 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40477 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40478 in order of increasing register number.
40479
40480 @item save-restore
40481 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40482 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40483 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40484 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40485 ABI.
40486
40487 @item type
40488 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40489 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40490 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40491 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40492 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40493 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40494
40495 @item group
40496 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40497 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40498 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40499 in @code{info registers}.
40500
40501 @end table
40502
40503 @node Predefined Target Types
40504 @section Predefined Target Types
40505 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40506
40507 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40508 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40509 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40510 types. The currently supported types are:
40511
40512 @table @code
40513
40514 @item int8
40515 @itemx int16
40516 @itemx int32
40517 @itemx int64
40518 @itemx int128
40519 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40520
40521 @item uint8
40522 @itemx uint16
40523 @itemx uint32
40524 @itemx uint64
40525 @itemx uint128
40526 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40527
40528 @item code_ptr
40529 @itemx data_ptr
40530 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40531 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40532 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40533 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40534 may be marked as data pointers.
40535
40536 @item ieee_single
40537 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40538
40539 @item ieee_double
40540 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40541
40542 @item arm_fpa_ext
40543 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40544
40545 @item i387_ext
40546 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40547
40548 @item i386_eflags
40549 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40550
40551 @item i386_mxcsr
40552 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40553
40554 @end table
40555
40556 @node Standard Target Features
40557 @section Standard Target Features
40558 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40559
40560 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40561 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40562 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40563 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40564 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40565 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40566 can recognize them.
40567
40568 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40569 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40570 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40571 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40572 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40573 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40574 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40575 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40576
40577 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40578 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40579 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40580
40581 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40582 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40583 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40584 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40585
40586 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40587 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40588 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40589
40590 @menu
40591 * AArch64 Features::
40592 * ARM Features::
40593 * i386 Features::
40594 * MicroBlaze Features::
40595 * MIPS Features::
40596 * M68K Features::
40597 * Nios II Features::
40598 * PowerPC Features::
40599 * S/390 and System z Features::
40600 * TIC6x Features::
40601 @end menu
40602
40603
40604 @node AArch64 Features
40605 @subsection AArch64 Features
40606 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40607
40608 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40609 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40610 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40611
40612 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40613 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40614 and @samp{fpcr}.
40615
40616 @node ARM Features
40617 @subsection ARM Features
40618 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40619
40620 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40621 ARM targets.
40622 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40623 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40624
40625 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40626 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40627 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40628 and @samp{xpsr}.
40629
40630 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40631 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40632
40633 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40634 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40635 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40636 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40637
40638 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40639 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40640 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40641 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40642 halves of the double-precision registers.
40643
40644 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40645 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40646 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40647 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40648 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40649 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40650
40651 @node i386 Features
40652 @subsection i386 Features
40653 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40654
40655 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40656 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40657
40658 @itemize @minus
40659 @item
40660 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40661 @item
40662 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40663 @item
40664 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40665 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40666 @item
40667 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40668 @item
40669 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40670 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40671 @end itemize
40672
40673 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40674
40675 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40676 describe registers:
40677
40678 @itemize @minus
40679 @item
40680 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40681 @item
40682 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40683 @item
40684 @samp{mxcsr}
40685 @end itemize
40686
40687 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40688 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40689 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40690
40691 @itemize @minus
40692 @item
40693 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40694 @item
40695 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40696 @end itemize
40697
40698 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
40699 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40700
40701 @itemize @minus
40702 @item
40703 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40704 @item
40705 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40706 @end itemize
40707
40708 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40709 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40710
40711 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40712 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40713 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40714
40715 @itemize @minus
40716 @item
40717 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40718 @end itemize
40719
40720 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40721
40722 @itemize @minus
40723 @item
40724 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40725 @end itemize
40726
40727 It should
40728 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40729
40730 @itemize @minus
40731 @item
40732 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40733 @item
40734 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40735 @end itemize
40736
40737 It should
40738 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40739
40740 @itemize @minus
40741 @item
40742 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40743 @end itemize
40744
40745 @node MicroBlaze Features
40746 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40747 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40748
40749 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40750 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40751 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40752 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40753 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40754
40755 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40756 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40757
40758 @node MIPS Features
40759 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40760 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40761
40762 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40763 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40764 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40765 on the target.
40766
40767 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40768 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40769 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40770
40771 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40772 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40773 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40774 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40775
40776 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40777 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40778 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40779 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40780
40781 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40782 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40783 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40784
40785 @node M68K Features
40786 @subsection M68K Features
40787 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40788
40789 @table @code
40790 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40791 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40792 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40793 One of those features must be always present.
40794 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40795 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40796 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40797 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40798
40799 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40800 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40801 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40802 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40803 @end table
40804
40805 @node Nios II Features
40806 @subsection Nios II Features
40807 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40808
40809 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40810 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40811 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40812 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40813 @samp{mpuacc}).
40814
40815 @node PowerPC Features
40816 @subsection PowerPC Features
40817 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40818
40819 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40820 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40821 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40822 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40823
40824 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40825 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40826
40827 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40828 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40829 and @samp{vrsave}.
40830
40831 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40832 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40833 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40834 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40835 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40836 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40837
40838 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40839 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40840 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40841 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40842 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40843 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40844 user.
40845
40846 @node S/390 and System z Features
40847 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40848 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40849 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40850
40851 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40852 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40853 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40854 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40855 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40856 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40857 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40858 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40859 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40860
40861 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40862 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40863 @samp{fpc}.
40864
40865 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40866 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40867
40868 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40869 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40870 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40871 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40872 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40873 32-bit wide.
40874
40875 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40876 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40877 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40878
40879 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40880 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40881 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40882 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40883 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40884 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40885 @samp{v31}.
40886
40887 @node TIC6x Features
40888 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40889 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40890 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40891 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40892 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40893 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40894
40895 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40896 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40897 through @samp{B31}.
40898
40899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40900 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40901
40902 @node Operating System Information
40903 @appendix Operating System Information
40904 @cindex operating system information
40905
40906 @menu
40907 * Process list::
40908 @end menu
40909
40910 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40911 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40912 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40913 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40914 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40915 on a different aspect of target.
40916
40917 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40918 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40919 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40920 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40921
40922 @node Process list
40923 @appendixsection Process list
40924 @cindex operating system information, process list
40925
40926 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40927 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40928 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40929 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40930
40931 An example document is:
40932
40933 @smallexample
40934 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40935 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40936 <osdata type="processes">
40937 <item>
40938 <column name="pid">1</column>
40939 <column name="user">root</column>
40940 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40941 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40942 </item>
40943 </osdata>
40944 @end smallexample
40945
40946 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40947 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40948 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40949 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40950 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40951 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40952 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40953
40954 @node Trace File Format
40955 @appendix Trace File Format
40956 @cindex trace file format
40957
40958 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40959 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40960
40961 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40962 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40963 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40964 in the future.
40965
40966 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40967 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40968 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40969 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40970 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40971 of this section.
40972
40973 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40974
40975 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40976 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40977 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40978 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40979 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40980 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40981 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40982 endianness.
40983
40984 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40985
40986 @table @code
40987 @item R @var{bytes}
40988 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40989 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40990 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40991 hexadecimal encoding.
40992
40993 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40994 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40995 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40996 @var{length} bytes.
40997
40998 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40999 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41000 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41001
41002 @end table
41003
41004 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41005 of blocks.
41006
41007 @node Index Section Format
41008 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41009 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41010 @cindex index section format
41011
41012 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41013 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41014 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41015 description.
41016
41017 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41018 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41019 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41020 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41021 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41022 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41023
41024 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41025
41026 @enumerate
41027 @item
41028 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41029 unless otherwise noted:
41030
41031 @enumerate
41032 @item
41033 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41034 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41035 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41036 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41037 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41038 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41039 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41040
41041 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41042 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41043 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41044 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41045
41046 @item
41047 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41048
41049 @item
41050 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41051 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41052 to the next offset.
41053
41054 @item
41055 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41056
41057 @item
41058 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41059
41060 @item
41061 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41062 @end enumerate
41063
41064 @item
41065 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41066 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41067 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41068 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41069 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41070 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41071 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41072 CU indices.
41073
41074 @item
41075 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41076 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41077 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41078 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41079
41080 @item
41081 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41082 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41083
41084 @enumerate
41085 @item
41086 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41087
41088 @item
41089 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41090 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41091
41092 @item
41093 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41094 @end enumerate
41095
41096 @item
41097 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41098 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41099
41100 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41101 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41102 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41103 constant pool.
41104
41105 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41106 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41107 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41108
41109 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41110 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41111 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41112 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41113 index version:
41114
41115 @table @asis
41116 @item Version 4
41117 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41118
41119 @item Versions 5 to 7
41120 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41121 @end table
41122
41123 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41124
41125 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41126 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41127 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41128 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41129 collision.
41130
41131 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41132 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41133 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41134 the code.
41135
41136 @item
41137 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41138 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41139 strings.
41140
41141 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41142 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41143 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41144 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41145 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41146 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41147
41148 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41149 @end enumerate
41150
41151 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41152 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41153 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41154
41155 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41156 (bit 0 = LSB):
41157
41158 @table @asis
41159
41160 @item Bits 0-23
41161 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41162 @item Bits 24-27
41163 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41164 @item Bits 28-30
41165 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41166
41167 @table @asis
41168 @item 0
41169 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41170 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41171 with previous versions of the index.
41172 @item 1
41173 The symbol is a type.
41174 @item 2
41175 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41176 @item 3
41177 The symbol is a function.
41178 @item 4
41179 Any other kind of symbol.
41180 @item 5,6,7
41181 These values are reserved.
41182 @end table
41183
41184 @item Bit 31
41185 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41186
41187 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41188 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41189 @value{GDBN} sources.
41190
41191 @end table
41192
41193 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41194 global/static attributes in the index.
41195
41196 @smallexample
41197 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41198 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41199 switch (die->tag)
41200 @{
41201 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41202 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41203 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41204 kind = TYPE;
41205 is_static = 1;
41206 break;
41207 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41208 kind = VARIABLE;
41209 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41210 break;
41211 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41212 kind = FUNCTION;
41213 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41214 break;
41215 case DW_TAG_constant:
41216 kind = VARIABLE;
41217 is_static = ! is_external;
41218 break;
41219 case DW_TAG_variable:
41220 kind = VARIABLE;
41221 is_static = ! is_external;
41222 break;
41223 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41224 kind = TYPE;
41225 is_static = 0;
41226 break;
41227 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41228 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41229 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41230 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41231 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41232 kind = TYPE;
41233 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41234 break;
41235 default:
41236 assert (0);
41237 @}
41238 @end smallexample
41239
41240 @node Man Pages
41241 @appendix Manual pages
41242 @cindex Man pages
41243
41244 @menu
41245 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41246 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41247 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41248 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41249 @end menu
41250
41251 @node gdb man
41252 @heading gdb man
41253
41254 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41255
41256 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41257 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41258 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41259 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41260 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41261 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41262 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41263 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41264 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41265 @c man end
41266
41267 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41268 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41269 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41270 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41271
41272 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41273 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41274
41275 @itemize @bullet
41276 @item
41277 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41278
41279 @item
41280 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41281
41282 @item
41283 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41284
41285 @item
41286 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41287 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41288 @end itemize
41289
41290 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41291 Modula-2.
41292
41293 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41294 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41295 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41296 by using the command @code{help}.
41297
41298 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41299 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41300 executable program as the argument:
41301
41302 @smallexample
41303 gdb program
41304 @end smallexample
41305
41306 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41307
41308 @smallexample
41309 gdb program core
41310 @end smallexample
41311
41312 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41313 to debug a running process:
41314
41315 @smallexample
41316 gdb program 1234
41317 gdb -p 1234
41318 @end smallexample
41319
41320 @noindent
41321 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41322 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41323 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41324
41325 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41326
41327 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41328 @table @env
41329 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41330 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41331
41332 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41333 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41334
41335 @item bt
41336 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41337
41338 @item print @var{expr}
41339 Display the value of an expression.
41340
41341 @item c
41342 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41343
41344 @item next
41345 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41346 function calls in the line.
41347
41348 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41349 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41350
41351 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41352 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41353
41354 @item step
41355 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41356 function calls in the line.
41357
41358 @item help [@var{name}]
41359 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41360 about using @value{GDBN}.
41361
41362 @item quit
41363 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41364 @end table
41365
41366 @ifset man
41367 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41368 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41369 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41370 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41371 @end ifset
41372 @c man end
41373
41374 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41375 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41376 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41377 encountered with no
41378 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41379 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41380 Many options have
41381 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41382 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41383 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41384 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41385 more usual convention.)
41386
41387 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41388 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41389 option is used.
41390
41391 @table @env
41392 @item -help
41393 @itemx -h
41394 List all options, with brief explanations.
41395
41396 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41397 @itemx -s @var{file}
41398 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41399
41400 @item -write
41401 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41402
41403 @item -exec=@var{file}
41404 @itemx -e @var{file}
41405 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41406 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41407 dump.
41408
41409 @item -se=@var{file}
41410 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41411 file.
41412
41413 @item -core=@var{file}
41414 @itemx -c @var{file}
41415 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41416
41417 @item -command=@var{file}
41418 @itemx -x @var{file}
41419 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41420
41421 @item -ex @var{command}
41422 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41423
41424 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41425 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41426 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41427
41428 @item -nh
41429 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41430
41431 @item -nx
41432 @itemx -n
41433 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41434
41435 @item -quiet
41436 @itemx -q
41437 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41438 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41439
41440 @item -batch
41441 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41442 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41443 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41444 commands in the command files.
41445
41446 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41447 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41448 more useful, the message
41449
41450 @smallexample
41451 Program exited normally.
41452 @end smallexample
41453
41454 @noindent
41455 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41456 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41457
41458 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41459 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41460 instead of the current directory.
41461
41462 @item -fullname
41463 @itemx -f
41464 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41465 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41466 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41467 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41468 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41469 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41470 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41471 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41472
41473 @item -b @var{bps}
41474 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41475 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41476
41477 @item -tty=@var{device}
41478 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41479 @end table
41480 @c man end
41481
41482 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41483 @ifset man
41484 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41485 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41486 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41487
41488 @smallexample
41489 info gdb
41490 @end smallexample
41491
41492 @noindent
41493 should give you access to the complete manual.
41494
41495 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41496 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41497 @end ifset
41498 @c man end
41499
41500 @node gdbserver man
41501 @heading gdbserver man
41502
41503 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41504 @format
41505 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41506 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41507
41508 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41509
41510 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41511 @c man end
41512 @end format
41513
41514 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41515 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41516 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41517
41518 @ifclear man
41519 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41520 @end ifclear
41521 @ifset man
41522 Usage (server (target) side):
41523 @end ifset
41524
41525 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41526 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41527 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41528 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41529
41530 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41531 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41532 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41533
41534 @smallexample
41535 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41536 @end smallexample
41537
41538 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41539
41540 @smallexample
41541 @ifset man
41542 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41543 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41544 @end ifset
41545 @ifclear man
41546 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41547 @end ifclear
41548 @end smallexample
41549
41550 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41551 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41552 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41553
41554 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41555
41556 @smallexample
41557 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41558 @end smallexample
41559
41560 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41561 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41562 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41563 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41564 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41565 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41566 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41567 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41568 print an error message and exit.
41569
41570 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41571 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41572
41573 @smallexample
41574 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41575 @end smallexample
41576
41577 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41578 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41579
41580 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41581 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41582 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41583 the program you want to debug.
41584
41585 @smallexample
41586 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41587 @end smallexample
41588
41589 @ifclear man
41590 @subheading Usage (host side)
41591 @end ifclear
41592 @ifset man
41593 Usage (host side):
41594 @end ifset
41595
41596 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41597 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41598 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41599 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41600 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41601 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41602 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41603 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41604 descriptor. For example:
41605
41606 @smallexample
41607 @ifset man
41608 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41609 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41610 @end ifset
41611 @ifclear man
41612 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41613 @end ifclear
41614 @end smallexample
41615
41616 @noindent
41617 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41618
41619 @smallexample
41620 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41621 @end smallexample
41622
41623 @noindent
41624 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41625 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41626 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41627 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41628 `Connection refused'.
41629
41630 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41631 described in
41632 @ifset man
41633 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41634 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41635 @end ifset
41636 @ifclear man
41637 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41638 @end ifclear
41639 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41640
41641 @smallexample
41642 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41643 @end smallexample
41644
41645 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41646 case.
41647 @c man end
41648
41649 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41650 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41651
41652 @itemize @bullet
41653
41654 @item
41655 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41656
41657 @smallexample
41658 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41659 @end smallexample
41660
41661 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41662 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41663 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41664 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41665 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41666 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41667 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41668
41669 @item
41670 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41671 program:
41672
41673 @smallexample
41674 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41675 @end smallexample
41676
41677 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41678 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41679 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41680 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41681
41682 @item
41683 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41684
41685 @smallexample
41686 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41687 @end smallexample
41688
41689 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41690 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41691 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41692 debug several processes in the same session.
41693 @end itemize
41694
41695 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41696
41697 @table @env
41698
41699 @item --help
41700 List all options, with brief explanations.
41701
41702 @item --version
41703 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41704
41705 @item --attach
41706 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41707
41708 @smallexample
41709 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41710 @end smallexample
41711
41712 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41713 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41714
41715 @item --multi
41716 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41717 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41718 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41719 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41720
41721 @smallexample
41722 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41723 @end smallexample
41724
41725 @item --debug
41726 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41727 process.
41728 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41729 the developers.
41730
41731 @item --remote-debug
41732 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41733 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41734 the developers.
41735
41736 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41737 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41738 of debugging output.
41739 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41740
41741 @item --wrapper
41742 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41743 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41744 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41745 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41746
41747 @item --once
41748 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41749 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41750 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41751 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41752
41753 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41754
41755 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41756 @c QDisableRandomization.
41757
41758 @end table
41759 @c man end
41760
41761 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41762 @ifset man
41763 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41764 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41765 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41766
41767 @smallexample
41768 info gdb
41769 @end smallexample
41770
41771 should give you access to the complete manual.
41772
41773 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41774 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41775 @end ifset
41776 @c man end
41777
41778 @node gcore man
41779 @heading gcore
41780
41781 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41782
41783 @format
41784 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41785 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41786 @c man end
41787 @end format
41788
41789 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41790 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41791 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41792 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41793 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41794 running without any change.
41795 @c man end
41796
41797 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41798 @table @env
41799 @item -o @var{filename}
41800 The optional argument
41801 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41802 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41803 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41804 @end table
41805 @c man end
41806
41807 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41808 @ifset man
41809 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41810 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41811 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41812
41813 @smallexample
41814 info gdb
41815 @end smallexample
41816
41817 @noindent
41818 should give you access to the complete manual.
41819
41820 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41821 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41822 @end ifset
41823 @c man end
41824
41825 @node gdbinit man
41826 @heading gdbinit
41827
41828 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41829
41830 @format
41831 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41832 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41833 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41834 @end ifset
41835
41836 ~/.gdbinit
41837
41838 ./.gdbinit
41839 @c man end
41840 @end format
41841
41842 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41843 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41844 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41845 described in
41846 @ifset man
41847 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41848 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41849 @end ifset
41850 @ifclear man
41851 @ref{Sequences}.
41852 @end ifclear
41853
41854 Please read more in
41855 @ifset man
41856 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41857 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41858 @end ifset
41859 @ifclear man
41860 @ref{Startup}.
41861 @end ifclear
41862
41863 @table @env
41864 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41865 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41866 @end ifset
41867 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41868 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41869 @end ifclear
41870 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41871 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41872 See more in
41873 @ifset man
41874 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41875 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41876 @end ifset
41877 @ifclear man
41878 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41879 @end ifclear
41880
41881 @item ~/.gdbinit
41882 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41883 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41884
41885 @item ./.gdbinit
41886 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41887 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41888 See more in
41889 @ifset man
41890 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41891 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41892 @end ifset
41893 @ifclear man
41894 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41895 @end ifclear
41896 @end table
41897 @c man end
41898
41899 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41900 @ifset man
41901 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41902
41903 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41904 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41905 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41906
41907 @smallexample
41908 info gdb
41909 @end smallexample
41910
41911 should give you access to the complete manual.
41912
41913 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41914 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41915 @end ifset
41916 @c man end
41917
41918 @include gpl.texi
41919
41920 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41921 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41922 @include fdl.texi
41923
41924 @node Concept Index
41925 @unnumbered Concept Index
41926
41927 @printindex cp
41928
41929 @node Command and Variable Index
41930 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41931
41932 @printindex fn
41933
41934 @tex
41935 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41936 % meantime:
41937 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41938 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41939 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41940 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41941 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41942 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41943 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41944 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41945 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41946 \page\colophon
41947 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41948 @end tex
41949
41950 @bye
This page took 1.017828 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.